Form 8-K (Amendment No. 1)

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

FORM 8-K/A

(AMENDMENT NO. 1)

 

 

CURRENT REPORT

Pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d)

of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934

Date of Report (Date of earliest event reported): August 1, 2008 (July 24, 2008)

 

 

THE NASDAQ OMX GROUP, INC.

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

 

 

 

Delaware   000-32651   52-1165937

(State or other jurisdiction

of incorporation)

  (Commission File Number)  

(I.R.S. Employer

Identification No.)

One Liberty Plaza, New York, New York 10006

(Address of principal executive offices) (Zip code)

Registrant’s telephone number, including area code: +1 212 401 8700

No change since last report

(Former Name or Address, If Changed Since Last Report)

 

 

Check the appropriate box below if the Form 8-K filing is intended to simultaneously satisfy the filing obligation of the registrant under any of the following provisions:

 

¨ Written communications pursuant to Rule 425 under the Securities Act (17 CFR 230.425)

 

¨ Soliciting material pursuant to Rule 14a-12 under the Exchange Act (17 CFR 240.14a-12)

 

¨ Pre-commencement communications pursuant to Rule 14d-2(b) under the Exchange Act (17 CFR 240.14d-2(b))

 

¨ Pre-commencement communications pursuant to Rule 13e-4(c) under the Exchange Act (17 CFR 240.13e-4(c))

 

 

 

EXPLANATORY NOTE

This Current Report on Form 8-K/A, or Form 8-K/A, dated August 1, 2008, amends the Current Report on Form 8-K filed by The NASDAQ OMX Group, Inc., or NASDAQ OMX, on July 29, 2008, concerning the acquisition of the Philadelphia Stock Exchange, Inc. and Subsidiaries, or PHLX, occurring on July 24, 2008. This Form 8-K/A includes the required historical financial information of PHLX and the required pro forma financial statements of the combined entity, each as required by Item 9.01 of Form 8-K. In addition, the required historical financial information of OMX AB (publ), or OMX, is also included in this Form 8-K/A. The business combination of The Nasdaq Stock Market, Inc. with OMX and the acquisition of a 33 1/3% interest in the Dubai International Financial Exchange, or DIFX, occurred on February 27, 2008 (collectively, the Transactions). As such, the financial information for OMX for the period January 1, 2007 through December 31, 2007 is also included in the unaudited

 

1


pro forma condensed combined statement of income for the year ended December 31, 2007 in this Form 8-K/A. In addition, the financial information for OMX for the period January 1, 2008 through February 26, 2008 is also included in the unaudited pro forma condensed combined statement of income for the three months ended March 31, 2008 in this Form 8-K/A. Since balance sheet financial information for OMX is included in NASDAQ OMX’s historical balance sheet at March 31, 2008, separate pro forma balance sheet data for OMX is not presented. All required historical financial statements of PHLX and OMX are hereby incorporated by reference in this Form 8-K/A and shall be deemed filed for purposes of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. The pro forma financial statements of the combined entity are intended to be furnished pursuant to Item 9.01(b). Such information, including Exhibit 99.5 attached hereto, shall not be deemed “filed” for purposes of Section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, nor shall it be deemed incorporated by reference into any filing under the Securities Act of 1933, except as shall be expressly set forth by specific reference in such filing.

Throughout this Form 8-K/A, including the exhibits hereto, unless otherwise specified:

 

   

“Nasdaq” refers to The Nasdaq Stock Market, Inc., as that entity operated prior to the Transactions.

 

   

“OMX” refers to OMX AB (publ), as that entity operated prior to the Transactions.

 

   

“PHLX” refers to the Philadelphia Stock Exchange, Inc. and Subsidiaries, as that entity operated prior to the acquisition.

 

   

“The NASDAQ OMX Group,” “NASDAQ OMX,” “we,” “us” and “our” refer to The NASDAQ OMX Group, Inc.

 

   

“SEK” refers to the lawful currency of Sweden.

Section 9 – Financial Statements and Exhibits

 

Item 9.01. Financial Statements and Exhibits.

 

(a) Financial Statements of Businesses Acquired.

PHLX

Attached as Exhibit 99.1 hereto and incorporated herein by reference are the unaudited consolidated balance sheets of PHLX as of March 31, 2008 and 2007, and the related unaudited consolidated statements of operations, stockholders’ equity and cash flows for the three months ended March 31, 2008 and 2007 and the related notes to such unaudited consolidated financial statements.

Attached as Exhibit 99.2 hereto and incorporated herein by reference are the audited consolidated balance sheets of PHLX as of December 31, 2007 and 2006, and the related consolidated statements of operations, stockholders’ equity and cash flows for each of the two years in the period ended December 31, 2007 and the related notes to such consolidated financial statements.

OMX

Attached as Exhibit 99.3 hereto and incorporated herein by reference are the audited consolidated balance sheets of OMX as of December 31, 2007 and 2006, and the related consolidated statements of income, changes in stockholders’ equity and cash flows for each of the two years in the period ended December 31, 2007 and the related notes to such consolidated financial statements.

Attached as Exhibit 99.4 hereto and incorporated herein by reference are the audited consolidated balance sheets of OMX as of December 31, 2006 and 2005, and the related consolidated statements of income, changes in stockholders’ equity and cash flows for each of the two years in the period ended December 31, 2006 and the related notes to such consolidated financial statements.

 

(b) Pro Forma Financial Information.

Attached as Exhibit 99.5 hereto and incorporated by reference herein are the:

 

   

Unaudited pro forma condensed combined statement of income of NASDAQ OMX for the year ended December 31, 2007.

 

   

Unaudited pro forma condensed combined balance sheet of NASDAQ OMX as of March 31, 2008 and the unaudited pro forma condensed combined statement of income of NASDAQ OMX for the three months ended March 31, 2008.

 

   

Notes to the unaudited pro forma condensed combined financial statements of NASDAQ OMX.

The unaudited pro forma condensed combined financial information is presented for informational purposes only. The pro forma data is not necessarily indicative of what NASDAQ OMX’s financial position or results of operations actually would have been had the PHLX acquisition and the Transactions been completed at and as of the dates indicated. In addition, the unaudited pro forma condensed combined financial information does not purport to project the future financial position or operating results of NASDAQ OMX.

 

2


(c) Not applicable.

 

(d) Exhibits

Exhibit 23.1 – Consent of Independent Certified Public Accountants, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania

Exhibit 23.2 – Consent of Independent Auditor, Stockholm, Sweden

Exhibit 23.3 – Consent of Independent Auditor, Stockholm, Sweden

Exhibit 99.1 – Unaudited Consolidated Financial Statements–The Philadelphia Stock Exchange, Inc. and Subsidiaries:

 

   

Consolidated Balance Sheets at March 31, 2008 and 2007

 

   

Consolidated Statements of Operations for the three months ended March 31, 2008 and 2007

 

   

Consolidated Statements of Shareholders’ Equity for the three months ended March 31, 2008 and 2007

 

   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the three months ended March 31, 2008 and 2007

 

   

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Exhibit 99.2 – Consolidated Financial Statements and Report of Independent Certified Public Accountants – The Philadelphia Stock Exchange, Inc. and Subsidiaries:

 

   

Consolidated Balance Sheets at December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

   

Consolidated Statements of Operations for the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

   

Consolidated Statements of Shareholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

   

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Exhibit 99.3 – Consolidated Financial Statements and Report of Independent Auditor – OMX AB:

 

   

Consolidated Income Statements for the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

   

Consolidated Balance Sheets at December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

   

Changes in Consolidated Shareholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

   

Consolidated Cash Flow Statements for the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

   

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

Exhibit 99.4 – Consolidated Financial Statements and Report of Independent Auditor – OMX AB:

 

   

Consolidated Income Statements for the years ended December 31, 2006 and 2005

 

   

Consolidated Balance Sheets at December 31, 2006 and 2005

 

   

Changes in Consolidated Shareholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2006 and 2005

 

   

Consolidated Cash Flow Statements for the years ended December 31, 2006 and 2005

 

   

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

Exhibit 99.5 – Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Combined Financial Statements of The NASDAQ OMX Group, Inc.:

 

   

Unaudited Pro Form Condensed Combined Statement of Income for the year ended December 31, 2007

 

   

Unaudited Pro Form Condensed Combined Balance Sheet as of March 31, 2008

 

   

Unaudited Pro Form Condensed Combined Statement of Income for the three months ended March 31, 2008

 

   

Notes to Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Combined Financial Statements

Forward Looking Information

The U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission, or SEC, encourages companies to disclose forward-looking information so that investors can better understand a company’s future prospects and make informed investment decisions. This Form 8-K/A and the exhibits hereto contain these types of statements. Words such as “anticipates,” “estimates,” “expects,” “projects,” “intends,” “plans,” “believes” and words or terms of similar substance used in connection with any discussion of future operating results or financial performance identify forward-looking statements.

 

3


These forward-looking statements involve certain risks and uncertainties. Factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from those contemplated by the forward-looking statements include, among others, the following:

 

   

our operating results may be lower than expected;

 

   

our ability to successfully integrate the businesses of Nasdaq, OMX and PHLX, including the fact that such integration may be more difficult, time consuming or costly than expected and our ability to realize synergies from the business combination of Nasdaq and OMX, the acquisition of PHLX, as well as our proposed acquisition of The Boston Stock Exchange;

 

   

loss of significant trading volume or listed companies;

 

   

covenants in the indenture governing our indebtedness and the agreements governing our other indebtedness, which may restrict the operation of our business;

 

   

economic, political and market conditions and fluctuations, including interest rate risk, inherent in U.S. and international operations;

 

   

government and industry regulation; and

 

   

adverse changes in the securities markets generally.

In connection with the acquisition of PHLX and the Transactions, factors that may cause actual results to differ materially from those contemplated by such forward-looking statements include, but are not limited to, the following: (i) the inability to realize, fully or at all, expected cost savings and other synergies from the acquisition of PHLX and the Transactions within the expected time frame; (ii) costs or difficulties related to the integration of PHLX and OMX that are greater than expected; (iii) lower revenues following the acquisition of PHLX and the Transactions than expected; (iv) regulation related to the acquisition of PHLX and the business combination of Nasdaq and OMX; and (v) general economic conditions that are less favorable than expected.

Most of these factors are difficult to predict accurately and are generally beyond our control. You should consider the uncertainty and risk resulting from such uncertainty in connection with any forward-looking statements that may be made herein. Readers are cautioned not to place undue reliance on these forward-looking statements and to carefully review the risk factors and other information detailed in Nasdaq’s annual report on Form 10-K and periodic reports filed with the SEC. Except for our ongoing obligations to disclose material information under the federal securities laws, we undertake no obligation to release publicly any revisions to any forward-looking statement set forth herein, or to report events or the occurrence of unanticipated events. For any forward-looking statements contained herein, we claim the protection of the safe harbor for forward-looking statements contained in the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995.

 

4


SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned hereunto duly authorized.

 

Dated: August 1, 2008     THE NASDAQ OMX GROUP, INC.
    By:   /s/ David P. Warren
    Name:   David P. Warren
    Title:   Executive Vice President and Chief
      Financial Officer

 

5

Exhibit 23.1

Exhibit 23.1

CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT CERTIFIED PUBLIC ACCOUNTANTS

We have issued our report dated April 30, 2008 accompanying the consolidated financial statements of Philadelphia Stock Exchange, Inc. and subsidiaries for the year ended December 31, 2007 which is included in this Form 8-K/A of The NASDAQ OMX Group, Inc. We hereby consent to use of the aforementioned report in the Form 8-K/A of The NASDAQ OMX Group, Inc. dated August 1, 2008 and the incorporation by reference of the aforementioned report in Form S-3 (File No. 333-131373, effective January 30, 2006) and on Form S-8 (File No. 333-110602, effective November 19, 2003; File No. 333-106945, effective October 7, 2003; File No. 333-76064, effective December 28, 2001; File No. 333-72852, effective November 6, 2001 and File No 333-70992, effective October 4, 2001) of The NASDAQ OMX Group, Inc. (formerly, NASDAQ Stock Market, Inc.).

 

/s/ GRANT THORNTON LLP
Philadelphia, Pennsylvania
August 1, 2008
Exhibit 23.2

Exhibit 23.2

CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITOR

We hereby consent to the incorporation by reference in the Registration Statements on Form S-3 (File No. 333-131373) and Form S-8 (File Nos. 333-110602, 333-106945, 333-76064, 333-72852, and 333-70992) of The NASDAQ OMX Group, Inc., of our report dated February 20, 2008 relating to the consolidated financial statements of OMX AB, which appears in the Current Report on Form 8-K/A of The NASDAQ OMX Group, Inc., dated August 1, 2008.

 

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers AB
Stockholm, Sweden
August 1, 2008
Exhibit 23.3

Exhibit 23.3

CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITOR

We hereby consent to the incorporation by reference in the Registration Statements on Form S-3 (File No. 333-131373) and Form S-8 (File Nos. 333-110602, 333-106945, 333-76064, 333-72852, and 333-70992) of The NASDAQ OMX Group, Inc., of our report dated August 6, 2007 relating to the consolidated financial statements of OMX AB, which appears in the Current Report on Form 8-K/A of The NASDAQ OMX Group, Inc., dated August 1, 2008.

 

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers AB
Stockholm, Sweden
August 1, 2008
Exhibit 99.1

Exhibit 99.1

Consolidated Financial Statements

The Philadelphia Stock Exchange, Inc. and Subsidiaries

March 31, 2008 and 2007

(Unaudited)

 

Contents

   Page

Consolidated Balance Sheets

   2

Consolidated Statements of Operations

   3

Consolidated Statements of Shareholders’ Equity

   4

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

   5

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

   6


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

March 31, 2008 and 2007

(Unaudited)

 

      2008     2007  
     (Dollars in thousands)  

ASSETS

    

Current assets

    

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 51,239     $ 46,403  

Restricted cash

     3,061       718  

Accounts receivable, net

    

Members

     10,665       8,083  

Payment for order flow

     7,047       5,070  

Others

     4,581       4,668  

Prepaid and other assets

     5,777       4,541  

Deferred income taxes

     —         291  
                

Total current assets

     82,370       69,774  
                

Clearing and depository items

     6,921       7,135  
                

Other assets

    

Advance to clearing accounts

     3,124       3,746  

Investments available for sale, at market

     16,547       16,196  

Investments held to maturity, at amortized cost

     45       105  

Investments held to maturity, at amortized cost - restricted

     3,023       3,013  

Investment in affiliate

     333       333  

Equipment and leasehold improvements, net of accumulated depreciation and amortization

     60,852       46,442  

Other assets

     289       382  

Deferred income taxes, net

     19,720       9,412  
                

Total other assets

     103,933       79,629  
                

Total assets

   $ 193,224     $ 156,538  
                

LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

    

Current liabilities

    

Accounts payable and other liabilities

   $ 24,546     $ 18,645  

Payment for order flow

     9,697       5,377  

Deferred revenue

     5,648       5,356  

Deferred credits

     501       451  

Covered sale fee payable

     216       423  

Deferred income taxes, net

     171       —    
                

Total current liabilities

     40,779       30,252  
                

Clearing and depository items

     6,921       7,135  
                

Accrued retiree benefits

     12,977       11,203  

Management equity plan

     24,100       6,370  

Deferred credits

     5,126       4,866  

Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan

     4,982       4,177  
                
     47,185       26,616  
                

Total liabilities

     94,885       64,003  
                

Shareholders’ equity

    

Common Stock, Class B, $0.01 par value 1,000,000 shares authorized, 441,504 shares issued and outstanding

     4       4  

Preferred Stock, $0.01 par value, 100,000 shares authorized, 1 share issued and outstanding

     —         —    

Additional paid-in-capital

     113,614       113,614  

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

     (3,678 )     (3,525 )

Accumulated deficit

     (8,361 )     (14,318 )
                
     101,579       95,775  

Treasury stock

     (3,240 )     (3,240 )
                

Total shareholders’ equity

     98,339       92,535  
                

Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity

   $ 193,224     $ 156,538  
                

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

2


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

Quarter ended March 31, 2008 and 2007

(Unaudited)

 

     2008    2007
     (Dollars in thousands)

Revenues

     

Transaction fees

   $ 31,144    $ 19,179

Other services

     

Clearing and settlement

     416      517

Security price data and floor charges

     3,739      3,304

Regulatory fees

     2,811      2,574

Dividend and interest income

     497      756

Other

     1,102      1,155
             

Total revenues

     39,709      27,485
             

Operating expenses

     

Staffing costs

     17,735      12,520

Data processing and communication costs

     2,928      2,841

Depreciation and amortization

     3,400      2,911

Occupancy costs

     1,316      1,057

Professional services

     2,296      3,209

License costs

     47      12

Governance compensation

     1,495      447

Other

     3,280      1,968
             

Total operating expenses

     32,497      24,965
             

Income (loss) before income tax expense (benefit)

     7,212      2,520

Income tax expense (benefit)

     3,217      1,215
             

Net income

   $ 3,995    $ 1,305
             

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

3


Philadelphia Stock Exchange, Inc. and Subsidiaries

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

Quarter Ended March 31, 2008 and Year ended December 31, 2007

(In thousands, except share amounts)

(Unaudited)

 

     Preferred Stock    Class A Common Stock     Class B Common Stock    Additional
paid-in
capital
   Accumulated
other
comprehensive
loss
    Accumulated
deficit
    Treasury
Stock
    Total
stockholders’
equity
 
     Shares    Amount    Shares     Amount     Shares    Amount            

Balance, December 31, 2006

   1    $ —      46,900     $ 1     394,604    $ 4    $ 113,614    $ (3,715 )   $ (15,623 )   $ (3,240 )   $ 91,041  
                                                                             

Change in treasury seats

                              —    

Capital contributions

                              —    

Conversion of Class A Common Stock

         (46,900 )     (1 )   46,900      —                 (1 )

Issuance of warrants

                              —    

Net loss

                          3,267         3,267  

Other comprehensive income, net of reclassifications and taxes

   —        —      —         —       —        —        —        424       —         —         424  
                                                                             

Total comprehensive loss

                            $ 3,691  
                                 

Balance, December 31, 2007

   1      —      —         —       441,504      4      113,614      (3,291 )     (12,356 )     (3,240 )     94,731  
                                                                             

Change in treasury seats

                              —    

Capital contributions

                              —    

Issuance of warrants

                              —    

Net income

                          3,995         3,995  

Other comprehensive income, net of reclassifications and taxes

   —        —      —         —       —        —        —        (387 )     —         —         (387 )
                                                                             

Total comprehensive loss

                            $ 3,608  
                                 

Balance, March 31, 2008

   1    $ —      —       $ —       441,504    $ 4      113,614      (3,678 )     (8,361 )     (3,240 )   $ 98,339  
                                                                             

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

4


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

Quarter ended March 31, 2008 and 2007

(Unaudited)

 

     2008     2007  

Cash flows from operating activities

    

Net loss

   $ 3,995     $ 1,305  

Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash provided by operating activities

    

Amortization/accretion of bond premiums/discounts

     2       (7 )

Depreciation and amortization

     3,400       2,911  

Loss on sale of investments

     30       87  

Loss on disposal of fixed assets

     79       —    

Non cash compensation expense

     3,234       1,275  

Deferred compensation

     339       224  

Changes in operating assets and liabilities

    

Accounts receivable

     (2,402 )     (4,130 )

Provision for rebates, discounts and allowances

     (15 )     9  

Prepaid and other assets

     548       (1,387 )

Deferred taxes

     (3,646 )     67  

Accounts payable and other liabilities

     6,570       203  

Deferred credits

     (1,896 )     (2,349 )

Deferred revenue

     650       (111 )

Covered sale fee payable

     (172 )     68  
                

Net cash provided by operating activities

     10,716       (1,835 )
                

Cash flows from investing activities

    

Proceeds from sale of investments

     605       1,030  

Purchase of investments

     (1,494 )     (1,623 )

Restricted cash

     (1,423 )     5,233  

Capital expenditures

     (3,780 )     (7,035 )

Increase in advance to clearing accounts, net

     498       (139 )
                

Net cash used in investing activities

     (5,594 )     (2,534 )
                

Cash flows from financing activities

    

Change in treasury seats

     —         (1 )
                

Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities

     —         (1 )
                

Increase in cash and cash equivalents

     5,122       (4,370 )

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

     46,117       50,773  
                

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

   $ 51,239     $ 46,403  
                

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

5


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

March 31, 2008 and 2007

NOTE A - ORGANIZATION AND OPERATIONS

The Philadelphia Stock Exchange, Inc. (the Exchange), provides a marketplace and facilities for the trading of equity securities, equity option, index option, and foreign currency option products for its members. On January 20, 2004, the Exchange demutualized and was converted from a Delaware non-stock corporation into a Delaware stock corporation. The Exchange’s subsidiaries include the Stock Clearing Corporation of Philadelphia (SCCP), the Philadelphia Board of Trade (PBOT), Advanced Tech Source (ATS), and Phlx Investment Product Services (PIPS). SCCP provides an interface clearing arrangement between certain of the Exchange’s floor members and National Securities Clearing Corporation (NSCC), and also provides margin services to certain market makers. Pursuant to a 1997 Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) order, the Exchange, SCCP, NSCC, and Depository Trust Company (DTC) entered into an agreement whereby SCCP provides limited clearing services. SCCP’s limited clearing services are facilitated through an omnibus account with NSCC and do not include the maintenance or offering of continuous net settlement accounts for its participants. The Exchange and SCCP are subject to regulatory oversight by the SEC. PBOT is subject to oversight by the Commodity Futures Trading Commission and operates as a designated contract market, which allows PBOT to list and trade various futures contracts. PBOT also engages in the distribution of market data products, including futures trading market data and sector index spot and settlement values data. PIPS was organized to develop and to act as sponsor of unit investment trusts to be listed and traded on the Exchange. ATS was organized to provide outsourced data processing services.

On November 10th, 2006, PHLX launched an all-electronic equities exchange, creating a marketplace for executing, displaying, and routing orders in all National Market System (“NMS”) Stocks. In addition, the SEC introduced Regulation NMS, designed to enhance and modernize the regulatory structure of the existing national market system. Fundamentally different than floor-based trading, the new equity-trading model is designed in compliance with Regulation NMS and competes with other equity exchanges using a new technology platform named “XLE”.

NOTE B - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

1. Basis of Presentation

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Exchange and its subsidiaries, SCCP, PBOT, ATS, and PIPS.

Significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.

2. Use of Estimates

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements, and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

3. Cash and Cash Equivalents

All highly liquid investments purchased with an original maturity of three months or less are considered cash equivalents.

(Continued)

 

6


NOTE B - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES - Continued

 

The Exchange periodically maintains cash balances at a financial institution in excess of the $100,000 Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation insurance limit.

4. Revenue Recognition

Transaction fees and the majority of clearing and settlement service fees relate to trades executed or cleared through the Exchange and its subsidiaries and are recorded on a settlement date basis. Regulatory fees include annual registered representative registration renewal fees and initial, transfer and termination fees from parties that are members of the Exchange. The renewal registration fees are billed annually and collected by the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (FINRA) and remitted to the Exchange in December preceding the effective year, and are deferred and recognized monthly over the course of the effective year. Registered representative initial registration, transfer and termination fees are also billed and collected by FINRA and are remitted monthly to the Exchange and recognized in the month they are assessed to the member. Security price data revenue includes distributions from the Exchange’s participation in the Consolidated Tape Association, the Nasdaq UTP Plan and the Options Price Reporting Authority and PBOT’s market data revenue from sale of the Exchange’s data associated with the current and closing index spot values and the settlement values for the Exchange and SIG Sector Indices and are accrued and recognized in the month the revenue is earned. Floor charges consist predominantly of trading post rental fees and other fees related to operating a trading floor and other revenue includes permit and Foreign Currency Options (FCO) participation fees, which are accrued and recognized in the month the services are provided.

5. Accounts Receivable

The Exchange’s accounts receivable are primarily due from monthly transaction fees and member fees. Credit is extended based on evaluation of customers’ financial condition and, generally, collateral is not required. Accounts receivable are stated in the consolidated financial statements at amounts due from customers net of an allowance for doubtful accounts. Accounts outstanding longer than the payment terms are considered past due. The Exchange determines its allowance by considering a number of factors, including the length of time trade accounts receivable are past due, the Exchange’s previous loss history, the obligor’s current ability to pay its obligation to the Exchange, and the condition of the general economy and the industry as a whole. The Exchange writes-off accounts receivable when they become uncollectible, and payments subsequently received on such receivables are credited to the allowance for doubtful accounts.

6. Investments

Investments classified as available for sale are stated at market value, and any net unrealized gain or loss is reported as a separate component of equity, net of deferred income taxes. Market value was obtained based on available quoted market prices as of March 31, 2008 and 2007. Debt securities for which the Exchange has the intent and ability to hold to maturity are classified as held to maturity and are valued at cost adjusted for the amortization/accretion of premiums/discounts computed by the interest method. Gain or loss recognized on sales of securities are based on the specific classification method and are recorded as of the trade date.

 

(Continued)

 

7


NOTE B - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES - Continued

 

7. Equipment and Leasehold Improvements

Equipment and leasehold improvements are carried at cost less allowances for accumulated depreciation and amortization. Depreciation of furniture and equipment is provided using the straight line method over the estimated useful lives of the applicable assets. Leasehold improvements are amortized over the lesser of the lease term or the useful life of such improvements.

8. Restricted Cash

The Exchange has classified cash totaling $11,000 and $11,000 as restricted at March 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively, representing capital contributions from owners of exchange memberships used for funding technological improvements and other capital needs including principal payments with respect to certain loans, as more fully described in note K (Capital Contribution). The Exchange has classified cash totaling $2,650,000 and $307,000 as of March 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively, as restricted, representing funds collected from market makers and specialists for the purpose of making qualifying payments for order flow, as more fully described in note I (Payment for Order Flow). Additionally, the Exchange has classified $400,000 as restricted at March 31, 2008 and 2007, representing SCCP restricted cash, deposits and escrow amounts.

All SCCP participant funds are maintained in cash, cash equivalents, or short-term investments, except for amounts utilized to satisfy the Depository Trust and Clearing Corporation (DTCC) participant fund requirements with respect to SCCP’s omnibus clearance and settlement accounts. At March 31, 2008 and 2007, the participant funds were invested in overnight reverse repurchase agreements.

9. Deferred Revenue

The Exchange has classified amounts totaling $5,648,000 (comprised of regulatory fees of $5,577,000, listing fees of $9,000 and licensing fees of $62,000) and $5,356,000 (comprised of regulatory fees of $5,224,000, listing fees of $12,000 and licensing fees of $120,000) as deferred income at March 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively. Deferred income is amortized to income over the applicable future year.

10. Deferred Credits

The Exchange has classified amounts totaling $5,627,000 (comprised of rent credits of $5,320,000 and depreciation credits of $307,000) and $5,317,000 (comprised of rent credits of $4,894,000 and depreciation credits of $423,000) as deferred credits at March 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively. The deferred rent credit (see note N.1) represents the tenant improvement allowance paid to the Exchange and will be amortized over the life of the lease renewal. The deferred depreciation credit represents a reimbursement of equipment purchases and internally developed software expenses related to development of PBOT’s trading platform and will be amortized over the life of the equipment and software.

 

(Continued)

 

8


NOTE B - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES - Continued

 

11. Securities Purchased Under Agreements to Resell

Relative to SCCP, transactions involving purchases of securities under agreements to resell (reverse repurchase agreements or reverse repos) are accounted for as collateralized financings except where SCCP does not have an agreement to sell (or purchase) the same, or substantially the same, securities before maturity at a fixed or determinable price. It is the policy of SCCP to obtain possession of or the legal right to collateral with a market value equal to or in excess of the principal amount loaned under reverse repurchase agreements. Collateral is valued daily, and SCCP may require counterparties to deposit additional collateral or return pledges when appropriate. As of March 31, 2008 and 2007, SCCP had open reverse repos, which amounted to $5,786,392 and $5,682,148, respectively, reflected in clearing and depository items on the balance sheet. The value of securities taken as collateral for these contracts was $6,075,712 and $5,966,256 at March 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively.

12. Government and Government Agency Securities

Government securities, which are expected to be held until maturity, are stated at cost and adjusted for the amortization of premiums computed by the interest method, which approximates fair value. SCCP maintains a $3,000,000 reserve fund that is invested in government securities. At March 31, 2008 and 2007, this reserve fund was part of investments held to maturity, which totaled $3,040,410 and $3,030,533, respectively. Pursuant to SCCP rules, the reserve fund is to be used to cover all reasonably anticipated operating expenses of SCCP and must be replenished within 60 days of the use of such monies.

13. Participants’ Securities Transactions

SCCP’s participants’ securities transactions are reported on a settlement date basis.

14. Participants’ Margin Accounts

Relative to SCCP, margin accounts receivable from and payable to participants include amounts due on cash and margin transactions. Securities owned by participants and held as collateral for receivables were valued at $780,000 and $1,236,000 at March 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively. Such collateral is not reflected in the consolidated financial statements. Securities owned by participants are marked to market in determining equity for margining purposes.

SCCP is potentially exposed to credit risk arising from nonperformance of its margin members in meeting their settlement obligations.

15. Income Taxes

Deferred income taxes are recognized for the tax consequences of differences in future years between the tax bases of assets and liabilities and their financial reporting amounts at each year-end based on tax laws and statutory tax rates applicable to the periods in which the differences are expected to result in taxable income. Valuation allowances are established when necessary to reduce deferred tax assets to the amount expected to be realized. Income tax expense is the tax payable for the period and the change during the period in deferred tax assets and liabilities.

(Continued)

 

9


NOTE B - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES - Continued

 

16. Computer Software Developed or Obtained for Internal Use

The Exchange follows the provisions of American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (AICPA) Statement of Position (SOP) No. 98-1, Accounting for the Costs of Computer Software Developed or Obtained for Internal Use, which requires entities to capitalize direct internal and external costs that meet certain capitalization criteria. Accordingly, the Exchange capitalized $1,694,000 and $1,478,000 through March 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively.

17. Comprehensive Income

The Exchange follows the provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (SFAS) No. 130, Reporting Comprehensive Income. SFAS No. 130 establishes standards to provide prominent disclosure of comprehensive income items. Comprehensive income is the change in equity of a business enterprise during a period from transactions and other events and circumstances from non-operating sources. Other comprehensive loss consists of net unrealized gains on investment securities available for sale and pension and postretirement plan adjustments. The components of other comprehensive income (loss) are as follows:

 

     Quarter ended March 31, 2008  
     Before
tax
amount
    Tax
expense
(benefit)
    Net of
tax
amount
 
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Unrealized gains on securities

      

Unrealized holding losses arising during period

   $ 683     $ 312     $ 371  

Less reclassification adjustment for losses realized in net income

     30       14       16  
                        

Unrealized losses on securities

     713       326       387  

Pension liability adjustments

     —         —         —    
                        

Other comprehensive loss, net

   $ 713     $ 326     $ 387  
                        
     Quarter ended March 31, 2007  
     Before
tax
amount
    Tax
expense
(benefit)
    Net of
tax
amount
 
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Unrealized gains on securities

      

Unrealized holding gains arising during period

   $ (437 )   $ (200 )   $ (237 )

Less reclassification adjustment for gains realized in net income

     87       40       47  
                        

Unrealized gains on securities

     (350 )     (160 )     (190 )
                        

Other comprehensive income, net

   $ (350 )   $ (160 )   $ (190 )
                        

(Continued)

 

10


NOTE B - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES - Continued

 

18. Pension Plan

Pension costs reflect an allocation of aggregate pension costs under a plan sponsored by the Parent. The Exchange funds the plan subject to the full funding limitation of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974.

In September 2006, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued SFAS 158, Employers’ Accounting for Defined Benefit Pension and Other Postretirement Plans: an amendment of FASB Statements No. 87, 88, 106, and 132(R). SFAS 158 requires the Exchange to recognize the funded status of its defined benefit postretirement benefit plan in the Exchange’s statement of financial position. The funded status was previously disclosed in the notes to the Exchange’s financial statements, but differed from the amount recognized in the balance sheet. SFAS 158 does not change the accounting for the Exchange’s defined contribution plan.

The recognition and disclosure provisions of SFAS 158 are effective for fiscal years ending after June 15, 2007, for nonpublic entities with defined benefit plans and are to be applied as of the end of the year of adoption. Retrospective application is not permitted. The Exchange voluntarily adopted the recognition and disclosures provisions of SFAS 158 effective December 31, 2006. The Exchange uses a December 31 measurement date for its pension and postretirement health benefit plan and thus the measurement date provisions will not affect the Exchange. Application of SFAS 158 will not change the calculation of net income in future periods, but will affect the calculation of other comprehensive income.

19. Postretirement Health Benefit Plan

Net postretirement health benefit costs are not funded. The net transition obligation for the plan is being amortized over a 20-year period, and will be fully amortized by January 1, 2013 (see notes B23 and M).

20. Advertising Costs

The Exchange expenses advertising costs as incurred. Advertising expense was $50,000 and $7,000 through March 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively.

(Continued)

 

11


NOTE B - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES - Continued

 

22. Reclassifications

Certain reclassifications have been made to the 2007 financial statements to conform to the 2008 presentation.

23. New Accounting Pronouncements

In early July 2006, the FASB issued FASB Interpretation (FIN) No. 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes – an Interpretation of Statement No. 109. FIN 48 was issued to address financial statement recognition and measurement by an enterprise of a tax position taken, or expected to be taken, in a tax return. The new standard will require several new disclosures in annual financial statements, including (a) the income statement classification of income tax-related interest and penalties and (b) a reconciliation of the total amount of unrecognized tax benefits. On February 1, 2008, the FASB issued FASB Staff Position (FSP) FIN 48-2, “Effective Date of FASB Interpretation No. 48 for Certain Nonpublic Enterprises.” The FSP defers the effective date of FIN 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes, for certain nonpublic companies to the Exchange’s annual financial statements for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2007. Nonpublic companies subject to the deferral are not required to adopt FIN 48 in interim period financial statements in the year of adoption. Earlier adoption is permitted, but when adopted, FIN 48 must be applied as of the beginning of the Exchange’s fiscal year. The Exchange is still evaluating the impact of adoption of FIN 48.

In September 2006, the FASB issued SFAS No. 157, Fair Value Measurements. SFAS No. 157 clarifies the principle that fair value should be based on assumptions market participants would use when pricing an asset or liability and establishes a fair value hierarchy that prioritizes information used to develop those assumptions. Under the standard, fair value measurements would be separately disclosed by level within the fair value hierarchy. SFAS No. 157 is effective for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2007. The adoption of SFAS No. 157 is not expected to have a material impact on the financial position or results of operations of the Exchange.

In February 2007, the FASB issued SFAS No. 159, The Fair Value Option for Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities – Including an amendment of FASB Statement No. 115. SFAS No. 159 expands the use of fair value accounting but does not affect existing standards, which require assets and liabilities to be carried at fair value. Under SFAS No. 159, a company many elect to use fair value to measure accounts and loans receivable, available-for-sale and held-to-maturity securities, equity method investments, accounts payable, guarantees, issued debt and other eligible financial instruments. SFAS No. 159 is effective for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2007. The Exchange has not determined yet whether it will elect to adopt SFAS No. 159.

NOTE C - REGULATORY DIRECTIVES

Pursuant to investigations conducted by the SEC regarding, among other things, listing and competition-related behavior, and by the United States Department of Justice (DOJ) regarding antitrust, the agencies in the year 2000 entered into settlements with the Exchange and certain other options exchanges.

(Continued)

 

12


NOTE C - REGULATORY DIRECTIVES - Continued

 

On September 11, 2000, the SEC issued an Order Instituting Public Administrative Proceedings (the 2000 Order), which accepted the settlement offers of the Exchange and certain other options exchanges, censured them, and, among other things, required them to adopt or modify certain rules regarding listing, allocation, harassment or intimidation, order handling, and certain other competition-related behavior. The 2000 Order also required the Exchange, jointly with other defendant exchanges, to establish a consolidated audit trail system, reform the plan by which capacity is procured and allocated and reform the plan by which exchanges list options. The 2000 Order also required the Exchange and other exchanges to enhance their surveillance, investigation, and enforcement processes.

On September 11, 2000, a U.S. district court entered a Proposed Final Judgment (Judgment), which instituted an antitrust proceeding brought by the DOJ and likewise accepted the settlement offers of the Exchange and certain other options exchanges. The Judgment, which was finalized by the court on December 6, 2000, among other things, established periodic reporting requirements, required the Exchange and the other exchanges to designate an Antitrust Compliance Officer and initiate an Antitrust Compliance Program, and prohibited certain agreements between and among the exchanges. The Judgment expires ten years from the date of its entry.

NOTE D - DISSOLUTION OF PHILADEP

In January 2001, Philadep adopted a Plan of Voluntary Dissolution (the Plan) providing for the cessation of Philadep’s corporate existence pursuant to the Pennsylvania Banking Code of 1965. In connection with the Plan, in February 2001, Philadep and the Exchange entered into an Assumption and Guarantee Agreement (the Assumption Agreement) providing for the Exchange to discharge certain obligations of Philadep not discharged directly by Philadep. Pursuant to the Assumption Agreement, the Exchange assumed Philadep’s obligations under its pension and/or post-retirement benefit plans.

As of December 31, 2002 (the “Final Distribution Date”), by virtue of the Plan and the Assumption Agreement, all funds, assets, and liabilities of Philadep, with a net asset value of $2,185,800, were assigned to and assumed by the Exchange. In 2005, Philadep received tax clearance from the Commonwealth of Pennsylvania and filed Articles of Dissolution with the Pennsylvania Department of Banking which were approved by the Department of Banking in 2006, causing Philadep to be dissolved. In December 2002, the SEC issued an order approving Philadep’s request to withdraw as a registered clearing agency effective as of December 31, 2002. The SEC required Philadep to keep a minimum reserve of $300,000 to cover potential reorganization claims. In 2000, Philadep was authorized by the SEC to amortize the $300,000 reserve to income over a three-year period.

 

13


NOTE E - INVESTMENTS

The amortized cost, gross unrealized gains and losses and estimated market values of the Exchange’s investment securities are summarized as follows (in thousands):

 

     Three Months Ended March 31, 2008
     Amortized
cost
   Gross
unrealized
gains
   Gross
unrealized
losses
   Estimated
market

value
     (Dollars in thousands)

Available-for-sale

           

Equity securities

   $ 13,892    $ 2,378    $ 774    $ 15,496

Debt securities

     1,044      18      11      1,051
                           
   $ 14,936    $ 2,396    $ 785    $ 16,547
                           

Held-to-maturity

           

Debt securities

   $ 3,068    $ 34    $ 1    $ 3,101
                           
     Three Months Ended March 31, 2007
     Amortized
cost
   Gross
unrealized
gains
   Gross
unrealized
losses
   Estimated
market
value
     (Dollars in thousands)

Available-for-sale

           

Equity securities

   $ 12,673    $ 3,064    $ 110    $ 15,627

Debt securities

     561      13      5      569
                           
   $ 13,234    $ 3,077    $ 115    $ 16,196
                           

Held-to-maturity

           

Debt securities

   $ 3,118    $ —      $ 23    $ 3,095
                           

The amortized cost and estimated market value of investment securities, by contractual maturity at March 31, 2008 (in thousands), are shown below:

 

     Available-for-sale    Held-to-maturity
     Amortized
cost
   Estimated
market
value
   Amortized
cost
   Estimated
market
value
     (Dollars in thousands)

Due within five years

   $ —      $ —      $ 3,002    $ 3,035

Municipal securities

     533      524      —        —  

Mortgage-backed securities

     511      527      66      66
                           

Total debt securities

   $ 1,044    $ 1,051    $ 3,068    $ 3,101
                           

(Continued)

 

14


NOTE E - INVESTMENTS - Continued

 

Proceeds from the sales of investments and gross realized gains and losses on such sales for quarter ended March 31, 2008 and 2007 were as follows:

 

     2008     2007  
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Proceeds

   $ 597     $ 1,008  

Gross gains

     60       5  

Gross losses

     (90 )     (92 )

The table below indicates the length of time individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position as of March 31, 2008 (in thousands):

 

Description of Securities

   Number
of
securities
   Less than 12 months    12 months or
longer
   Total
      Fair
value
   Unrealized
losses
   Fair
Value
   Unrealized
losses
   Fair
value
   Unrealized
losses

Mortgage-backed securities

   6    $ —      $ —      $ 139    $ 2    $ 139    $ 2

Municipal Securities

   1      524      9      —        —        524      9

Marketable equity securities

   23      3,831      724      530      51      4,361      775
                                              

Total temporarily impaired investment securities

   30    $ 4,355    $ 733    $ 669    $ 53    $ 5,024    $ 786
                                              

Management has considered factors regarding other than temporarily impaired securities and determined that there are no securities that are impaired as of March 31, 2008.

The Company invests a portion of its investments in auction-rate securities, the market for which has recently undergone significant change. As of March 31, 2008, the Exchange had approximately $1,000,000 in auction-rate securities (“ARS”). ARSs have a long-term stated maturity, but are reset through a “dutch auction” process that occurs periodically depending on the terms of the individual security. Until February 2008, the ARS market was highly liquid. During February 2008, however, a significant number of auctions related to these securities failed, meaning that there was not enough demand to sell the entire issue at auction. The impact of the failed auctions on holders of ARS is that the holder cannot sell the securities and the issuer’s interest rate is generally reset to a higher “penalty” rate.

At March 31, 2008 and 2007, the Company held 4.76 shares and 4.69 shares of DTCC common stock, respectively. As a member firm of DTCC, the Exchange is designated, by DTCC rule, as a mandatory purchaser participant and is required to own the shares for as long as it remains a member. The number of shares required to be owned is determined by DTCC and the Exchange is prohibited from owning anything more or less than the amount calculated by DTCC. The shares are substantially restricted and cannot be sold to any party other than the DTCC. For this reason, these shares are recorded at cost and are classified in other assets on the Exchange’s balance sheet at March 31, 2008 and 2007.

 

15


NOTE F - INVESTMENT IN AFFILIATE

The Exchange has a minority equity interest in The Options Clearing Corporation (OCC) carried at cost totaling $333,000. In the event the Exchange should cease to be qualified to participate in OCC, OCC has the right to purchase all the shares owned by the Exchange. The shareholders’ agreement provides that the purchase price will be the lesser of the Exchange’s cost or the aggregate book value of the shares.

It is intended that the income of OCC will either be distributed to the member exchanges or retained within OCC. This determination will be made annually by the OCC Board of Directors. As the investment in OCC is not marketable and because there is little likelihood of dividends being distributed to the shareholders, the Exchange will realize its share of OCC’s equity upon ultimate liquidation of OCC, an event not in the foreseeable future. Accordingly, the investment in OCC is carried at the Exchange’s cost. There were no distributions in the three months ending March 31, 2008 and 2007.

NOTE G - EQUIPMENT AND LEASEHOLD IMPROVEMENTS

The Exchange’s investment in equipment and leasehold improvements comprises the following:

 

     Estimated
useful lives
   2008    2007
          (Dollars in thousands)

Equipment

   3 -7 years    $ 53,706    $ 48,742

Software

   5 years      45,524      41,241

Leasehold improvements

   Various      29,204      17,664
                
        128,434      107,647

Less - accumulated depreciation and amortization

        67,582      61,205
                
      $ 60,852    $ 46,442
                

NOTE H - CLEARING ITEMS

The clearing items represent cash, receivables and payables for open securities transactions cleared for participants through SCCP’s clearing system. A summary of the balances at March 31, 2008 and 2007, follows:

 

     2008    2007
     (Dollars in thousands)

Cash - restricted

   $ 75    $ 132

Securities purchased under agreements to resell - restricted

     3,118      2,677

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

     2,668      3,005

Cash

     100      101

Margin accounts, debit balances

     629      807

Miscellaneous accounts, debit balances

     1      —  

Omnibus accounts with other clearing organizations

     23      80

Deposits with other clearing agencies

     307      333
             
   $ 6,921    $ 7,135
             

(Continued)

 

16


NOTE H - CLEARING ITEMS - Continued

 

     2008    2007
     (Dollars in thousands)

Margin accounts, credit balances

   $ 290    $ 227

Continuous net settlement and other accounts, credit balances

     7      20

Participants’ fund

     3,500      3,142

Advance from corporate accounts

     3,124      3,746

Dividend and other payables

     —        —  
             
   $ 6,921    $ 7,135
             

SCCP participants are required to contribute to the Participants’ Fund (the Fund). Amounts are dependent upon the nature and volume of services utilized by the participant. The Fund is designed to provide security for participants’ obligations to SCCP, and is available to protect against the possibility of certain losses and as necessary to meet participant fund requirements of NSCC and/or DTC. SCCP determined that each participant’s contribution was in accordance with the formulas approved by the SCCP Board of Directors. All formulas were applied to all SCCP participants on a uniform non-discriminatory basis.

All required contributions to the Fund must be made in cash and SCCP may allocate any portion of the Fund to satisfy DTCC’s participant fund requirements with respect to SCCP’s Omnibus Clearance and Settlement account. Accordingly, at March 31, 2008, SCCP had $307,000 deposited with DTCC, at March 31, 2007, SCCP had $333,000 deposited with DTCC. SCCP’s excess participant fund cash not used to fund its DTCC participants’ fund requirements is segregated and invested by SCCP in accordance with its rules.

SCCP rebates interest monthly to participants with deposits greater than $50,000 at the average federal funds rate, less one half of a percent. Through March 31, 2008 and 2007, SCCP rebated $3,000 and $9,000, respectively, in interest, to the participants in accordance with the formulas. The participants’ fund consisted of $3,500,000 and $3,142,000 in cash deposits and securities at March 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively.

NOTE I - PAYMENT FOR ORDER FLOW

The Exchange administers the collection and payment of Payment for Order Flow (“PFOF”) fees assessed on certain qualifying transactions. PFOF funds are made available to order flow providers at the direction of specialist units and Directed Registered Options Traders. At March 31, 2008, the Exchange held total cash in the amount of $2,650,000 and total receivable and payable balances of $7,047,000 and $9,697,000, respectively, related to its PFOF programs. At March 31, 2007, the Exchange held total cash in the amount of $307,000 and total receivable and payable balances of $5,070,000 and $5,377,000, respectively, related to its PFOF programs.

(Continued)

 

17


NOTE J - NOTES PAYABLE - Continued

 

During 2008, the Exchange maintained two collateralized line of credit facilities. Under these facilities, the Exchange has lines of credit totaling $10,000,000, comprised of agreements of $5,000,000 each at two different banks. Interest on outstanding balances is payable at the prime rate minus 0.5% and the prime rate, respectively. During 2007, the Exchange maintained two collateralized line of credit facilities. Under these facilities, the Exchange has lines of credit totaling $10,000,000, comprised of agreements of $5,000,000 each at two different banks. Interest on outstanding balances is payable at the prime rate. The Exchange has pledged a minimum of $1,500,000 in marketable securities and certain of its accounts receivable to each bank as collateral for the lines of credit. At March 31, 2008 and 2007, no portion of the lines of credit was outstanding.

During 2008 and 2007, SCCP maintained two collateralized line-of-credit agreements. Under these agreements, SCCP has lines of credit totaling $40,000,000, comprised of agreements of $20,000,000 each at two different banks. Interest is payable to the two accounts at the federal funds rate plus 1.6%. At March 31, 2008 and 2007, no portion of the lines of credit was outstanding.

NOTE K - CAPITAL CONTRIBUTION

In June 2000, the Exchange implemented a three-year capital contribution program. The program assessed a $1,500/month contribution on owners of the Exchange’s 505 seats to be used to provide funding for technological improvements and other capital needs. Through March 31, 2008, the Exchange had collected $27,188,000 (2008 - $-0-; 2007 - $-0-; 2006 - $2,000; 2005 - $6,000; 2004 - $33,000; 2003 - $4,251,000; 2002 - $9,336,000; 2001 - $8,888,000; 2000 - $4,672,000) from its seat owners. The program expired in May 2003.

NOTE L - INCOME TAXES

The components of the provision for income taxes are as follows:

 

     Quarter ended March 31,  
     2008     2007  
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Currently payable

    

Federal

   $ 3,946     $ 1,626  

State and local

     2,293       1,201  
                
     6,239       2,827  
                

Deferred taxes

     (3,022 )     (1,612 )
                
   $ 3,217     $ 1,215  
                

The 2008 and 2007 provisions for income taxes are different from the amount which would be provided by applying the statutory Federal income tax rate to the income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes, primarily as a result of permanent book tax differences and tax credits.

Deferred taxes result from federal and state net operating losses, recording depreciation, pension costs, deferred compensation, retiree medical benefits, unrealized gains/losses on investments, stock compensation, the reserve for possible losses on aged items in different periods for financial accounting and income tax reporting purposes, and research credits.

(Continued)

 

18


NOTE L - INCOME TAXES - Continued

 

The components of the net deferred tax asset/liability recognized in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets are as follows:

 

     Quarter ended March 31,
     2008    2007
     (Dollars in thousands)

Deferred tax assets

   $ 40,609    $ 29,098

Deferred tax liability

     21,060      19,395
             

Net deferred tax asset before valuation allowance

     19,549      9,703

Valuation allowance

     —        —  
             

Net deferred tax asset

   $ 19,549    $ 9,703
             

During 2006, the Exchange performed a study regarding available Research and Development (“R&D”) tax credits relating to their internally development software. Based upon this study, there are $7,504,000 of R&D credits available to the Exchange that were generated between 1998 and 2006. As of December 31, 2007, the Exchange had net deferred tax assets relating to research and development credits of $6,408,000. These credits expire in 2018 through 2026.

The Exchange files a consolidated federal income tax return. It is the Exchange’s policy to calculate all taxes on a separate company basis. Any tax calculated at the subsidiary level is paid to the parent for subsequent payment to the federal government.

NOTE M - EMPLOYEE BENEFITS

1. Pension Plan

The Company participates in a trusteed noncontributory pension plan and a postretirement benefit plan covering substantially all employees of the Parent and its subsidiaries. The Company provides defined benefits which are generally a function of years of service and based on an employee’s average pay over the employee’s career with the Company.

The Exchange’s net periodic pension cost and other postretirement benefits costs include the following components:

 

     Pension benefits     Postretirement benefits
     2008     2007     2008    2007
     (Dollars in thousands)

Service cost

   $ 443     $ 457     $ 146    $ 174

Interest cost

     438       380       161      137

Expected return on plan assets

     (541 )     (515 )     —        —  

Amortization of transition obligation

     —         —         —        4

Amortization of prior service cost

     12       21       4      —  

Amortization of net losses

     —         —         51      45
                             

Net periodic benefit cost

   $ 352     $ 343     $ 362    $ 360
                             

(Continued)

 

19


NOTE M - EMPLOYEE BENEFITS - Continued

 

2. Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan

The Exchange maintains nonqualified Supplemental Executive Retirement Plans (“Plans”) for certain key executives. The Plans are unfunded. The Exchange has reflected its liability related to the Plans of $4,982,000 and $4,177,000 as deferred compensation in the accompanying balance sheet at March 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively.

The Exchange’s net periodic pension cost includes the following components:

 

     Plan #1    Plan #2
     2008    2007    2008    2007
     (Dollars in thousands)

Service cost

   $ —      $ —      $ 235    $ 115

Interest cost

     2      2      140      57

Amortization of prior service cost

     —        —        190      62

Amortization of net losses

     5      5      —        —  
                           

Net periodic benefit cost

   $ 7    $ 7    $ 565    $ 234
                           

3. Savings Plan

The Exchange and SCCP also participate in a voluntary defined contribution 401(k) plan which covers substantially all of the Exchange and its Subsidiaries’ employees. Employer contributions to this 401(k) plan were $223,000 and $180,000 through March 31, 2008 and 2007 respectively.

In December 2006, the Board of Governors approved changes to the Exchange’s retirement program. Employees hired on or after January 1, 2007 participate in an enhanced 401(k) plan only. Employees hired prior to January 1, 2007 were given a one-time opportunity to choose between continued participation in the current defined benefit pension plan plus current 401(k) plan or participation in the enhanced 401(k) plan.

4. Postretirement Health Benefit Plan

The Exchange adopted SFAS No. 106, Employer’s Accounting for Postretirement Benefits Other Than Pensions, as of January 1, 1993. This statement requires the accrual of the cost of providing postretirement benefits, including medical and life insurance coverage, during the active service period of the employee. The transition obligation as of January 1, 1993, was estimated to be $2,617,000, which the Exchange has elected to amortize over 20 years as permitted by SFAS No. 106.

On December 8, 2003, the President signed into law the Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act of 2003 (the “Act”). The Act provides for an expansion of Medicare, primarily adding a prescription drug benefit for Medicare-eligible retirees starting in 2006. The Act also provides a federal subsidy to sponsors that provide a benefit that is at least actuarially equivalent to Medicare Part D. The Exchange has concluded that the benefits provided by the plans are actuarially equivalent to Medicare Part D under the legislation, and that the effects of the Act on medical obligations and costs to the Company are not significant.

(Continued)

 

20


NOTE N - COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

 

1. Operating Leases

Rental expense was $1,279,000 and $1,017,000 through March 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively. Rental expense includes $65,000 in 2008 and $55,000 in 2007, for taxes and maintenance related to leased property.

The Exchange’s minimum future annual rental obligations, exclusive of insurance, maintenance, and other costs, applicable to existing operating leases, are as follows:

Year ending December 31, (in thousands)

 

2008 (Apr – Dec)

   $ 2,921

2009

     3,806

2010

     3,742

2011 and thereafter

     42,696
      
   $ 53,165
      

The Exchange leases its facilities under leases which are included in the preceding commitment schedule. Two lease agreements expired in May 2005 and two in October 2006, one of which was renewed for an additional 15 year lease term (primary lease). In December 2004, the Exchange renewed its lease agreement for approximately 91,000 square feet of office space at its existing location and in March 2005 and July 2005, the Exchange expanded its space to primarily address the other lease agreements that were expiring in May 2005 and October 2006 and to expand its data center for approximately 56,000 square feet of additional office space. In October 2006, the Exchange increased its space to expand its data center for approximately 7,000 square feet of office space. For the primary space, the lease term is 15 years, effective November 1, 2006, and contains a renewal option for extending the agreement for an additional two consecutive five-year terms. The five-year renewal options provide for possible escalation in annual rental costs depending on certain economic factors between now and the exercise periods of the renewal options. The expansion space commenced between June 1, 2005 and November 1, 2006 with free rent periods on certain amounts of space from between three months and seventeen months. It is co-terminus with the primary lease. Additionally, the landlord reimbursed the Exchange $2,708,000 in 2005 and $2,380,000 from January through February 2006 for tenant improvements made after January 1, 2003. Reimbursement of tenant improvements is recorded as deferred rent credits and will be amortized on a straight-line basis over the 15 year lease renewal term as a reduction of rent expense. The lease agreements include termination options in October 2011 and 2016, subject to a termination fee.

In June 2006, the Exchange expanded its space to accommodate its data center by approximately 26,000 square feet of office space in a Keystone Opportunity Zone, in which the Exchange qualified for state and local tax savings through 2018. The lease term is 15 years and 6 months, effective November 30, 2007, and contains a renewal option for extending the agreement for an additional two consecutive five-year terms. The five-year renewal options provide for possible escalation in annual rental costs depending on certain economic factors between now and the exercise periods of the renewal options. The landlord reimbursed the Exchange $762,000 in 2008 for tenant improvements. Reimbursement of tenant improvements will be recorded as deferred rent credits and will be amortized on a straight-line basis over the 15 year lease renewal term as a reduction of rent expense.

In May of 2006, pursuant to rights granted to the Exchange in its main lease, the Exchange acquired a limited partnership interest in Market 1900 Associates, L.P., a Pennsylvania limited partnership, an entity which, in turn, acquired a partnership interest of the entity whose primary asset is the real estate in which the Exchange’s main leased premises are located. The Exchange recognized a gain of $5,738,000 on the purchase and subsequent sale of these ownership interests.

 

(Continued)

 

21


NOTE N - COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES - Continued

 

2. Class Action Settlement

In May 2000, the Exchange settled consolidated class action lawsuits filed against it and certain other exchanges in October 1999 (the Original Settlements). The lawsuits alleged antitrust violations in connection with the listing of options. The Exchange was obligated under its Original Settlement Agreement to pay $2,800,000 (the Original Settlement Amount) to plaintiffs, which was accrued and included in the 2000 Consolidated Statement of Operations in Other Expenses. Payment of the Original Settlement Amount was secured by a letter of credit issued by a bank, which was renewed every year since 2001 and expired on November 28, 2005 and was not renewed due to the Original Settlement Agreement being replaced by a Modified Settlement Agreement, as described below.

In February 2001, the Court before whom the class action was filed issued an order granting a summary judgment motion filed by all Exchanges on the grounds that the Exchanges are entitled to implied immunity from liability under the antitrust laws. In April 2001, the Court issued an order stating that, as a result of its granting summary judgment, it does not have jurisdiction to entertain the plaintiffs’ request to preliminarily approve the proposed settlement, and thus denied the plaintiffs’ motion for approval of the settlement. The plaintiffs in April and May 2001 appealed the Court orders. In January 2003, after appellate briefing and oral argument, the Appellate Court issued a decision in which it a) affirmed the Court’s dismissal of the class action complaint on the basis of implied repeal, and b) vacated the Court’s order stating that it did not have jurisdiction to hear motions for preliminary approval of the settlements and remanded the matter to the Court to entertain such motions. The plaintiffs filed a petition with the Court of Appeals for panel rehearing and for rehearing en banc. This petition was denied.

In February 2004, the plaintiffs filed a motion with the Court seeking preliminary approval of the Original Settlements including the Exchange’s. In July 2004, the Court issued a complex order and decision regarding the Original Settlements wherein, among other things, the court agreed with certain objections to the settlement while approving the original settlement of one of the exchange defendants. In January 2006, the Exchange, the other exchange defendants and several market maker defendants submitted to the Court a Modified Settlement Agreement that was complemented by supplemental settlement agreements of additional defendants (collectively the Modified Settlement Agreement). On February 8, 2006, the Court entered an order preliminarily approving the Modified Settlement Agreement and scheduling May 22, 2006, for consideration of final approval of the settlement. Pursuant to the Modified Settlement Agreement the Exchange is obligated to pay a Modified Settlement amount that is significantly reduced from the Original Settlement Amount. As a result, the Exchange paid $575,000 ($525,000 principal, $50,000 interest) and reversed $3,406,000 ($2,275,000 in principal, $1,131,000 in interest) of previously accrued settlement liabilities through other expenses which are reflected in operating expenses in the consolidated statement of operations. An amended final judgment and order approving the Modified Settlement Agreement was entered on December 14, 2006. No appeal was taken on the final judgment, and the settlement under the Modified Settlement Agreement is final.

3. Other

In December 2003, six purported trading firms sued the Exchange and other options exchanges, ROTs, and specialists in federal court in Chicago, alleging improper handling of options orders placed by these firms. The case was dismissed by order of the court on March 30, 2005, but plaintiffs were permitted to amend their complaint excluding antitrust allegations. Other similarly situated plaintiffs filed similar complaints against the Exchange, among others, on September 28, 2005 and September 30, 2005, respectively. All of these have been consolidated with this first case. Plaintiffs’ amended complaint (without antitrust claims), with allegations very similar to the original complaints, was dismissed on September 13, 2006 and their Motion for Reconsideration was denied on March 22, 2007. Plaintiffs’ appeal to the United States Court of Appeals was dismissed on April 20, 2007. The Exchange is producing a response to a third party subpoena, but is no longer a party to the action.

 

(Continued)

 

22


NOTE N - COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES - Continued

 

In 1998, Joseph Carapico, a member of the Exchange, and PennMont Securities (“PennMont”), an entity through which he trades securities at the Exchange, filed suit against the Exchange in Pennsylvania Common Pleas Court. The suit was amended in 2003 to request the Court to appoint a custodian to conduct the business of the Exchange, direct defendants to provide immediate notice to members of the commencement of any exploratory talks regarding certain corporate transactions, declare whether any fundamental transaction that might be undertaken by the Exchange was lawful, and enjoin the Exchange from pursuing certain mergers, sales of assets, conversions, or other transfers. On October 6, 2004, the Court granted summary judgment against the plaintiffs and dismissed the case with prejudice. On February 24, 2006, the Superior Court affirmed, and on September 15, 2006, the Supreme Court of Pennsylvania denied plaintiffs’ petition for allowance of appeal, ending the litigation in favor of the Exchange. The Exchange now seeks recovery of nearly $1,000,000 in legal fees pursuant to Exchange Rule 651 in a separate action filed against PennMont and Carapico in Pennsylvania Common Pleas Court on April 4, 2008.

PennMont, a member of the Exchange, filed suit on December 31, 2007 against the Exchange and Meyer S. Frucher, the Exchange’s Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, seeking to enjoin PHLX’s enforcement of Exchange Rule 651 against PennMont with respect to the above matter that PennMont filed in 1998, and seeking damages in connection therewith. On February 13, 2008, after the parties had briefed PennMont’s motion for a temporary restraining order and a preliminary injunction, the Court denied the motion and dismissed the action for failure to state a claim. PennMont filed an appeal to the United States Court of Appeals for the Third Circuit, which remains pending. On February 27, 2008, the District Court denied PennMont’s emergency motion for injunction pending appeal, and on March 7, 2008, the United States Court of Appeals for the Third Circuit denied a similar emergency motion for injunction pending appeal.

PennMont, a member of the Exchange, filed suit on December 22, 2005 against five individuals: Meyer S. Frucher, the Exchange’s Chairman and Chief Executive Officer; William Briggs, the Exchange’s Executive Vice President; Norman Steisel, the Exchange’s Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer; and Kevin Foley and Christopher Nagy, former members of the Exchange’s Board of Governors. The Exchange is advancing defense expenses to the Defendants in accordance with its Restated Certificate of Incorporation and By-Laws. The complaint alleges mismanagement from the mid-1990s forward, with a specific focus on demutualization, and alleges direct shareholder class action and derivative claims under the Racketeer Influenced and Corrupt Organizations Act and nine common law causes of action. The complaint seeks monetary damages for plaintiffs and fellow shareholders. Defendants filed a motion to dismiss the complaint on multiple grounds. The Court dismissed the matter for failure to state a claim on August 15, 2007, and plaintiff has filed an appeal to the United States Court of Appeals for the Third Circuit, which remains pending. On March 5, 2008, the Exchange filed a motion to dismiss the appeal. On March 12, 2008, the Third Circuit motions panel referred the motion to dismiss to the merits panel.

Certain Exchange shareholders and members filed a proposed shareholder class action suit on June 14, 2006 in the United States District Court for the Eastern District of Pennsylvania, alleging securities fraud against the Exchange’s Board of Governors and its officer Norman Steisel (the “Exchange Defendants”) in connection with the six strategic investments secured by the Exchange in June and August 2005. The Exchange is advancing defense expenses to the Exchange Defendants in accordance with its Restated Certificate of Incorporation and By-Laws. The complaint also alleged “fraudulent transfer” of Exchange stock against the Strategic Investors. Plaintiffs requested rescission of the sale of stock to the Strategic Investors, or in the alternative, monetary damages. On July 19, 2006, plaintiffs filed an amended complaint that expanded upon the securities fraud claim asserted against the Exchange Defendants to attack not only the Strategic Transactions, but also demutualization and the Exchange’s September 2005 self-tender offer. Plaintiffs requested the following relief: (i) rescission of stock sales pursuant to the tender offer; (ii) reversal of demutualization “to the extent such is possible and, to the extent such is not possible,” damages; and (iii) rescission of the stock issued to the Strategic Investors. The amended complaint also asserted a claim for breach of fiduciary duty against the Exchange Defendants for which plaintiffs sought damages. With respect to the Strategic Investors, in addition to “fraudulent transfer,” the amended complaint asserted claims for securities fraud, “commercial bribery” pursuant to the Robinson-Patman Act, and aiding and abetting breach of fiduciary duty. The plaintiffs subsequently informed the Court that they were pursuing only their securities fraud claims. Motions to dismiss filed on behalf of all of the defendants were granted on March 31, 2007, and plaintiffs have filed an appeal to the United States Court of Appeals for the Third Circuit, which remains pending. On January 28, 2008, plaintiffs filed a motion for remand of the appeal to the District Court for consideration of the applicability of the settlement release in Ginsburg v. Philadelphia Stock Exchange, Inc. et al., No. 2202-CC (Del. Ch.)

 

23


(“Ginsburg”). On May 27, 2008, the Third Circuit motions panel issued an order referring the motion to remand to the merits panel. On July 7, 2008, the plaintiffs filed a motion to: (i) bifurcate consideration of whether the Ginsburg release bars the action from consideration of the merits; (ii) consolidate the appeal with the plaintiffs’ appeal of the dismissal of a separate purported shareholder class action suit that they had filed on June 18, 2007 in the United States District Court for the Eastern District of Pennsylvania against Keefe Bruyette & Woods, Inc. (“KBW”), and Joseph J. Spalluto, a KBW managing director, asserting claims stemming from financial advisory services rendered to the Exchange by KBW; and (iii) withdraw the plaintiffs’ prior motion for remand. On July 16, the Exchange Defendants filed a response in opposition to the motion and a cross-motion to dismiss the appeal.

 

(Continued)

 

24


NOTE N - COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES - Continued

 

Another shareholder class action was filed against the Exchange, its then-Board of Governors, and the Strategic Investors in the Delaware Court of Chancery on June 6, 2006. As in the above matter, the plaintiff asserted a breach of fiduciary duty against the Board defendants, and sought the unwinding of the strategic investments, or in the alternative, monetary damages. Plaintiff’s claim against the Strategic Investors was for aiding and abetting a breach of fiduciary duty. A substantial portion of the legal costs associated with the defense of both class action matters has been covered by Insurance. Motions to dismiss filed on behalf of all defendants were denied on December 7, 2006. On October 22, 2007, the court issued an order and final judgment providing for final class certification and approving as fair and adequate to the class a settlement that had been reached on June 20, 2007, on the eve of trial. Certain objecting class members appealed the October 22, 2007 order, and the Delaware Supreme Court affirmed the judgment on March 27, 2008. Among other consideration, the settlement consideration includes: (i) 14% of each of the Strategic Investor’s equity interest in the Exchange; (ii) payment by the Exchange’s insurers of $14 million to the class; (iii) payment by the Exchange of $3.1 million to the class; and (iv) cancellation of the interest of Myer S. Frucher, the Exchange’s Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, in 14% of the restricted stock units that were previously awarded to him pursuant to the Exchange’s management equity compensation plan. By its terms, the settlement did not constitute an acknowledgement of liability by any of the defendants.

PennMont, a member of the Exchange, filed suit on April 19, 2006 in the United States District Court for the Eastern District of Pennsylvania, alleging insider trading in violation of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 against Meyer S. Frucher, the Exchange’s Chairman and Chief Executive Officer; John F. Wallace, the Exchange’s On-Floor Vice Chairman; and Pasquale DiDonato, the principal of a floor broker at the Exchange. The Exchange has advanced defense expenses to Frucher and Wallace in accordance with its Restated Certificate of Incorporation and By-Laws. The complaint’s allegations concerned the sale of 100 shares of the Exchange’s Class A common stock from plaintiff to defendant DiDonato in January 2005. PennMont filed an amended complaint on August 4, 2006 that purports to state a controlling person claim against Wallace and hold him liable as a “tipper,” and that purports to state a direct securities fraud claim against Frucher. Defendants’ motions to dismiss the amended complaint were denied on March 23, 2007. After the close of discovery, defendants filed a motion for summary judgment on November 19, 2007, and their motions were granted on March 28, 2008. The Exchange now seeks recovery of about $215,000 in legal fees pursuant to Exchange Rule 651.

PennMont, a member of the Exchange, filed suit on June 7, 2008 in the United States District Court for the Eastern District of Pennsylvania, seeking a declaratory judgment that Exchange Rule 651 does not permit the Exchange to recover its legal fees incurred in the above matter that PennMont filed on April 19, 2006. The Exchange has not yet responded to the complaint.

Richard Feinberg, a member of the Exchange, filed suit on September 9, 2005 in the United States District Court for the Eastern District of Pennsylvania alleging insider trading in violation of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 against I. Isabelle Benton, a member of the Exchange’s Board of Governors, and Benton Partners II, L.P., a member of the Exchange in which Ms. Benton is a partner. The Exchange has advanced defense expenses to Benton in accordance with its Restated Certificate of Incorporation and By-Laws. The complaint’s allegations concerned the sale of 100 shares of the Exchange’s Class A common stock from plaintiff to defendant Benton Partners II, L.P., in December 2004. At the close of discovery, defendants filed a motion for summary judgment on June 22, 2007, and the motion was denied on December 13, 2008. Trial began on March 3, 2008, and at the close of plaintiff’s case the Court entered judgment on a directed verdict for defendants. Final judgment in favor of defendants was entered on March 10, 2008. The Exchange now seeks recovery of about $470,000 in legal fees pursuant to Exchange Rule 651.

On June 2, 2006, NexTrade, Inc., filed a claim against the Exchange in the United States District Court for the Middle District of Florida alleging patent infringement and breach of contract. The suit arises out of an April 2005 licensing agreement between the Exchange and NexTrade regarding an alleged patent for expirationless options. Plaintiff sought unspecified damages, costs, and fees for infringement and breach, along with a declaratory judgment that NexTrade’s patent covers long dated options in addition to expirationless options. A motion to dismiss filed by the Exchange was denied in August 2006, and discovery commenced. The parties entered into a settlement agreement in January 2008, and the action was dismissed.

(Continued)

 

25


NOTE N - COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES - Continued

 

Certain Exchange shareholders and members filed a proposed shareholder class action suit on June 18, 2007 in the United States District Court for the Eastern District of Pennsylvania against Keefe Bruyette & Woods, Inc. (“KBW”), and Joseph J. Spalluto, a KBW managing director, asserting claims stemming from financial advisory services rendered to the Exchange by KBW. On February 5, 2008, KBW filed a complaint against the Exchange in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York seeking indemnification pursuant to an engagement agreement between the parties for costs incurred by KBW in connection with the underlying shareholder suit against KBW and Spalutto, and in connection with McGowan Investors L.P., et al. v. Meyer S. Frucher, et al., No. 06-2558 (E.D. Pa.). The Exchange filed a state court action in Philadelphia against KBW on February 25, 2008 seeking a declaration that its indemnification obligation does not apply. On March 12, 2008 KBW removed that action to the United States District Court for the Eastern District of Pennsylvania. On March 14, 2008, KBW filed a motion to dismiss, stay, or transfer the Eastern District of Pennsylvania action to the Southern District of New York. On March 17, 2008, the Exchange sought leave to file a motion to transfer the Southern District of New York action to the Eastern District of Pennsylvania. On March 24, 2008, the Exchange filed an Answer in the Southern District of New York action denying liability. The Exchange and KBW have reached an agreement in principle to resolve the two cross suits regarding indemnification.

William and Maureen Dooner, husband and wife, filed suit against the Exchange, among others, on May 28, 2004 in the Court of Common Pleas, Philadelphia County primarily alleging that the Exchange had provided negligent security on its trading floor which resulted in bodily injury and other harm to Mr. Dooner (and a loss of consortium for his wife). Mr. Dooner alleges that he was pulled to the ground, striking his head, by another trader in a trading crowd which action arose out of a disagreement over positioning within a trading crowd. On March 3, 2006, a jury awarded Mr. and Mrs. Dooner a total of $1,935,000 of which the Exchange was held liable for $967,500 (50%). The Exchange appealed and the Superior Court of Pennsylvania vacated the judgment on October 17, 2007. The Supreme Court of Pennsylvania granted Plaintiff’s petition for allowance of appeal. Insurance has fully indemnified and will fully indemnify the Exchange.

On June 16, 2008, Lewis Levin, a former seat owner of the Exchange, filed a purported class action suit against Susquehanna International Group, LLP (“SIG”), Jeffrey Yass, a SIG executive, Meyer S. Frucher, the Exchange’s Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, and XYZ, “a legal entity or person related to, or associated with, [SIG].” The complaint asserts a single claim under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 against SIG and “persons allied with SIG” arising from SIG’s alleged purchases of Exchange seats or shares while in possession of material non-public information about the Exchange supposedly learned from Mr. Frucher or others at his direction. Mr. Frucher has not been served with the complaint.

On March 22, 2006, the Exchange was served with a complaint filed in the Court of Common Pleas of Philadelphia County by the owner of 200 shares of the Exchange’s Class A Common Stock (the “Shares”) and by two prospective purchasers of those shares. The complaint alleges that the Exchange in 2005 wrongfully prevented the transfer of the Shares to their record owner, Steven Braverman, due to debts owed by Mr. Braverman to the Exchange thus depriving Mr. Braverman of a gain of $120,000 from an agreed upon sale to the two prospective purchasers in May 2005. The two prospective purchasers allege that they were wrongfully deprived of gains of $30,000 each, which they would have realized upon their acceptance of a tender offer made by the Exchange in October 2005. The Exchange reached a settlement with the two prospective purchasers in December of 2006, by allowing the transfer of shares with the proceeds being held in escrow pending the outcome of the litigation with Mr. Braverman. The Exchange filed an amended counterclaim and a motion for summary judgment in January of 2007. A settlement with Braverman, individually, was reached and finalized in October 2007.

On June 12, 2008, the Exchange and the Philadelphia Board of Trade (“PBOT”) entered into a Settlement Agreement and Release with Susquehanna Investment Group (“SIG”) with respect to potential claims by SIG arising out of (i) a Letter of Intent dated March 18, 2004 between SIG and PBOT, and (ii) alleged losses suffered by SIG in connection with the Exchange’s Directed Order and Payment for Order Flow Program. While the Exchange disputes SIG’s assertions and believes them to be without merit, in order to avoid burdensome and distracting litigation, the Exchange has paid SIG the sum of $750,000 to finally settle, release and discharge all claims relating to items (i) and (ii) above.

In March 2004, the Exchange received a request for documents from the SEC’s Division of Enforcement related to a review of the Exchange’s surveillance, investigation and enforcement functions from April 1999 through

 

26


January 2002. This resulted in a settlement with the Division of Enforcement in June 2006 which included: (i) an order that the Exchange cease and desist from committing or causing any violations of Section 19(g) of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934; (ii) an undertaking that the Exchange shall institute a training program for floor members and certain staff that addresses compliance with the federal securities laws and the Exchange’s rules; and (iii) a further undertaking that the Exchange retain in 2006 and 2008 a third party auditor to conduct a comprehensive compliance audit and allocate up to $500,000 in each of 2006 and 2008 on those audits.

(Continued)

 

27


NOTE N - COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES - Continued

 

In August 2003, the Exchange entered into an exclusive license agreement with The NASDAQ Stock Market, Inc. (NASDAQ) for listing and trading options on the Nasdaq Composite Index which began on March 22, 2004. The initial term of the agreement is for three years. Under the agreement, the Exchange is responsible for paying a license fee per contract traded, but must pay NASDAQ a minimum of $1,250,000 during the 3 year term of the agreement. A member organization committed that they would cover any shortfall owed by the Exchange to NASDAQ. Pursuant to a termination and release notice, dated February 17, 2006, NASDAQ and the Exchange released each other from all obligations in this agreement and the Exchange agreed to pay NASDAQ $320,000 in final satisfaction. A member organization reimbursed the Exchange for such amount.

The Exchange has entered into employment agreements with certain employees. In addition to base salaries, the agreements provide for retention and, in part, incentive bonuses based on criteria established by the Board of Governors.

SCCP is a participant of NSCC and as such submits and guarantees activity of certain of the Exchange’s members for clearance through the SCCP omnibus account. SCCP is entitled to all of the services and benefits of a participant of NSCC and is subject to all of the liabilities of a participant. The Exchange guarantees to NSCC all liabilities and/or obligations of SCCP to NSCC which now, or in the future may arise including liabilities and obligations which may arise from SCCP’s membership in DTC.

In the normal course of its business, the Exchange is exposed to asserted and unasserted claims. In the opinion of management, the resolution of these matters will not have a material adverse affect on the Exchange’s consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

NOTE O - EQUITY

1. Equity

The Exchange is authorized to issue (i) 1,000,000 shares of common stock, 50,500 shares of which are designated Class A Common Stock and 949,500 shares of which are designated Class B Common Stock (collectively, the Common Stock), and (ii) 100,000 shares of preferred stock, all with a par value of $.01 per share. As described below, one share of Series A Preferred Stock was issued.

Shareholder and Independent Governors of the Exchange are elected by the holders of the Common Stock. Member and Designated Independent Governors are chosen, and their removal may be directed by the members (permit holders) of the Exchange. All voting rights of a member are exercised through the member organization with which the member is primarily affiliated. The Member and Designated Independent Governors who are chosen by the members are formally elected at the annual meeting of stockholders by the Phlx Member Voting Trust (the Trust), a Delaware statutory trust whose trustee is an independent institution that is required to vote in accordance with the vote of the Exchange’s members. One share of Series A Preferred Stock of the Exchange was issued to the Trust, the sole purpose of which is to allow the Trust to vote for the election or removal of Member and Designated Independent Governors as directed by a member vote. Except for the election and removal of Member and Designated Independent Governors, and subject to the rights of any class or series of preferred stock if and when issued, the Common Stock retains all voting rights of the stockholders of the Exchange.

The holders of the Common Stock will have all dividend and other distribution rights of stockholders in the Exchange, subject to the rights of any class or series of preferred stock, if and when issued. The Series A Preferred Stock does not have any dividend rights. The Exchange’s by-laws prohibit the payment of dividends from revenues received by the Exchange from regulatory fines, fees or penalties.

On January 20, 2007, the third anniversary of the demutualization of the Exchange, all 46,900 shares of Class A Common Stock converted to Class B Common Stock such that all 441,504 shares of the Exchange are, as of that date, Class B shares. Upon conversion to Class B, the eligibility of holders of Class A shares for a contingent dividend terminated. The former holders of the Class A shares otherwise continue to have the same rights and privileges, including voting, as the Class B holders.

 

(Continued)

 

28


NOTE O - EQUITY - Continued

 

NOTE P - MANAGEMENT EQUITY PLAN

On December 14, 2006, the Exchange established the Philadelphia Stock Exchange, Inc. 2005 Stock Incentive Plan (“Plan”) whereby the Board of Governors may grant Restricted Stock Units (“RSUs”) to management, which is defined in the Plan as a notional unit representing the right to receive one share of stock on a settlement date at which time, all vested RSU’s shall be settled by issuance of shares of stock underlying such vested units, or at the discretion of the Compensation Committee, in cash or partially in cash and partially in shares of stock. The settlement dates shall be the earliest to occur of (i) the third anniversary of the date of the grant; (ii) a change in control; or (iii) termination of employment or service. The Exchange has accounted for the awards using the assumption that the awards will be fully settled in cash. Fair value of the Exchange’s stock is based on an independent valuation. The RSUs shall vest in accordance with the following schedule, subject to each holder’s continued employment or service with the Exchange or its affiliates as applicable: (i) 33.3% of the RSUs shall be vested on the date of the grant; and the remaining 66.7% of such RSUs shall vest ratably in 24 equal monthly installments beginning on the first day of each of the subsequent 24 months following the date of the grant. Compensation expense is charged to earnings over the vesting of each award. The charge is based upon each award’s current value, which is adjusted annually to reflect changes in value associated with movements in the value of the Exchange’s stock. The number of RSUs to be given to each individual was set at a special meeting of the Board of Governors on December 19, 2006. During the year ended December 31, 2006, the Exchange awarded 17,761 RSUs with a grant date value of $860 per unit vesting over three years ending December 31, 2008. Total compensation expense related to the Plan was $5,095,000 for the year ended December 31, 2006 and is included in staffing costs on the consolidated statements of operations and in management equity plan on the consolidated balance sheets. During the year ended December 31, 2007, the Exchange awarded 8,984 RSUs with a grant date value of $1,340 per unit vesting over two and three years ending December 31, 2009. The Exchange revalued all RSU’s as of December 31, 2007 based on a fair value of $1,340 per unit. Total compensation expense related to the Plan was $15,772,000 for the year ended December 31, 2007 and is included in staffing costs on the consolidated statements of operations and in management equity plan on the consolidated balance sheets. The Exchange revalued all RSU’s as of March 31, 2008 based on a fair value of $1,340 per unit. Total compensation expense related to the Plan was $3,234,000 and $1,275,000 for the quarters ended March 31, 2008 and 2007, respectively, and is included in staffing costs on the consolidated statements of operations and in management equity plan on the consolidated balance sheets. Additional compensation expense related to these awards, estimated to be $11,738,000, and the related income taxes, will be recognized over the vesting period through December 31, 2009.

 

(Continued)

 

29


NOTE P - MANAGEMENT EQUITY PLAN - continued

 

Included as part of the compensation approved by the Board of Governors at the December 19, 2006 regular meeting was change of control arrangements for certain members of executive management as well as the Independent Governors on the Board of Governors.

NOTE Q - COMPENSATION PACKAGES

Also in 2007, the Board of Governors approved cash compensation awards totaling $5,000,000 to all Governors substantially similar to RSU awards granted to management, with vesting through December 31, 2008 or at a change in control. The Board of Governors also granted increased executive cash compensation in the amount of $5,300,000 reflecting the Board’s policy to compensate executives at 90% of the Exchange’s peer group, with executives waiving any additional increases to the change in control payments. In 2007, the Board of Governors approved additional change of control agreements for the non-independent Governors.

NOTE R - ACQUISITION AGREEMENT WITH NASDAQ STOCK MARKET, INC.

On November 6, 2007, the Exchange entered into a definitive agreement to be acquired by the NASDAQ Stock Market, Inc. (NASDAQ). The transaction, which has already been approved by the Exchange shareholders, is expected to close in the third quarter of 2008, subject to the approval of appropriate regulatory authorities, including the SEC, and certain other conditions.

NOTE S - STAY PAY BONUSES

Due to the acquisition agreement with NASDAQ, the Exchange implemented stay pay bonus programs in January and April 2008 totaling $4,727,000 payable to employees who continue their employment with the Exchange and/or the NASDAQ through July 30, 2008 and/or August 15, 2008 (stay pay dates). The stay pay bonus will be paid in a lump sum within 30 business days following the stay pay dates.

The Board has also approved compensation in the amount of $5,385,000 for performance and long-term incentive for the first six months of 2008. The bonuses were paid May 15, 2008.

 

30

Exhibit 99.2

Exhibit 99.2

Consolidated Financial Statements and Report of

Independent Certified Public Accountants

The Philadelphia Stock Exchange, Inc. and Subsidiaries

December 31, 2007 and 2006

Contents

 

     Page

Report of Independent Certified Public Accountants

   2

Financial Statements

  

Consolidated Balance Sheets

   3

Consolidated Statements of Operations

   4

Consolidated Statements of Shareholders’ Equity

   5

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

   6

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

   7


LOGO

 

Report of Independent Certified Public Accountants   

Audit Ÿ Tax Ÿ Advisory

Grant Thornton LLP

www.GrantThornton.com

Board of Governors and Members

  

The Philadelphia Stock Exchange, Inc. and Subsidiaries

  

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of the Philadelphia Stock Exchange, Inc. and Subsidiaries (collectively, the Exchange) as of December 31, 2007 and 2006, and the related consolidated statements of operations, shareholders’ equity and cash flows for the years then ended. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Exchange’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States of America as established by the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Exchange’s internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall consolidated financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of the Exchange as of December 31, 2007 and 2006, and the consolidated results of their operations and their consolidated cash flows for the years then ended, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

Our audits were conducted for the purpose of forming an opinion on the basic consolidated financial statements taken as a whole. The financial/operational highlights information is presented for purposes of additional analysis and is not a required part of the basic financial statements. Such information, except for that portion marked “unaudited,” on which we express no opinion, has been subjected to the auditing procedures applied in the audits of the basic consolidated financial statements and, in our opinion, the information is fairly stated in all material respects in relation to the basic consolidated financial statements taken as a whole.

 

LOGO
Philadelphia, Pennsylvania

April 30, 2008

Grant Thornton LLP

U.S. member firm of Grant Thornton International Ltd.


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

December 31,

 

     2007     2006  
     (Dollars in thousands)  
ASSETS     

Current assets

    

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 46,117     $ 50,773  

Restricted cash

     1,643       5,951  

Accounts receivable, net Members

     9,407       6,563  

Payment for order flow

     6,110       4,294  

Others

     4,359       2,843  

Prepaid and other assets

     6,335       3,149  

Deferred income taxes

     —         232  
                

Total current assets

     73,971       73,805  
                

Clearing and depository items

     7,344       7,192  
                

Other assets

    

Advance to clearing accounts

     3,622       3,607  

Investments available for sale, at market

     16,398       15,337  

Investments held to maturity, at amortized cost

     47       110  

Investments held to maturity, at amortized cost - restricted

     3,026       3,023  

Investment in affiliate

     333       333  

Equipment and leasehold improvements, net of accumulated depreciation and amortization

     60,551       42,318  

Other assets

     279       369  

Deferred income taxes, net

     16,335       9,112  
                

Total other assets

     100,591       74,209  
                

Total assets

   $ 181,906     $ 155,206  
                
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY     

Current liabilities

    

Accounts payable and other liabilities

   $ 18,063     $ 14,385  

Payment for order flow

     7,342       9,833  

Deferred revenue

     7,544       7,120  

Deferred credits

     451       451  

Deferred income taxes

     758       —    

Covered sale fee payable

     388       355  
                

Total current liabilities

     34,546       32,144  
                

Clearing and depository items

     7,344       7,192  
                

Accrued retiree benefits

     12,755       10,804  

Management equity plan

     20,867       5,095  

Accrued governance compensation

     2,493       —    

Deferred credits

     4,526       4,977  

Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan

     4,643       3,953  
                
     45,284       24,829  
                

Total liabilities

     87,174       64,165  
                

Shareholders’ equity

    

Common Stock, Class A, $0.01 par value, 0 shares authorized, 0 shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2007; 50,500 shares authorized, 46,900 shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2006

     —         1  

Common Stock, Class B, $0.01 par value, 1,000,000 shares authorized, 441,504 shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2007; 949,500 shares authorized, 394,604 shares issued and outstanding at December 31, 2006

     5       4  

Additional paid-in-capital

     113,614       113,614  

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

     (3,291 )     (3,715 )

Accumulated deficit

     (12,356 )     (15,623 )
                
     97,972       94,281  

Treasury stock

     (3,240 )     (3,240 )
                

Total shareholders’ equity

     94,732       91,041  
                

Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity

   $ 181,906     $ 155,206  
                

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

3


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS

Year ended December 31,

 

     2007    2006  
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Revenues

     

Transaction fees

   $ 100,771    $ 75,710  

Other services

     

Clearing and settlement

     1,891      2,252  

Security price data and floor charges

     12,251      10,673  

Regulatory fees

     10,613      10,350  

Dividend and interest income

     2,896      2,889  

Gain on real estate transaction

     —        5,738  

Other

     7,335      5,934  
               

Total revenues

     135,757      113,546  
               

Operating expenses

     

Staffing costs

     70,067      46,829  

Data processing and communication costs

     12,585      10,505  

Depreciation and amortization

     12,597      11,862  

Occupancy costs

     4,899      4,999  

Professional services

     9,187      7,927  

License costs

     210      1,730  

Equity issued to third parties

     —        15,449  

Governance compensation

     4,366      1,821  

Class action settlement

     3,100      —    

Other

     9,347      3,499  
               

Total operating expenses

     126,358      104,621  
               

Income before income tax expense

     9,399      8,925  

Income tax expense

     6,132      9,349  
               

Net income (loss)

   $ 3,267    $ (424 )
               

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

4


Philadelphia Stock Exchange, Inc. and Subsidiaries

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

Years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006

(In thousands, except share amounts)

 

    Preferred Stock   Class A
Common Stock
    Class B
Common Stock
  Additional
paid-in
capital
    Accumulated
other
comprehensive
loss
    Accumulated
deficit
    Treasury
Stock
    Total
stockholders’
equity
 
    Shares   Amount   Shares     Amount     Shares   Amount          

Balance, December 31, 2005

  1   $ —     46,900     $ 1     45,450   $ 1   $ 98,196     $ (478 )   $ (15,199 )   $ (3,240 )   $ 79,281  
                                                                         

Change in treasury seats

  —       —     —         —       —       —       (28 )     —         —         —         (28 )

Capital contributions

  —       —     —         —       —       —       2       —         —         —         2  

Issuance of Class B Common Stock

  —       —     —         —       349,154     3     (5 )     —         —         —         (2 )

Issuance of warrants

  —       —     —         —       —       —       15,449       —         —         —         15,449  

Effect of adoption of SFAS No. 158, net of taxes

  —       —     —         —       —       —       —         (3,273 )     —         —         (3,273 )

Net loss

  —       —     —         —       —       —       —         —         (424 )     —         (424 )

Other comprehensive income, net of reclassifications and taxes

  —       —     —         —       —       —       —         36       —         —         36  
                                                                         

Total comprehensive loss

                      $ (388 )
                           

Balance, December 31, 2006

  1     —     46,900       1     394,604     4     113,614       (3,715 )     (15,623 )     (3,240 )     91,041  
                                                                         

Change in treasury seats

  —       —     —         —       —       —       —         —         —         —         —    

Conversion of Class A Common Stock

  —       —     (46,900 )     (1 )   46,900     1     —         —         —         —         —    

Net income

  —       —     —         —       —       —       —         —         3,267       —         3,267  

Other comprehensive income, net of reclassifications and taxes

  —       —     —         —       —       —       —         424       —         —         424  
                                                                         

Total comprehensive income

                      $ 3,691  
                           

Balance, December 31, 2007

  1   $ —     —       $ —       441,504   $ 5     113,614       (3,291 )     (12,356 )     (3,240 )   $ 94,732  
                                                                         

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

5


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

Year ended December 31,

 

     2007     2006  

Cash flows from operating activities

    

Net income (loss)

   $ 3,267     $ (424 )

Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by operating activities

    

Amortization/accretion of bond premiums/discounts

     3       29  

Depreciation and amortization

     12,597       11,862  

Equity issued to third parties

     —         15,449  

Provision for rebates, discounts and allowances

     800       80  

Gain on real estates transaction

     —         (5,738 )

Non cash compensation expense

     15,772       5,095  

Settlement of class action lawsuit

     —         (3,406 )

Realized gain on sale of investments

     (533 )     (944 )

Loss on disposal of fixed assets

     339       1,135  

Supplemental executive retirement plan

     931       891  

Deferred taxes

     (6,590 )     (3,339 )

Changes in operating assets and liabilities

    

Accounts receivable

     (6,976 )     (200 )

Prepaid and other assets

     (3,096 )     (477 )

Accounts payable and other liabilities

     6,462       (3,539 )

Deferred credits

     (451 )     2,163  

Deferred revenue

     424       291  

Covered sale fee payable

     33       (259 )
                

Net cash provided by operating activities

     22,982       18,669  
                

Cash flows from investing activities

    

Proceeds from sale of investments

     9,913       9,250  

Purchase of investments

     (10,673 )     (8,260 )

Proceeds from sale of real estate

     —         5,738  

Decrease in restricted cash

     4,308       72  

Capital expenditures

     (31,170 )     (19,713 )

Increase in advance to clearing accounts, net

     (15 )     3  
                

Net cash used in investing activities

     (27,637 )     (12,910 )
                

Cash flows from financing activities

    

Repayments of long-term debt

     —         (46 )

Capital contributions

     —         2  

Proceeds from issuance of Class B common stock

     —         —    

Purchase of treasury stock

     —         —    

Change in treasury seats

     (1 )     (28 )
                

Net cash used in financing activities

     (1 )     (72 )
                

(Decrease) increase in cash and cash equivalents

     (4,656 )     5,687  

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

     50,773       45,086  
                

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

   $ 46,117     $ 50,773  
                

Supplemental disclosures of cash flow information

    

Cash paid during the year for interest

   $ 18     $ 5  
                

Cash paid during the year for taxes

   $ 15,687     $ —    
                

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

6


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

December 31, 2007 and 2006

NOTE A - ORGANIZATION AND OPERATIONS

The Philadelphia Stock Exchange, Inc. (the Exchange), provides a marketplace and facilities for the trading of equity securities, equity option, index option, and foreign currency option products for its members. On January 20, 2004, the Exchange demutualized and was converted from a Delaware non-stock corporation into a Delaware stock corporation. The Exchange’s subsidiaries include the Stock Clearing Corporation of Philadelphia (SCCP), the Philadelphia Board of Trade (PBOT), Advanced Tech Source (ATS), and Phlx Investment Product Services (PIPS). SCCP provides an interface clearing arrangement between certain of the Exchange’s floor members and National Securities Clearing Corporation (NSCC), and also provides margin services to certain market makers. Pursuant to a 1997 Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) order, the Exchange, SCCP, NSCC, and Depository Trust Company (DTC) entered into an agreement whereby SCCP provides limited clearing services. SCCP’s limited clearing services are facilitated through an omnibus account with NSCC and do not include the maintenance or offering of continuous net settlement accounts for its participants. The Exchange and SCCP are subject to regulatory oversight by the SEC. PBOT is subject to oversight by the Commodity Futures Trading Commission and operates as a designated contract market, which allows PBOT to list and trade various futures contracts. PBOT also engages in the distribution of market data products, including futures trading market data and sector index spot and settlement values data. PIPS was organized to develop and to act as sponsor of unit investment trusts to be listed and traded on the Exchange. ATS was organized to provide outsourced data processing services.

On November 10th, 2006, PHLX launched an all-electronic equities exchange, creating a marketplace for executing, displaying, and routing orders in all National Market System Stocks. In addition, the SEC introduced Regulation NMS, designed to enhance and modernize the regulatory structure of the existing national market system (“NMS”). Fundamentally different than floor-based trading, the new equity-trading model is designed in compliance with Regulation NMS, as well as competes with a new technology platform named “XLE”.

NOTE B - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

 

  1. Basis of Presentation

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Exchange and its subsidiaries, SCCP, PBOT, ATS, and PIPS.

Significant intercompany accounts and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation.

 

  2. Use of Estimates

The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements, and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

 

  3. Cash and Cash Equivalents

All highly liquid investments purchased with an original maturity of three months or less are considered cash equivalents.

(Continued)

 

7


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE B - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES - Continued

The Exchange periodically maintains cash balances at a financial institution in excess of the $100,000 Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation insurance limit.

 

  4. Revenue Recognition

Transaction fees and the majority of clearing and settlement service fees relate to trades executed or cleared through the Exchange and its subsidiaries and are recorded on a settlement date basis. Regulatory fees include annual registered representative registration renewal fees and initial, transfer and termination fees from parries that are members of the Exchange. The renewal registration fees are billed annually and collected by the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (FINRA) and remitted to the Exchange in December preceding the effective year, and are deferred and recognized monthly over the course of the effective year. Registered representative initial registration, transfer and termination fees are also billed and collected by FINRA and are remitted monthly to the Exchange and recognized in the month they are assessed to the member. Security price data revenue includes distributions from the Exchange’s participation in the Consolidated Tape Association, the Nasdaq UTP Plan and the Options Price Reporting Authority and PBOT’s market data revenue from sale of the Exchange’s data associated with the current and closing index spot values and the settlement values for the Exchange and SIG Sector Indices and are accrued and recognized in the month the revenue is earned. Floor charges consist predominantly of trading post rental fees and other fees related to operating a trading floor and other revenue includes permit and Foreign Currency Options (FCO) participation fees, which are accrued and recognized in the month the services are provided.

 

  5. Accounts Receivable

The Exchange’s accounts receivable are primarily due from monthly transaction fees and member fees. Credit is extended based on evaluation of customers’ financial condition and, generally, collateral is not required. Accounts receivable are stated in the consolidated financial statements at amounts due from customers net of an allowance for doubtful accounts. Accounts outstanding longer than the payment terms are considered past due. The Exchange determines its allowance by considering a number of factors, including the length of time trade accounts receivable are past due, the Exchange’s previous loss history, the obligor’s current ability to pay its obligation to the Exchange, and the condition of the general economy and the industry as a whole. The Exchange writes-off accounts receivable when they become uncollectible, and payments subsequently received on such receivables are credited to the allowance for doubtful accounts.

 

  6. Investments

Investments classified as available for sale are stated at market value, and any net unrealized gain or loss is reported as a separate component of equity, net of deferred income taxes. Market value was obtained based on available quoted market prices as of December 31, 2007 and 2006. Debt securities for which the Exchange has the intent and ability to hold to maturity are classified as held to maturity and are valued at cost adjusted for the amortization/accretion of premiums/discounts computed by the interest method. Gain or loss recognized on sales of securities are based on the specific classification method and are recorded as of the trade date.

 

(Continued)

8


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE B - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES - Continued

 

  7. Equipment and Leasehold Improvements

Equipment and leasehold improvements are carried at cost less allowances for accumulated depreciation and amortization. Depreciation of furniture and equipment is provided using the straight line method over the estimated useful lives of the applicable assets. Leasehold Improvements are amortized over the lesser of the lease term or the useful lift of such improvements.

 

  8. Restricted Cash

The Exchange has classified cash totaling $11,000 and $12,000 as restricted at December 31, 2007 and 2006, respectively, representing capital contributions from owners of exchange memberships used for funding technological improvements and other capital needs including principal payments with respect to certain loans, as more fully described in note K (Capital Contribution). The Exchange has classified cash totaling $1,232,000 and $5,539,000 as of December 31, 2007 and 2006, respectively, as restricted, representing funds collected from market makers and specialists for the purpose of making qualifying payments for order flow, as more fully described in note I (Payment for Order Flow). Additionally, the Exchange has classified $400,000 as restricted at December 31,2007 and 2006, representing SCCP restricted cash, deposits and escrow amounts.

All SCCP participant funds are maintained in cash, cash equivalents, or short-term investments, except for amounts utilized to satisfy the Depository Trust and Clearing Corporation (DTCC) participant fund requirements with respect to SCCP’s omnibus clearance and settlement accounts. At December 31,2007 and 2006, the participant funds were invested in overnight reverse repurchase agreements.

 

  9. Deferred Revenue

The Exchange has classified amounts totaling $7,544,000 (comprised of regulatory fees of $7,436,000, PBOT member dues of $-0- and licensing fees of $108,000) and $7,120,000 (comprised of regulatory fees of $6,965,000, PBOT member dues of $4,000 and licensing fees of $151,000) as deferred income at December 31, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Deferred income is amortized to income over the applicable future year.

 

  10. Deferred Credits

The Exchange has classified amounts totaling $4,977,000 (comprised of rent credits of $4,642,000 and depreciation credits of $335,000) and $5,428,000 (comprised of rent credits of $4,977,000 and depreciation credits of $451,000) as deferred credits at December 31, 2007 and 2006, respectively. The deferred rent credit (see note N.I) represents the tenant improvement allowance paid to the Exchange and will be amortized over the life of the lease renewal. The deferred depreciation credit represents a reimbursement of equipment purchases and internally developed software expenses related to development of PBOT’s trading platform and will be amortized over the life of the equipment and software.

 

(Continued)

9


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE B - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES - Continued

 

  11. Securities Purchased Under Agreements to Resell

Relative to SCCP, transactions involving purchases of securities under agreements to resell (reverse repurchase agreements or reverse repos) an accounted for as collateralized financings except where SCCP does not have an agreement to sell (or purchase) the same, or substantially the same, securities before maturity at a fixed or determinable price. It is the policy of SCCP to obtain possession of or the legal right to collateral with a market value equal to or in excess of the principal amount loaned under reverse repurchase agreements. Collateral is valued dairy, and SCCP may require counterparties to deposit additional collateral or return pledges when appropriate. As of December 31, 2007 and 2006, SCCP had open reverse repos, which amounted to $5,638,957 and $3,719,147, respectively, reflected in clearing and depository items on the balance sheet. The value of securities taken as collateral for these contracts was $5,920,905 and $3,905,105 at December 31, 2007 and 2006, respectively.

 

  12. Government and Government Agency Securities

Government securities, which are expected to be held until maturity, are stated at cost and adjusted for the amortization of premiums computed by the interest method, which approximates fair value. SCCP maintains a $3,000,000 reserve fund that is invested in government securities. At December 31, 2007 and 2006, this reserve fund was part of investments held to maturity, which totaled $3,025,817 and $3,022,533, respectively. Pursuant to SCCP rules, the reserve fund is to be used to cover all reasonably anticipated operating expenses of SCCP and must be replenished within 60 days of the use of such monies.

 

 

13.

Participants’ Securities Transactions

SCCP’s participants’ securities transactions are reported on a settlement date basis.

 

  14. Participants’ Margin Accounts

Relative to SCCP, margin accounts receivable from and payable to participants include amounts due on cash and margin transactions. Securities owned by participants and held as collateral for receivables were valued at $1,426,000 and $3,440,000 at December 31, 2007 and 2006, respectively. Such collateral is not reflected in the consolidated financial statements. Securities owned by participants are marked to market in determining equity for margining purposes.

SCCP is potentially exposed to credit risk arising from nonperformance of its margin members in meeting their settlement obligations.

 

  15. Income Taxes

Deferred income taxes are recognized for the tax consequences of differences in future years between the tax bases of assets and liabilities and their financial reporting amounts at each year-end based on tax laws and statutory tax rates applicable to the periods in which the differences are expected to result in taxable income. Valuation allowances are established when necessary to reduce deferred tax assets to the amount expected to be realized. Income tax expense is the tax payable for the period and the change during the period in deferred tax assets and liabilities.

 

(Continued)

10


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE B - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES - Continued

 

  16. Computer Software Developed or Obtained for Internal Use

The Exchange follows the provisions of American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (AICPA) Statement of Position (SOP) No. 98-1, Accounting for the Costs of Computer Software Developed or Obtained for Internal Use, which requires entitles to capitalize direct internal and external costs that meet certain capitalization criteria. Accordingly, the Exchange capitalized $5,226,000 and $5,081,000 in 2007 and 2006, respectively.

 

  17. Comprehensive Income

The Exchange follows the provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (SFAS) No. 130, Reporting Comprehensive Income. SFAS No. 130 establishes standards to provide prominent disclosure of comprehensive income items. Comprehensive income is the change in equity of a business enterprise during a period from transactions and other events and circumstances from non-operating sources. Other comprehensive loss consists of net unrealized gains on investment securities available for sale and pension and postretirement plan adjustments. The components of other comprehensive income (loss) are as follows:

 

     Year ended December 31, 2007  
     Before
tax
amount
    Tax
expense

(benefit)
    Net of
tax
amount
 
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Unrealized gains on securities

      

Unrealized holding gains arising during period

   $ 244     $ 112     $ 132  

Less reclassification adjustment for gains realized in net income

     (533 )     (244 )     (289 )
                        

Unrealized gains on securities

     (289 )     (132 )     (157 )

Pension liability adjustments

     1,070       489       581  
                        

Other comprehensive loss, net

   $ (781 )   $ (357 )   $ (424 )
                        

 

     Year ended December 31, 2006  
     Before
tax

amount
    Tax
expense

(benefit)
    Net of
tax
amount
 
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Unrealized gains on securities

      

Unrealized holding gains arising during period

   $  1,252     $ 703     $ 549  

Less reclassification adjustment for gains realized in net income

     (944 )     (431 )     (513 )
                        

Unrealized gains on securities

     308       272       36  
                        

Other comprehensive income, net

   $ 308     $ 272     $ 36  
                        

 

(Continued)

11


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE B - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES - Continued

 

  18. Pension Plan

Pension costs reflect an allocation of aggregate pension costs under a plan sponsored by the Parent. The Exchange funds the plan subject to the full funding limitation of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974.

In September 2006, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued SFAS 158, Employers’ Accounting for Defined Benefit Pension and Other Postretirement Plans: an amendment of FASB Statements No. 87, 88, 106, and 132(R). SFAS 158 requires the Exchange to recognize the funded status of its defined benefit postretirement benefit plan in the Exchange’s statement of financial position. The funded status was previously disclosed in the notes to the Exchange’s financial statements, but differed from the amount recognized in the balance sheet. SFAS 158 does not change the accounting for the Exchange’s defined contribution plan.

The recognition and disclosure provisions of SFAS 158 are effective for fiscal years ending after June 15, 2007, for nonpublic entities with defined benefit plans and are to be applied as of the end of the year of adoption. Retrospective application is not permitted. The Exchange voluntarily adopted the recognition and disclosures provisions of SFAS 158 effective December 31, 2006. The Exchange uses a December 31 measurement date for its pension and postretirement health benefit plan and thus the measurement date provisions will not affect the Exchange.

At December 31, 2006, the Exchange’s projected benefit obligation under its pension and retiree medical health plans exceeded the fair value of the plan assets by $372,240 and $366,861, respectively, and thus the plans are underfunded. The adoption of SFAS 158 had the following effect on the Exchange’s balance sheet as of December 31, 2006:

 

     Prior to
adoption of
Statement 158
    Adjustments     After
adoption of
Statement 158
 

Noncurrent liability

   $  9,495,000     $ 6,404,000     $  15,899,000  

Deferred income taxes

     6,213,000       3,131,000       9,344,000  

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

     (442,000 )     (3,273,000 )     (3,715,000 )

The adoption of SFAS 158 did not affect the Company’s statement of operations for the year ended December 31, 2006, or any prior periods. Application of SFAS 158 will not change the calculation of net income in future periods, but will affect the calculation of other comprehensive income.

 

  19. Postretirement Health Benefit Plan

Net postretirement health benefit costs are not funded. The net transition obligation for the plan is being amortized over a 20-year period, and will be fully amortized by January 1, 2013 (see note M).

 

  20. Advertising Costs

The Exchange expenses advertising costs as incurred. Advertising expense was $212,000 and $161,000 for 2007 and 2006, respectively.

 

(Continued)

12


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE B - SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES - Continued

 

  21. Reclassifications

Certain reclassifications have been made to the 2006 financial statements to conform to the 2007 presentation.

 

  22. New Accounting Pronouncements

In early July 2006, the FASB issued FASB Interpretation (FIN) No. 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes – an Interpretation of Statement No. 109. FIN 48 was issued to address financial statement recognition and measurement by an enterprise of a tax position taken, or expected to be taken, in a tax return. The new standard will require several new disclosures in annual financial statements, including (a) the income statement classification of income tax-related interest and penalties and (b) a reconciliation of the total amount of unrecognized tax benefits. On February 1, 2008, the FASB issued FASB Staff Position (FSP) FIN 48-2, “Effective Date of FASB Interpretation No. 48 for Certain Nonpublic Enterprises.” The FSP defers the effective date of FIN 48, Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes, for certain nonpublic companies to the Exchange’s annual financial statements for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2007. Nonpublic companies subject to the deferral are not required to adopt FIN 48 in interim period financial statements in the year of adoption. Earlier adoption is permitted, but when adopted, FIN 48 must be applied as of the beginning of the Exchange’s fiscal year. The Exchange is still evaluating the impact of adoption of FIN 48.

In September 2006, the FASB issued SFAS No. 157, Fair Value Measurements. SFAS No. 157 clarifies the principle that fair value should be based on assumptions market participants would use when pricing an asset or liability and establishes a fair value hierarchy that prioritizes information used to develop those assumptions. Under the standard, fair value measurements would be separately disclosed by level within the fair value hierarchy. SFAS No. 157 is effective for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2007. The adoption of SFAS No. 157 is not expected to have a material impact on the financial position or results of operations of the Exchange.

In February 2007, the FASB issued SFAS No. 159, The Fair Value Option for Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities – Including an amendment of FASB Statement No. 115. SFAS No. 159 expands the use of fair value accounting but does not affect existing standards, which require assets and liabilities to be carried at fair value. Under SFAS No. 159, a company many elect to use fair value to measure accounts and loans receivable, available-for-sale and held-to-maturity securities, equity method investments, accounts payable, guarantees, issued debt and other eligible financial instruments. SFAS No. 159 is effective for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2007. The Exchange has not determined yet whether it will elect to adopt SFAS No. 159.

NOTE C - REGULATORY DIRECTIVES

Pursuant to investigations conducted by the SEC regarding, among other things, listing and competition-related behavior, and by the United States Department of Justice (DOJ) regarding antitrust, the agencies in the year 2000 entered into settlements with the Exchange and certain other options exchanges.

 

(Continued)

13


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE C - REGULATORY DIRECTIVES - Continued

On September 11, 2000, the SEC issued an Order Instituting Public Administrative Proceedings (the 2000 Order), which accepted the settlement offers of the Exchange and certain other options exchanges, censured them, and, among other things, required them to adopt or modify certain rules regarding listing, allocation, harassment or intimidation, order handling, and certain other competition-related behavior. The 2000 Order also required the Exchange, jointly with other defendant exchanges, to establish a consolidated audit trail system, reform the plan by which capacity is procured and allocated and reform the plan by which exchanges list options. The 2000 Order also required the Exchange and other exchanges to enhance their surveillance, investigation, and enforcement processes.

On September 11, 2000, a U.S. district court entered a Proposed Final Judgment (Judgment), which instituted an antitrust proceeding brought by the DOJ and likewise accepted the settlement offers of the Exchange and certain other options exchanges. The Judgment, which was finalized by the court on December 6, 2000, among other things, established periodic reporting requirements, required the Exchange and the other exchanges to designate an Antitrust Compliance Officer and initiate an Antitrust Compliance Program, and prohibited certain agreements between and among the exchanges. The Judgment expires ten years from the date of its entry.

NOTE D - DISSOLUTION OF PHILADEP

In January 2001, Philadep adopted a Plan of Voluntary Dissolution (the Plan) providing for the cessation of Philadep’s corporate existence pursuant to the Pennsylvania Banking Code of 1965. In connection with the Plan, in February 2001, Philadep and the Exchange entered into an Assumption and Guarantee Agreement (the Assumption Agreement) providing for the Exchange to discharge certain obligations of Philadep not discharged directly by Philadep. Pursuant to the Assumption Agreement, the Exchange assumed Philadep’s obligations under its pension and/or post-retirement benefit plans.

As of December 31, 2002 (the “Final Distribution Date”), by virtue of the Plan and the Assumption Agreement, all funds, assets, and liabilities of Philadep, with a net asset value of $2,185,800, were assigned to and assumed by the Exchange. In 2005, Philadep received tax clearance from the Commonwealth of Pennsylvania and filed Articles of Dissolution with the Pennsylvania Department of Banking which were approved by the Department of Banking in 2006, causing Philadep to be dissolved. In December 2002, the SEC issued an order approving Philadep’s request to withdraw as a registered clearing agency effective as of December 31, 2002. At December 31, 2007 and 2006, the Exchange maintained reserves of $-0- and $194,000, respectively, for potential claims related to dividends and interest on securities that were on deposit with Philadep. The SEC required Philadep to keep a separate minimum reserve of $300,000 to cover potential reorganization claims. In 2000, Philadep was authorized by the SEC to amortize the $300,000 reserve to income over a three-year period.

 

14


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE E - INVESTMENTS

The amortized cost, gross unrealized gains and losses and estimated market values of the Exchange’s investment securities are summarized as follows (in thousands):

 

     2007
     Amortized
cost
   Gross
unrealized
gains
   Gross
unrealized
losses
   Estimated
market
value
          (Dollars in thousands)     

Available-for-sale

           

Equity securities

   $ 13,036    $ 2,807    $ 503    $ 15,340

Debt securities

     1,049      14      5      1,058
                           
   $ 14,085    $ 2,821    $ 508    $ 16,398
                           

Held-to-maturity

           

Debt securities

   $ 3,073    $ 23    $ 1    $ 3,095
                           
     2006
      Amortized
cost
   Gross
unrealized
gains
   Gross
unrealized
losses
   Estimated
market
value
          (Dollars in thousands)     

Available-for-sale

           

Equity securities

   $ 12,145    $ 2,731    $ 125    $ 14,751

Debt securities

     579      12      5      586
                           
   $ 12,724    $ 2,743    $ 130    $ 15,337
                           

Held-to-maturity

           

Debt securities

   $ 3,133    $ —      $ 24    $ 3,109
                           

The amortized cost and estimated market value of investment securities, by contractual maturity at December 31, 2007 (in thousands), are shown below:

 

     Available-for-sale    Held-to-maturity
     Amortized
cost
   Estimated
market
value
   Amortized
cost
   Estimated
market
value
          (Dollars in thousands)     

Due within five years

   $ —      $ —      $ 3,073    $ 3,095

Municipal securities

     523      532      —        —  

Mortgage-backed securities

     516      526      —        —  
                           

Total debt securities

   $ 1,039    $ 1,058    $ 3,073    $ 3,095
                           

 

(Continued)

15


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE E - INVESTMENTS - Continued

Proceeds from the sales of investments and gross realized gains and losses on such sales for 2007 and 2006 were as follows:

 

     2007     2006  
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Proceeds

   $ 9,876     $ 9,250  

Gross gains

     926       1,297  

Gross losses

     (393 )     (353 )

The table below indicates the length of time individual securities have been in a continuous unrealized loss position as of December 31,2007 (in thousands):

 

Description of
Securities

   Number
of
securities
   Less than 12 months    12 months or longer    Total
      Fair
value
   Unrealized
losses
   Fair
value
   Unrealized
losses
   Fair
value
   Unrealized
losses

Mortgage-backed securities

   5    $ —      $ —      $ 140    $ 3    $ 140    $ 3

Marketable equity securities

   19      4,015      505      —        —        4,015      505
                                              

Total temporarily impaired investment securities

   24    $ 4,015    $ 505    $ 140    $ 3    $ 4,155    $ 508
                                              

Management has considered factors regarding other than temporarily impaired securities and determined that there are no securities that are impaired as of December 31, 2007.

The Company invests a portion of its investments in auction-rate securities, the market for which has recently undergone significant change. As of December 31, 2007, the Exchange had approximately $1,000,000 in auction-rate securities (“ARS”). ARSs have a long-term stated maturity, but are reset through a “dutch auction” process that occurs periodically depending on the terms of the individual security. Until February 2008, the ARS market was highly liquid. During February 2008, however, a significant number of auctions related to these securities failed, meaning that there was not enough demand to sell the entire issue at auction. The impact of the failed auctions on holders of ARS is that the holder cannot sell the securities and the issuer’s interest rate is generally reset to a higher “penalty” rate.

At December 31, 2007 and 2006, the Company held 4.70 shares of DTCC common stock. As a member firm of DTCC, the Exchange is designated, by DTCC rule, as a mandatory purchaser participant and is required to own the shares for as long as it remains a member. The number of shares required to be owned is determined by DTCC and the Exchange is prohibited from owning anything more or less than the amount calculated by DTCC. The shares are substantially restricted and cannot be sold to any party other than the DTCC. For this reason, these shares are recorded at cost and are classified in other assets on the Exchange’s balance sheet at December 31, 2007 and 2006.

 

16


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE F - INVESTMENT IN AFFILIATE

The Exchange has a minority equity interest in The Options Clearing Corporation (OCC) carried at cost totaling $333,000. In the event the Exchange should cease to be qualified to participate in OCC, OCC has the right to purchase all the shares owned by the Exchange. The shareholders’ agreement provides that the purchase price will be the lesser of the Exchange’s cost or the aggregate book value of the shares.

It is intended that the income of OCC will either be distributed to the member exchanges or retained within OCC. This determination will be made annually by the OCC Board of Directors. As the investment in OCC is not marketable and because there is little likelihood of dividends being distributed to the shareholders, the Exchange will realize its share of OCC’s equity upon ultimate liquidation of OCC, an event not in the foreseeable future. Accordingly, the investment in OCC is carried at the Exchange’s cost. There were no distributions in 2007 and 2006.

NOTE G - EQUIPMENT AND LEASEHOLD IMPROVEMENTS

The Exchange’s investment in equipment and leasehold improvements comprises the following:

 

     Estimated
useful lives
   2007    2006
          (Dollars in thousands)

Equipment

   3-7 years    $ 53,123    $ 45,846

Software

   5 years      43,341      39,099

Leasehold Improvements

   Various      28,239      15,638
                
        124,703      100,583

Less - accumulated depreciation and amortization

        64,152      58,265
                
      $ 60,551    $ 42,318
                

NOTE H - CLEARING ITEMS

The clearing items represent cash, receivables and payables for open securities transactions cleared for participants through SCCP’s clearing system. A summary of the balances at December 31, 2007 and 2006, follows:

 

     2007    2006
     (Dollars in thousands)

Cash - restricted

   $ 67    $ 122

Securities purchased under agreements to resell - restricted

     3,012      2,786

Securities purchased under agreements to resell

     2,627      933

Cash

     108      113

Margin accounts, debit balances

     1,104      2,895

Miscellaneous accounts, debit balances

     1      7

Omnibus accounts with other clearing organizations

     4      2

Deposits with other clearing agencies

     421      334
             
   $ 7,344    $ 7,192
             

 

(Continued)

17


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE H - CLEARING ITEMS - Continued

 

     2007    2006
     (Dollars in thousands)

Margin accounts, credit balances

   $ 215    $ 298

Continuous net settlement and other accounts, credit balances

     7      17

Participants’ fund

     3,500      3,242

Advance from corporate accounts

     3,622      3,607

Dividend and other payables

     —        28
             
   $ 7,344    $ 7,192
             

SCCP participants are required to contribute to the Participants’ Fund (the Fund). Amounts are dependent upon the nature and volume of services utilized by the participant. The Fund is designed to provide security for participants’ obligations to SCCP, and is available to protect against the possibility of certain losses and as necessary to meet participant fund requirements of NSCC and/or DTC. SCCP determined that each participant’s contribution was to accordance with the formulas approved by the SCCP Board of Directors. All formulas were applied to all SCCP participants on a uniform non-discriminatory basis.

All required contributions to the Fund must be made in cash and SCCP may allocate any portion of the Fund to satisfy DTCC’s participant fund requirements with respect to SCCP’s Omnibus Clearance and Settlement account. Accordingly, at December 31, 2007, SCCP had $420,000 deposited with DTCC, at December 31, 2006, SCCP had $334,000 deposited with DTCC. SCCP’s excess participant fund cash not used to fund its DTCC participants’ fund requirements is segregated and invested by SCCP in accordance with its rules.

SCCP rebates interest monthly to participants with deposits greater than $50,000 at the average federal funds rate, less one half of a percent. During 2007 and 2006, SCCP rebated $34,000 and $36,000, respectively, in interest, to the participants in accordance with the formulas. The participants’ fund consisted of $3,500,000 and $3,242,000 in cash deposits and securities at December 31, 2007 and 2006, respectively.

NOTE I - PAYMENT FOR ORDER FLOW

The Exchange administers the collection and payment of Payment for Order Flow (“PFOF”) fees assessed on certain qualifying transactions. PFOF funds are made available to order flow providers at the direction of specialist units and Directed Registered Options Traders. At December 31, 2007, the Exchange held total cash in the amount of $1,232,000 and total receivable and payable balances of $6,110,000 and $7,342,000, respectively, related to its PFOF programs. At December 31, 2006, the Exchange held total cash in the amount of $5,539,000 and total receivable and payable balances of $4,294,000 and $9,833,000, respectively, related to its PFOF programs.

NOTE J - NOTES PAYABLE

The Exchange had no loan obligations at December 31, 2007 and 2006. The Exchange had a capital lease obligation of $46,000 at December 31, 2005, which was paid off in 2006.

 

(Continued)

18


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE J - NOTES PAYABLE - Continued

During 2007, the Exchange maintained two collateralized line of credit facilities. Under these facilities, the Exchange has lines of credit totaling $10,000,000, comprised of agreements of $5,000,000 each at two different banks. Interest on outstanding balances is payable at the prime rate minus 0.5% and the prime rate, respectively. During 2006, the Exchange maintained two collateralized line of credit facilities. Under these facilities, the Exchange has lines of credit totaling $10,000,000, comprised of agreements of $5,000,000 each at two different banks. Interest on outstanding balances is payable at the prime rate. The Exchange has pledged a minimum of $1,500,000 in marketable securities and certain of its accounts receivable to each bank as collateral for the lines of credit. At December 31, 2007 and 2006, no portion of the lines of credit was outstanding.

During 2007 and 2006, SCCP maintained two collateralized line-of-credit agreements. Under these agreements, SCCP has lines of credit totaling $40,000,000, comprised of agreements of $20,000,000 each at two different banks. Interest is payable to the two accounts at the federal funds rate plus 1.6%. At December 31,2007 and 2006, no portion of the lines of credit was outstanding.

NOTE K - CAPITAL CONTRIBUTION

In June 2000, the Exchange implemented a three-year capital contribution program. The program assessed a $1,500/month contribution on owners of the Exchange’s 505 seats to be used to provide funding for technological improvements and other capital needs. Through December 31, 2007, the Exchange had collected $27,188,000 (2007 - $-0-; 2006 - $2,000; 2005 - $6,000; 2004 - $33,000; 2003 - $4,251,000; 2002 - $9,336,000; 2001 - $8,888,000; 2000 - $4,672,000) from its seat owners. The program expired in May 2003.

NOTE L - INCOME TAXES

The components of the provision for income taxes are as follows:

 

     Year ended December 31,  
     2007     2006  
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Currently payable

    

Federal

   $ 6,830     $ 7,260  

Stale and local

     5,892       5,545  
                
     12,722       12,805  
                

Deferred taxes

     (6,590 )     (3,456 )
                
   $ 6,132     $ 9,349  
                

The 2007 and 2006 provisions for income taxes are different from the amount which would be provided by applying the statutory Federal income tax rate to the income (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes, primarily as a result of permanent book tax differences and tax credits.

Deferred taxes result from federal and state net operating losses, recording depreciation, pension costs, deferred compensation, retiree medical benefits, unrealized gains/losses on investments, the reserve for possible losses on aged items in different periods for financial accounting and income tax reporting purposes, research and development credits and valuation allowance.

 

(Continued)

19


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE L - INCOME TAXES - Continued

The components of the net deferred tax asset/liability recognized in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets are as follows:

 

     Year ended December 31,  
     2007     2006  
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Deferred tax assets

   $ 35,250     $
 
 
27,051
 
 

Defend tax liability

     18,031       16,065  
                

Net deferred tax asset before valuation allowance

     17,219       10,986  

Valuation allowance

     (1,642 )     (1,642 )
                

Net deferred tax asset

   $ 15,577     $ 9,344  
                

During 2006, the Exchange performed a study regarding available Research and Development (“R&D”) tax credits relating to their internally development software. Based upon this study, there are $5,037,000 of R&D credits available to the Exchange that were generated between 1998 and 2006. As of December 31,2007, the Exchange had net deferred tax assets relating to research and development credits of $4,014,000. These credits expire in 2018 through 2026. Additionally, alternative minimum tax credits are available of approximately $549,000 for 2006. The Exchange has approximately $5,000,000, expiring through 2024, of net operating loss carryforwards available to reduce future federal taxable income. These net operating losses are subject to an annual limitation under Internal Revenue Code Section 382 of approximately $2,100,000.

The Exchange files a consolidated federal income tax return. It is the Exchange’s policy to calculate all taxes on a separate company basis. Any tax calculated at the subsidiary level is paid to the parent for subsequent payment to the federal government.

NOTE M - EMPLOYEE BENEFITS

 

  1. Pension Plan

The Company participates in a trusteed noncontributory pension plan and a postretirement benefit plan covering substantially all employees of the Parent and its subsidiaries. The Company provides defined benefits which are generally a function of years of service and based on an employee’s average pay over the employee’s career with the Company.

 

(Continued)

20


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE M - EMPLOYEE BENEFITS - Continued

The funded status of the defined benefit plan and postretirement benefit plan is as follows:

 

     Pension benefits     Postretirement benefits  
     2007     2006     2007     2006  
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Change in benefit obligation

        

Benefit obligation, beginning of year

   $ 27,969     $ 27,252     $ 9,184     $ 8,595  

Service cost

     1,829       1,641       697       688  

Interest cost

     1,519       1,503       546       489  

Assumption changes

     895       (1,080 )     783       —    

Actuarial gain

     (2,423 )     (904 )     (297 )     (463 )

Benefits paid

     (475 )     (443 )     (156 )     (125 )
                                

Benefit obligation, end of year

     29,314       27,969       10,757       9,184  
                                

Change in plan assets

        

Fair value of plan assets, beginning of year

     25,625       19,883       —         —    

Return on plan assets

     1,584       2,235       —         —    

Employer contributions

     358       3,948       156       125  

Expenses

     (18 )     2       —         —    

Benefits paid

     (475 )     (443 )     (156 )     (125 )
                                

Fair value of plan assets, end of year

     27,074       25,625       —         —    
                                

Funded status, end of year

   $ (2,240 )   $ (2,344 )   $ (10,757 )   $ (9,184 )
                                

Amounts recognized in balance sheets at December 31,2007

        

Current liabilities (anticipated contributions)

   $ —       $ —       $ (242 )   $ (155 )

Noncurrent liabilities

     (2,240 )     (2,344 )     (10,515 )     (9,029 )
                                

Net amount recognized in balance sheets

   $ (2,240 )   $ (2,344 )   $ (10,757 )   $ (9,184 )
                                

Amounts recognized in accumulated other comprehensive loss

        

Net actuarial loss

   $ 2,377     $ 3,412     $ 3,894     $ 3,586  

Unrecognized transition obligation

     —         —         89       107  

Prior service cost

     49       134       —         —    
                                
   $ 2,426     $ 3,546     $ 3,983     $ 3,693  
                                

 

(Continued)

21


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE M - EMPLOYEE BENEFITS - Continued

The postretirement benefit plan provides certain health care and life insurance benefits for retired employees. Substantially all of the Company’s employees may become eligible for those benefits if they reach normal retirement age white employed by the Company and fulfill other eligibility requirements as specified by the plan.

The accumulated benefit obligation for the pension plan at December 31, 2007 and 2006 was $29,314,000 and $27,969,000, respectively. The accumulated postretirement benefit obligation at December 31, 2007 and 2006 was $10,737,000 and $9,184,000, respectively.

 

     Pension benefits     Postretirement benefits  
     2007     2006     2007     2006  

Weighted-average assumptions used to determine benefit obligations at December 31

        

Discount rate

   6.00 %   6.00 %   6.00 %   6.00 %

Rate of compensation increase

   4.50     4.50     4.50     4.50  

Weighted-average assumptions used to determine net periodic benefit cost for years ended December 31

        

Discount rate

   6.00 %   5.75 %   6.00 %   5.75 %

Expected long-term return on plan assets

   8.00     8.00     N/A     N/A  

Rate of compensation increase

   4.50     4.50     4.50     4.50  

The Exchange sets the discount rate assumption annually for its retirement-related benefit plan at the measurement date to reflect the yield of high-quality fixed-income debt instruments.

Assumed health care cost trend rates related to postretirement benefits at December 31:

 

     2007     2006  

Current trend rate

     9.00 %     9.50 %

Ultimate trend rate

     5.00 %     5.00 %

Year that the rate reaches the ultimate trend rate

     2015       2015  
     Year ended December 31,  
     2007     2006  
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Effect of 1% Change in Assumed Healthcare Trend rates

    

One-Percentage point Increase

    

Effect on Total of Service Cost and Interest Cost

   $ 210     $ 276  

Effect on Postretirement Benefit Obligation

     1,658       1,800  

One-Percentage point Increase

    

Effect on Total of Service Cost and Interest Cost

     (168 )     (215 )

Effect on Postretirement Benefit Obligation

     (1,342 )     (1,437 )

 

(Continued)

22


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE M - EMPLOYEE BENEFITS - Continued

The Exchange’s net periodic pension cost and other postretirement benefits costs include the following components:

 

     Pension Benefits     Postretirement benefits
     2007     2006     2007    2006
     (Dollars in thousands)

Service cost

   $ 1,829     $ 1,641     $ 697    $ 688

Interest cost

     1,519       1,503       546      489

Expected return on plan assets

     (2,059 )     (1,645 )     —        —  

Amortization of transition obligation

     —         —         18      18

Amortization of prior service cost

     85       85       —        2

Amortization of net losses

     —         228       178      224
                             

Net periodic benefit cost

   $ 1,374     $ 1,812     $ 1,439    $ 1,421
                             

The Exchange’s expected long-term rate on pension plan assets of 8% is based on the aggregate historical returns of the investments that comprise the defined benefit plan portfolio over the most recent six consecutive year period. The investment strategy of the plan is to achieve an asset allocation balance within planned targets to preserve principal while obtaining an average 8% annual return for the long-term.

The Exchange’s strategy is to fund its defined benefit pension plan obligations. The need for further contributions will be based on changes in the value of plan assets and the movements of interest rates during the year. The Exchange expects to contribute $-0- to the pension plan in 2008. The Exchange’s pension plan asset allocation at December 31, 2007 and 2006, and target allocation for 2008 by category are as follows;

 

      Percentage of
plan assets
    Target
allocation
 

Asset category

   2007     2006     2008  

Equity securities

   69 %   68 %   65 %

Fixed income securities

   29 %   28 %   30 %

Cash

   2 %   4 %   5 %

The following assumed benefit payments, which reflect expected future service, as appropriate, are expected to be paid as follows:

 

     Pension
benefits
   Postretirement
benefits
     (Dollars in thousands)

2008

   $ 763    $ 242

2009

     841      278

2010

     925      304

2011-2016

     11,942      3,226

 

(Continued)

23


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE M - EMPLOYEE BENEFITS - Continued

 

  2. Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan

The Exchange maintains nonqualified Supplemental Executive Retirement Plans (“Plans”) for certain key executives. The Plans are unfunded. The Exchange has reflected its liability related to the Plans of $4,643,000 and $3,953,000 as deferred compensation in the accompanying balance sheet at December 31, 2007 and 2006, respectively.

The funded status of the Plans are as follows:

 

     Plan #1     Plan #2  
     2007     2006     2007     2006  
     (Dollars in thousands)  

Change in benefit obligation

        

Benefit obligation, beginning of year

   $ 132     $ 139     $ 3,821     $ 3,382  

Service cost

     —         —         459       457  

Interest cost

     7       8       229       191  

Assumption changes

     5       (1 )     —         —    

Actuarial loss

     19       18       3       (209 )

Benefits paid

     (32 )     (32 )     —         —    
                                

Benefit obligation, end of year

   $ 131     $ 132     $ 4,512     $ 3,821  
                                

Change in plan assets

        

Fair value of plan assets, beginning of year

   $ —       $ —       $ —       $ —    

Employer contributions

     32       32       —         —    

Benefits paid

     (32 )     (32 )     —         —    
                                

Fair value of plan assets, end of year

   $ —       $ —       $ —       $ —    
                                

Funded Status, end of year

   $ (131 )   $ (132 )   $ (4,512 )   $ (3,821 )
                                

Amount recognized in accumulated other comprehensive loss

   $ 116     $ 111     $ (1 )   $ (3 )

Net actuarial loss (gain)

     —         —         1,859       2,107  
                                

Prior service cost

   $ 116     $ 111     $ 1,858     $ 2,104  
                                

The accumulated benefit obligation for Plan #1 at December 31, 2007 and 2006 was $131,000 and $132,000, respectively. The accumulated benefit obligation for Plan #2 at December 31, 2007 and 2006 was $4,512,000 and $3,821,000, respectively.

 

(Continued)

24


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE M - EMPLOYEE BENEFITS - Continued

 

     Plan #1     Plan #2  
     2007     2006     2007     2006  

Weighted-average assumptions used to determine benefit obligations at December 31

        

Discount rate

   6.00 %   6.00 %   6.00 %   6.00 %

Rate of compensation increase

   4.50     4.50     4.00     4.00  

Weighted-average assumptions used to determine net periodic benefit cost for years ended December 31

        

Discount rate

   6.00 %   5.75 %   6.00 %   5.75 %

Expected long-term return on plan assets

   8.00     8.00     N/A     N/A  

Rate of compensation increase

   4.50     4.50     4.00     4.00  

The Exchange sets the discount rate assumption annually for its retirement-related benefit plan at the measurement date to reflect the yield of high-quality fixed-income debt instruments.

The Exchange’s net periodic pension cost includes the following components:

 

     Plan #1    Plan #2
     2007    2006    2007    2006
     (Dollars in thousands)

Service cost

   $ —      $ —      $ 459    $ 457

Interest cost

     7      7      229      192

Amortization of prior service cost

     —        —        248      248

Amortization of net losses

     19      20      —        —  
                           

Net periodic benefit cost

   $ 26    $ 27    $ 936    $ 897
                           

The following assumed benefit payments, which reflect expected future service, as appropriate, are expected to be paid as follows:

 

     Plan #1
benefits
   Plan #2
benefits
     (Dollars in thousands)

2008

   $ 32    $ 64

2009

     26      61

2010

     22      58

2011-2017

     75      3,683

 

(Continued)

25


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE M - EMPLOYEE BENEFITS - Continued

 

  3. Savings Plan

The Exchange and SCCP also participate in a voluntary defined contribution 401(k) plan which covers substantially all of the Exchange and its Subsidiaries’ employees. Employer contributions to this 401(k) plan were $716,000 in 2007 and $618,000 in 2006.

In December 2006, the Board of Governors approved changes to the Exchange’s retirement program. Employees hired on or after January 1, 2007 will participate in an enhanced 401(k) plan only. Employees hired prior to January 1, 2007 will be given a one-time opportunity to choose between continued participation in the current defined benefit pension plan plus current 401(k) plan or participation in the enhanced 401(k) plan.

 

  4. Postretirement Health Benefit Plan

The Exchange adopted SFAS No. 106, Employer’s Accounting for Postretirement Benefits Other Than Pensions, as of January 1, 1993. This statement requires the accrual of the cost of providing postretirement benefits, including medical and life insurance coverage, during the active service period of the employee. The transition obligation as of January 1,1993, was estimated to be $2,617,000, which the Exchange has elected to amortize over 20 years as permitted by SFAS No. 106.

On December 8, 2003, the President signed into law the Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act of 2003 (the “Act”). The Act provides for an expansion of Medicare, primarily adding a prescription drug benefit for Medicare-eligible retirees starting in 2006. The Act also provides a federal subsidy to sponsors that provide a benefit that is at least actuarially equivalent to Medicare Part D. The Exchange has concluded that the benefits provided by the plans are actuarially equivalent to Medicare Part D under the legislation, and that the effects of the Act on medical obligations and costs to the Company are not significant.

NOTE N - COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

 

  1. Operating Leases

Rental expense was $4,441,000 in 2007 and $4,434,000 in 2006. Rental expense includes $223,000 in 2007 and $358,000 in 2006, for taxes and maintenance related to leased property.

The Exchange’s minimum future annual rental obligations, exclusive of insurance, maintenance, and other costs, applicable to existing operating leases, are as follows:

 

Year ending December 31, (in thousands)

    

2008

   $ 3,895

2009

     3,806

2010

     3,742

2011 and thereafter

     42,696
      
   $ 54,139
      

 

(Continued)

26


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE N - COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES - Continued

The Exchange leases its facilities under leases which are included in the preceding commitment schedule. Two lease agreements expired in May 2005 and two in October 2006, one of which was renewed for an additional 15 year lease term (primary lease). In December 2004, the Exchange renewed its lease agreement for approximately 91,000 square feet of office space at its existing location and in March 2005 and July 2005, the Exchange expanded its space to primarily address the other lease agreements that were expiring in May 2005 and October 2006 and to expand its data center for approximately 56,000 square feet of additional office space. In October 2006, the Exchange increased its space to expand its data center for approximately 7,000 square feet of office space. For the primary space, the lease term is 15 years, effective November 1, 2006, and contains a renewal option for extending the agreement for an additional two consecutive five-year terms. The five-year renewal options provide for possible escalation in annual rental costs depending on certain economic factors between now and the exercise periods of the renewal options. The expansion space commenced between June 1, 2005 and November 1, 2006 with free rent periods on certain amounts of space from between three months and seventeen months. It is co-terminus with the primary lease. Additionally, the landlord reimbursed the Exchange $2,708,000 in 2005 and $2,380,000 from January through February 2006 for tenant improvements made after January 1, 2003. Reimbursement of tenant improvements is recorded as deferred rent credits and will be amortized on a straight-line basis over the 15 year lease renewal term as a reduction of rent expense. The lease agreements include termination options in October 2011 and 2016, subject to a termination fee.

In June 2006, the Exchange expanded its space to accommodate its data center by approximately 26,000 square feet of office space in a Keystone Opportunity Zone, in which the Exchange qualified for state and local tax savings through 2018. The lease term is 15 years and 6 months, effective November 30, 2007, and contains a renewal option for extending the agreement for an additional two consecutive five-year terms. The five-year renewal options provide for possible escalation in annual rental costs depending on certain economic factors between now and the exercise periods of the renewal options. The landlord will reimburse the Exchange $762,000 in 2008 for tenant improvements. Reimbursement of tenant improvements will be recorded as deferred rent credits and will be amortized on a straight-line basis over the 15 year lease renewal term as a reduction of rent expense.

In May of 2006, pursuant to rights granted to the Exchange in its main lease, the Exchange acquired a limited partnership interest in Market 1900 Associates, L.P., a Pennsylvania limited partnership, an entity which, in turn, acquired a partnership interest of the entity whose primary asset is the real estate in which the Exchange’s main leased premises are located. The Exchange recognized a gain of $5,738,000 on the purchase and subsequent sale of these ownership interests.

 

  2. Class Action Settlement

In May 2000, the Exchange settled consolidated class action lawsuits filed against it and certain other exchanges in October 1999 (the Original Settlements). The lawsuits alleged antitrust violations in connection with the listing of options. The Exchange was obligated under its Original Settlement Agreement to pay $2,800,000 (the Original Settlement Amount) to plaintiffs, which was accrued and included in the 2000 Consolidated Statement of Operations in Other Expenses. Payment of the Original Settlement Amount was secured by a letter of credit issued by a bank, which was renewed every year since 2001 and expired on November 28, 2005 and was not renewed due to the Original Settlement Agreement being replaced by a Modified Settlement Agreement, as described below.

 

(Continued)

27


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE N - COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES - Continued

In February 2001, the Court before whom the class action was filed issued an order granting a summary judgment motion filed by all Exchanges on the grounds that the Exchanges are entitled to implied immunity from liability under the antitrust laws. In April 2001, the Court issued an order stating that, as a result of its granting summary judgment, it does not have jurisdiction to entertain the plaintiffs’ request to preliminarily approve the proposed settlement, and thus denied the plaintiffs’ motion for approval of the settlement. The plaintiffs in April and May 2001 appealed the Court orders. In January 2003, after appellate briefing and oral argument, the Appellate Court issued a decision in which it a) affirmed the Court’s dismissal of the class action complaint on the basis of implied repeal, and b) vacated the Court’s order stating (that it did not have jurisdiction to hear motions for preliminary approval of the settlements and remanded the matter to the Court to entertain such motions. The plaintiffs filed a petition win the Court of Appeals for panel rehearing and for rehearing on banc. This petition was denied.

In February 2004, the plaintiffs filed a motion with the Court seeking preliminary approval of the Original Settlements including the Exchange’s. In July 2004, the Court issued a complex order and decision regarding the Original Settlements wherein, among other things, the court agreed with certain objections to the settlement while approving the original settlement of one of the exchange defendants. In January 2006, the Exchange, the other exchange defendants and several market maker defendants submitted to the Court a Modified Settlement Agreement that was complemented by supplemental settlement agreements of additional defendants (collectively the Modified Settlement Agreement). On February 8, 2006, the Court entered an order preliminarily approving the Modified Settlement Agreement and scheduling May 22, 2006, for consideration of final approval of the settlement. Pursuant to the Modified Settlement Agreement the Exchange is obligated to pay a Modified Settlement amount that is significantly reduced from the Original Settlement Amount. As a result, the Exchange paid $575,000 ($525,000 principal, $50,000 interest) and reversed $3,406,000 ($2,275,000 in principal, $1,131,000 in interest) of previously accrued settlement liabilities through other expenses which are reflected in operating expenses in the consolidated statement of operations. An amended final judgment and order approving the Modified Settlement Agreement was entered on December 14, 2006. No appeal was taken on the final judgment, and the settlement under the Modified Settlement Agreement is final.

 

  3. Other

In December 2003, six purported trading firms sued the Exchange and other options exchanges, ROTs, and specialists in federal court in Chicago, alleging improper handling at options orders placed by these firms. The case was dismissed by order of the court on March 30, 2005, but plaintiffs were permitted to amend their complaint excluding antitrust allegations. Other similarly situated plaintiffs filed similar complaints against the Exchange, among others, on September 28, 2005 and September 30, 2005, respectively. All of these have been consolidated with this first case. Plaintiffs’ amended complaint (without antitrust claims), with allegations very similar to the original complaints, was dismissed on September 13,2006 and their Motion for Reconsideration was denied on March 22, 2007. Plaintiffs’ appeal to the United States Court of Appeals was dismissed on April 20, 2007. The Exchange is producing a response to a third party subpoena, but is no longer a party to the action.

In 1998, Joseph Carapico, a member of the Exchange, and PennMont Securities (“PennMont”), an entity through which he trades securities at the Exchange, filed suit against the Exchange in Pennsylvania Common Pleas Court. The suit was amended in 2003 to request the Court to appoint a custodian to conduct the business of the Exchange, direct defendants to provide immediate notice to members of the commencement of any exploratory talks regarding certain corporate transactions, declare whether any fundamental transaction that might be undertaken by the Exchange was lawful, and enjoin the Exchange from

 

(Continued)

28


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

NOTE N - COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES - Continued

 

pursuing certain mergers, sales of assets, conversions, or other transfers. On October 6, 2004, the Court granted summary judgment against the plaintiffs and dismissed the case with prejudice. On February 24, 2006, the Superior Court affirmed, and on September 15, 2006, the Supreme Court of Pennsylvania denied plaintiffs’ petition for allowance of appeal, ending the litigation in favor of the Exchange. The Exchange now seeks recovery of nearly $1,000,000 in legal fees pursuant to Exchange Rule 651.

PennMont, a member of the Exchange, filed suit on December 31, 2007 against the Exchange and Meyer S. Frucher, the Exchange’s Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, seeking to enjoin PHLX’s enforcement of Exchange Rule 651 against PennMont and seeking damages in connection therewith. On February 13, 2008, after the parties had briefed PennMont’s motion for a temporary restraining order and a preliminary injunction, the Court denied the motion and dismissed the action for failure to state a claim. PennMont filed an appeal to the United States Court of Appeals for the Third Circuit, which remains pending. On February 27, 2008, the District Court denied PennMont’s emergency motion for injunction pending appeal, and on March 7, 2008, the United States Court of Appeals for the Third Circuit denied a similar emergency motion for injunction pending appeal.

PennMont, a member of the Exchange, filed suit on December 22, 2005 against five individuals: Meyer S. Frucher, the Exchange’s Chairman and Chief Executive Officer; William Briggs, the Exchange’s Executive Vice President; Norman Steisel, the Exchange’s Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer; and Kevin Foley and Christopher Nagy, former members of the Exchange’s Board of Governors. The Exchange is advancing defense expenses to the Defendants in accordance with its Restated Certificate of Incorporation and By-Laws. The complaint alleges mismanagement from the mid-1990s forward, with a specific focus on demutualization, and alleges direct shareholder class action and derivative claims under the Racketeer Influenced and Corrupt Organizations Act and nine common law causes of action. The complaint seeks monetary damages for plaintiffs and fellow shareholders. Defendants filed a motion to dismiss the complaint on multiple grounds. The Court dismissed the matter for failure to state a claim on August 15, 2007, and plaintiff has filed an appeal to the United States Court of Appeals for the Third Circuit.

Certain Exchange shareholders and members filed a proposed shareholder class action suit on June 14, 2006 in the United States. District Court for the Eastern District of Pennsylvania, alleging securities fraud against the Exchange’s Board of Governors and its officer Norman Steisel (the “Exchange Defendants”) in connection with the six strategic investments secured by the Exchange in June and August 2005. The Exchange is advancing defense expenses to the Exchange Defendants in accordance with its Restated Certificate of Incorporation and By-Laws. The complaint also alleged “fraudulent transfer” of Exchange stock against the Strategic Investors. Plaintiffs requested rescission of the sale of stock to the Strategic Investors, or in the alternative, monetary damages. On July 19, 2006, plaintiffs filed an amended complaint that expanded upon the securities fraud claim asserted against the Exchange Defendants to attack not only the Strategic Transactions, but also demutualization and the Exchange’s September 2005 self-tender offer. Plaintiffs requested the following relief: (i) rescission of stock sales pursuant to the tender offer; (ii) reversal of demutualization “to the extent such is possible and, to the extent such is not possible,” damages; and (iii) rescission of the stock issued to the Strategic Investors. The amended complaint also asserted a claim for breach of fiduciary duty against the Exchange Defendants for which plaintiffs sought damages. With respect to the Strategic Investors, in addition to “fraudulent transfer,” the amended complaint asserted claims for securities fraud, “commercial bribery” pursuant to the Robinson-Patman Act, and aiding and abetting breach of fiduciary duty. The plaintiffs subsequently informed the

 

(Continued)

29


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

NOTE N - COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES - Continued

 

Court that they were pursuing only their securities fraud claims. Motions to dismiss filed on behalf of all of the defendants were granted on March 31,2007, and plaintiffs have filed an appeal to the United States Court of Appeals for the Third Circuit. On January 28, 2008, plaintiffs filed motion for remand of the appeal to the District Court for consideration of the applicability of the settlement release in Ginsburg v. Philadelphia Stock Exchange, Inc. et al., No. 2202-CC (Del Ch.).

Another shareholder class action was filed against the Exchange, its then-Board of Governors, and the Strategic Investors in the Delaware Court of Chancery on June 6, 2006. As in the above matter, the plaintiff asserted a breach of fiduciary duty against the Board defendants, and sought the unwinding of the strategic investments, or in the alternative, monetary damages. Plaintiff’s claim against the Strategic Investors was for aiding and abetting a breach of fiduciary duty. A substantial portion of the legal costs associated with the defense of both class action matters has been covered by Insurance. Motions to dismiss filed on behalf of all defendants were denied on December 7, 2006. On October 22, 2007, the court issued an order and final judgment providing for final class certification and approving as fair and adequate to the class a settlement that had been reached on June 20, 2007, on the eve of trial. Certain objecting class members appealed the October 22, 2007 order, and the Delaware Supreme Court affirmed the judgment on March 27, 2008. Among other consideration, the settlement provided that the Exchange would cause its insurers to pay to the class $14 million, and would itself further pay $3.1 million to the class. Among other consideration, the settlement consideration includes: (i) 14% of each of the Strategic Investor’s equity interest in the Exchange; (ii) payment by the Exchange’s insurers of $14 million to the class; (iii) payment by the Exchange of $3.1 million to the class; and (iv) cancellation of the interest of Myer S. Frucher, the Exchange’s Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, in 14% of the restricted stock units that were previously awarded to him pursuant to the Exchange’s management equity compensation plan. By its terms, the settlement did not constitute an acknowledgement of liability by any of the defendants.

PennMont, a member of the Exchange, filed suit on April 19, 2006 in the United States District Court for the Eastern District of Pennsylvania, alleging insider trading in violation of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 against Meyer S. Frucher, the Exchange’s Chairman and Chief Executive Officer; John F. Wallace, the Exchange’s On-Floor Vice Chairman; and Pasquale DiDonato, the principal of a floor broker at the Exchange. The Exchange has advanced defense expenses to Frucher and Wallace in accordance with its Restated Certificate of Incorporation and By-Laws. The complaint’s allegations concerned the sale of 100 shares of the Exchange’s Class A common stock from plaintiff to defendant DiDonato in January 2005. PennMont filed an amended complaint on August 4, 2006 that purports to state a controlling person claim against Wallace and hold him liable as a “tipper,” and that purports to state a direct securities fraud claim against Frucher. Defendants’ motions to dismiss the amended complaint were denied on March 23, 2007. After the close of discovery, defendants filed a motion for summary judgment on November 19, 2007, and their motions were granted on March 28, 2008.

Richard Feinberg, a member of the Exchange, filed suit on September 9, 2005 in the United States District Court for the Eastern District of Pennsylvania alleging insider trading in violation of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 against I. Isabelle Benton, a member of the Exchange’s Board of Governors, and Benton Partners II L.P., a member of the Exchange in which Ms. Benton is a partner. The Exchange has advanced defense expenses to Benton in accordance with its Restated Certificate of Incorporation and By-Laws. The complaint’s allegations concerned the sale of 100 shares of the Exchange’s Class A common stock from plaintiff to defendant Benton Partners II, L.P., in December 2004. At the close of discovery, defendants filed a motion for summary judgment on June 22, 2007, and the motion was denied on December 13, 2008. Trial began on March 3, 2008, and at the close of plaintiff’s case the Court entered judgment on a directed verdict for defendants. Final judgment in favor of defendants was entered on March 10, 2008.

 

(Continued)

30


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE N - COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES - Continued

On June 2, 2006, NexTrade, Inc., filed a claim against the Exchange in the United States District Court for the Middle District of Florida alleging patent infringement and breach of contract. The suit arises out of an April 2005 licensing agreement between the Exchange and NexTrade regarding an alleged patent for expirationless options. Plaintiff sought unspecified damages, costs, and fees for infringement and breach, along with a declaratory judgment that NexTrade’s patent covers long dated options in addition to expirationless options. A motion to dismiss filed by the Exchange was denied in August 2006, and discovery commenced. The parties entered into a settlement agreement in January 2008, and the action was dismissed.

Certain Exchange shareholders and members filed a proposed shareholder class action suit on June 18, 2007 in the United States District Court for the Eastern District of Pennsylvania against Keefe Bruyette & Woods, Inc. (“KBW”), and Joseph J. Spalluto, a KBW managing director, asserting claims stemming from financial advisory services rendered to the Exchange by KBW. On February 5, 2008, KBW filed a complaint against the Exchange in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York seeking indemnification pursuant to an engagement agreement between the parties for costs incurred by KBW in connection with the underlying shareholder suit against KBW and Spalutto, and in connection with McGawan Investors L.P., et al. v. Meyer S. Frucher, et al., No. 06-2558 (E.D. Pa.). The Exchange filed a state court action in Philadelphia against KBW on February 25, 2008 seeking a declaration that its indemnification obligation does not apply. On March 12, 2008 KBW removed that action to the United States District Court for the Eastern District of Pennsylvania. On March 14, 2008, KBW filed a motion to dismiss, stay, or transfer the Eastern District of Pennsylvania action to the Southern District of New York. On March 17, 2008, the Exchange sought leave to file a motion to transfer the Southern District of New York action to the Eastern District of Pennsylvania. On March 24, 2008, the Exchange filed an Answer in the Southern District of New York action denying liability. The Exchange and KBW have reached an agreement in principle to resolve the two cross suits regarding indemnification.

William and Maureen Dooner, husband and wife, filed suit against the Exchange, among others, on May 28, 2004 in the Court of Common Pleas, Philadelphia County primarily alleging that the Exchange had provided negligent security on its trading floor which resulted in bodily injury and other harm to Mr. Dooner (and a loss of consortium for his wife). Mr. Dooner alleges that he was pulled to the ground, striking his head, by another trader in a trading crowd which action arose out of a disagreement over positioning within a trading crowd. On March 3, 2006, a jury awarded Mr. and Mrs. Dooner a total of $1,935,000 of which the Exchange was held liable for $967,500 (50%). The Exchange appealed and the Superior Court of Pennsylvania vacated the judgment on October 17, 2007. The Supreme Court of Pennsylvania granted Plaintiff’s petition for allowance of appeal. Insurance has and will fully indemnify the Exchange.

On March 22, 2006, the Exchange was served with a complaint filed in the Court of Common Pleas of Philadelphia County by the owner of 200 shares of the Exchange’s Class A Common Stock (the “Shares”) and by two prospective purchasers of those shares. The complaint alleges that the Exchange in 2005 wrongfully prevented the transfer of the Shares to their record owner, Steven Braverman, due to debts owed by Mr. Braverman to the Exchange thus depriving Mr. Braverman of a gain of $120,000 from an agreed upon sale to the two prospective purchasers in May 2005. The two prospective purchasers allege that they were wrongfully deprived of gains of $30,000 each, which they would have realized upon their acceptance of a tender offer made by the Exchange in October 2005. The Exchange reached a settlement with the two prospective purchasers in December of 2006, by allowing the transfer of shares with the proceeds being held in escrow pending the outcome of the litigation with Mr. Braverman. The Exchange filed an amended counterclaim and a motion for summary judgment in January of 2007. A settlement with Braverman, individually, was reached and finalized in October of 2007.

 

(Continued)

31


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE N - COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES - Continued

In March 2004, the Exchange received a request for documents from the SEC’s Division of Enforcement related to a review of the Exchange’s surveillance, investigation and enforcement functions from April 1999 through January 2002. This resulted in a settlement with the Division of Enforcement in May 2006 which included: (i) an order that the Exchange cease and desist from committing or causing any violations of Section 19(g) of the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934; (ii) an undertaking that the Exchange shall institute a training program for staff that addresses compliance with the federal securities laws and the Exchange’s rules; and (iii) a further undertaking that the Exchange retain in 2006 and 2008 a third party auditor to conduct a comprehensive compliance audit and allocate up to $500,000 in each of 2006 and 2008 on those audits.

PBOT has entered into a Letter of Intent (LOI) to which the Exchange is a third-party beneficiary, which contemplates the creation of a Joint Development Agreement (Agreement) amongst the parties to the LOI. This Agreement has not yet been consummated.

In August 2003, the Exchange entered into an exclusive license agreement with The NASDAQ Stock Market, Inc. (NASDAQ) for listing and trading options on the Nasdaq Composite Index which began on March 22, 2004. The initial term of the agreement is for three years. Under the agreement, the Exchange is responsible for paying a license fee per contract traded, but must pay NASDAQ a minimum of $1,250,000 during the 3 year term of the agreement. A member organization committed that they would cover any shortfall owed by the Exchange to NASDAQ. Pursuant to a termination and release notice, dated February 17, 2006, NASDAQ and the Exchange released each other from all obligations in this agreement and the Exchange agreed to pay NASDAQ $320,000 in final satisfaction. A member organization reimbursed the Exchange for such amount.

The Exchange has entered into employment agreements with certain employees. In addition to base salaries, the agreements provide for retention and, in part, incentive bonuses based on criteria established by the Board of Governors.

SCCP is a participant of NSCC and as such submits and guarantees activity of certain of the Exchange’s members for clearance through the SCCP omnibus account. SCCP is entitled to all of the services and benefits of a participant of NSCC and is subject to all of the liabilities of a participant. The Exchange guarantees to NSCC all liabilities and/or obligations of SCCP to NSCC which now, or in the future may arise including liabilities and obligations which may arise from SCCP’s membership in DTC.

In the normal course of its business, the Exchange is exposed to asserted and unasserted claims. In the opinion of management, the resolution of these matters will not have a material adverse affect on the Exchange’s consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

NOTE O - EQUITY

 

  1. Equity

The Exchange is authorized to issue (i) 1,000,000 shares of common stock, 50,500 shares of which are designated Class A Common Stock and 949,500 shares of which are designated Class B Common Stock (collectively, the Common Stock), and (ii) 100,000 shares of preferred stock, all with a par value of $.01 per share. As described below, one share of Series A Preferred Stock was issued.

 

(Continued)

32


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE O - EQUITY - Continued

Shareholder and Independent Governors of the Exchange are elected by the holders of the Common Stock. Member and Designated Independent Governors are chosen, and their removal may be directed by the members (permit holders) of the Exchange. All voting rights of a member are exercised through the member organization with which the member is primarily affiliated. The Member and Designated Independent Governors who are chosen by the members are formally elected at the annual meeting of stockholders by the Phlx Member Voting Trust (the Trust), a Delaware statutory trust whose trustee is an independent institution that is required to vote in accordance with the vote of the Exchange’s members. One share of Series A Preferred Stock of the Exchange was issued to the Trust, the sole purpose of which is to allow the Trust to vote for the election or removal of Member and Designated Independent Governors as directed by a member vote. Except for the election and removal of Member and Designated Independent Governors, and subject to the rights of any class or series of preferred stock if and when issued, the Common Stock retains all voting rights of the stockholders of the Exchange.

The holders of the Common Stock will have all dividend and other distribution rights of stockholders in the Exchange, subject to the rights of any class or series of preferred stock, if and when issued. The Series A Preferred Stock does not have any dividend rights. The Exchange’s by-laws prohibit the payment of dividends from revenues received by the Exchange from regulatory fines, fees or penalties.

On January 20, 2007, the third anniversary of the demutualization of the Exchange, all 46,900 shares of Class A Common Stock converted to Class B Common Stock such that all 441,504 shares of the Exchange are, as of that date, Class B shares. Upon conversion to Class B, the eligibility of holders of Class A shares for a contingent dividend terminated. The former holders of the Class A shares otherwise continue to have the same rights and privileges, including voting, as the Class B holders.

 

  2. Strategic Partners

As approved by the Board of Governors on June 15, 2005, the Company, on June 16, 2005, entered into strategic alliances with Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith and Citadel Derivatives Group (the “First Round Strategic Partners”). Pursuant to the terms of each transaction and in exchange for a cash purchase price of $7.5 million, each First Round Strategic Partner acquired (i) shares of Class B Common Stock representing 10% of the number of shares of Common Stock outstanding (or available for issuance to management pursuant to the Phlx’s management incentive plan) immediately after and taking into account the closing of the First Round Strategic Alliances and (ii) a warrant (a “First Round Warrant”) to acquire, for nominal consideration, additional shares of Common Stock such that together with the shares already owned by the investor, the investor would own shares representing up to 19.9% of the shares of Common Stock outstanding (or available for issuance to management pursuant to the Phlx’s management incentive plan) immediately after and taking into account the exercise of such First Round Warrant (with provision made, through a “Shortfall Warrant” if the issuance thereof is necessary, to maintain the right to acquire such 19.9% if any dilutive warrants, options, convertible securities or other similar rights are outstanding at the time the First Round Warrant is exercised).

As approved by the Board of Governors on August 12, 2005, the Company on August 16, 2005, entered into strategic alliances with Citigroup Financial Products, Inc., Credit Suisse First Boston Next Fund, Inc. UBS Securities, LLC (collectively, the “5% Investors”) and Morgan Stanley & Co., Incorporated (“Morgan Stanley”) (together with the 5% Investors, the “Second Round Strategic Partners”). Like the First Round Strategic Partners, Morgan Stanley acquired, pursuant to the terms of the transaction and in exchange for a cash purchase price of $7.5 million, (i) shares of Class B Common Stock representing 10% of the number of shares of Common Stock outstanding (or available for issuance to management pursuant to the Exchange’s management

 

(Continued)

33


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

NOTE O - EQUITY - Continued

 

incentive plan) immediately after and taking into account the closing of the Second Round Strategic Alliances and (ii) a warrant (a “Second Round Warrant” and, together with the First Round Warrants, the “Warrants”), to acquire, for nominal consideration, additional shares of Common Stock such that, together with the shares already owned by Morgan Stanley, it would own shares representing up to 19.9% of the shares of Common Stock outstanding (or available for issuance to management pursuant to the Exchange’s management incentive plan) immediately after and taking into account the exercise of such Second Round Warrant (with provision made, through a “Shortfall Second Round Warrant” if the issuance thereof is necessary, to maintain the right to acquire such 19.9% if any dilutive warrants, options, convertible securities or other similar rights are outstanding at the time the Second Round Warrant is exercised).

Pursuant to the terms of the transaction and in exchange for a cash purchase price of $3.75 million, the 5% Investors acquired (i) shares of Class B Common Stock representing 5% of the number of shares of Common Stock outstanding (or available for issuance to management pursuant to the Exchange’s management incentive plan) immediately after and taking into account the closing of the Second Round Strategic Alliances and (ii) a Second Round Warrant to acquire, for nominal consideration, additional shares of Common Stock such that, together with the shares already owned by such 5% Investors, each 5% Investor would own shares representing up to 9.9% of the shares of Common Stock outstanding (or available for issuance to management pursuant to the Exchange’s management incentive plan) immediately after and taking into account the exercise of such Second Round Warrant (with provision made, through a “Shortfall Second Round Warrant” if the issuance thereof is necessary, to maintain the right to acquire such 9.9% if any dilutive warrants, options, convertible securities or other similar rights are outstanding at the time the Second Round Warrant is exercised).

As a result of the Second Round Strategic Alliances, the Board of Governors issued an additional 3,156 shares of Class B Common Stock to each of the First Round Strategic Partners, in order to restore their Common Stock ownership to 10% after taking into account the Second Round Strategic Alliances.

The number of additional shares of Common Stock that may be issued pursuant to a First or Second Round Warrant and any Shortfall First or Second Round Warrant will vary depending on whether the First or Second Round Strategic Partner holding such First or Second Round Warrant meets the specific performance criteria set forth in the First or Second Round Warrant, which require that the First or Second Round Strategic Partner trade an agreed-upon number of option contracts, subject to certain exceptions, on the Phlx’s exchange on a daily basis over a specified period of months.

As a result of the above transactions, the Exchange issued 45,450 shares of Class B Common Stock to the six Strategic Partners described above for $33,750,000. Additionally, the Exchange recognized expense of $-0- and $15,449,000 in 2007 and 2006, respectively, related to the costs associated with the Strategic Partners meeting their performance criteria and earning additional Class B Common stock under their warrants and is included in equity granted to third parties and additional-paid-in-capital in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations and consolidated balance sheets, respectively.

In January 2006, Citadel Derivatives Group, LLC met all of its performance criteria under the warrants issued to them on June 15, 2005. Citadel Derivatives Group, LLC exercised their warrant on February 14, 2006 and the Company issued to them 10,334 shares of Class B Common Stock. In June 2006, Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith (“Merrill Lynch”) met all of their performance criteria under the warrants issued to them on June 15, 2005. Merrill Lynch exercised their warrant on July 17, 2006 and the Exchange issued to them 77,759 shares of Class B Common Stock. In June 2006, Morgan Stanley met all of their

 

(Continued)

34


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

NOTE O - EQUITY - Continued

 

performance criteria under the warrants issued to them on June 15, 2005. Morgan Stanley exercised their warrant on Jury 17, 2006 and the Exchange issued to them 77,759 shares of Class B Common Stock. In June 2006, Citigroup Financial Products, Inc. met all of their performance criteria under the warrants issued to them on June 15, 2005. Citigroup Financial Products, Inc. exercised their warrant on July 17, 2006 and the Exchange issued to them 38,659 shares of Class B Common Stock. In June 2006, Credit Suisse First Boston Next Fund, Inc. met all of their performance criteria under the warrants issued to them on June 15, 2005. Credit Suisse First Boston Next Fund, Inc. exercised their warrant on July 17, 2006 and the Exchange issued to them 38,559 shares of Class B Common Stock. In June 2006, UBS Securities, LLC met all of their performance criteria under the warrants issued to them on June 15, 2005. UBS Securities, LLC exercised their warrant on July 17, 2006 and the Exchange issued to them 38,659 shares of Class B Common Stock. On July 17,2006, the Exchange also issued to Citadel Derivatives Group, LLC, 67,425 shares of Class B Common Stock pursuant to the Shortfall Warrant.

NOTE P - MANAGEMENT EQUITY PLAN

On December 14,2006, the Exchange established the Philadelphia Stock Exchange, Inc. 2005 Stock Incentive Plan (“Plan”) whereby the Board of Governors may grant Restricted Stock Units (“RSUs”) to management, which is defined in the Plan as a notional unit representing the right to receive one share of stock on a settlement date at which time, all vested RSU’s shall be settled by issuance of shares of stock underlying such vested units, or at the discretion of the Compensation Committee, in cash or partially in cash and partially in shares of stock. The settlement dates shall be the earliest to occur of (i) the third anniversary of the date of the grant; (ii) a change in control; or (iii) termination of employment or service. The Exchange has accounted for the awards using the assumption that the awards will be fully settled in cash. Fair value of the Exchange’s stock is based on an independent valuation. The RSUs shall vest in accordance with the following schedule, subject to each holder’s continued employment or service with the Exchange or its affiliates as applicable: (i) 33.3% of the RSUs shall be vested of the date on the grant; and the remaining 66.7% of such RSUs shall vest ratably in 24 equal monthly installments beginning on the first day of each of the subsequent 24 months following the date of the grant. Compensation expense is charged to earnings over the vesting of each award. The charge is based upon each award’s current value, which is adjusted annually to reflect changes in value associated with movements in the value of the Exchange’s stock. The number of RSUs to be given to each individual was set at a special meeting of the Board of Governors on December 19, 2006. During the year ended December 31, 2006, the Exchange awarded 17,761 RSUs with a grant date value of $860 per unit vesting over three years ending December 31, 2008. Total compensation expense related to the Plan was $5,095,000 for the year ended December 31, 2006 and is included in staffing costs on the consolidated statements of operations and in accounts payable and other liabilities on the consolidated balance sheets. During the year ended December 31, 2007, the Exchange awarded 8,984 RSUs with a grant date value of $1,340 per unit vesting over two and three years ending December 31, 2009. The Exchange revalued all RSU’s as of December 31,2007 based on a fair value of $1,340 per unit. Total compensation expense related to the Plan was $15,772,000 for the year ended December 31, 2007 and is included in staffing costs on the consolidated statements of operations and in accounts payable and other liabilities on the consolidated balance sheets. Additional compensation expense related to these awards, estimated to be $14,972,000, and the related income taxes, will be recognized over the vesting period through December 31, 2009.

Included as part of the compensation approved by the Board of Governors at the December 19,2006 regular meeting was change of control arrangements for certain members of executive management as well as the Independent Governors on the Board of Governors.

 

35


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - CONTINUED

December 31, 2007 and 2006

 

NOTE Q - COMPENSATION PACKAGES

Also in 2007, the Board of Governors approved cash compensation awards totaling $5,000,000 to all Governors substantially similar to RSU awards granted to management, with vesting through December 31, 2008 or at a change in control. The Board of Governors also granted increased executive cash compensation in the amount of $5,300,000 reflecting the Board’s policy to compensate executives at 90% of the Exchange’s peer group, with executives waiving any additional increases to the change in control payments. In 2007, the Board of Governors approved additional change of control agreements for the non-independent Governors.

NOTE R - ACQUISITION AGREEMENT WITH NASDAQ STOCK MARKET, INC.

On November 6, 2007, the Exchange entered into a definitive agreement to be acquired by the NASDAQ Stock Market, Inc. (NASDAQ). The transaction, which has already been approved by the Exchange shareholders, is expected to close in the first half of 2008, subject to the approval of appropriate regulatory authorities, including the SEC, and certain other conditions.

NOTE S - SUBSEQUENT EVENT - STAY PAY BONUSES

Due to the acquisition agreement with NASDAQ, the Exchange implemented stay pay bonus programs in January and April 2008 totaling $4,727,000 payable to employees who continue their employment with the Exchange and/or the NASDAQ through July 30, 2008 and/or August 15, 2008 (stay pay dates). The stay pay bonus will be paid in a lump sum within 30 business days following the stay pay dates.

The Board has also approved compensation in the amount of $5,385,000 for performance and long-term incentive for the first six months of 2008, payable May 15, 2008.

 

36


PHILADELPHIA STOCK EXCHANGE, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS

(In thousands, except average share value information)

 

     2007    2006     2005     2004     2003  

Revenues

   $ 135,757    $ 113,546     $ 82,822     $ 74,813     $ 67,239  

Operating expenses, excluding equity issued to third parties

     126,358      89,172       79,733       74,876       67,637  

Income (loss) before taxes and equity issued to third parties

     9,399      24,374       2,899       (63 )     (398 )

Equity issued to third parties

     —        15,449       17,835       —         —    

Income tax expense (benefit)

     6,132      9,349       (987 )     70       —    

Income (loss) from continuing operations

     3,267      (424 )     (13,949 )     (133 )     (398 )

Net income from discontinued operations

     —        —         —         —         —    

Net income (loss)

     3,267      (424 )     (13,949 )     (133 )     (398 )

Equipment and leasehold improvements, net

     60,551      42,318       35,602       31,790       30,595  

Shareholders’/members’ equity

     94,731      91,041       79,281       45,731       45,406  

 

OPERATIONAL HIGHLIGHTS (UNAUDITED)

 

 

Unaudited data dollar value of shares traded on the Exchange*

   $ 76,500,697    $ 34,973,751     $ 49,700,742     $ 88,893,815     $ 86,849,825  

Average share value of shares traded on the Exchange

   $ 47.86    $ 47.08     $ 35.38     $ 30.51     $ 26.29  

Shares traded on the Exchange

     1,598,480      742,834       1,404,949       2,913,782       3,304,035  

Equity options contracts traded on the Exchange

     399,197      265,371       156,222       127,818       109,205  

Index options traded on the Exchange

     6,727      7,626       7,237       5,276       3,222  

U.S. Dollar settled PHLX World Currency option contracts traded on the Exchange

     2,024      —         —         —         —    

Physically settled currency option contracts traded on the Exchange

     77      131       160       231       279  

 

* These statistics do not pertain to the trading of Phlx Common Stock. Phlx Common Stock is not presently listed or publicly traded on the Exchange or any other national securities exchange.

 

37

Exhibit 99.3

Exhibit 99.3

OMX AB

INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

     Page

Report of Independent Auditor

   1

Consolidated Income Statements for the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006

   2

Consolidated Balance Sheets at December 31, 2007 and 2006

   3

Changes in Consolidated Shareholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006

   4

Consolidated Cash Flow Statements for the years ended December 31, 2007 and 2006

   5

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

   35


Report of Independent Auditor

To the Shareholders in OMX AB

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of OMX AB and its subsidiaries as of December 31, 2007 and December 31, 2006 and the related consolidated statements of income, shareholders’ equity and cash flows for the years then ended. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States of America. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of OMX AB and its subsidiaries at December 31 2007 and December 31, 2006 and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the years then ended in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.

February 20, 2008

PricewaterhouseCoopers AB

Stockholm Sweden

 

1


OMX AB

CONSOLIDATED INCOME STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2007 AND 2006

 

(in millions of SEK)

   Note    2007   2006  

Continuing operations(1)

       

Revenues

   2, 3     

Net sales

      3,838   3,313  

Own work capitalized

      134   68  

Other revenues

      101   105  
             

Total revenues, etc

      4,073   3,486  
             

Expenses

       

Premises expenses

   12    (180)   (204 )

Marketing expenses

      (70)   (63 )

Consultancy expenses

   6    (366)   (310 )

Operations and maintenance, IT

   12    (308)   (239 )

Other external expenses

   6    (245)   (167 )

Personnel expenses

   7    (1,326)   (1,083 )

Depreciation, amortization and impairment

   13,14    (262)   (216 )
             

Total expenses

      (2,757)   (2,282 )
             

Participation in earnings of associated companies

   10    44   46  

Operating income

   3    1,360   1,250  

Financial items

   9     

Financial revenues

      89   42  

Financial expenses

      (151)   (95 )
             

Total financial items

      (62)   (53 )
             

Income/loss after financial items

      1,298   1,197  

Tax for the year

   11    (249)   (240 )
             

Net profit/loss for the period, continuing operations

      1049   957  
             

Discontinuing operations ( 1)

       

Net profit/loss for the period, discontinuing operations

      (63)   (46 )
             

Net profit/loss for the period

      986   911  
             

of which, attributable to shareholders of OMX AB

      979   907  

of which, attributable to minority interests

      7   4  

Average number of shares, millions

      120.640   118.671  

Number of shares, millions

      120.640   120.640  

Average number of shares after dilution, millions

      120.640   118.886  

Number of shares after dilution, millions

      120.640   120.640  

Continuing operations

       

Earnings per share, SEK(2)

   31    8.64   8.03  

Earnings per share after dilution, SEK( 2)

   31    8.64   8.03  

Discontinuing operations

       

Earnings per share, SEK(2)

   31    (0.52)   (0.39 )

Earnings per share after dilution, SEK( 2)

   31    (0.52)   (0.39 )

OMX Total

       

Earnings per share, SEK(2)

   31    8.12   7.64  

Earnings per share after dilution, SEK( 2)

   31    8.12   7.64  

Dividend per share, SEK

      —     6.50  

 

(1)

The income statements for discontinuing operations has been adjusted compared with the 2006 Annual reports as a result of organizational changes which led to certain parts of the business being retained.

 

(2)

Earnings per share are calculated on the basis of the weighted average number of shares during the year. The amount is based on OMX AB shareholders’ portion of net profit/loss for the period.

 

2


CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

 

(SEK m)    Note    December 31, 2007    December 31, 2006

ASSETS

        

Fixed assets

        

Intangible assets

   13      

Goodwill

      3,304    3,140

Capitalized expenditure for R&D

      900    634

Other intangible assets

      635    576

Tangible fixed assets

   14      

Equipment

      288    321

Financial fixed assets

   27      

Participations in associated companies

   10    139    186

Other investments held as fixed assets

   15    505    363

Deferred tax assets

   11    113    125

Receivables from associated companies

   8    —      6

Other long-term receivables

   17    42    40

Total fixed assets

        5,926    5,391

Current assets

        

Short-term receivables

   27      

Accounts receivable – trade

      594    425

Market value, outstanding derivative positions

   18    3,404    4,401

Receivables from associated companies

   8    8    1

Tax receivables

   11    13    6

Other receivables

   19    819    888

Prepaid expenses and accrued income

   20    394    418

Current investments

   21,27    607    518

Cash equivalents

   32,27    424    410

Assets held for sale

   4    47    70

Total current assets

        6,310    7,137

TOTAL ASSETS

      12,236    12,528

 

(SEK m)    Note    December 31, 2007    December 31, 2006

SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY AND LIABILITIES

        

Shareholders’ equity

   22      

Share capital (120,640,467 shares, ratio value SEK 2)

      241    241

Other capital contributions

      3,536    3,536

Reserves

      167    -103

Profit brought forward

        1,148    923

Equity attributable to shareholders in Parent Company

      5,092    4,597

Minority interest

        25    17

Total shareholders’ equity

      5,117    4,614

Long-term liabilities

   27      

Interest-bearing long-term liabilities

   23    858    1,360

Deferred tax liability

   11    76    15

Other long-term liabilities

   23    104    123

Provisions

   24    100    121

Total long-term liabilities

      1,138    1,619

Short-term liabilities

   27      

Liabilities to credit institutions

   27    1,045    398

Accounts payable – trade

   27    172    109

Tax liabilities

   11    62    54

Market value, outstanding derivative positions

   18    3,404    4,401

Other liabilities

   25    690    836

Accrued expenses and deferred income

   26    583    473

Provisions

   24    25    24

Total short-term liabilities

        5,981    6,295

TOTAL SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY AND LIABILITIES

      12,236    12,528

For information on the Group’s pledged assets and contingent liabilities, see Notes 28, 29 and 30.

 

3


CHANGES IN CONSOLIDATED SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

See Note 22

 

    

Attributable to shareholders in the Parent Company

         
(SEK m)    Share
capital
  

Other

capital
contributions

   Reserves    Profit/
loss
forward
   Minority
interest
   Total
shareholders’
equity

OPENING BALANCE, JANUARY 1, 2006

   237    3,271    100    1,127    14    4,749

New share issue, net after transaction costs of SEK 0

   4    265             269

Minority interest

               -1    -1

Dividend to shareholders

            -1,120       -1,120

Equity swap for Share Match Program

            -8       -8

Share Match Program

            2       2

Cash-flow hedging

                 

Gain/loss attributable to shareholders’ equity

         -9          -9

Carried forward/transferred to income

         -9          -9

Exchange-rate differences

                 

Hedging of shareholders’ equity, net

         25          25

Translation differences

         -198          -198

Financial assets available for sale

                 

Carried forward/ transferred to income

         -12          -12

Change in associated companies’ shareholders’ equity

                  15         15

TOTAL TRANSACTIONS RECOGNIZED DIRECTLY IN SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

   4    265    -203    -1,111    -1    -1,046

Profit for 2006

                  907    4    911

TOTAL REPORTED REVENUES AND EXPENSES FOR 2006

   4    265    -203    -204    3    -135

OPENING BALANCE, JANUARY 1, 2007

   241    3,536    -103    923    17    4,614

Minority interest

               1    1

Dividend to shareholders 1)

            -781       -781

Share Match Program

            3       3

Cash-flow hedging

                 

Gain/loss attributable to shareholders’ equity

         8          8

Carried forward/transferred to income

         10          10

Exchange-rate differences

                 

Hedging of shareholders’ equity, net

         -46          -46

Translation differences

         178          178

Financial assets available for sale

                 

Profit/loss to shareholders’ equity

         120          120

Change in associated companies’ shareholders’ equity

                  24         24

TOTAL TRANSACTIONS REPORTED AGAINST SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

   —      —      270    -754    1    -483

Profit for 2007

                  979    7    986

TOTAL REPORTED REVENUES AND EXPENSES FOR 2007

   —      —      270    225    8    503

CLOSING BALANCE, DECEMBER 31, 2007

   241    3,536    167    1,148    25    5,117

 

1) A dividend to shareholders was paid in the amount of SEK 784 m, of which OMX received SEK 3 m through the equity swap agreement with a third party that hedges the Share Match Program 2006.

 

4


OMX AB

CONSOLIDATED CASH FLOW STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2007 AND 2006

 

(in millions of SEK)

   Note    Year Ended December 31,  
      2007     2006  

Operating activities

       

Continuing operations

       

Net profit/loss for the period

      1,049     957  

Adjustments for items not included in cash flow

       

Depreciation/amortization

   13,14    262     208  

Impairment

   13,14    —       8  

Utilization of provisions

   24    (19 )   (41 )

Participations in earnings of associated companies

   10    (44 )   (46 )

Capital loss

      (105 )   (109 )

Financial items, without any cash effect

   32    10     (2 )

Income tax, without any cash effect

   11    75     158  

Other adjustments

      11     (93 )
               

Total cash flow from operating activities before
changes in working capital

      1,239     1,040  
               

Changes in working capital

       

Operating receivables

      (122 )   154  

Operating liabilities

      100     (158 )
               

Total changes in working capital

      (22 )   (4 )
               

Cash flow from operating activities, continuing operations

      1,217     1,036  

Discontinuing operations

       

Net cash flow from operating activities,
discontinuing operations

      (58 )   (4 )
               

Cash flow from operating activities, total

      1,159     1,032  
               

Investing activities

       

Continuing operations

       

Investments in intangible assets

   13    (444 )   (379 )

Sale of intangible assets

   13    —       4  

Investments in tangible assets

   14    (58 )   (67 )

Sale of tangible assets

   14    8     9  

Cash flow from associated companies

   10    10     34  

Acquisitions of subsidiaries

   5    50     (19 )

Sale of subsidiaries

      (5 )   —    

Sale of associated companies

   10    116     575  

Sale of operations in OMX companies

      (11 )   —    

Increase/decrease in other shares and participations

      7     (304 )

Decrease/increase in long-term receivables

   17    (27 )   60  

Increase/decrease in long-term liabilities

   23    (46 )   14  

Decrease/increase in short-term investments of more than three months

      (89 )   206  
               

Cash flow from investing activities, continuing operations

      (489 )   133  
               

Discontinuing operations

       

Net cash flow from investing activities,
discontinuing operations

      (8 )   -21  

Cash flow from investing activities, total

      (497 )   112  

Financing activities

       

Continuing operations

       

Dividend

      (781 )   (1,120 )

New share issue

      —       13  

Change in financial receivables

      (1 )   70  

Loans raised

      147     —    

Amortization of loans

      —       (157 )

Change in current trading account

      (22 )   (1 )
               

Cash flow from financing activities, continuing operations

      (657 )   (1,195 )
               

Discontinuing operations

       

Net cash flow from financing activities,
discontinuing operations

      (3 )   (42 )

Cash flow from investing activities, total

      (660 )   (1,237 )
               

Cash equivalents

      2     (93 )

Cash equivalents – opening balance

      409     519  

Exchange-rate difference in cash equivalents

      13     (17 )
               

Cash equivalents – closing balance

      424     409  

 

5


ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES

OMX AB (publ), Corporate Registration Number, 556243-8001, is a limited liability company registered in Sweden. The Parent Company has its registered office in Stockholm and is listed on the Stockholm Stock Exchange, the Copenhagen Stock Exchange, the Helsinki Stock Exchange and the Iceland Stock Exchange. OMX pertains to the OMX Group, comprising OMX AB and subsidiaries.

The consolidated accounts were approved for publication by the Board on February 20, 2008 and will be presented to the Annual General Meeting on April 21, 2008 for approval, with the reservation that the Annual General Meeting is likely to be postponed in the event of the merger with NASDAQ being carried out in the first quarter. Amounts are in SEK millions (SEK m) unless otherwise stated. Amounts in parentheses indicate values for 2006

SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES

The most central accounting principles applied in the preparation of the consolidated accounts are described below. These principles have been applied consistently for all of the years presented unless otherwise stated.

The following standards and statements came into effect in 2007

 

   

IFRS 7 Financial Instruments: Disclosures

 

   

IAS 1 Presentation of Financial Statements (amendment)

 

   

IFRIC 8 Scope of IFRS 2

 

   

IFRIC 9 Reassessment of Embedded Derivatives

 

   

IFRIC 10 Interim Financial Reporting and Impairment.

The new/amended IFRSs that came into effect as of January 1, 2007 have no impact on the OMX Group’s income statement, balance sheet, cash-flow statement or shareholders’ equity. However, IFRS 7 has entailed increased disclosures regarding the Group’s financial instruments.

The following standards or statements came into effect in 2007 but are not relevant to the Group.

 

   

IFRS 4 Insurance Contracts

 

   

IFRIC 7 Applying the Restatement Approach under IAS 29 Financial Reporting in Hyperinflationary Economies.

COMPLIANCE WITH STANDARDS AND LEGISLATION

The consolidated accounts have been prepared in accordance with the International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) issued by the International Accounting principles Standards Board (IASB) and the interpretations issued by International Financial Reporting Interpretations Committee (IFRIC). In addition, the consolidated accounts also include certain additional information provided in accordance with the Swedish Financial Accounting Standards Council’s standard RR 30, Supplementary Accounting Regulations for Groups.

 

6


BASIS FOR THE PREPARATION OF THE REPORTS

The Group’s functional currency is SEK, which is also the reporting currency. This means that the financial statements are presented in SEK. Unless otherwise indicated, all amounts are rounded off to the nearest thousand. Assets and liabilities are stated at their historical cost, except for certain financial assets and liabilities that are stated at fair value. Financial assets and liabilities stated at fair value comprise derivative instruments, financial assets classed as financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement or as financial assets available for sale.

Fixed assets and disposal groups held for sale are stated at the lower of their previous carrying amount or their fair value after deductions for sales costs.

Preparing financial statements in accordance with IFRS requires that management make evaluations, estimations and assumptions that affect the application of the accounting principles and the stated amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and costs. Estimations and assumptions are based on historical experience and a number of other factors that may be considered reasonable under prevailing conditions. The results of these estimations and assumptions are then used to evaluate the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities not otherwise clear from other sources. The actual outcome may deviate from these estimations and assumptions.

Estimations and assumptions are regularly reviewed. Changes in estimations are reported in the period in which the change is made, if the change affects only that period, or in the period in which the change is made and subsequent periods, if the change affects both the period concerned and subsequent periods.

Evaluations made by management in the implementation of IFRS that have a significant effect on financial statements and the estimations made that may entail material adjustments in subsequent years’ financial statements are described in greater detail in Note 1.

CONSOLIDATED ACCOUNTS

SUBSIDIARIES

Subsidiaries are all companies in which OMX has the right to devise financial and operative strategies in a manner normally associated with a shareholding amounting to more than half of voting rights. Subsidiaries are included in the consolidated accounts from the date on which the Group gains this controlling influence. Subsidiaries are excluded from the consolidated accounts from the date on which the controlling influence ceases.

The purchase accounting method is used for the reporting of the Group’s acquisitions of subsidiaries. The acquisition cost of an acquisition comprises the fair value of assets transferred in payment, issued equity instruments and liabilities arising or assumed on the date of transfer, plus costs directly attributable to the acquisition. The identifiable acquired assets, assumed liabilities and contingent liabilities associated with an acquisition are initially valued at fair value on the date of acquisition, regardless of the extent of any minority interests. The surplus consisting of the difference between the acquisition cost and the fair value of the Group’s share of identifiable acquired net assets is reported as goodwill. If the acquisition cost is less than the fair value of the acquired subsidiary’s net assets, the difference is recognized directly in the income statement.

Inter-company transactions, balance sheet items and unrealized gains on transactions between Group companies are eliminated. Unrealized losses are also eliminated, unless the transaction is evidence of the need for impairment to be recognized in the transferred asset. The accounting principles for subsidiaries have been changed, where necessary, to guarantee the consistent application of Group principles.

 

7


ASSOCIATED COMPANIES

An associated company is an operation that is neither a subsidiary nor a joint venture, usually on the basis of holdings of between 20 and 50 percent of the voting rights, but in which OMX exercises a significant influence over its management. Associated companies are accounted for using the equity method and are initially valued at cost. The carrying amount of the Group’s holdings in associated companies includes goodwill (net after any impairment) identified on acquisition.

The Group’s share of the associated company’s earnings after tax generated following the acquisition is reported in the operating income and its share of changes in provisions following the acquisition is reported among provisions. The share of earnings is reported in operating income for cases in which the operations of the associated companies are similar to OMX’s own operations. Accumulated changes following the acquisition are reported as changes in the carrying amount of the holding. If the Group’s participations in an associated company’s losses amounts to or exceeds its holding in the associated company, including any unsecured receivables, the Group will not report further losses unless it has assumed obligations or made payments on behalf of the associated company. Any dilution gains or losses in associated companies are recognized directly in shareholders’ equity.

Unrealized gains on transactions between the Group and its associated companies are eliminated in relation to the Group’s holding in the associated company. Unrealized losses are also eliminated, unless the transaction is evidence of the need for impairment to be recognized in the transferred asset. The accounting principles for associated companies have been changed, where necessary, to guarantee the consistent application of principles within the Group.

SEGMENT REPORTING

A business segment is a group of assets and operations providing products or services exposed to risks and opportunities that differ from those applicable to other business segments. Geographic segments provide products and services within an economic environment exposed to risks and opportunities that differ from those applicable to other economic environments.

From January 1, 2006, OMX has been divided into three divisions – Nordic Market-places, Information Services & New Markets and Market Technology. Geographically, OMX is divided into four regions: Nordic Countries, Rest of Europe, North America and Asia/Australia. The geographic grouping corresponds to regions where the company’s operations have relatively similar system solutions, rules and regulations and customer behavior. Comparative figures have been adjusted according to the new organization.

CURRENCY TRANSLATION

FUNCTIONAL CURRENCY AND REPORTING CURRENCY

Items included in the financial statements of the various units within the Group are valued in the currency used in the economic environment in which each company mainly operates (functional currency). In the consolidated accounts, SEK is used, which is the Parent Company’s functional and reporting currency.

TRANSACTIONS AND BALANCE SHEET ITEMS

Transactions in foreign currencies are translated into the functional currency according to the exchange rates applicable on the transaction date. Exchange-rate gains and losses arising through the payment of such transactions and on the translation of monetary assets and liabilities in foreign currencies at the exchange rate applicable on the closing date are reported in the income statement. The exception is where transactions represent hedges meeting the requirements for hedge accounting of cash flows or net investments in which gains and losses are reported against shareholders’ equity. Translation differences for non-monetary items, such as shares classed as financial assets available for sale, are entered in the reserves in shareholders’ equity.

 

8


GROUP COMPANIES

The earnings and financial position of all Group companies (of which none uses a high-inflation currency), which use a functional currency other than the reporting currency, are translated into the Group’s reporting currency in accordance with the following:

a) assets and liabilities for each balance sheet are translated at the closing date exchange rate,

b) revenues and expenses for each income statement are translated at the average exchange rate, and

c) all exchange-rate differences that arise are reported as a separate item in share-holders’ equity.

In consolidation, exchange-rate differences arising as a consequence of the translation of net investments in foreign operations, borrowing and other currency instruments identified as hedges for such investments are allocated to shareholders’ equity. In the divestment of foreign operations, such exchange-rate differences are reported in the income statement as part of the capital gain/loss. Goodwill and adjustments of fair value arising in the acquisition of foreign operations are treated as assets and liabilities associated with those operations and are translated at the closing date exchange rate.

TANGIBLE FIXED ASSETS

Tangible fixed assets are reported at their acquisition cost with deductions for depreciation and possible impairment. The acquisition cost includes expenses directly attributable to the acquisition of the asset. Depending on which alternative is suitable, additional expenses are added to the carrying amount of the asset or are reported as a separate asset only if it is probable that future financial advantages associated with the asset will benefit the Group and if the acquisition cost of the asset can be ascertained in a reliable manner. All other forms of repairs and maintenance shall be reported as costs in the income statement during the period in which they are incurred. Straight-line depreciation is conducted over three to ten years, which is estimated to be the asset’s useful life. Assets’ residual values and useful lives are tested and adjusted as necessary. An asset’s carrying amount is immediately written down to its recoverable amount if the asset’s carrying amount exceeds its estimated recoverable amount. On divestment, gains and losses are determined by comparing the sales proceeds and the carrying amount and are reported in the income statement.

INTANGIBLE FIXED ASSETS

Intangible fixed assets are reported at their acquisition cost with deductions for amortization and possible impairment. The acquisition cost includes expenses directly attributable to the acquisition of the asset. Depending on which alternative is suitable, additional expenses are added to the carrying amount of the asset or are reported as a separate asset only if it is probable that future financial advantages associated with the asset will benefit the Group and if the acquisition cost of the asset can be ascertained in a reliable manner.

GOODWILL

Goodwill comprises the amount by which the acquisition cost exceeds the identifiable fair value of the Group’s share of the net assets of the acquired subsidiary/associated company at the time of acquisition. Goodwill on the acquisition of subsidiaries is reported as an intangible asset. On the acquisition of associated companies, goodwill is included in the holding in the associated company. Goodwill is deemed to have an indeterminate useful life and is divided among cash-generating units at as detailed a level as possible and is tested annually to identify possible impairment. The Group’s goodwill values are attributable mainly to the acquisitions of the Nordic exchanges within the Nordic Marketplaces division, where each legal company represents a cash-generating unit. The carrying amount is the acquisition cost less accumulated impairment. Gains or losses on the divestment of a unit include the remaining carrying amount of the goodwill attributable to the divested unit.

 

9


OTHER INTANGIBLE FIXED ASSETS

Other intangible fixed assets are amortized on a straight-line basis over an expected useful life of three to 20 years. All other intangible fixed assets are tested annually to identify possible impairment needs.

Capitalized expenditures for research and development

All expenditures for research are charged as an expense when they arise. Expenses relating to the development of new products are treated as intangible assets when they fulfill the following criteria: it is likely that the asset will provide future financial benefit to the Group (contribute a positive cash flow), the acquisition cost can be calculated in a reliable manner, the company intends to take the asset to completion, and that the company has the technical, financial and other resources to complete development, use or sell the asset. Important documentation for the verification of such capitalization includes business plans, budgets, outcomes and external evaluations. In certain cases, capitalization is based on the company’s estimation of future outcome, such as prevailing market conditions. The acquisition cost of an internally developed intangible asset is the total of those expenses incurred from the time when the intangible asset first fulfils the criteria set out by generally accepted accounting principles (see criteria above). Internally developed intangible assets are reported at acquisition cost with deductions for accumulated impairment losses and any write-downs. Revenue from in-house work carried out during the fiscal year on company assets that have been carried forward as fixed assets is reported in the income statement under the heading “Own work capitalized.” The item relates only to capitalized personnel expenses. No reduction of personnel expenses has been made for work that relates to capitalized assets. Instead, these expenses have been met by the reported revenue. Own work capitalized has therefore no impact on income but does have a negative impact on the operating margin.

Customer contacts

Customer agreements that have been identified in conjunction with acquisitions have been valued on the basis of expected cash flow and reported as intangible assets. Reported customer agreements are entirely attributable to the acquisitions of the Copenhagen Stock Exchange (CSE) and Eignarhaldsfelagid Verdbrefathing hf (EV). Straight-line amortization is applied to these agreements over their estimated useful lives (20 years).

Brands and licenses

Brands and licenses are reported at their acquisition cost. Brands and licenses are reported at acquisition cost less accumulated amortization. Straight-line amortization is applied to distribute the cost of brands and licenses over their estimated useful lives (five to 20 years).

Software

Acquired software licenses are capitalized on the basis of the costs arising when the software concerned is acquired and brought into use. These costs are amortized over the estimated useful life (three to five years). Costs for the development or maintenance of software are expensed as they arise. Costs closely associated with the production of identifiable and unique software controlled by the Group, which generates probable financial benefit for more then a year and exceeds the costs, are reported as intangible assets. Costs closely associated with the production of software include personnel costs for software development and a reasonable portion of attributable indirect costs. Development costs for software reported as assets are amortized over their estimated useful lives.

 

10


Impairment

Assets with an indeterminable useful life are not depreciated/amortized but tested annually for impairment. Depreciated/amortized assets are assessed for a reduction in value whenever events or changes in conditions indicate that the carrying amount may not be recoverable. Impairment is recognized in the amount by which an asset’s carrying amount exceeds its recoverable amount. The recoverable amount is the higher of an asset’s fair value less sale costs and its value in use. In assessing the need for impairment, assets are grouped at the lowest level at which separately identifiable cash flows exist (cash-generating units). On the closing date, a test is performed on other assets than financial assets and goodwill that have previously been depreciated/amortized to ascertain whether the asset should be reversed.

Financial instruments

The Group classifies its financial instruments according to the following categories:

 

   

financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement

 

   

loan receivables and accounts receivable

 

   

financial instruments held to maturity

 

   

financial assets available for sale

 

   

financial liabilities stated at fair value in the income statement

 

   

financial liabilities carried at amortized cost.

The classification depends on the purpose for which the instruments were acquired. Management determines the classification of instruments on the first occasion on which they are reported and reassesses their classification on each report occasion.

A financial asset or liability is entered in the balance sheet when the company becomes a party to the contractual conditions of the instrument. Accounts receivable are recognized in the balance sheet once the invoice has been sent. Liabilities are recognized when the corresponding party has performed its undertaking and the company is liable for payment, even if the invoice has not yet been received. Accounts payable are recognized when invoices are received.

A financial asset is derecognized in the balance sheet when the rights conveyed by the agreement are realized, when they mature or when the company loses control over them. The same applies to part of a financial asset. A financial liability is derecognized in the balance sheet when the obligations of the contract have been met or otherwise concluded. The same applies to part of a financial liability.

Acquisitions and disposals of financial assets are recognized on the date of the transaction, the date on which the Group undertakes to acquire or divest the assets, except in cases where the company acquires or divests listed securities, in which case settlement date accounting is applied.

Financial instruments are initially stated at fair value plus transaction costs, which applies to all financial assets that are not valued at fair value in the income statement.

Financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement

This category has two subordinate categories: financial assets held for trading and those initially categorized as stated at fair value in the income statement. A financial asset is classified in this category if it is primarily acquired with the purpose of being sold within a short period of time or if this classification is determined by management. Derivative instruments are also categorized as held for trading if not identified as hedges. Assets in this category are classified as current assets if held for trading or expected to be sold within 12 months from the closing date. Assets in this category are continuously reported at fair value and changes in value are reported in the income statement.

 

11


Loans receivable and accounts receivable

Loan receivables and accounts receivable are non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable payments that are not listed in an active market. They are characterized by the fact that they arise when the Group makes funds, goods or services available directly to a customer without intending to trade the resulting receivable. They are included among current assets with the exception of items maturing more than 12 months after the closing date, which are classified as fixed assets. Loan receivables and accounts receivable are included under the heading accounts receivable and other receivables in the balance sheet. Accounts receivable are reported at the amount expected to be received less deductions for doubtful receivables judged on an individual basis. Because accounts receivable are expected to have a short maturity period, values are reported at a nominal amount without discounting. Impairment losses on accounts receivable are reported among operating expenses. Loan receivables are stated at amortized cost applying the effective interest method.

Financial instruments held to maturity

Financial instruments that are held to maturity are non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable payments and with specified terms, which the Group’s management intends and has the ability to hold until maturity. Assets in this category are stated at amortized cost applying the effective interest method.

Financial assets available for sale

Financial assets available for sale are non-derivative assets that are either attributable to this category or have not been classified in any of the other categories. They are included in fixed assets if management does not intend to divest the asset within 12 months after the balance sheet date. Assets in this category are continuously valued at fair value and the change in value is reported in shareholders’ equity. Exchange-rate fluctuations in monetary securities are reported in the income statement while exchange-rate fluctuations in non-monetary securities are reported against shareholders’ equity. When instruments classified as instruments available for sale are divested or when impairment losses are to be made on the instruments, accumulated adjustments in fair value are recognized in the income statement as gains and losses from financial instruments. Interest on securities available for sale that have been calculated by applying the effective interest method are reported in the income statement under other revenue. Dividends on equity instruments available for sale are reported in the income statement under other revenue when the Group’s right to receive payment has been established.

Financial liabilities stated at fair value in the income statement

Financial liabilities valued at fair value in the income statement are derivatives with negative fair values unless identified as hedges.

Financial liabilities carried at amortized cost

Financial liabilities carried at amortized cost denotes financial liabilities other than those included in the category financial liabilities stated at fair value in the income statement. Borrowing is included among other financial liabilities, initially at fair value, net after transaction costs. Borrowing is subsequently reported at accrued acquisition cost and any difference between the amount received (net) and the repayment amount is distributed over the term of the loan as interest expense applying the effective interest method.

CASH EQUIVALENTS

Cash equivalents include cash and bank balances and other short-term investments maturing within three months from the acquisition date and that can easily be converted into cash.

SHARE CAPITAL

Transaction costs directly attributable to the issuing of new shares or options are reported net after tax in shareholders’ equity as a deduction from the proceeds of the new share issue. In the event that a Group company acquires shares in the Parent Company (repurchase of treasury shares), the purchase price

 

12


paid, including any directly attributable transaction costs (net after tax) reduces that part of shareholders’ equity that relates to shareholders in the Parent Company until the shares have been canceled, reissued or divested. If these shares are subsequently sold or reissued, the amount received, net after directly attributable transaction costs and income tax effects, is reported in that portion of shareholders’ equity that relates to shareholders in the Parent Company.

DEFERRED TAX

Current and deferred income tax for Swedish and foreign Group companies is reported under the heading Taxes in the income statement. The companies are liable to pay taxes according to applicable legislation in each country. National income tax is calculated on nominally entered earnings with additions for non-deductible items, deductions for non-taxable revenues and other deductions, primarily untaxed dividends from subsidiaries. In the balance sheet, deferred tax liabilities and assets are calculated and reported on the basis of temporary differences between the carrying amounts and taxable values of assets and liabilities, as well as other tax-related deductions or deficits. Deferred tax assets are reported at a value considered true and fair and only when it is likely that it will be possible to realize the underlying loss carryforwards within the foreseeable future. The reported values are reviewed at each closing date. Deferred income tax is calculated by applying the tax rates and laws that have been decided or announced on the closing date and that are expected to apply when the deferred tax asset in question is realized or when the deferred tax liability is settled. The effects of changes in applicable tax rates are recognized in income in the period in which the change becomes law. See Note 11.

EMPLOYEE BENEFITS

PENSION COMMITMENTS

According to IAS 19, pension obligations are classified as defined-contribution plans or defined-benefit plans. The defined-contribution plans are mainly accounted for at the cost (premium/ contribution) incurred during the fiscal year for securing employee pension benefits. In these cases, there is no need to perform an actuarial evaluation of the pension plan from an insurance perspective and the Group’s earnings are charged for expenses in pace with the benefits being earned. Defined-benefit plans must be established according to the present value of defined-benefit obligations and the fair value of any plan assets. In that case, the “Projected Unit Credit Method” is used to calculate obligations and costs, in which consideration is also given to future salary increases. OMX has only defined-contribution pension obligations and in the event that companies with defined-benefit plans are acquired, management will determine whether there is cause and opportunity to replace the defined-benefit plan with a defined-contribution plan.

EMPLOYEE STOCK OPTION PROGRAM

OMX issued employee stock options during the years 2001 and 2002.

If the share price exceeds the redemption price when the options are redeemed, the employee is entitled to receive shares or compensation in cash for the difference between the share price and the redemption price. This is known as a “cash-settled plan.” The options were allocated free of charge, and their fair value was reported as a liability as of January 1, 2004 when the transition to IFRS 2 took place. The valuation of the liability is affected by changes in the fair value of the options and by personnel turnover, and this is reported as changes in personnel costs in the income statement. When employees leave the company, the liability is reduced by the corresponding amount of the employee’s share. In order to limit the costs for the program (including social security contributions) in the event of a price increase, limit dilution and secure the provision of shares upon exercise of these options, an agreement was signed earlier with an external party to provide OMX shares at a fixed price (share swap). As described under “Financial instruments,” above, the share swap will be

 

13


stated at fair value on an ongoing basis. Changes in fair value are transferred to the income statement and reported as changes in personnel costs, and thus limit the effect of changes in the fair value of the employee stock options as described above. The financing costs for the share swap are reported as a financial expense. For OMX employees in countries where social security contributions are payable for share-based benefits, the social security contributions are expensed on an ongoing basis for the benefit of the employee. The benefit consists of the fair value of the options as described above.

SHARE MATCH PROGRAM

A Share Match Program was introduced in 2006. The Share Match Program is a long-term program for approximately 30 senior executives and key individuals in OMX and runs over a period of three years. The Share Match Program is a program regulated/settled on the basis of shareholders’ equity.

Payroll costs for the Share Match Program are reported during the vesting period for matching shares based on the fair value of the shares on allotment date. The fair value is based on the share price when the investment is made, adjusted to ensure that no dividend is paid prior to the matching and adjusted to the market conditions included in the program. This date is the date of the offering. Amounts corresponding to the costs for the Share Match Program are reported in the balance sheet as shareholders’ equity. The vesting conditions affect the number of shares that OMX will match. We estimate the probability of achieving performance targets for shares under performance-based programs when personnel expenses are calculated for these shares. Costs are calculated based on the number of shares that is expected to be matched at the end of the vesting period. Non-market related conditions for vesting are considered in the assumptions regarding the number of options expected to be vested. When purchased and vested shares are matched, social security contributions shall be paid on the value of the employee benefit in certain countries. The employee benefit is generally based on the market value on matching date. Provisions for estimated social security contributions are established during the vesting period.

OMX’s Annual General Meeting on April 12, 2007 resolved to approve the proposed Share Match Program 2007 regarding approximately 95 senior executives and key individuals in OMX. The Share Match Program 2007 has not been initiated and will not be initiated due to the fact that OMX has been subject to a public offer since May 2007.

COMPENSATION UPON TERMINATION OF EMPLOYMENT

Compensation is payable upon termination of employment when an employee is given notice of termination of employment before the normal pension time, or when an employee voluntarily resigns in exchange for such compensation. The Group reports severance pay when it is demonstrably obliged either to lay off employees irrevocably in accordance with a detailed formal plan, or to pay compensation upon termination of employment resulting from an offer made to encourage voluntary resignation.

VARIABLE SALARY

The Group reports a liability and an expense for variable salary, based on a Group-wide program, “Short-term Incentive 2007,” see Note 7. The Group reports a provision when there is a legal obligation to do so, or an informal obligation based on prior practice.

PROVISIONS

Provisions are reported in the balance sheet when the Group has an existing legal or informal obligation in this regard due to the occurrence of an event that can be expected to result in an outflow of financial benefits that can reasonably be estimated. Provisions for restructuring costs are reported when the Group has presented a detailed plan for implementing the measures, the plan has been communicated to the parties concerned, and a well-founded expectation has been created. See Note 24.

 

14


DERIVATIVE INSTRUMENTS AND HEDGING MEASURES

Derivative instruments comprise, among others, futures, options and swaps that are used to cover the risk of exchange-rate fluctuations or exposure to interest-rate risks. Derivative instruments are first reported at fair value on the date on which the contract was signed and the fair value is subsequently reassessed on each reporting occasion. The method for reporting gains or losses depends on whether the derivative instrument is classified as a hedging instrument and in such a case the nature of the hedged item. In the Group, derivative instruments are classified as either hedging of fair value of reported assets or liability or of a binding commitment (hedging of fair value), hedging of forecasted transactions (cash-flow hedging) or as hedging of net investments in foreign operations.

Whenever hedging is entered into, the relationship between the hedging instrument and the hedged items, and the company’s risk-management targets and strategy for hedging is documented in the Group. The Group also documents, whenever hedging is entered into, its assessment of whether the derivatives used in conjunction with hedging transactions are expected to be effective in achieving counteracting effects in fair value or the cash flow that are attributable to the hedged risk. The Group continuously documents the effectiveness of the hedging transactions.

Hedging of fair value

Changes in the fair value of derivative instruments classified as hedging of fair value are reported on the same line of the income statement as the change in value of the hedged item. Gains and losses pertaining to hedging are reported in the income statement on the same date as when gains and losses are reported for items that have been hedged. Since the entire change in value of the derivative instrument is reported directly in the income statement, any ineffective portion of the derivative instrument is recognized in the income statement. In the case that the conditions for hedge accounting are no longer fulfilled, the derivative instrument is reported at fair value including any change in value in the income statement in accordance with the principle described above.

Cash-flow hedging

Changes in value of cash-flow hedging are reported in shareholders’ equity and reentered in the income statement in line with the hedged cash flow impacting the income statement. Any ineffective portion of the change in value is reported directly in the income statement. If the forecasted cash flow forming the basis of the hedging transaction is no longer deemed to be probable, the accumulated result reported in shareholders’ equity is transferred directly to the income statement.

Hedging of foreign net investments

Changes in value of exchange-rate differences attributable to derivative instruments intended to hedge net investments in foreign operations are reported in shareholders’ equity. Any ineffective portion of gains or losses is reported directly in the income statement as a financial item. The accumulated result in shareholders’ equity is re-entered in the income statement in the event that the foreign operations are divested.

DERIVATIVES TO WHICH HEDGE ACCOUNTING IS NOT APPLIED

If hedge accounting is not applied, increases or decreases in the value of the derivative are reported as income or expense in Operating profit/loss or in Net financial income/expense, depending on the purpose for which the derivative instrument is being used and whether its use relates to an operating item or a financial item. If hedge accounting is not applied when interest swaps are used, the interest coupon is reported as interest and any other value change of the interest swap is reported as other financial income or other financial expense.

 

15


Derivative positions at Nordic Marketplaces

By virtue of their clearing operations in the derivatives markets, Nordic Marketplaces is formally the counterparty in all derivative positions traded via the exchanges. However, the derivatives are not used by the exchanges for the purpose of trading on their own behalf but should be viewed as a way of documenting the counterparty guarantees given in clearing operations. The counterparty risks are measured using models that are agreed with the financial inspection authority of the country in question. The risk situation in regard to the risks involved in liquidating positions is unchanged compared with before. Collateral for liquidating outstanding derivative instruments is pledged in the same manner as before. According to IAS 39/IAS 32, the market value of the abovementioned derivative positions must be reported gross in the balance sheet after netting by customer where an offset possibility exists.

CALCULATION OF FAIR VALUE

The fair value of financial instruments that are traded in an active market (such as market-listed derivative instruments, financial assets held for trading and financial assets available for sale) is based on quoted market prices on the closing date. The shares in Oslo Børs Holding ASA are listed on the Norwegian Securities Dealers Association’s OTC list. The market for the share is characterized by a low number of settlements and high volatility. The value of the shareholding is based on the volume-weighted average of transactions in the most recent quarter.

The fair value of financial instruments that are not traded in an active market (such as OTC derivatives) is determined by applying generally accepted valuation techniques. The Group uses a number of different methods and makes assumptions based on the market conditions that prevail on the closing date. Quoted market prices or quotes by brokers for similar instruments are used for long-term liabilities. Other techniques, such as calculation of discounted cash flows, are used to determine the fair value of the remaining financial instruments. The fair value of interest swaps is calculated as the present value of the estimated future cash flows. The fair value of currency futures is determined based on market prices for currency futures on the closing date. The par value of accounts receivable and accounts payable, less any perceived credits, is assumed to correspond to their fair value. The fair value of financial liabilities is calculated, for clarification in notes, by discounting the future contracted cash flow to the current market rate of interest available to the Group for similar financial instruments.

COLLATERAL PLEDGED TO OMX’S EXCHANGE OPERATIONS

Through their clearing operations, OMX’s exchanges enter as the counterparty into each options and futures contract, thereby guaranteeing the fulfillment of each contract. Customers, who either through an option or futures contract, incur a financial obligation towards OMX’s exchanges, must pledge collateral against this obligation in accordance with the specific rules regulating this area. Most of the collateral pledged comprises cash and securities issued by the Swedish State. For other collateral pledged, see Note 28.

CONTINGENCIES

A contingency relates to a possible commitment arising from events that have occurred but for which the actual commitment can only be confirmed by the occurrence of one or more uncertain future events that are not fully within the company’s control, or a commitment that arises from events that have occurred but are not reported as liabilities or provisions due to the fact that it is unlikely that an outflow of resources will be required to regulate the commitment, or that the size of the commitment cannot be calculated with sufficient accuracy.

 

16


REVENUE RECOGNITION

The Group’s reported net sales relate primarily to trading revenue and the sale of systems and services. Revenue is recognized in the income statement when the product or service has been delivered in accordance with the applicable terms and conditions for delivery and it is probable that future financial benefits will flow to the company and these benefits can be measured reliably. Interest income is recognized on a time proportion basis that is calculated on the basis of the yield on the under­lying asset. Dividends are recognized in the income statement when the shareholders’ right to receive payment is established. Income received in the form of assets (for example shares) is valued at fair value on the transaction date.

NORDIC MARKETPLACES

Revenues within this business area comprise, in addition to trading revenues, premium revenues for options written and payments for futures sold. Premium revenue and expenses as well as futures payments made and received are shown as net figures in the income statement. Consequently, current account assets and liabilities are reported according to the net accounting principle in the balance sheet where right of offset applies. Issuers’ revenues are recognized on a continuous basis as services are rendered.

INFORMATION SERVICES & NEW MARKETS

Revenues within this business area comprise, in addition to trading revenues from Baltic Markets, information revenue, revenues from the central securities depositories in Tallinn and Riga and revenue from services in securities administration. These revenues are recognized on a continuous basis as services are rendered.

MARKET TECHNOLOGY

OMX applies the percentage-of-completion method to its technology sales, license and project revenues. In applying the percentage-of-completion method, income is recognized in line with the completion (development) of a project. An anticipated loss on a project is immediately treated as an expense. The fundamental premise of the percentage-of-completion method is that project revenue and expenditure can be accurately assessed and that the degree of development can be reliably established. At OMX, the degree of development is established through the relationship between the hours that have been worked by closing date and the estimated number of project hours in total. The occasional project arises for which an accurate assessment of project revenue and expenditure cannot be made when the year-end accounts are prepared. In these cases, no profit is reported for the project. The percentage-of-completion method is applied as soon as possible. A present-value calculation has been performed for those project receivables that do not fall due within 12 months. Income from support and facility management services is recognized on a continuous basis as services are rendered and over the contract period.

INTERNAL SALES

The main principle for transactions between companies within the Group is that the price is determined according to market price. Market price is the price an external customer is willing to pay or the price an external supplier would charge for providing the service. In cases where comparable market prices cannot be established, the price of the transaction is determined according to the cost-coverage method plus a margin. The cost-coverage method entails remuneration for direct costs as well as a reasonable portion of the indirect costs that the company has accumulated while providing the service. Any internal profit that arises as a result is eliminated within the Group. Common functions, such as premises-leasing expenses and office services, are invoiced between companies within the Group according to the cost-coverage method.

LEASING

In the consolidated accounts, leasing is classified as financial or operational leasing. Financial leasing applies where the financial risks and benefits associated with ownership are, in all material aspects, transferred to the lessee. Where this is not the case, operational leasing applies. In the case of operational leasing, leasing fees are expensed over the period of the lease, which commences when usage starts. OMX only has operational leasing commitments.

 

17


DIVIDENDS

Dividends to the Parent Company’s shareholders are reported as a liability in the Group’s financial statements in the period when the dividend is approved by the Parent Company’s shareholders.

FIXED ASSETS HELD FOR SALE AND DISCONTINUED OPERATIONS

When a decision has been made to discontinue an asset or cash-generating unit by selling it, the asset or unit in question is classified as being held for sale.

Assets classified as held for sale are reported separately in the balance sheet at the lower of carrying amount and fair value, with a deduction made for selling costs. Earnings of discontinued operations and operations in the process of being discontinued are reported in a separate column in the income statement. Losses resulting from decreases in value when assets are classified for sale are included in the income statement.

CASH-FLOW STATEMENT

The cash-flow statement was prepared in accordance with the indirect method. Financial investments with a duration in excess of three months are not included in cash equivalents. Accordingly, cash equivalents may fluctuate when there are changes in the duration of investments.

CURRENT TRADING ACCOUNT

The current trading account’s assets and liabilities in OMX’s exchange operations have been reported according to the net accounting principle within the respective clearing operations in cases where a right of offset exists.

ASSESSMENT OF THE EFFECTS ON OUR FINANCIAL REPORTING RELATING TO FUTURE ACCOUNTING STANDARDS

When the consolidated financial statements were prepared as at December 31, 2007, the following standards and interpretations had been published but had not yet come into effect.

The following standards or statements come into effect in 2008/2009:

 

   

IAS 1 Amendment: Presentation of Financial Statements (January 1, 2009)

 

   

IAS 23 Amendment: Borrowing Costs (January 1, 2009)

 

   

IAS 27 Amendment: Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements (January 1, 2009)

 

   

IFRS 2 Amendment: Share-based Payment (January 1, 2009)

 

   

IFRS 3 Amendment: Business Combination (July 1, 2009)

 

   

IFRS 8 Operating Segments (January 1, 2009)

 

   

IFRIC 11 – IFRS 2 Group and Treasury Share Transactions (January 1, 2008).

The following standards or statements will come into effect in 2008/2009 but are not relevant to the Group:

 

   

IFRIC 14 – IAS 19 The Limit on a Defined Benefit Asset, Minimum Funding Requirements and Their Interaction (January 1, 2008)

 

   

IFRIC 12 Service Concession Arrangements (January 1, 2008)

 

   

IFRIC 13 Customer Loyalty Programmes (July 1, 2008).

Of the above-listed standards and interpretations, the amendments to IAS 1, IAS 23, IAS 27, IFRS 2, IFRS 3, IFRIC 12, IFRIC 13 and IFRIC 14 had not been adopted by the EU at January 1, 2008. A number of annual improvements to standards and statements are expected in 2008/2009, which have not been adopted by the EU. In the management’s view, none of these new standards or changes to standards is expected to have any influence on the Group’s earnings or financial position at present.

 

18


RISK MANAGEMENT

RISK MANAGEMENT AT OMX

OMX’s business operations place high demands on effective risk management which comprise a fundamental part of the Group’s strategic and systematic efforts to achieve operational goals while minimizing potential disruptions. Parts of OMX are subject to special regulation and supervision. The conditions for an efficient process are created through a business adapted and integrated risk management model that takes into account external and internal requirements. This enables controlled risk for the purpose of optimizing business value. There is particular focus at Group and business area levels to maintain high levels of capability in crisis management, business-related continuity and incident management, as well as business intelligence.

The aim of risk management is to increase value for our shareholders, customers, employees and other stakeholders by maintaining an adequate level of protection of the Group’s prioritized assets. This is achieved by eliminating or minimizing risks and disruptions to our business operations that would otherwise generate financial losses or other undesired costs.

OMX’S RISK MANAGEMENT ORGANIZATION

The following roles and responsibilities are included in OMX’s risk management in order to ensure compliance with laws and regulations, governance, coordination and the development of methodology, as well as operational risk management activities:

The Board of Directors is ultimately responsible for adequate and efficient risk management.

The President is ultimately responsible for ensuring that risk management is applied in accordance with the Board’s directions.

The Group Risk Management & Control (GRMC) staff function has the task of governing and coordinating risk management with regard to organization, roles and responsibilities, framework including methodology, reporting and control. GRMC includes governance of Security, Risk Management, Insurance and Internal Control including coordination and support in the event of crises and major incidents.

Management (at executive, business area and business support level) is responsible for identifying, assessing, managing and reporting the risks found within their respective areas of responsibility.

Specialists in various security areas, such as operational and financial risk management and insurance, support management and others in the line organization with analyses and management of risks and incidents.

All employees and contracted personnel are, to a certain extent, included in risk management in their roles and respective areas of responsibility. Internal Audit is responsible for the independent audit of risk management, regarding both observance of governance, control activities and reporting.

OMX’S RISK MANAGEMENT PROCESS

OMX’s risk management is a business-integrated process that covers both business and support units at various levels in the organization. The methodology applied is partially based on the international ERM-standard (Enterprise Risk Management standard) in accordance with COSO (the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission) with additional methodology for the areas of Security, Insurance and Internal Control. The

 

19


risk management process is integrated in the operations conducting business activities, such as strategic management and development work, and is directly linked to the company’s business planning and follow-up.

Risk management is a standardized and continuous process which aims to identify, evaluate, manage, control and report significant risks to which OMX may be exposed. Risk management employs different forms of preventative measures and strategies, such as risk prevention, damage limitation and risk financing, in order to safeguard the Group’s objectives and the majority of goals set at business area and operational levels.

OMX’s risk management not only includes risks in the day-to-day business operations but also risks arising in conjunction with forward-looking strategic investments in order to optimize the company’s business opportunities.

Risk management including control activities is decentralized to each business area and support function. As a result, all business areas, support functions and Group staff functions work with the management of financial, operational and strategic risks. Risks are divided into short-term and long-term risks.

The operations report identified and assessed risks periodically to GRMC, which presents consolidated risk reports to the Risk Steering Group. The CEO reports on consolidated risks in OMX to the Board.

RISK MANAGEMENT IN OMX’S BUSINESS AREAS

The Nordic Marketplaces business area and its units comprise operations that are subject to special regulation. Corresponding requirements apply to the Information Services & New Markets business area which includes trading information, the Baltic exchange operations and central securities depositories. Finally, the Market Technology business area provides system solutions, systems operation and other services to exchanges, clearing organizations, central securities depositories and other types of authorized companies in the financial markets in a number of different countries. All business areas manage operational and strategic risks particularly those that fall under their respective areas of focus and responsibility.

Nordic Marketplaces

Nordic Marketplaces primarily manages risks attributable to the clearing operations for derivatives instruments. These risks arise as a result of the clearing organization serving as the counterparty in those transactions, entailing issuing a guarantee for ensuring that a clearing contract will be fulfilled. The clearing operations’ risks include counterparty risks, settlement risks and liquidity risks, of which the significant risk is that one or more clearing counterparties will fail to fulfill its commitments. One of the primary obligations of clearing counterparties is to pledge the requisite collateral, in terms of both amount and securities as required by the applicable rules, as protection against the counterparty risk assumed. In addition, netting is applied which implies that the counterparty risk is reduced to the net exposure of outstanding positions in relation to each counterparty. This facilitates risk management in the clearing operations by decreasing the value of the payments to be made, and reducing the need for liquidity facilities.

Market Technology

The special risks associated with the Market Technology business area are attributable mainly to the various phases in the provision of a service: the sales phase, the delivery and implementation phase and the production phase.

 

20


The sales phase involves the risk of the absence of profitability and foreign exchange risk. Operational risks are managed in the other phases. Significant emphasis placed on IT security and planning for continuity and reliable operations encompasses risk management with the aim of preventing risks and limiting damage.

FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT IN 2007

OMX is exposed to various kinds of financial risks through its international operations.

ORGANIZATION AND OPERATION

The Group’s financial operations and financial risk management are centered around OMX’s internal bank, OMX Treasury. The goal of OMX Treasury is, within given risk limitations, to manage the Group’s financial risk exposure, to optimize net financial income and generate value for business operations through financial services. Significant economies of scale, lower financial costs and better oversight and management of the Group’s financial risks are achieved through centralized financial operations. Operations are conducted according to a Finance Policy, which forms the framework and specifies guidelines and limitations. The Finance Policy is determined by OMX AB’s Board of Directors and revised continuously.

The Policy deals with the following risks:

 

   

Credit and counterparty risks

 

   

Liquidity and financing risks

 

   

Market risks

 

   

Currency risks (transaction and translation exposure)

 

   

Interest-rate risks

 

   

Price risk.

CREDIT AND COUNTERPARTY RISKS

OMX’s financial transactions give rise to credit risks towards financial counterparties. Credit risk or counterparty risk refers to the risk of loss if the counterparty does not fulfill its obligations. There are counterparty risks when investing in cash equivalents. In accordance with the Finance Policy, financial assets are divided into regulatory capital and surplus liquidity. The assets are handled differently depending on the type of capital managed. The aim is to centralize all surplus liquidity to OMX Treasury to reduce the Group’s liabilities. For cases in which a liability cannot be reduced, this liquidity shall be invested in fixed-income instruments with counterparties that have a high degree of creditworthiness and are defined in the Finance Policy. The management of regulatory capital is centralized to OMX Treasury and comprises the main portion of the Group’s outstanding investments, which according to the Finance Policy are to be invested only in fixed-income instruments with low credit risks. On December 31, 2007, the majority of the regulatory capital was invested in securities issued by the Swedish Government.

The derivative instruments that OMX uses involve a counterparty risk, that is, that the counterparty will not fulfill its portion of the agreement relating to futures or options.

All handling of derivative instruments, apart from derivative instruments attributable to OMX Nordic Exchange Stockholm AB’s clearing operations, are centralized to OMX Treasury. To reduce credit risk, all derivative instruments are usually extended by only three months, meaning that the credit risk involved is low. In order to limit counterparty risk, only

 

21


counterparties with a high degree of creditworthiness according to the adopted Finance Policy are accepted. OMX Treasury also uses ISDA agreements to minimize counterparty risk.

Counterparty risk is monitored continuously within OMX Treasury. Any deviations from mandates are reported to the CFO. The scope of the counterparty risks at year-end is described in the table “Counterparty risks.” No change in the method or assumptions applied to the calculation of counterparty risk took place during the year. The risks existing on the closing date are deemed to be representative for the Group’s risk during the year.

Counterparty risk also arises through OMX Derivative Markets (which is a secondary name for OMX Nordic Exchange Stockholm AB) providing clearing services and thereby serving as the central counterparty in all contracts subject to counterparty clearing. The Risk Management Department at OMX Derivative Markets has the primary responsibility for managing this risk. The aim is to manage the risk in accordance with surveillance requirements, international industry standards and the permitted risk level determined by OMX AB’s Board, and other relevant bodies within the Group. The principles for managing this risk according to this aim are based on a high level of quality in the clearing operations, a high level of quality in the risk-management framework, application of suitable and conservative methodology for calculating the margin, ensuring a solid legal foundation (that is, an established, clear and transparent set of regulations) and maintaining suitable financial capital and suitable resources in the clearing operations. Pledged collateral amounts to SEK 15,886 m (15,458) (see Note 29 Collateral received by OMX’s exchange operations) on December 31, 2007. The pledged collateral meets the criteria for approved collateral as stipulated by OMX Derivative Market’s derivative regulations. None of OMX Derivative Market’s clearing members, or other counterparties, accounted for more than 15 percent of the total exposure on December 31, 2007.

The Group’s financial transactions regarding accounts receivable give rise to credit risks with financial counterparties. OMX’s work to ensure the credit quality of its accounts receivable and to minimize the risk of customer losses is described below.

Nordic Marketplaces och Information Services

A company that intends to be listed on any of OMX’s exchanges is required to fulfill the criteria set forth in the listing agreement. One of these requirements is that the company shall provide documentation on its profitability and financial resources to conduct its operations.

As regards other services and products in Nordic Marketplaces and Information Services, fixed fees are invoiced in advanced and larger variable fees are invoiced monthly in arrears. This minimizes the risk of losses in accounts receivable.

Market Technology

Customers in Market Technology are exchanges, alternative trading venues, banks and securities brokers. Each major project commences shall have a documented project plan that includes a credit assessment of the customer. The assessment is primarily based on the ownership structure of the potential customer and the customer’s financial strength and/or business plans prepared for new initiatives. A start fee, covering OMX’s costs for the immediate period of the project, is invoiced when the project begins. In general, OMX works actively with collection of outstanding accounts receivable. Weekly follow-ups are complied and reported to executive management. The claim is sent to debt recovery as a final stage if a

 

22


customer does not pay. None of OMX’s customers accounted for more than 9 percent of invoicing on December 31, 2007.

Liquidity and financing risks

Liquidity risk, or financing risk, is the risk that OMX is unable to fulfill its commitments associated with financial liabilities. OMX’s borrowing represents the most significant portion of the Group’s financial liabilities. In accordance with the Finance Policy, OMX Treasury is to ensure that OMX has sufficient cash equivalents and/or credit facilities to cover short-term liability payments. The aim is that the key figure of “payment readiness” shall exceed one (1), meaning that OMX shall have adequate funds in the form of cash equivalents or credit facilities to cover, at a minimum, liabilities that are due for payment within one year. Financing risk refers to the risk that costs will be higher and financing possibilities limited when a loan is to be refinanced, and that it will not be possible to fulfill payment obligations due to insufficient liquidity or difficulties in obtaining financing. OMX Treasury follows the level of payment readiness and submits monthly reports to the CFO and quarterly reports to the Board. If the payment readiness target has not bee fulfilled, OMX Treasury presents a report to the CFO and takes remedial action as soon as possible.

No change to the methodology or assumptions in the calculation of financing risk took place during the year. However, the liability portfolio has consciously not been extended due to the future combination with NASDAQ, which is why the maturity structure has been shortened and payment readiness decline during the year.

Financing risk is also dealt with by endeavoring to find a suitable balance between short and long-term financing and a diversification between various forms of financing and markets. OMX’s total granted credit facilities as per December 31, 2007 amounted to SEK 3,684 m (3,741), of which SEK 82 m (30) has been utilized (see table: Credit facilities). Of OMX’s credit facilities, SEK 2,100 m is a syndicated credit facility with a three-year term. One portion, SEK 1,500 m, is linked to the company’s commercial paper program for the same amount and, if OMX is unable to issue the commercial papers, entitles the company to borrow capital in the amount of SEK 1,500 m. There are also overdraft and credit facilities for approximately a year of SEK 1,568 m which is dedicated to liquidity requirements linked to OMX’s clearing operations. Financial conditions linked to these credit facilities will be applied if OMX receives a credit rating from Standard & Poor’s of BBB or below. OMX’s long-term counterparty rating with Standard & Poor’s was “A with a negative outlook,” its short-term counterparty rating was “A-1 with a negative outlook”, and it had a rating of K1 on the Nordic scale. During the year, Standard & Poor’s assessment of OMX’s credit rating was changed from “a stable outlook” to “a negative outlook” when the merger between OMX and NASDAQ was announced.

The average term of liabilities as at December 31, 2007 was 2.4 years (3.4). There are five bond loans totaling SEK 1,350 m (see table: Interest-bearing assets and liabilities, Group).

The terms for all of the Group’s financial liabilities are described in the table Maturity structure, financial liabilities.

For OMX’s capital structure, the OMX Board has determined that the financial target for the net debt/equity ratio shall not exceed 30 percent over time. This financial target is continuously monitored by OMX Treasury and reported to the CFO every month and to the Board every quarter. The net debt/equity ratio varied between 14 and 30 percent during the year. Interest-bearing net liabilities amounted to SEK 850 m (847) and shareholders’ equity to SEK

 

23


5,117 m (4,614) on December 31, 2007, which meant that the net debt/equity ratio was 16.6 percent (18.4)

Market risk

Market risk is the risk that future cash flows or the fair value of a financial instrument will vary due to changes in the market price. There are three types of market risk: currency risk, interest-rate risk and other price risks.

Currency risks

A significant portion of the Group’s sales are attributable to operations outside Sweden, which means that changes in currency exchange rates have an impact on the Group’s income statement and balance sheet. Currency risk exposure occurs during the sale and purchase of foreign currencies (transaction exposure) and during the translation of foreign subsidiaries’ balance sheets and income statements to SEK (translation exposure).

In accordance with the Group’s Financial Policy, 100 percent of contracted flows and 0-100 percent of forecast flows up to 12 months shall be hedged. Deviations from the prescribed hedge levels can occur within specified guidelines. Hedging of transaction exposure is carried out through currency forwards and options or loans in foreign currencies.

The majority of transaction exposure arising within the Group is attributable to the technology operations through customer contracts and costs in foreign currency. OMX’s total net exposure and hedging of this exposure is monitored continuously by OMX Treasury and reported every month to the CFO and every quarter to the Board. The Currency transaction exposure table describes OMX’s transaction exposure before and after hedging transactions. The table also shows the effect that exchange-rate fluctuations of +/- 5 percent would have on OMX’s earnings. At December 31, 2007, this effect amounted to SEK 6 m. The time of such impact on earnings should be spread over the period that the hedged flows will have an effect on the income statement. Exchange-rate fluctuations of +/- 5 percent are based on the risk parameter defined in OMX’s Financial Policy under currency risk.

Currency forwards that hedge contracted flows fulfill the conditions for hedge accounting. These forwards have been defined as hedging of fair value and are reported in the income statement together with changes in fair value of the asset which gave rise to the hedged risk, see the Hedge relations table. The forward contracts that hedge forecast flows fulfill the requirements for hedge accounting. These forward contracts have been defined as cash-flow hedging. Changes in fair value of these hedges are reported directly against shareholders’ equity, while the portion of the hedge that is not effective is reported directly in the income statement.

Transaction exposure originating from financial cash flows is eliminated by the subsidiaries raising borrowings and making investments in local currency or by hedging these flows by using currency forwards (see table: Hedging of financial loans and assets).

Translation exposure occurs in conjunction with the translation of OMX’s foreign subsidiaries’ balance sheets and income statements and in the recalculation of consolidated goodwill relating to foreign subsidiaries into SEK. In accordance with the Financial Policy, portions of the translation exposure are hedged in order to reduce the volatility of OMX’s financial key ratios. The table Translation exposure – net assets in foreign subsidiaries describes OMX’s translation exposure before and after hedging transactions. The table also shows the effect that exchange-rate fluctuations of +/- 5 percent would have on OMX’s shareholders’ equity. At December 31, 2007, this

 

24


effect amounted to SEK 208 m. The time of such impact on shareholders’ equity should be the closing date. No change to the methodology or assumptions in the calculation of currency risk exposure took place during the year. The risks existing on the closing date are deemed to be representative for the Group’s risk during the year.

Interest-rate risks

The Group is exposed to interest-rate risks that can impact the Group’s earnings due to changing market rates. Both the Group’s interest-bearing assets, consisting primarily of regulatory capital for counterparty risks within the exchange and clearing operations, and interest-bearing liabilities are exposed to interest-rate risks. The speed with which a permanent change in interest rates can impact the Group’s net financial income depends on the fixed-interest terms of investments and loans.

Fixed-interest terms for Group liabilities are short as stipulated in the Financial Policy. According to the Financial Policy, interest swaps and standardized interest futures are used to change the length of fixed-interest terms, thereby minimizing interest-rate risk.

The Financial Policy provides guidelines on how regulatory capital is to be managed based on an index with a duration of approximately two years. OMX Treasury has a mandate to deviate from this index, although the duration deviation in the portfolio must fall within an interval of zero to three years. As a rule, surplus liquidity is placed in investments with short fixed-interest terms. OMX Treasury continuously monitors the Group’s interest-rate risk for both assets and liabilities. This risk is reported to the CFO every month and to the Board every quarter.

At year-end, net financial debt amounted to SEK 850 m (net debt: SEK 847 m). Financial assets as of December 31, 2007 amounted to SEK 1,081 m (950) and the average effective rate of interest for these assets was 4.03 percent (3.70), while the fixed-interest term was approximately 1.2 years. Interest-bearing securities that are retained are booked at fair value.

At year-end, interest-bearing financial liabilities amounted to SEK 1,931 m (1,797), of which SEK 858 m (1,350) are long-term (see table: Interest-bearing assets and liabilities, Group). During the year, the average fixed-interest term for liabilities varied between two and five months. As per December 31, 2007, the fixed-interest term for borrowings was three months and the effective rate was 4.72 percent (3.33). The interest-bearing financial liabilities are not booked at fair value since the liabilities are to be held until maturity. The exceptions are bonds which have been hedged by using fixed-income derivatives. These fixed-income derivatives are defined as hedging of fair value and fulfill the requirements for hedge accounting. The fixed-income derivative agreements are reported in the income statement together with changes in fair value of the asset or liability that gave rise to the hedged risk (see the Hedge relations table).

In the event of a parallel shift in the Swedish and foreign yield curves upward by one percentage point, the Group’s earnings would be negatively affected in an amount of SEK 22 m (23) on an annualized basis, given the nominal amount and the fixed-interest terms prevailing on December 31, 2007.

No change to the methodology or assumptions in the calculation of interest-rate risk exposure took place during the year. The risks existing on the closing date are deemed to be representative for the Group’s risk during the year.

Price risk in shareholding

OMX is exposed to price risk in the equities market through the holdings of shares in Oslo Børs VPS A/S. The holdings were valued at SEK 449 m on

 

25


December 31, 2007. The holdings are continuously monitored by OMX Treasury. At December 31, 2007, a 10-percent lower share price would entail a negative change in value of SEK 45 m in OMX’s holdings in Oslo Børs VPS A/S. This change in value would be directly reported against shareholders’ equity. Other shareholdings are not significant in size (see Note 16). The holdings in associated companies are not included in the sensitivity analysis.

No change to the methodology or assumptions in the calculation of price risk took place during the year. The risks existing on the closing date are deemed to be representative for the Group’s risk during the year.

HEDGING OF EMPLOYEE STOCK OPTION PROGRAM

In order to limit costs for the programs if the share price were to increase, limit dilution and ensure that shares can be provided when options are exercised, an agreement has previously been made with an external party regarding the provision of OMX shares, known as an equity swap. The agreement is valid until June 30, 2009 and corresponds to approximately 130,000 shares at an agreed price of SEK 220.50 per share. The equity swap agreement covers the portion of outstanding employee stock options that are currently deemed to be exercised. In the case that over time it is deemed likely that a different number of employee stock options will be utilized, the number of shares in the agreement with the third party will be adjusted.

OMX continuously pays interest compensation to the counterparty in exchange for the counterparty undertaking to provide the shares. Interest compensation in the agreement corresponds to the net amount of interest expenses on the underlying value of the shares when the agreement was signed and the dividend on the underlying shares (approximately 130,000 shares). Interest expenses are based on a STIBOR of 90 days.

Changes in OMX’s share price affect the value of the equity swap. These changes in fair value are reported in the income statement.

OMX Treasury continuously monitors the company’s exposure and manages the equity swaps to attain the desired hedging effect.

HEDGING OF SHARE MATCH PROGRAM

In order to limit expenses for the program in the event of an increase in the share price, eliminate dilution, and to ensure that shares can be provided when shares are matched in the Share Match Program, OMX has signed an equity-swap agreement amounting to approximately 57,000 shares at a predetermined price of SEK 146 per share. The equity swap covers the portion of shares that are expected to be allotted at the end of the program. The equity swap is reported as an equity instrument in accordance with IAS 32.

OMX has also signed an equity-swap agreement amounting to 18,000 shares at a predetermined price of SEK 123.50 in order to limit the expenses for the social security contributions arising in conjunction with the Share Match Program. Changes in the price of OMX’s shares affect the value of the share swap. These changes in fair value are reported in the income statement.

OMX continuously pays interest compensation to the counterparty in exchange for the counterparty undertaking to provide the shares. Interest compensation in the agreement corresponds to the net amount of interest expenses on the underlying value of the shares when the agreement was signed and the dividend on the underlying shares. Interest expenses are based on a STIBOR of 90 days.

OMX Treasury continuously monitors the company’s exposure and manages the equity swaps to attain the desired hedging effect.

 

26


CALCULATION OF FAIR VALUE

The fair value of financial instruments that are traded in an active market is based on quoted market prices on the closing date.

The fair value of financial instruments that are not traded in an active market is determined by applying generally accepted valuation techniques. The Group uses a number of different methods and makes assumptions based on the market conditions that prevail on the closing date. Quoted market prices or quotes by brokers for similar instruments are used for long-term liabilities. Other techniques, such as calculation of discounted cash flows, are used to determine the fair value of the remaining financial instruments. The fair value of interest swaps is calculated as the present value of the estimated future cash flows. The fair value of currency forwards is determined based on market prices for currency forwards on the closing date.

The par value of accounts receivable and accounts payable, less any estimated credits, is assumed to correspond to their fair value. The fair value of financial liabilities is calculated by discounting the future contracted cash flow to the current market rate of interest available to the Group for similar financial instruments.

CURRENCY EXPOSURE

CURRENCY TRANSACTION EXPOSURE

The table shows the Group’s commercial future net flows and net exposure as at December 31, 2007. A sensitivity analysis shows the effect on earnings of a +/- 5 percent change in the value of the SEK.

 

Currency    Net flow in each
base currency
(m)
   Future net flow
December 31, 2007
(SEK m)
  

Net exposure

after hedging
(SEK m)

   Sensitivity
base 1)
(SEK m)

AUD/SEK

   -6.5    -36.4    -40.3    -2.0

EUR/SEK

   65.1    614.7    40.0    -2.0

GBP/SEK

   -0.5    -6.8    -13.0    -0.6

NOK/SEK

   26.5    31.4    -6.7    -0.3

RUB/SEK

   16.0    4.2    0.0    0.0

SGD/SEK

   2.1    9.2    -8.3    -0.4

USD/SEK

   61.7    395.6    8.2    -0.5

Total

      1,011.9    -20.1    -5.8

 

1)

The negative change in earnings in the event of a +/- 5-percent change in the exchange-rate.

HEDGING OF CURRENCY TRANSACTION EXPOSURE

The table shows a summary of outstanding futures as of December 31, 2007 pertaining to all hedges for commercial flows and transaction exposure. The purpose of the hedges is to safeguard the value of contracted future flows and to increase forecastability. In accordance with the Group’s Financial Policy, 100 percent of the contracted flows and 0–100 percent of estimated flows of up to 12 months shall be hedged. Deviations from the prescribed degree of hedging are permitted within the established guidelines. Currency hedging is undertaken in the market through currency futures, option contracts or loans in foreign currencies.

 

27


Currency    Hedged in each
base currency
(m)1)
   Nominal value
at year-end rate
(SEK m)
   Nominal value
at forward rate
(SEK m)
   Unrealized
forward result
(SEK m)
   Average
forward
rate2)
  

Date of

maturity

AUD/SEK

   -0.7    -3.9    -3.7    -0.2    5.35    <12 months

EUR/SEK

   -60.9    -574.7    -571.7    -2.9    9.39    <12 months

GBP/SEK

   -0.5    -6.2    -6.0    -0.2    12.47    <12 months

NOK/SEK

   -32.2    -38.2    -39.1    0.9    1.22    <12 months

RUB/SEK

   -16.0    -4.2    -4.1    -0.1    0.26    <12 months

SGD/SEK

   -3.9    -17.5    -17.1    -0.4    4.36    <12 months

USD/SEK

   -60.3    -387.3    -387.0    -0.4    6.41    <12 months

Total

   -174.5    -1,032.0    -1,028.7    -3.3      

 

1)

The aggregated negative change in value of the forward contracts in the event of a +/- 5-percent change in the exchange-rate corresponds to SEK 51.4 m (based on the nominal amount of the contract at forward rate).

2)

The average forward rate is based on the spot rate in the forward contracts entered into. Thus, the forward premium is excluded.

TRANSLATION EXPOSURE – NET INVESTMENTS IN FOREIGN SUBSIDIARIES

The table shows foreign subsidiaries’ net assets in foreign operations and goodwill denominated in foreign currencies. Translation exposure is hedged in order to reduce the volatility in OMX’s key ratios. A sensitivity analysis shows the effect on results in the event of a +/- 5-percent change in the value of SEK.

 

Currency    Equity
(SEK m)
   Goodwill
(SEK m)
   Hedging of
net investment1)
   Total
(SEK m)
   Sensitivity2)
(SEK m)

AUD

   17.2    0.0    0.0    17.2    -0.9

CAD

   4.6    0.0    0.0    4.6    -0.2

DKK

   713.6    1,176.1    0.0    1,889.6    -94.5

EUR

   1,667.2    1,362.1    -1,510.6    1,518.6    -75.9

EEK

   51.4    2.3    0.0    53.7    -2.7

GBP

   -170.2    61.9    0.0    -1,08.3    -5.4

HKD

   -2.1    0.0    0.0    -2.1    -0.1

ISK

   158.6    154.2    0.0    312.7    -15.6

LTL

   21.6    11.6    0.0    33.2    -1.7

LVL

   24.2    1.0    0.0    25.2    -1.3

NOK

   55.0    22.4    0.0    77.4    -3.9

SGD

   7.5    0.0    0.0    7.5    -0.4

USD

   -113.2    8.3    0.0    -104.7    -5.1

Total

   2,435.4    2,799.9    -1,510.6    3,724.6    -207.7

 

1)

The aggregated negative change in value of the forward contracts in the event of a +/- 5-percent change in the exchange-rate corresponds to SEK 75.5 m (based on the nominal amount of the contract at forward rate).

2)

The negative change in earnings in the event of a +/- 5-percent change in the exchange-rate.

HEDGING RELATIONS

The table summarizes the hedging relations reported by the Group for which hedge accounting are applied. The type of hedging entered into is specified in the table.

All currency hedges expire within 12 months. The hedging relation for interest swaps expires in December 2008.

 

28


Hedging instrument   Type of hedging   Hedged item   Currency   Hedged amount
in base currency
(m)
  Nominal value
at year-end rate,
(SEK m)
  Nominal value
at forward rate,
(SEK m)
  Unrealized
forward rate,
(SEK m)
  Average
forward
rate1)

Currency future

 

Fair value hedge

 

Contracted Currency flows

  EUR/SEK   -60.9   -574.7   -571.7   -2.9   9.39

Currency future

 

Hedge of net investment

 

Shareholders’ equity

           
   

equity in subsidiary

  EUR/SEK   -160.0   -1,510.6   -1,510.9   0.2   9.44

Currency future

 

Fair value hedge

 

Contracted Currency flows

  NOK/SEK   -32.2   -38.2   -39.1   0.9   1.22

Currency future

 

Fair value hedge

 

Contracted Currency flows

  RUB/SEK   -16.0   -4.2   -4.1   -0.1   0.26

Currency future

 

Fair value hedge

 

Contracted Currency flows

  USD/SEK   -60.4   -387.4   -386.9   -0.4   6.41

Interest swap

 

Fair value hedge

 

Issued bonds

  SEK   200.0   200.0   N/A   -0.4   N/A

Total

              -2.7  

 

1)

The average forward rate is based on the spot rate in the forward contracts entered into. Thus, the forward premium is excluded.

HEDGING OF FINANCIAL LOANS AND ASSETS

The table shows a summary of the Group’s currency futures for hedging of financial assets and loans as at December 31, 2007.

 

29


Currency   

Hedged in each

base currency
(m)1)

   Nominal value
at year-end rate
(SEK m)
   Nominal value
at forward rate
(SEK m)
  

Unrealized

forward result
(SEK m)

   Average
forward
rate2)
   Date of
maturity

AUD/SEK

   17.2    96.9    97.4    -0.5    5.66    < 12 mån

CAD/SEK

   0.1    0.5    0.5    0.0    6.41    < 12 mån

DKK/SEK

   460.1    582.4    573.2    9.2    1.25    < 12 mån

EUR/SEK

   47.3    446.3    444.5    1.8    9.40    < 12 mån

GBP/SEK

   -16.2    -208.7    -212.5    3.8    13.11    < 12 mån

HKD/SEK

   -4.1    -3.3    -3.3    0.0    0.81    < 12 mån

ISK/SEK

   866.2    89.0    92.1    -3.2    0.11    < 12 mån

NOK/SEK

   21.3    25.3    25.9    -0.6    1.22    < 12 mån

SGD/SEK

   0.8    3.3    3.3    0.1    4.37    < 12 mån

THB/SEK

   -8.4    -1.8    -1.7    -0.1    0.20    < 12 mån

USD/SEK

   13.1    83.8    84.0    -0.3    6.43    < 12 mån

Total

      1,113.7    1,103.4    10.2      

 

1)

The aggregated negative change in value of the forward contracts in the event of a +/- 5-percent change in the exchange-rate corresponds to SEK 76.9 m (based on the nominal amount of the contract at forward rate).

2)

The average forward rate is based on the spot rate in the forward contracts entered into. Thus, the forward premium is excluded.

FINANCIAL ASSETS

The tables below show a summary of the Group’s and the Parent Company’s financial assets and a maturity structure of financial assets due for payment.

 

      On December 31, 2007    On December 31, 2006
GROUP    Carrying
amount
   of which due
for payment
   Carrying
amount
   of which due
for payment

Other investments held as fixed assets1)

   505    —      363    —  

Receivables with associated companies

   —      —      6    —  

Other long-term receivables

   42    0    40   

Accounts receivable2)

   594    229    425    173

Market value of outstanding derivative positions3)

   3,404    —      4,401    —  

Other short-term receivables4) 5)

   848    —      889    —  

Short-term investments

   607    —      518    —  

Cash equivalents

   424    —      410    —  

TOTAL

   6,424    229    7,052    173

 

1)

The item “Other investments held as fixed assets” is not exposed to credit risk. Refer instead to the section on Market risk.

2)

OMX’s work to ensure a high level of credit quality in its accounts receivables is described in the Credit and counterparty risk section on page 74.

3)

Customers, who either through an option or futures contract, incur a financial obligation towards OMX Nordic Exchange Stockholm AB must pledge collateral against this obligation in accordance with the specific rules regulating this area. At December 31, 2007, the pledged collateral for these items totaled SEK 15,886 m. The main portion of this pledged collateral comprises cash and securities issued by the Swedish Government (see Note 29).

 

30


4)

This item primarily refers to current trading account assets, which amounted to SEK 628 m (748) at December 31, 2007. During the period between transaction and settlement, usually one to five days, OMX has a receivable from the purchasing party and a liability with the selling party. The counterparty risk is limited to one of the parties not delivering the sold securities or the agreed purchase prices, and does not comprise the full value of the total receivable.

5)

The balance sheet also includes items that are not classified as financial instruments under IFRS 7.

The maximum credit exposure corresponds to the carry amounts stated above.

FINANCIAL RECEIVABLES DUE FOR PAYMENT

 

Days    >30    31–90    91–180    181–360    < 360

On December 31, 2007 Accounts receivable

   155    39    23    3    9

On December 31, 2006 Accounts receivable

   95    51    8    10    9

PROVISION FOR ANTICIPATED LOSSES IN ACCOUNTS RECEIVABLES

 

      December 31, 2007    December 31, 2006

Accounts receivable

   620    426

Provision for anticipated losses1)

   -26    -1

Carrying amount, accounts receivable

   594    425

 

1)

Accounts receivable were impaired in the amount of SEK 1 m (1) during the year.

INTEREST-BEARING ASSETS AND LIABILITIES

The table shows interest-bearing assets and liabilities as per December 31, 2007 and shows average remaining terms, fixed-interest terms and average interest.

 

      Outstanding
amount
    Remaining
term, months
   Remaining fixed-
interest
term, months
   Average
interest rate, %

ASSETS

          

Current assets (including cash and bank balances and excluding regulatory capital)

   203     <12    <12    4.89

Long-term assets

   21     >12    <12    4.16

Regulatory capital

   857     >12    >12    3.83

TOTAL ASSETS

   1,081           4.03

LIABILITIES

          

Commercial paper

   545 1)   2    2    4.64

 

31


Bond loans

           

OMX PP March 2008

   300    2    2    4.899

OMX PP December 20082)

   200    12    3    5.08

OMX PP December 2009

   200    24    3    5.05

OMX PP May 2013

   400    65    4    4.85

OMX PP Nov 2014

   250    84    5    4.85

Bond loans, total

   1,350    41    3.6    4.88

Bank loans

   28    0    0   

Other

   8    0    0     

TOTAL LIABILITIES

   1,931    29    3.0    4.72

 

1)

The market value of the outstanding commercial paper.

2)

The issued bond has been swapped from a fixed to a floating interest rate. The swapped interest rate is applied when calculating the average interest rate.

COUNTERPARTY RISKS

The table shows the Group’s counterparty risks in financial instruments (excluding counterparty risks related to the clearing operations and accounts receivables) at December 31, 2007.

 

      Total
counterparty
exposure
(SEK m)
  

Maximum exposure
toward individual
institutions/
players1)

(SEK m)

Regulatory capital invested in fixed-income instruments issued by the Swedish Government

   607    607

Regulatory capital invested in mortgage certificates

   154    154

Other regulatory capital and surplus liquidity invested in banks and other short-term investments

   299    68

Other financial assets

   21    6

Total interest-bearing assets

   1,081    835

Derivative transactions

   22    13

 

1)

No institutions/players represent maximum exposure in more than one category.

CREDIT FACILITIES

The table shows the Group’s total credit facilities and those that had been utilized as at December 31, 2007.

 

(SEK m)    Contracted
facilities
    Utilized
facilities

Syndicated bank loan/commercial paper program

   1,500 1)   0

Syndicated bank loan

   600     0

 

32


Overdraft facility

   116    12

Contracted facilities for exchange and clearing operations

     

Sweden (SEK)

   1,200    0

Norway (NOK)

   95    0

Denmark (DKK)

   51    38

UK (GBP)

   103    29

Finland (EUR)

   9    3

Iceland (ISK)

   10    0

Total

   3,684    82

 

1)

Since the credit facility is linked to the commercial paper program and is to function as a credit facility if OMX is unable to issue a commercial paper program, the unutilized credit facility shall be reduced by the outstanding commercial paper. The outstanding commercial paper as of December 31, 2007 amounted to SEK 550 m, implying that OMX can utilize only SEK 950 m of the current credit facility.

MATURITY STRUCTURE, FINANCIAL LIABILITIES

The table below shows an analysis of the terms of the remaining contracts for financial liabilities. The amounts reported refer to the actual payments that are associated with the Group’s financial liabilities.

GROUP

 

At December 31, 2007    Due for
payment
   < 1 month     1–3 months    3–12 months    1–5 years    > 5 years

Interest-bearing long-term liabilities

   —      —       2    40    372    663

Other long-term liabilities

   —      —       —      —      82    10

Liabilities to credit institutions

   —      75     778    200    —      —  

Accounts payable

   3    165     1    3    —      —  

Market value of outstanding derivative positions

   —      3,404     —      —      —      —  

Other current liabilities

   —      596 2)   23    63    16    —  

Hedging transactions2)

   —      551     2,739    —      —      —  

TOTAL

   3    4,791     3,543    306    470    673
At December 31, 2006    Due for
payment
   > 1 months     1–3 months    3–12 months    1–5 years    > 5 years

Interest-bearing long-term liabilities

   —      —       6    21    853    675

Other long-term liabilities

   —      —       —      —      107    1

Liabilities to credit institutions

   —      350     50    —      —      —  

Accounts payable

   12    77     4    16    —      —  

Market value of outstanding derivative positions

   —      4,401     —      —      —      —  

Other current liabilities

   —      734 1)   3    72    6    —  

Hedging transactions2)

   —      241     2,440    —      —      —  

TOTAL

   12    5,803     2,503    109    966    676

 

33


1)

Of which SEK 28 m (38) refers to a credit facility that is automatically extended.

2)

The cash flows are related to the Group’s hedging transactions (currency futures). However, most of the outflows that arise will, at the same time, generate corresponding inflows in another currency. Accordingly, the significant negative cash-flow effects shown in the table under this category will not arise in net amounts. Customer payments in foreign currency that are received prior to the hedging instruments falling due for payment have, on in certain instances, been swapped to fall due for payment at the same time and with the same counterparty. As a result, only a net flow arises in these instances.

 

34


NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Amounts are in SEK millions (SEK m) unless otherwise stated. Amounts in parentheses indicate values for 2006. “OMX” refers to the OMX Group, that is OMX AB and its subsidiaries.

NOTE 1. USE OF ESTIMATES

In order to prepare the accounting in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, company management and the Board of Directors are required to make assessments and assumptions that affect asset and liability items, income and expense items, and other information reported in the accounts, for example contingent liabilities. These assessments are based on historical experience and the various assumptions that management and the Board deem to be reasonable under the prevailing circumstances. Consequently, such conclusions form the basis of decisions concerning reported values of assets and liabilities in the case that it is not possible to determine such values based on information from other sources. Actual outcomes may differ from these assessments if different assumptions are made or if different circumstances prevail. The areas of revenue recognition and doubtful receivables, the valuation of goodwill and capitalized development projects, taxes, provisions for expenses for premises and other restructuring measures, legal disputes and contingent liabilities in particular may entail a significant impact on OMX’s results and financial position (see the respective following Notes for further information).

NOTE 2. CLASSIFICATION OF REVENUE

The classification of revenue is based on a number of assessments and assumptions concerning revenue recognition in delivery projects in the Technology operations. These are reported as “License, support and project revenue” below. The uncertainty inherent in these assessments primarily refers to the forecast time of completion.

REVENUE PER SIGNIFICANT TYPE OF REVENUE, CONTINUING OPERATIONS

 

(SEK m)    2007    2006

Total revenue:

     

Trading revenue

   1,578    1,291

Issuers’ revenue

   391    343

Information revenue

   568    443

Revenue from Baltic Markets

   76    68

Revenue from Broker Services

   186    205

License, support and project revenue

   834    758

Facility Management Services

   220    200

Other revenue

   228    178

Total

   4,073    3,486

CAPITAL GAINS WITHIN OTHER REVENUES, CONTINUING OPERATIONS

 

Group    2007    2006

Capital gains, sale of NOS ASA

   —      22

Capital gains, sale of VPC AB

   —      83

Capital gains, sale of shares in Orc Software AB

   101    —  

Capital gains, sale of Lawshare

   3    —  

Total

   104    105

 

35


CURRENCY EFFECTS

The Group’s total revenue includes exchange-rate differences totaling negative SEK 6 m (neg: 7). Exchange-rate differences also had an effect on operating expenses of SEK 0 m (0).

FINANCIAL ITEMS REPORTED IN OPERATIONS

Financial items had a negative effect on operating revenue amounting to SEK 12 m (pos: 8). For further information, refer to Note 9, Financial items.

NOTE 3. BUSINESS AREAS AND GEOGRAPHIC SEGMENTS

Internal reporting and follow-up within OMX is organized based on the business areas Nordic Marketplaces, Information Services & New Markets and Market Technology.

These business areas make up OMX’s primary reporting segments while the geographic divisions make up the secondary reporting segment. OMX is divided into four geographic regions: Nordic countries, Rest of Europe, North America and Asia/Australia. This geographic division is based on the areas in which the Group’s operations have relatively similar systems solutions, frameworks of regulations and customer behavior.

REVENUE AND EARNINGS BY DIVISION, CONTINUING OPERATIONS

 

(SEK m)    2007    2006

Revenue

     

Nordic Marketplaces

   2,111    1,778

Information Services & New Markets

   854    752

Market Technology

   1,768    1,300

Group eliminations

   -660    -344

TOTAL GROUP

   4,073    3,486

Operating income

     

Nordic Marketplaces1)

   981    940

Information Services & New Markets1)

   261    217

Market Technology1)

   213    93

Difference in elimination of expenses and income in the Group2)

   -95    —  

TOTAL GROUP

   1,360    1,250

 

1)

Including distribution of income for the Parent Company and other functions totaling a loss of SEK 284 m (income: 15).

 

2)

Development of Genium occurs within the Market Technology business area. Initially, Genium was developed for OMX Nordic Exchanges, which is why OMX’s created assets on March 31, 2007 were transferred to the Nordic Marketplaces business area. Since there is a difference between expenses in Market Technology and the amount that OMX can capitalize, a difference arises in the eliminations of costs and income in the Group. This accounting effect will remain for the duration of the development project.

 

36


ASSETS AND LIABILITIES PER BUSINESS AREA

 

     2007    2006
(SEK m)    Assets    Liabilities    Assets    Liabilities

Nordic Marketplaces

   7,875    5,421    8,439    5,099

Information Services & New markets

   509    124    440    69
Market Technology    2,446    1,227    2,702    1,128

Operations being discontinued

   47    —      70    —  

Unallocated items

   1,359    347    877    1,618

TOTAL GROUP

   12,236    7,119    12,528    7,914

Items per business area are tangible assets, intangible assets, external operating receivables, external operating liabilities and goodwill. Other items are not allocated in the Group and are reported as unallocated items. Unallocated items also include all eliminations of internal business dealings between the various business areas and all interest-bearing liabilities. Assets and liabilities that could be affected by the business areas are allocated in accordance with OMX’s business control model, which does not support a full distribution of balance-sheet items.

INVESTMENTS, DEPRECIATION AND IMPAIRMENT PER BUSINESS AREA

 

     2007    2006
(SEK m)    Invest.    Deprec./
impairment
   Invest.    Deprec./
impairment

Nordic Marketplaces

   198    -76    294    -70

Information Services & New Markets

   164    -53    19    -22

Market Technology1)

   231    -140    529    -132

TOTAL GROUP

   593    -269    842    -224

 

1)

Impairments of SEK 7 m in operations being discontinued are included in the Jan – Dec 2007 period and SEK 8 m for the Jan – Dec 2006 period.

Investments refer to acquisitions of tangible and intangible fixed assets. For further information on acquisitions, depreciation and impairment, see Notes 13 and 14.

INFORMATION REGARDING SECONDARY SEGMENTS

(GEOGRAPHIC AREAS)

EXTERNAL REVENUE PER GEOGRAPHIC AREA1)

 

(SEK m)    2007    2006

Nordic countries

   2,505    2,134

Rest of Europe

   1,244    990

North America

   388    146

Asia/Australia

   168    340

TOTAL GROUP

   4,305    3,610

 

1)

Based on the location of customers.

ASSETS AND INVESTMENTS PER GEOGRAPHIC AREA

 

     2007    2006
(SEK m)    Assets    Invest.    Assets    Invest.

Nordic countries

   6,232    576    5,581    788

Rest of Europe

   1,135    7    1,269    45

North America

   83    7    103    5

Asia/Australia

   27    3    26    4

Group eliminations and unallocated items1)

   4,759    —      5,549    —  

TOTAL GROUP

   12,236    593    12,528    842

 

1)

Group eliminations and unallocated items include goodwill in the amount of SEK 3,318 m (2,967).

 

37


Investments refer to acquisitions of tangible and intangible fixed assets.

NOTE 4. DISCONTINUING OPERATIONS

Operations being discontinued comprise the UK operations in securities administration services.

Revenue from discontinuing operations was SEK 232 m (124) during January – December, while expenses amounted to SEK 285 m (163). Operating loss was SEK 53 m (loss: 39), comparative figure has been adjusted compared with the 2006 annual report due to OMX, at the beginning of 2007, signing an agreement with HCL Technologies, the global IT services provider, regarding an extended partnership, which means that OMX no longer has any discontinuing operations in the Nordic region. The partnership meant that HCL Technologies assumed responsibility for the development and maintenance of systems for securities management targeting banks and brokers and that the remaining part of the Nordic operations will be moved to the Information Services & New Markets business area, and included in the Broker Services unit. The reported figures for 2006 are pro forma, which meant that operating profit improved by SEK 34 m.

During the fourth quarter of 2007, Lawshare was divested, a unit within operations being discontinued that supplies broker services to investment companies and asset managers. The divestment resulted in capital gain of SEK 3 m in the fourth quarter of 2007.

OMX’s aim is to identify a long-term solution with clear advantages for the remaining parts of the operations being discontinued. Discussions are currently in progress with potential partners.

Assets classified as holdings held for sale

 

(SEK m)    2007    2006

Group

     

Intangible assets

   43    62

Tangible fixed assets

   4    8

Total fixed assets held for sale

   47    70

NOTE 5. ACQUIRED OPERATIONS

FINDATA AB

In March 2007, OMX announced acquisition of Findata AB, a leading supplier of information about Nordic companies, which also offers adapted index. Findata has seven employees in Stockholm and the company’s sales amounted to SEK 17 m with favorable profitability for the full-year 2006. The purchase consideration amounted to SEK 43.5 m and a possible supplementary purchase consideration of a maximum of SEK 35 m. The operation will be consolidated into the Information Services & New Markets business area.

PRELIMINARY ACQUISITION ESTIMATE

 

(SEK m)      

Cash

   71

Acquisition costs

   3

ACQUISITION PRICE

   74

Acquired net assets

   31

Goodwill

   43

ACQUIRED ASSETS AND LIABILITIES

 

(SEK m)    Fair
value
   Carrying
amount

Fixed assets

   30    0

Current assets

   3    3

Cash and bank balances

   1    1

Current liabilities

   -3    -3

ACQUIRED NET ASSETS

   31    1

 

38


The difference between fair value and the carrying amount of fixed assets is primarily attributable to the valuation of acquired contracts.

Findata contributes SEK 13 m to the Group’s revenue and SEK 4 m in net income. Goodwill is attributable to the expected synergies arising from the continued development of OMX information services. The cash-flow effect of the acquisition amounts to SEK 73 m, comprising a cash payment of SEK 71 m, acquisition costs of SEK 3 m, less received cash balances of SEK 1 m. Of the total amount of acquisition costs, SEK 43.5 m was paid during the first quarter of 2007. Supplementary purchasing consideration of SEK 5 m was paid during the third quarter of 2007 and an additional SEK 5 m will be paid during 2008. The remaining profit-related supplementary purchase consideration, which is assessed to amount to SEK 17.5 m, will be paid in the first quarter of 2008 and 2009. Of the acquisition costs, SEK 1 m had an effect on cash flow in the first quarter, the remaining costs were paid during the second quarter.

NOTE 6. AUDITORS’ FEES

The following fees were paid to auditors and accounting firms for auditing and audit-related services required by law as well as for advice and other assistance arising from observations made during the course of the auditing process.

Fees were also paid for additional independent advice, mostly pertaining to audit-related consultations on accounting and taxation issues.

FEES TO THE GROUP’S AUDITORS

 

      GROUP
(SEK 000s)    2007    2006

PricewaterhouseCoopers

     

Auditing assignments1)

   12,814    10,729

Other assignment2)

   2,749    2,337

Ernst & Young

     

Auditing assignments

   296    488

Other assignments

   768    918

KPMG

     

Auditing assignments

   474    335

Other assignments

   2,087    378

BDO Feinstein

     

Auditing assignments

   —      36

Other assignments

   —      —  

Övriga revisorer

     

Auditing assignments

   376    780

Other assignments

   649    310

TOTAL

   20,213    16,311

 

1)

For 2007, auditing assignments pertaining to proposed mergers and public takeover bids for OMX amounting to SEK 5,048,000.

 

2)

For 2007, other assignments refer primarily to tax consultations.

NOTE 7. PERSONNEL

PERSONNEL EXPENSES AND BENEFITS PAID TO SENIOR EXECUTIVES

The reporting of senior executive benefits has been carried out in accordance with the recommendations of the Swedish Industry and Commerce Stock Exchange Committee (NBK).

 

39


SENIOR MANAGEMENT

NBK divides senior management into two categories: “top management” and “other senior management”. Top management comprises: the Chairman of the Board, any Board members receiving remuneration in addition to Board fees and the President and Chief Executive Officer (CEO). Other senior management normally relates to members of the executive management team.

Top management at OMX is defined as:

 

   

Urban Bäckström (Chairman of the Board)

 

   

Magnus Böcker (CEO of OMX and President of OMX AB).

Other senior management at OMX is defined as the Group’s Executive Management Team and comprises the following five individuals:

 

   

Jukka Ruuska (President of Nordic Marketplaces)

 

   

Hans-Ole Jochumsen (President of Information Services and New Markets)

 

   

Markus Gerdien (President of Market Technology)

 

   

Kristina Schauman (Chief Financial Officer)

 

   

Bo Svefors (Senior Vice President Marketing & Communications).

The Secretary to the Executive Management Team was OMX’s General Counsel

Magnus Billing.

OMX’S REMUNERATION COMMITTEE

The Remuneration Committee is appointed on an annual basis by the Board of Directors. The Remuneration Committee’s task is to prepare remuneration matters for Board decisions on issues relating to the salary and remuneration paid to the President and CEO, and to approve salaries and other remuneration to Executive Management Team which is subsequently reported to the Board. The Committee also approves the targets for the Executive Management Team established by the President. In addition, the Remuneration Committee’s task is to propose remuneration for the Board members in the subsidiaries within the OMX Group that have external Board members, and to make recommendations regarding remuneration principles, benefits and other types of remuneration for OMX employees. The Board appointed the following people as members of the Remuneration Committee: Urban Bäckström (Chairman), Birgitta Klasén and Bengt Halse. The Committee’s secretary until June was Pernilla Gladh, Senior Vice President Human Resources. From July, Elin Sebö, Head of Compensation & Benefits, was the Committee’s secretary. During 2007, the Remuneration Committee held a total of six meetings at which minutes were taken.

OMX’S REMUNERATION POLICY

The aim of OMX’s remuneration policy is to offer market-based remuneration that is competitive and that promotes a situation whereby qualified expertise can be recruited to and retained within OMX.

The fundamental principles are:

 

   

To work towards a consensus between employees and shareholders regarding the long-term perspective of operations.

 

   

To ensure that employees within OMX’s different organizations receive remuneration that reflects market conditions and is competitive.

 

   

To offer a salary scale based on results achieved, work duties, skills, experience and position held, which also means adopting a neutral stance in relation to gender, ethnic background, disability, sexual orientation, etc.

REMUNERATION STRUCTURE 2007

OMX’s employee remuneration comprises the following parts:

 

   

Fixed salary

 

   

Variable salary

 

   

Short Term Incentive Program

 

   

Long Term Incentive Scheme (OMX Share Match Program 2007)

 

   

Pension

 

   

Severance pay and other benefits.

 

40


At the discretion of the Board of Directors, decisions can be made to revise or terminate an existing program related to the remuneration structure.

REMUNERATION STRUCTURE 2008

The Board has not proposed any guidelines for remuneration to the company’s President and the Executive Management Team since the company will probably no longer be traded on the OMX Nordic Exchange due to the merger with NASDAQ.

FIXED SALARY

Every OMX employee has an annual salary review, with the exception of the members of the Executive Management Team, for whom a review takes place every second year and the President, for whom a review takes places every third year. The review considers employee performance, salary levels in the market and any changes to responsibilities as well as the company’s development and local rules and agreements.

VARIABLE SALARY

Short Term Incentive Program

OMX has had a Group-wide program for variable salary called “OMX Short Term Incentive Program” since 2004. The program consists of quantitative (financial) and qualitative (individual) goals. The prerequisite for achieving the quantitative goal is that OMX attained its established targets. The maximum dividend of the quantitative portion occurs at 130-percent fulfillment of the company’s goals. The qualitative goals are individual and are determined by an employee’s immediate superior during the first quarter of the year. The immediate manager also evaluates whether these goals have been achieved one year later.

Short Term Incentive 2007

The program for variable salary, “OMX Short Term Incentive 2007,” comprised approximately 200 managers and key employees. The total maximum variable portion that can be paid out for 2007 is SEK 43 m, excluding social security contributions. For 2007, the program comprised financial and individual goals, of which 60 percent is financial goal and 40 percent individual goal. The financial goal for 2007 was connected to achievement of the budgeted operating income for OMX. Of the maximum SEK 26 m representing the financial portion, SEK 17 m will be paid out. The estimated payment for the individual portion is calculated at 75 percent of the maximum of SEK 17 m. The total outcome for 2007 is estimated at SEK 30 m, excluding social security contributions.

Short Term Incentive 2008

Variable salary 2008 follows the same structure for 2007. The financial goal for 2008 is also connected to the budgeted operating income for OMX. The “OMX Short Term Incentive 2008” program also includes 200 managers and key employees. In 2008, individuals included in the program received an increase in possible variable remuneration and as a result will be excluded from the OMX salary review for 2008. The total maximum variable portion that can be paid out for 2008 is SEK 73 m, excluding social security contributions. The prerequisites for the payment follow the same guidelines as the preceding year.

The maximum bonus to senior executives for variable salary for 2008 is 75 percent of fixed salary, with the exception of Magnus Böcker, OMX President, whose maximum variable remuneration is 50 percent of fixed salary and the financial goal is connected to OMX’s return on capital employed and the budgeted operating income.

Long Term Incentive Scheme

OMX Share Match Program 2006

OMX’s Annual General Meeting in April 2006 approved the OMX Share Match Program 2006. The program for 2006 was directed to 30 senior executives and key individuals in OMX. Participants in the program are required to invest in OMX shares at a maximum of 7.5 percent of their fixed salary on an annual basis

 

41


before tax or the maximum amount earned under the Short Term Incentive program in 2005 after tax. Under the prerequisite that employment is not terminated, the participants in the program will receive up to five OMX shares, known as matching shares, in 2009, for each invested OMX share, if the following conditions have been fulfilled:

 

(i) The average percentage increase in earnings per share between January 1, 2006 and December 31, 2008 is equal to or exceeds 25 percent, and

 

(ii) The total annual return to shareholders is equal to or exceeds an index determined by the Board, plus 10 percentage points.

No matching shares will be issued if the average annual percentage increase in earnings per share falls below 2 percent per year or if the total annual return to shareholders has not improved on the comparative index.

OMX Share Match Program 2007

At the Annual General Meeting in April 2007, the OMX Share Match Program 2007 was approved. The program for 2007 was directed to 95 senior executives and key employees within OMX. The program largely followed the same structure and guidelines as the OMX Share Match Program 2006.

At the beginning of May 2007, when NASDAQ announced its bid for OMX, the Board decided to close the OMX Share Match Program 2007 before participants made their investments. Participants will be compensated for this by twice the maximum investing level, following the finalization of the transaction in the spring of 2008. The cost for 2007 amounted to SEK 17 m, total cost is estimated at approximately SEK 41 m.

PENSIONS

OMX offers its employees a defined-contribution occupational pension unless otherwise regulated in local agreements or other regulations. OMX’s pension plan for employees in Sweden has been created to provide employees with a market-competitive occupational pension. The age of retirement is 65 years. OMX’s President and CEO, Magnus Böcker, receives a defined-contribution pension benefit. The total premium provision amounts to 30 percent of fixed salary.

Other members of the Executive Management Team are included in the OMX pension plan, with the exception of Jukka Ruuska and Hans-Ole Jochumsen. Jukka Ruuska is included in the pension plan stipulated by the Finnish labor market regulations. Current premiums for Jukka Ruuska are equivalent to a pension provision of 17 percent of total remuneration. Hans-Ole Jochumsen, is included in the pension plan stipulated by Danish labor market practice; current premiums are equivalent to a pension provision of 20 percent.

The retirement age for employees, including the President and CEO and the Executive Management Team is 65 years.

The President and other members of the Executive Management Team have the possibility to waive salaries, variable remunerations and remunerations for long-term incentive programs in favor of direct pensions. During 2007, Magnus Böcker chose to convert a certain part of his remunerations into direct pension.

SEVERANCE PAY AND OTHER BENEFITS

Severance Terms/Period of Notice

The period of notice that applies between OMX and the President and CEO is 12 months from the company’s side and six months from the employee’s side. In the event of a company initiative to terminate the employment contract of the President and CEO, remuneration will be paid to the President and CEO corresponding to the fixed salary and other benefits (occupational pension and insurance including health insurance) during the period of notice. In addition to this, the President and CEO will receive a severance payment of six months’ fixed salary. Other members of the Executive Management Team have a period of notice of 12 months from the company’s side and six months from the employee’s side. In addition, Jukka Ruuska, President Nordic Marketplaces and Hans-Ole Jochumsen, President New Markets & Information Services have severance pay of

 

42


six months’ fixed salary. The President and CEO and other senior executives have a non-competition clause of 12 months, which includes a penalty if not followed. Since January 1, 2007, President Magnus Böcker had a clause in his employment contract that entitles him to six months’ salary compensation in the event of ownership change, in which Magnus Böcker’s own role changes and results in his decision to leave the company. The primary reason for the addition of this clause is to promote an ownership change regardless of the impact on Magnus Böcker’s own position.

Other Benefits

In addition to the occupational pension premiums detailed above, OMX also pays for long-term disability insurance, occupational group life insurance (TGL) and workers’ compensation insurance (TFA). Employees may also complement their insurance coverage through OMX’s optional group insurance. Employees in Finland and Denmark have equivalent benefits that are stipulated in the collective agreement for the financial sector. Also, the Executive Management Team and other senior executives are entitled to health insurance. In addition, during 2007, Jukka Ruuska, President Nordic Marketplaces has added a clause to his employment contract that entitles him to six months’ salary as compensation in the event of an ownership change, for the same reason.

ABSENCE DUE TO ILLNESS

The number of employees on absence due to illness during the fiscal year is accounted for as a percentage of the employees’ total ordinary working hours in parent company. Long-term absence due to illness is absence for 60 or more consecutive days.

 

Absence due to illness, Parent Company, %    2007    2006

Total absence due to illness

   0.8    1.5

Long-term absence (portion of total absence)

   28.4    46.5

Absence due to illness, men

   0.1    0.3

Absence due to illness, women

   1.6    2.4

Absence due to illness, employees under 29 years of age

   1.5    0

Absence due to illness, employees 30 – 49 years

   0.8    1.5

Absence due to illness, employees over 50 years

   0.4    1.7

DISTRIBUTION ACCORDING TO GENDER

 

     2007    2006
      Number    of whom men    Number    of whom men

Board of Directors (excl. CEO)1)

           

Parent Company

   7    5    8    6

Subsidiaries

   62    55    85    76

TOTAL GROUP

   69    60    93    82

 

1)

Pertains to the number of Board members in the Group’s operating companies on December 31, 2007.

 

     2007    2006
      Number    of whom men    Number    of whom men

Group management (incl. CEO)2)

           

Parent Company

   6    5    6    5

Subsidiaries

   91    67    62    46

TOTAL GROUP

   97    72    68    51

 

2)

Group management is defined as all presidents in the Group’s operating companies, persons who are members of the Executive Management Team and persons in the management groups within the OMX business areas on December 31, 2007.

 

43


REMUNERATION TO THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS AND THE EXECUTIVE MANAGEMENT TEAM

EXPENSED REMUNERATION

Board fees have not been paid to Board members who are employees of the Group. In addition to the Board fees below, Board fees totaling SEK 5 m (7) were paid during the year to subsidiary Board members. These fees have only been paid to persons who are not employees of the Group.

 

(SEK)          Board fees    Fixed salary    Variable salary    Pension    Benefits     TOTAL

Urban Bäckström

   2007    800,000    —      —      —      —       800,000
   2006    325,000    —      —      —      —       325,000

Magnus Böcker

   2007    —      5,137,522    1,550,000    1,500,000    6,899,235  2)   15,086,757
   2006    —      4,646,117    1,665,000    1,007,400    1,969,353     9,287,870

Executive Management, others 1)

   2007    —      13,835,863    6,175,000    2,850,474    383,026     23,244,363
   2006    —      12,260,008    4,955,000    2,459,845    128,787     19,803,640

Adine Grate Axén

   2007    —      —      —      —      —       —  
   2006    400,000    —      —      —      —       400,000

Bengt Halse

   2007    300,000    —      —      —      —       300,000
   2006    300,000    —      —      —      —       300,000

Birgitta Kantola

   2007    325,000    —      —      —      —       325,000
   2006    —      —      —      —      —       —  

Birgitta Klasén

   2007    300,000    —      —      —      —       300,000
   2006    250,000    —      —      —      —       250,000

Tarmo Korpela

   2007    —      —      —      —      —       —  
   2006    250,000    —      —      —      —       250,000

Markku Pohjola

   2007    250,000    —      —      —      —       250,000
   2006    250,000    —      —      —      —       250,000

Hans Munk Nielsen

   2007    350,000    —      —      —      —       350,000
   2006    325,000    —      —      —      —       250,000

Olof Stenhammar

   2007    —      —      —      —      —       —  
   2006    800,000    —      —      —      543     800,543

Lars Wedenborn

   2007    325,000    —      —      —      —       325,000
   2006    —      —      —      —      —       —  

TOTAL

   2007    2,650,000    18,973,385    7,725,000    4,350,474    7,282,261     40,981,120

TOTAL

   2006    2,900,000    16,906,125    6,620,000    3,467,245    2,098,683     31,917,053

 

1)

Executive Management Team for 2006 and 2007 comprise: Jukka Ruuska, Kristina Schauman, Bo Svefors, Hans-Ole Jochumsen and Markus Gerdien.

 

2)

Refers primarily to the divestment of 76,000 employee stock options.

 

44


FINANCIAL INSTRUMENT

 

     

Employee stock options1)

   Share Match Program2)
(Quantity)    2002    2001    2000      

Magnus Böcker

   0    0    150,000    4,615

Executive Management, others 3)

   0    0    0    10,023

TOTAL

   0    0    150,000    14,638

 

1)

No remuneration was paid for employee stock options from those allotted options.

 

2)

Pertains to the stock option program 2006.

 

3)

Pertains to members of the Executive Management Team on December 31, 2007.

INFORMATION ON EACH YEAR’S EMPLOYEE STOCK OPTION PROGRAM

 

      2002    2001

Strike price, SEK

   71    175

Redemption of shares with effect from

   July 2, 2003    June 15, 2002

Expiry date

   July 2, 2009    June 15, 2008

Number of allotted options

   733,000    1,150,000

Opening balance

   195,000    400,000

Exercised options

   152,000    312,000

Expired and obsolete

   3,000    34,000

Closing balance

   40,000    54,000

Of which fully vested (guaranteed) December 31, 2007

   40,000    54,000

Theoretical value, SEK m1)

   7    5

Theoretical value per option at issue1), SEK

   15    38

Theoretical value per option, SEK, as at Dec 31, 2007

   185    88

Theoretical dilution2), %

   0.03    0.05

Weighted average share price for redeemed employee stock options during the year

   210.58    —  

 

1)

The theoretical value of allotted options is fixed through an established options valuation model (Black & Scholes) at the time they are allotted. As at December 31, 2007, a volatility of 40 percent has been utilized.

 

2)

Theoretical dilution refers to the maximum number of shares that could be issued were it decided, on execution of redemption, to allot shares through a new share issue. However, to limit such dilution, hedging has been arranged through a “share swap,” meaning that no such dilution will occur.

 

45


OPENING AMOUNT OF NON-REDEEMED PORTION OF THE EMPLOYEE STOCK OPTIONS PROGRAM IN THE INCOME STATEMENT

 

(SEK m)    2007    2006

Income statement

     

Social security expenses attributable to personnel expenses

   1    1

Interest attributable to agreements on synthetic share buy-back

   -2    -2

Change in value, employee stock options

   3    3

Change in value, share swap

   -9    15

Balance sheet

     

Liability pertaining to employee stock options program

   12    15

Liability, social security expenses, employee stock options program

   3    4

Receivable pertaining to share swap

   5    1

In accordance with IFRS 2, the expenses for the stock options program are reported on an ongoing basis as personnel expenses in the income statement.

In order to limit costs for the programs (including social security contributions), if the share price were to increase, limit dilution and ensure that shares can be provided when redemption is requested, an agreement has previously been made with an external party regarding the provision of OMX shares if redemption were to be requested, known as a share swap. The agreement is valid until June 30, 2009 and corresponds to approximately 400,000 shares at an agreed price of SEK 126 per share. The buy-back agreement covers the portion of outstanding employee stock options that are currently deemed to be exercised. In the case that it is deemed probable that a number of employee stock options will be exercised over time, the number of shares in the agreement with the third-party will be amended. OMX continuously pays interest compensation to the counterparty in exchange for the counter-party undertaking to provide the shares. OMX receives the share dividend paid during the term of the agreement. Changes in the share price of OMX’s shares affect the value of the share swap and the result is reported against personnel expenses in the income statement.

SHARE MATCH PROGRAM 2006

 

Start date

   April 6, 2006

Matching date

   April 30, 2009

Number of invested shares

   26 855

Maximum number of matching shares

   134 275

Estimated number of matching shares

   57 000

Total estimated expense, SEK m

   20

Expenses for the year, SEK m

   8

Participants in the Share Match Program 2006 invest in OMX shares and, depending on whether OMX achieves performance targets related to earnings per share and how OMX’s shares perform in comparison to its competitors, participants may obtain a maximum of five matching shares per invested OMX share after three years. The number of shares that the participant may buy in the program is limited.

In order to limit expenses for the program in the event of an increase in the share price and to ensure that shares can be provided when shares are matched in the Share Match Program, OMX has signed a share-swap agreement amounting to approximately 57,000 shares at a predetermined price of SEK 146 per share. The share swap covers the portion of shares that are expected to be allotted at the end of the program. The share swap is reported as an equity instrument in accordance with IAS 32. OMX has also signed a share-swap agreement amounting to 18,000 shares at a predetermined price of SEK 123.50 to limit the expenses for the social security contributions arising in conjunction with the Share Match Program. Changes in the price of OMX’s shares affect the value

 

46


of the share swap. These changes in fair value are reported in the income statement. OMX continuously pays interest compensation to the counterparty in exchange for the counterparty undertaking to provide the shares. Interest compensation in the agreement corresponds to the net amount of interest expenses on the underlying value of the shares when the agreement was signed and the dividend on the underlying shares. Interest expenses are based on a STIBOR of 90 days.

At the OMX Annual General Meeting on April 12, 2007, it was decided to approve the proposed share match program for 2007 pertaining to approximately 95 senior executives and key employees of OMX. The share match program for 2007 has not commenced, and will not commence, as a result of OMX being the target of public takeover bid since May 2007.

AVERAGE NUMBER OF EMPLOYEES

 

      2007     2006  
      Number of
employees
   of whom
men
    Number of
employees
   of whom
men
 

Parent Company

   35    20     33    17  

Subsidiaries

          

Sweden

   892    602     821    555  

Australia

   79    61     66    54  

Denmark

   99    60     90    55  

Estonia

   44    12     38    10  

Finland

   112    59     107    58  

Hong Kong

   5    2     5    2  

Iceland

   66    44     29    23  

Italy

   3    3     2    2  

Canada

   19    13     16    11  

Latvia

   29    11     25    9  

Lithuania

   22    10     19    7  

Norway

   9    9     9    9  

Singapore

   6    5     5    5  

UK

   21    17     17    13  

USA

   40    32     42    35  

Total subsidiaries

   1,446    940     1,291    848  

TOTAL GROUP

   1,481    960     1,324    865  
SALARIES AND REMUNERATION  
SALARIES, OTHER REMUNERATION AND SOCIAL SECURITY EXPENSES  
      2007     2006  
(SEK m)    Salaries and
other
remuneration
   Social
security
expenses
(of which
pension
expenses)
    Salaries and
other
remuneration
   Social
security
expenses
(of which
pension
expenses)
 

Parent Company

   39    27 (11)   34    19 (6)

Subsidiaries

   944    340 (118)   797    268 (99)

TOTAL GROUP

   983    367 (129)   831    287 (105)

 

47


SALARIES AND OTHER REMUNERATION DISTRIBUTED PER COUNTRY

AND BETWEEN BOARD MEMBERS AND EMPLOYEES

 

      2007    2006
      Board of
Directors and
CEO
(of which
remuneration
and similar)
    Other
employees
   Board of
Directors and
CEO
(of which
remuneration
and similar)
    Other
employees

Parent Company

   16  (2)   23    (2)   25

Subsidiaries

         

Sweden

   (2)   513    (3)   455

Australia

   (0)   57    (0)   38

Canada

   —    (–)   12    —    (–)   9

Denmark

   (1)   63    (1)   57

Iceland

   (2)   44    (-)   19

Hong Kong

   —    (–)   3    (0)   3

Singapore

   —    (–)   4    (0)   4

Italy

   (1)   1    (1)   1

Norway

   —    (–)   5    —    (–)   6

UK

   (0)   104    (0)   72

USA

   —    (–)   41    —    (–)   43

Finland

   (1)   52    (0)   47

Estonia

   (0)   8    (0)   5

Latvia

   (0)   5    (-)   2

Lithuania

   (0)   4    (0)   3

Total subsidiaries

   28  (7)   916    33  (5)   764

TOTAL GROUP

   44  (9)   939    42  (7)   789

PENSIONS

OMX’s defined-contribution pension obligations are mainly accounted for at the cost (premium/contribution) incurred during the fiscal year for securing employee pension benefits. In these cases, there is no need to perform an actuarial valuation of the pension plan and the Group’s earnings are charged for expenses in pace with the benefits being earned.

INFORMATION ABOUT RELATED PARTIES

With the exception of remunerations to Board members and senior executives as reported above, no other remunerations or loans were granted to Board members, senior executives or their related parties during the 2007 and 2006 fiscal years.

NOTE 8. TRANSACTIONS WITH RELATED PARTIES

“Related parties” refers to companies and individuals on whom OMX is in a position to exercise significant, though not controlling, influence.

When transactions with associated companies reported in accordance with the equity method are not eliminated in the consolidated financial statements, separate information is shown in the table below to disclose those transactions that took place between OMX and these companies.

Information relating to transactions with individuals in close proximity (Board of Directors and senior executives) is set out in Note 7.

TRANSACTIONS WITH RELATED PARTIES, GROUP, 2007

 

(SEK m)    Sales1)    Purchases1)    Receivables     Liabilities

Associated companies

          

Central Securities

          

Depositories of Lithuania

   1    —      —       —  

EDX London Ltd

   32    —      2)   —  

Orc Software AB

   —      3    —       —  

 

1)

Sales and purchases from related parties occur at market prices.

 

2)

Entire receivable is current.

 

48


Note 9. Financial items

FINANCIAL ITEMS REPORTED IN INCOME STATEMENT

Financial item reported in financial items

 

      GROUP
     2007    2006

FINANCIAL REVENUE

         

Interest revenue

     

- Financial assets valued at fair value in the income statement1)

   2    5

- Interest revenue, Group companies

   —      —  

- Interest revenue, other

   61    37

Dividends

     

- Financial assets available for sale

   17    —  

- Group companies

   —      —  

Changes in financial assets/liabilities

     

- Valued at fair value in the income statement

   15    7

- Derivatives intended for hedging of shareholders’ equity in subsidiaries

   —      —  

Total financial revenue

   95    49

FINANCIAL EXPENSES

     

Interest expenses

     

- Interest expenses, Group companies

   —      —  

- Interest expenses, other

   -123    -93

Changes in financial assets/liabilities

     

- Valued at fair value in income statement

   -16    -11

- Valued at fair value in income statement2)

   -1    —  

- Derivatives intended for hedging of shareholders’ equity in subsidiaries

   —      —  

- Impairment loss on shares in subsidiaries

   —      —  

Other financial expenses

   -27    -5

Total financial expenses

   -167    -109

TOTAL FINANCIAL ITEMS

   -72    -60

FINANCIAL ITEMS REPORTED IN OPERATIONS

 

      GROUP
     2007    2006

Revenue

         

Ineffectiveness of following hedging:

     

- Cash-flow hedging

   —      —  

- Net investing hedges

   —      —  

Changes in hedging instrument valued at fair value in the income statement

   47    76

Total revenue

   47    76

EXPENSES

     

Amount transferred from shareholders’ equity and reported in income statement

     

- Cash flow hedging

   -10    -9

 

49


      GROUP
      2007    2006

- Net investing hedging

   —      —  

Ineffectiveness of the following hedging:

     

- Cash flow hedging

   —      —  

- Net investment hedging

   —      —  

Changes in hedging objects valued at fair value in the income statement

   -49    -59

Total expenses

   -59    -68

TOTAL FINANCIAL ITEMS REPORTED IN OPERATION

   -12    8

 

1)

Interest revenue of SEK 9 m and interest revenue of SEK 11 m on December 31, 2007.

 

2)

Capital gain on hedging instrument SEK 4 m and capital loss on financial instrument of SEK 5 m on December 31, 2007.

NOTE 10. ASSOCIATED COMPANIES

SHARES IN ASSOCIATED COMPANIES CONSOLIDATED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE EQUITY METHOD

 

      GROUP  
(SEK m)    2007    2006  

Reported value at beginning of year

   186    623  

Reclassification of owner change1)

   -72    —    

Sale of associated companies

   -11    -459  

Share in earnings of associated companies

   44    46  2)

Dividends and Group contributions received from associated companies

   -10    -34  

Translation differences

   2    -3  

Other changes in associated companies’ equity

   —      13  

Reported value at year-end

   139    186  

 

1)

The entire expense of SEK 72 m pertains to Näringslivskredit NKL AB, which from December 1, 2007 is a wholly owned subsidiary of OMX.

 

2)

Share in earnings of assoiated companies includes VPC AB in the amount of SEK 24 m in 2006.

Consolidated values pertaining to owned participation in revenue, earnings, assets and liabilities are specified below.

The market value of the holding in Orc Software (3.8 million shares) was SEK 624 m (524) as per December 31, 2007. The carrying amount was SEK 85 m (76). Other holdings are not listed. For these amounts the fair value is deemed to be the same as the carrying amount.

 

SEK m    Country    Revenue    Earnings    Assets    Liabilities    Shareholders’
equity
   Participation,
%
 

Associated companies, 2007

                    

Central Securities Depositories of Lithuania

   Lithuania    6    2    12    1    11    40  

EDX London Ltd

   UK    35    16    34    4    40    24  

ORC Software AB

   Sweden    133    25    152    67    85    25  

Associated companies, 2006

                    

Central Securities Depositories of Lithuania

   Lithuania    5    2    11    0    11    40  

EDX London Ltd

   UK    26    3    31    6    25    24  

Näringslivskredit NLK AB

   Sweden    1    1    99    27    72    48  1)

ORC Software AB

   Sweden    123    16    140    64    76    30  

 

1)

Portion of equity amounts to 90 percent.

 

50


None of the above participations in associated companies is owned by the Parent Company. Participations in associate companies on December 31, 2007 include goodwill of SEK 2 m (2).

NOTE 11. TAXES

Both current and deferred income tax are reported for Swedish and foreign Group entities under “Taxes” in the income statement. Companies in the Group are liable to pay tax in accordance with relevant taxation legislation in the respective countries. The corporate tax rate was calculated on nominal reported income adding non-deductible items and deducting non-taxable revenue. Assessments and assumptions have been made when calculating the amounts and percentages presented in this Note. All assessments and assumptions involve a certain degree of uncertainty.

DISTRIBUTION OF INCOME BEFORE TAX

 

     GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Sweden

   352    334

Other countries

   840    771

Share in earnings of associated companies

   43    46

TOTAL

   1,235    1,151

The “Distribution of tax for the year” table reports how tax is specified between Sweden and other countries and the division of current and deferred taxes. The positive earnings in the Swedish portion of the operations did not lead to a corresponding dissolution of tax loss carryforwards equivalent to tax assets, since the Group had tax-exempted revenue and deficit that were not previously taken into account. The Group’s operations in other countries resulted in mostly current tax. The Parent Company’s taxable revenue deviated significantly from earnings before tax since the company had major tax-exempted dividends from subsidiaries and adjustments for previous years.

DISTRIBUTION OF TAX FOR THE YEAR

 

     GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Current tax

     

Sweden

   -25    -3

Other countries

   -176    -112

Total

   -201    -115

Deferred tax

     

Sweden

   -15    -97

Other countries

   -33    -28

Total

   -48    -125

Total

   -249    -240

Tax rate, %

   20    21

The Group’s positive deviation from the nominal Swedish tax rate of 28 percent is primarily due to tax-exempt capital gains arising from the sale of shares in ORC Software, and other tax-exempt revenue. The fact that the Group conducts operations in several countries with a lower tax rate than Sweden also has a positive impact on the tax rate. The fact that operations are conducted in countries with lower tax rates than the nominal Swedish tax rate also had a

 

51


positive effect on the tax rate. Another positive effect is that the Group has booked tax assets on tax loss carry-forwards that were not previously included due to the open statement in the income tax returns. The negative effects of the tax rates are the losses that are attributable to discontinuing operations which were not included in the tax calculations. The fact that operations are conducted in countries with lower tax rates than the nominal Swedish tax rate and that the Group will continue to receive tax-exempted revenue will result in the Group’s tax rate will continue to be lower than 25 percent.

RECONCILIATION OF EFFECTIVE TAX

 

      GROUP
(%)    2007    2006

Swedish income tax rate

   28    28

Difference between different countries’ tax rates

   -2    -1

Deficit for which tax-loss carryforwards have not been observed

   5    1

Utilization of previously non-capitalized deficits

   -3    —  

Capital gains

   -2    -4

Tax-exempt revenues

   -7    -5

Non-deductible expenses

   1    1

Earnings from associated companies

   -4    -1

Adjustments for preceding year

   3    —  

Other

   1    2

EFFECTIVE TAX RATE

   20    21

Of the Group’s total tax-loss carryforwards, which is approximately SEK 923 m, only SEK 317 m is considered in the calculation of deferred tax. The tax-loss carryforwards that are considered in the calculation of deferred tax are reported to the extent that it is probable that it will be utilized against future taxable surplus. It is not deemed possible for those tax-loss carryforwards not considered in the calculation to be utilized against in the foreseeable future since these loss carryforwards are attributable to countries in which the Group has limited revenues. The Parent Company’s accumulated tax-loss carryforwards have, despite the fiscal loss, reduced with SEK 176 m due to the Group contribution received in the amount of SEK 336 m.

DISTRIBUTION OF ACCUMULATED TAX-LOSS CARRYFORWARDS

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Sweden

   315    369

Other countries

   608    528

TOTAL

   923    897

TOTAL TAX-LOSS CARRYFORWARDS THAT CORRESPOND TO TAX ASSETS

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Sweden

   315    369

Other countries

   83    64

TOTAL

   398    433

The Group’s deferred tax assets attributable to Sweden are deemed to be consumed within the forthcoming two years. The largest portion of foreign loss carryforwards that correspond to tax assets should be utilized within the same time period. Deferred tax assets referring to restructuring will be utilized at the same rate as the utilization of restructuring provisions.

 

52


DEFERRED TAX ASSETS AND TAX LIABILITIES

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Deferred tax assets

     

Loss carryforwards

   108    115

Provisions for restructuring measures

   5    10

Total deferred tax assets

   113    125

Deferred tax liabilities

     

Untaxed reserves

   -56    -39

Other

   -20    —  

Total deferred tax liabilities

   -76    -39

DEFERRED TAX ASSETS, NET

   37    86

Losses in Swedish companies can be utilized for an unlimited amount of time. For foreign subsidiaries, the useful life of the loss is limited in certain cases. The minimum time period within which foreign losses can be utilized is 15 years. Of the losses that can be utilized for a limited amount of time (2017 - 2018), SEK 21 m are tax-loss carry-forwards that correspond to tax assets.

UTILIZATION OF TOTAL LOSSES AT YEAR-END

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Last utilization year

     

2017–2018

   90    128

Unlimited

   833    769

TOTAL

   923    897

UNTAXED RESERVES

Stockholmsbörsen AB signed a credit insurance related to clearing participants’ default. The insurance is intended to cover losses arising in clearing operations and which normally are covered solely by the company’s shareholders’ equity. The insurance has been signed by OMX’s wholly owned insurance company OMX Capital Insurance AG in Switzerland, which for part of the risk has secured reinsurance from Radian Asset Assurance Inc. in the US. OMX Capital Insurance AG has reserved funds in an insurance provision. At the Group level, the provision is distributed between unrestricted capital and deferred tax liabilities.

OTHER DEFERRED TAX LIABILITIES

In certain countries, subsidiaries’ earnings are taxed only following the decision on dividends. In order that Group shareholders can utilize profits from these countries, companies must pay tax. Deferred tax liability on these profits has been reported in the Group.

TAX ITEM REPORTED DIRECTLY AGAINST SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Deferred tax attributable to revaluation of financial instruments

   18    -7

Current tax in Group contribution received

      —  

TOTAL

   18    -7

ONGOING TAX DISPUTES

Ongoing current disputes, either individually or collectively, are not considered to pose any material threat to the Group’s business operations, its financial position or its earnings.

 

53


NOTE 12. OPERATIONAL LEASING

GROUP

OMX has no financial leasing commitments. Set out below are the operational leasing commitments of the Group.

LEASING FEES FOR THE PERIOD

 

(SEK m)    2007    2006

Equipment

   22    2

Computer operations

   59    57

Premises

   201    190

TOTAL

   282    249

CONTRACTED LEASING FEES

 

(SEK m)    2008    2009    2010    2011    2012    2013–18

Equipment

   4    5    2    —      —      —  

Computer operations

   34    25    9    —      —      —  

Premises

   190    186    167    167    167    774

of which, premises sublet

   23    24    20    21    21    46

of which, provisions made

   16    11    7    6    5    9

TOTAL

   228    216    178    167    167    774

In September 2007, an agreement was signed for the outsourcing with Verizon Business, which pertains to services for the operation of external network and computer center. The agreement extends for seven years. The total contract amount is approximately SEK 600 m for the entire agreement period.

NOTE 13. INTANGIBLE ASSETS

 

GROUP, (SEK m)    Goodwill    Capitalized
expenditure
for deve-
lopment
   Other
intangible
assets

Acquisition cost brought forward, Jan 1, 2006

   2,960    1,059    640

Assets acquired through acquisitions

   335    —      244

Assets acquired during the year

   —      185    26

Reclassifications

   —      112    -94

Exchange-rate differences

   -120    —      -10

Acquisition cost carried forward, Dec 31, 2006

   3,175    1,356    806

Amortization brought forward, Jan 1, 2006

   —      456    110

Amortization for the year

   —      51    78

Amortization carried forward, Dec 31, 2006

   —      507    188

Impairment brought forward, Jan 1, 2006

   5    194    7

 

54


Change for the year

   —      21 1)   4

Impairment carried forward, Dec 31, 2006

   5    215     11

CARRYING AMOUNT, DEC 31, 2006

   3,170    634     607

Of which assets held for sale

   31    —       31

Acquisition cost brought forward, Jan 1, 2007

   3,175    1,356     806

Assets acquired through acquisitions

   47    —       30

Assets acquired during the year

   —      363     87

Divestments during the year

   -15    —       —  

Reclassifications

   —      8     —  

Exchange-rate differences

   117    3     9

Acquisition cost carried forward, Dec 31, 2007

   3,324    1,730     932

Amortization brought forward, Jan 1, 2007

   —      507     188

Amortization for the year

   —      108     66

Amortization carried forward, Dec 31, 2007

   —      615     254

Impairment brought forward, Jan 1, 2007

   5    215     11

Impairment for the year

   —      —       4

Impairment carried forward, Dec 31, 2007

   5    215     15

CARRYING AMOUNT, DEC 31, 2007

   3,319    900     663

Of which assets held for sale

   15    —       28

 

1)

SEK 20 m relates to the impairment of intangible assets that took place in conjunction with the sale of shares in VPC AB.

TOTAL INTANGIBLE ASSETS, USEFUL LIFE

 

(SEK m)    Acquisition cost     Carrying amount

Development in progress

   570     529

3 years

   59     26

5 years

   1 157     349

10 years

   429     269

20 years

   435     390

TOTAL

   2,650  1)   1,563

 

1)

Excluding exchange-rate differences of SEK 12 m.

The useful life for intangible assets in the Parent Company is five years.

Development in progress relates to various components in the marketplace system. Their values are reviewed continuously and amortization is initiated when the respective component has been completed. Of the carrying amount per December 31, 2007, SEK 43 m refers to the Banks & Brokers operation which is being discontinued.

Assets with a useful life of ten years mainly consist of the product EXIGO CSD, which is a central system in OMX’s systems platform.

Assets with a useful life of 20 years comprise surplus values in customer contracts attributable to the acquisition of CSE and EV.

The testing of the value of all intangible assets takes place on an ongoing basis throughout the year by using a risk-adjusted discounted cash flow. This review is based on assumptions and assessments, which entail a certain degree of uncertainty. OMX’s WACC has been utilized as the discount factor, which is 10 percent for the Technology operations and 9 percent for the Exchange operations. The lifetime is assumed to be the same as the amortization period.

 

55


During 2007, impairment of SEK 4 m was recognized since it was not possible to justify the carrying amount of these assets with the value of the future cash flow and that the carrying amount exceeded fair value. The cost has been booked as an impairment in the income statement.

CAPITALIZED EXPENDITURE FOR RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT

This item relates to OMX’s systems solutions. The major components are the new development of OMX’s platform for future systems solutions – GENIUM, a new system for settlement, registration and custody of securities – EXIGO CSD, the next generation of CLICKTM – CLICK XT, a systems solution for banks and brokerage firms – STP, and a systems platform for energy trading – CONDICOTM.

OTHER INTANGIBLE ASSETS

GROUP

 

(SEK m)    2007    2006

Software

   151    102

Licenses

   10    8

Surpluses in acquired customer contracts

   417    405

Other

   85    92

TOTAL

   663    607

GOODWILL

Goodwill is divided between the Group’s cash-generating units, primarily within the Nordic Marketplaces business area:

 

(SEK m)    2007    2006

Nordic Marketplaces

     

Stockholm Stock Exchange

   590    590

Helsinki Stock Exchange

   1,362    1,304

Copenhagen Stock Exchange

   925    876

Iceland Stock Exchange

   138    130

Total Nordic Marketplaces

   3,015    2,900

Information Services & New Markets

     

Findata, Libra

   59    14

Other exchanges

   15    14

Market Technology

     

Computershare

   184    180

Other

   46    62

Total Market Technology

   230    242

Total

   3,319    3,170

An impairment test of goodwill was performed at the end of 2007. It is necessary to make a number of assessments and assumptions that entail a certain degree of uncertainty for this test.

The value in use of goodwill attributable to exchange operations was calculated based on the discounted eternal cash flow with a growth rate of 0 percent and a discount rate of 9 percent which corresponds to the company’s WACC for the Exchange operations.

The perpetual useful life was applied against the background of the company’s long history of a stable and strong cash flow. The acquisitions are of great strategic importance to OMX. A larger market and increased liquidity were achieved through these acquisitions. Cost-efficiency, and thereby competitiveness are increased by integrating the technical infrastructure. OMX’s technology operations also benefit from the large home market that was created. A growth rate of 0 percent based on expected outcome for 2007 was applied by way of prudence due to the difficulty in assessing the market of the exchange operations. The value in use was calculated at a discount rate (WACC) of 10 percent corresponding to the company’s average cost of capital for the Technology operations. No impairment requirements were identified.

 

56


A sensitivity analysis in which the discount rate was increased by 10 percent and the cash flow was decreased by 10 percent did not give rise to any further impairment requirements.

NOTE 14. TANGIBLE FIXED ASSETS

 

     GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Equipment

     

Acquisition cost brought forward

   1,088    1,091

Assets acquired through acquisitions

   —      1

Acquisitions for the year

   66    77

Disposals

   -38    -36

Sales

   -8    -23

Reclassifications

   -3    —  

Exchange-rate differences

   2    -22

Acquisition cost carried forward

   1,107    1,088

Depreciation brought forward

   737    711

Depreciation for the year

   88    87

Disposals

   -35    -28

Sales

   -1    -15

Exchange-rate differences

   —      -18

Depreciation carried forward

   789    737

Impairment brought forward

   22    18

Impairment for the year

   4    4

Impairment carried forward

   26    22

CARRYING AMOUNT

   292    329

Of which assets held for sale

   4    8

The useful life for computers amounts to three years, for leasehold improvements to ten years and for other equipment to five years.

 

57


NOTE 15. OTHER SECURITIES INVESTMENTS HELD AS FIXED ASSETS

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Financial assets available for sale

     

Shares and participations

   505    363

Total

   505    363
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Acquisition cost brought forward

   363    56

Acquisitions during the year

   12    363

Divestments during the year

   —      -56

Revaluation of shareholders’ equity

   120    —  

Reclassification

   10    —  

ACQUISITION COST CARRIED FORWARD

   505    363

 

58


NOTE 16. FINANCIAL ASSETS AND LIABILITIES

The tables below show the Group’s and the Parent Company’s financial assets and liabilities. For a description of OMX’s risk management regarding the items reported, refer to the Risk Management section.

 

     

CARRYING AMOUNT IN THE
BALANCE SHEET,3)

December 31, 2007

GROUP    Accrued
acquisition
cost
   Fair value
recognized
in income
statement
   Fair value
recognized in
shareholders’
equity

OTHER INVESTMENTS HELD AS FIXED ASSETS

        

Financial assets available for sale

        

- Other financial assets available for sale

   —      —      505

OTHER LONG-TERM RECEIVABLES

        

Financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement (first occasion)

        

- Fixed-income derivatives to which hedge accounting at fair value is applied

   —      0    —  

- Equity derivatives valued at fair value

   —      2    —  

Loan receivables and accounts receivable

        

- Other loan receivables and accounts receivable

   35    —      —  

Other2)

        

- Equity derivatives valued at fair value

   —      —      5

ACCOUNTS RECEIVABLE

        

Loan receivables and accounts receivable

        

- Other loan receivables and accounts receivable

   594    —      —  

MARKET VALUE OF OUTSTANDING DERIVATIVE POSITIONS

        

Loan receivables and accounts receivable

        

- Other loan receivables and accounts receivable

   3,404    —      —  

OTHER SHORT-TERM RECEIVABLES1)

        

Loan receivables and accounts receivable

        

- Other loan receivables and accounts receivable

   823    —      —  

Financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement (held for trading)

        

- Currency derivatives

   —      25    —  

SHORT-TERM INVESTMENTS

        

Financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement (held for trading)

        

- Other financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement

   —      607    —  

CASH EQUIVALENTS

        

Financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement (first occasion)

        

- Other financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement

   —      424    —  

Total financial assets

   4,856    1,058    510

 

59


 

     

CARRYING AMOUNT IN THE
BALANCE SHEET,3)

December 31, 2006

GROUP    Accrued
acquisition
cost
   Fair value
recognized
in income
statement
   Fair value
recognized in
shareholders’
equity

OTHER INVESTMENTS HELD AS FIXED ASSETS

        

Financial assets available for sale

        

- Other financial assets available for sale

   —      —      363

OTHER LONG-TERM RECEIVABLES

        

Financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement (first occasion)

        

- Fixed-income derivatives to which hedge accounting at fair value is applied

   —      3    —  

- Equity derivatives valued at fair value

   —      0    —  

Loan receivables and accounts receivable

        

- Other loan receivables and accounts receivable

   42    —      —  

Other2)

        

- Equity derivatives valued at fair value

   —      —      1

ACCOUNTS RECEIVABLE

        

Loan receivables and accounts receivable

        

- Other loan receivables and accounts receivable

   425    —      —  

MARKET VALUE OF OUTSTANDING DERIVATIVE POSITIONS

        

Loan receivables and accounts receivable

        

- Other loan receivables and accounts receivable

   4,401    —      —  

OTHER SHORT-TERM RECEIVABLES1)

        

Loan receivables and accounts receivable

        

- Other loan receivables and accounts receivable

   873    —      —  

Financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement (held for trading)

        

- Currency derivatives

   —      16    —  

SHORT-TERM INVESTMENTS

        

Financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement (held for trading)

        

- Other financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement

   —      518    —  

CASH EQUIVALENTS

        

Financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement (first occasion)

        

- Other financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement

   —      410    —  

Total financial assets

   5,741    947    364

 

60


 

     

CARRYING AMOUNT IN THE
BALANCE SHEET,3)

December 31, 2007

GROUP    Accrued
acquisition
cost
   Fair value
recognized
in income
statement
   Fair value
recognized in
shareholders’
equity

INTEREST-BEARING LONG-TERM LIABILITIES

        

Financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement (first occasion)

        

- Financial liabilities to which hedge accounting with fixed-income derivatives at fair value is applied

   —      0    —  

Financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

        

- Other financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

   858    —      —  

OTHER LONG-TERM LIABILITIES1)

        

Financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

        

- Other financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

   92    —      —  

-

        

LIABILITIES TO CREDIT INSTITUTIONS

        

Financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

        

- Other financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

   1,045    —      —  

ACCOUNTS PAYABLE

        

Financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

        

- Other financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

   172      

MARKET VALUE OF OUTSTANDING DERIVATIVE POSITIONS

        

Financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

        

- Other financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

   3,404    —      —  

OTHER SHORT-TERM LIABILITIES1)

        

Financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

        

- Other financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

   706    —      —  

Financial liabilities stated at fair value in the income statement (held for trading)

        

- Currency derivatives

   —      18    —  

Other2)

        

- Of which currency derivatives to which hedge accounting of cash flows is applied

   —      -8    —  

- Of which derivatives to which hedge accounting of net investments is applied

      0   

Total financial liabilities

   6,277    10    —  

 

61


 

     

CARRYING AMOUNT IN THE
BALANCE SHEET,3)

December 31, 2006

GROUP    Accrued
acquisition
cost
   Fair value
recognized
in income
statement
   Fair value
recognized in
shareholders’
equity

INTEREST-BEARING LONG-TERM LIABILITIES

        

Financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement (first occasion)

        

- Financial liabilities to which hedge accounting with fixed-income derivatives at fair value is applied

   —      2    —  

Financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

        

- Other financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

   1,358    —      —  

OTHER LONG-TERM LIABILITIES1)

        

Financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

        

- Other financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

   108    —      —  

-

        

LIABILITIES TO CREDIT INSTITUTIONS

        

Financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

        

- Other financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

   398    —      —  

ACCOUNTS PAYABLE

        

Financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

        

- Other financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

   109      

MARKET VALUE OF OUTSTANDING DERIVATIVE POSITIONS

        

Financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

        

- Other financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

   4,401    —      —  

OTHER SHORT-TERM LIABILITIES1)

        

Financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

        

- Other financial liabilities valued at accrued acquisition cost

   822    —      —  

Financial liabilities stated at fair value in the income statement (held for trading)

        

- Currency derivatives

   —      5    —  

Other2)

        

- Of which currency derivatives to which hedge accounting of cash flows is applied

   —      17    —  

- Of which derivatives to which hedge accounting of net investments is applied

      0    —  

Total financial liabilities

   7,196    24    —  

 

1)

The balance sheet also includes items that are not classified as financial instruments under IFRS 7.

 

2)

Derivatives that meet the criteria for hedge accounting and for which fair value is recognized in shareholders’ equity up to the point of realization. The products do not fall under any category established by IFRS 7.

 

3)

The carrying amount in the balance sheet concurs with the fair value.

 

62


NOTE 17. OTHER LONG-TERM RECEIVABLES

 

    

2007

Carrying
amount

  

2006

Carrying
amount

GROUP

(SEK m)

     

Other deposits

   8    17

Long-term project receivables

   —      —  

Hedge employee stock options

   8    —  

Other long-term receivables

   26    23

TOTAL

   42    40

The fair value of other long-term receivables corresponds to the carrying amounts above.

NOTE 18. MARKET VALUE, OUTSTANDING DERIVATIVE POSITIONS

Through its clearing operations in the derivative markets, Nordic Marketplaces is the formal counterparty in all derivative positions traded via the exchanges. However, the exchanges do not utilize the derivatives for purpose of conducting

 

63


their own trading, instead these derivatives are to be seen as a method of documenting the counterparty guarantees established in the clearing operations. Counterparty risks are measured by models that have been agreed upon with the financial supervisory authority in the respective countries. The risk situation associated with the divestment of positions remains unchanged compared with prior years. Collateral for the divestment of outstanding derivative instruments is provided as previously. According to IAS 39/32, the market value of the above-mentioned derivative positions is reported in the balance sheet.

Receivables and liabilities attributable to outstanding derivative positions have been netted to the extent that such a legal offset right exists and, at the same time, that it is OMX’s intention to settle these items. The market value as per December 31, 2007 was SEK 3,404 m (4,401), which almost exclusively refers to the Stockholm Stock Exchange’s derivative positions.

NOTE 19. OTHER RECEIVABLES

 

     GROUP
(SEK m)    2007     2006

Current account assets

   628     748

Other non-interest-bearing receivables

   162  1)   139

Other interest-bearing receivables

   29     1

TOTAL

   819     888

 

1)

Costs have arisen in OMX in conjunction with the ongoing work regarding the combination with NASDAQ that will be reimbursed by NASDAQ, of which SEK 97 m are reported in the Group and SEK 80 m are reported in the Parent Company.

NOTE 20. PREPAID EXPENSES AND ACCRUED INCOME

 

     GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Premises, rent

   57    34

Systems sales, facility management1)

   209    216

Information sales

   44    86

Transaction revenue

   12    25

Licenses

   16    11

IT

   6    —  

Insurance

   6    14

Unrealized exchange-rate gains

   27    23

Other

   17    9

TOTAL

   394    418

 

1)

The item includes project revenue reported in accordance with the percentage- of-completion ­principle.

NOTE 21. FINANCIAL ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR SALE

 

     GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Government securities

   607    518

TOTAL

   607    518

The fair values of the above items correspond to the carrying amounts.

NOTE 22. SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

The number of shares in 2007 amounted to 120,640,467, with a ratio value of SEK 2 with one vote per share. Consolidated shareholders’ equity amounted to SEK 42 (38) per share.

 

64


ASSOCIATED COMPANIES

Income that is not paid out as a dividend in associated companies is recorded in the Group’s shareholders’ equity among profit/loss brought forward. The application of the equity method of accounting for associated companies means that the value of shareholders’ equity in the Group is reported at SEK 110 m (76) higher than if the cost method had been used.

SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY, GROUP

 

(SEK m)    2007    2006

Share capital

   241    241

Other contributed funds

   3,536    3,536

Other reserves

     

Fair value reserve

   120    —  

Hedging reserve

   —      -18

Translation reserve

   47    -85

Profit/loss brought forward

   169    16

Net income for the year

   979    907

Minority interests

   25    17

TOTAL SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

   5,117    4,614

OTHER RESERVES, GROUP

 

(SEK m)    Fair
value
reserve
   Hedging
reserv
   Translation
reserve
   Total

Opening balance, 2006

   12    —      88    100

Cash-flow hedging

           

Gain/loss to shareholders’ equity

   —      -9    —      -9

Transferred to income statement

   —      -9    —      -9

Exchange-rate differences

           

Hedging of equity

   —      —      25    25

Translation differences

   —      —      -198    -198

Financial assets available for sale

           

Transferred to income statement

   -12    —      —      -12

Opening balance, 2007

   —      -18    -85    -103

Cash-flow hedging

           

Gain/loss to shareholders’ equity

   —      8    —      8

Transferred to income statement

   —      10    —      10

Exchange-rate differences

           

Hedging of equity

   —      —      -46    -46

Translation differences

   —      —      178    178

Financial assets available for sale

           

Gain/loss to shareholders’ equity

   120    —      —      120

Closing balance 2007

   120    —      47    167

Items are reported net after tax.

FAIR VALUE RESERVE

The fair value reserve includes the accumulated net change in fair value of financial assets available for sale until the asset is eliminated from the balance sheet.

HEDGING RESERVE

The hedging reserve includes the change in value of cash-flow hedges. The change in value is re-entered in the income statement in line with the hedged cash flow impacting the income statement.

 

65


TRANSLATION RESERVE

The translation reserve includes all exchange-rate differences arising in conjunction with the translation of financial statements from foreign operations that have prepared their financial statements in a currency other than the currency in which the consolidated financial statements are presented. The Parent Company and Group present their financial statements in Swedish kronor (SEK). The translation reserve also comprises exchange-rate differences arising in conjunction with the translation of liabilities reported as hedging instruments of a net investment in a foreign operation.

NOTE 23. LONG-TERM LIABILITIES

This Note contains information on the Group’s and Parent Company’s long-term liabilities. For information regarding dates of maturity for the long term liabilities, and for information regarding the Group’s exposure to interest rate risks and risks of exchange-rate fluctuations, refer to the section entitled Risk Management on page 19.

For information regarding the reporting of employee stock options, refer to the section entitled Accounting Principles.

DIVISION OF LONG-TERM LIABILITIES

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Interest-bearing long-term liabilities

     

Bond loans (interest-bearing)

   858    1,360

Other long-term liabilities

     

Liabilities, employee stock options

   12    15

Liabilities Computershare

   79    97

Rent deposit

   10    9

Other

   3    2

TOTAL

   962    1,483

NOTE 24. PROVISIONS

OTHER PROVISIONS

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Opening balance

   79    128

Reclassifications

   —      —  

Provisions made during the period

   5    —  

Utilized reserves

   -25    -44

Exchange-rate effects

   -2    -5

TOTAL

   57    79

The opening balance comprises the provisions for expenses for unutilized premises of SEK 79 m. The provision for premises was utilized in the amount of SEK 27 m including exchange-rate effects.

 

66


The provision for expenses for unutilized premises is based on management’s assumptions and assessments and is associated with a certain degree of uncertainty. These expenses refer primarily to OMX’s offices in London and New York. The provision was established in 2004 as a result of the reduction in personnel associated with the focus on cost-savings and efficiency-enhancement measures in the operations with which OMX has worked in recent years, and a decline in market conditions for the lease of premises, leading to certain areas being leased at a lower rent than OMX’s lease conditions. See Note 12 regarding the cash-flow dates. For leasing contracts invoicing sub-lets, a reserve has been established for known losses for five years in the future. The leasing contract will expire during the period 2009–2015.

RESTRICTED RESERVE, CSE

The total amount of provisions presented below also includes a reserve attributable to the operations in the Copenhagen Stock Exchange, CSE. This reserve may not be distributed and may only be used to cover losses in CSE in accordance with the Danish Security Trading Act. The reserve amounts to SEK 68 m as per December 31, 2007 and is classified in its entirety as long term.

TOTAL PROVISIONS

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Long-term portion

   100    121

Short-term portion

   25    24

TOTAL

   125    145

NOTE 25. OTHER LIABILITIES

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Current account liabilities

   550    650

Other non-interest-bearing liabilities

   112    148

Other interest-bearing liabilities

   28    38

TOTAL

   690    836

NOTE 26. ACCRUED EXPENSES AND DEFERRED INCOME

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Personnel expenses

   235    187

Delivery costs

   28    —  

Systems sales1)

   8    8

Support revenue

   30    26

Facility Management1)

   17    15

Trading revenue

   4    10

Issuers’ revenue2)

   58    60

Commission revenue

   31    22

License revenue

   11    —  

Other deferred income

   12    27

Unrealized exchange-rate losses

   19    13

Accrued interest

   41    30

Other

   89    75

TOTAL

   583    473

 

1)

Customer invoicing terms for projects are usually set within a contract and it is not uncommon that payments do not correspond to work carried out at a given time. Work that has been invoiced, but not yet carried out, is treated as a liability to the customer. During the period when the work to which the invoice relates is carried out, this liability is re-booked as revenue.

 

2)

Relates to listing fees paid by companies listed on the exchanges within OMX’s exchanges. These fees are paid quarterly in advance and are based on the average market capitalization of a company over the preceding 12-month period.

 

67


NOTE 27. OTHER INTEREST-BEARING AND NON-INTEREST-BEARING RECEIVABLES AND LIABILITIES

This note contains information on the classification between interest-bearing and non-interest-bearing items in the balance sheet. For infomation regarding dates of maturity, fixed-interest periods and the average weighted interest of interest-bearing items, refer to the section entitled Risk Management on page 19.

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    Interest-
bearing
   Non-interest-bearing    Total

Financial fixed assets

   21    778    799

Current receivables

   29    5,203    5,232

Short-term investments

   607    —      607

Cash equivalents

   424    —      424

Long-term liabilities

   858    280    1,138

Short-term liabilities

   1,073    4,908    5,981

RECEIVABLES AND LIABILITIES, NET

   -850    793    -57

NOTE 28. COLLATERAL RECEIVED BY OMX’S EXCHANGE OPERATIONS

Through its clearing operations, OMX Nordic Exchange Stockholm is a counterparty in every options and futures contract and thereby guarantees the fulfillment of each contract. Customers, who through an options or futures contract, assume an obligation to OMX Nordic Exchange Stockholm, must pledge collateral for the obligation according to special rules for this.

 

GROUP

(SEK m)

   2007    2006

OMX Nordic Exchange Stockholm

   15,886    15,458

TOTAL

   15,886    15,458

NOTE 29. PLEDGED COLLATERAL

 

GROUP

(SEK m)

   2007    2006      

OMX Technology Pty Ltd

   3    3    Lease deposit

OMX Technology Ltd (Hong-Kong)

   0    0    Lease deposit

HEX Securities Services Ltd OY 1)

   33    32    Liquidity guarantee

Other

   1    —      Other

TOTAL

   37    35   

 

1)

Relates to pledged collateral for the right to act as the Swedish equivalent of the account-handling institution.

NOTE 30. CONTINGENT LIABILITIES

 

GROUP

(SEK m)

   2007    2006

Guarantees issued for clearing operations (OMX AB)1)

   2,878    3,020

Other guarantees (OMX AB)2)

   187    174

Total

   3,065    3,194

 

1)

Through its clearing operations, OMX AB’s exchange operations act as a counterparty in each transaction and thereby guarantees the fulfillment of each contract. OMX’s exchange operations are to pledge collateral for commitments with other clearing houses. The amount of these commitments is calculated on the gross exposure between the clearing houses. As collateral for these obligations, the operations have obtained bank guarantees, which are guaranteed by OMX AB through counterparty agreements.

 

68


2)

Primarily obligations for leasing contracts and in conjunction with the systems sales in Market Technology. In addition to the items above, there are general Parent Company guarantees for wholly owned subsidiaries of OMX AB.

OMX is party to a number of cases and disputes for which no provisions have been established since it is the opinion of management that all cases will be found in favor of OMX. There is a certain degree of uncertainty associated with this opinion.

NOTE 31. EARNINGS PER SHARE

CHANGE IN NUMBER OF SHARES

No change in the number of shares took place in 2007.

 

      2007    2006

Outstanding shares at beginning of the period

   120,640,467    118,474,307

New share issue

   —      2,166,160

Outstanding shares at the end of the period

   120,640,467    120,640,467

EARNINGS PER SHARE

Earnings per share are based on net income/loss for the year attributable to the ­Parent Company’s owners:

 

      2007    2006

Net income/loss for the year, SEK m, attributable to the shareholders in OMX AB

   979    907

Average number of shares outstanding

   120,640,467    118,671,254

EARNINGS PER SHARE, SEK

   8.12    7.64

Of which attributable to continuing operations

   8.64    8.03

Of which attributable to discontinued operations

   -0.52    -0.39

EARNINGS PER SHARE AFTER DILUTION

Earnings per share are based on net income/loss for the year attributable to the ­Parent Company’s owners:

 

      2007    2006

Net income/loss for the year, SEK m, attributable to the shareholders in OMX AB

   979    907

Average number of shares after dilution and with full utilization of options1)

   120,640,467    118,885,754

EARNINGS PER SHARE, SEK2)

   8.12    7.64

 

1)

No dilution of shares took place in 2007.

 

2)

Earnings per share after dilution corresponds to earnings per share before dilution since it has not been deemed probable that the warrants will be utilized due to the fact that the issue price was higher than the share price in 2005 and 2006.

NOTE 32. CASH FLOW

CASH EQUIVALENTS

The following sub-components are included in cash equivalents:*

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Cash and bank balances

   180    257

Short-term investments

   851    671

Total cash equivalents

   1,031    928

Short-term investments with

     

terms of > 3 months

   -607    -518

Total according to balance sheet

   424    410

 

69


Financial assets available for sale are short-term investments that comprise discounting instruments, bonds and securities issued by the government, local authority, a Swedish limited liability bank company and a Swedish housing finance institution. All short-term investments entail an insignificant risk of fluctuations in value and can readily be converted to cash funds. However, only those investments with a maximum terms of three months are included in the item “Cash equivalents” in the balance sheet and in the cash-flow statement. Other short-term investments are reported as “Cash flow from investing activities.”

Cash equivalents that were not available to the Group amounted to SEK 221 m at the end of the period. Funds dedicated for operations under supervision amount to SEK 685 m, of which SEK 607 m is reported as short-term investments and is included in cash flow from investing activities.

FINANCIAL ITEMS

The following financial items reported in the income statement affect the cash flow:

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Financial revenue

     

Interest

   63    42

Dividends

   17    —  

Change in financial assets/liabilities

     

- valued at fair value in the income statement

   15    7

- derivative contracts intended to protect subsidiaries’ shareholders’ equity

   —      —  

Total revenue

   95    49

Interest expenses and similar profit/loss items

     

Interest

   -113    -95

Change in financial assets/liabilities

     

- valued at fair value in the income statement

   -16    -11

- valued at fair value in the income statement

   -1    —  

- derivative contracts intended to protect subsidiaries’ shareholders’ equity

   —      —  

Other

   -27    -5

Total expenses

   -157    -111

TOTAL

   -62    -62

CASH FLOW FROM ACQUISITIONS AND DIVESTMENTS OF GROUP

COMPANIES

Cash flow from acquisitions

In 2007, Findata AB and the shares in the former associated company Näringslivskredit AB were acquired. In 2006, Eignarhaldsfelagid Verdbrefathing (EV) was acquired. The cash flow from the acquisition of Findata AB is described in the table below:

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Intangible assets

   73    275

Tangible fixed assets

   —      1

Financial fixed assets

   —      8

Receivables

   3    19

Cash equivalents

   1    33

Long-term liabilities

   —      —  

 

70


Current liabilities

   -3    -22

Minority interests

   —      —  

Total purchase price

   74    314

Total purchase price paid

   -74    -314

Less earlier holding in acquired company

   —      —  

Less payment with treasury shares

   —      256

Purchase price paid

   -74    -58

Cash equivalents in acquired Group company

   1    33

TOTAL CASH FLOW FROM ACQUISITIONS

   -73    -25

Acquisition costs affecting cash flow in the forthcoming year

   22    6

TOTAL CASH FLOW FROM ACQUISITIONS

     

DURING THE FISCAL YEAR

   -51    -19

The cash-flow effect of the increased shareholdings in Näringslivskredit AB amounted to SEK 106 m. The positive effect is attributable to the company’s cash and bank balance being consolidated in the Group from December. The purchase price paid amounted to SEK 375,000.

In 2007, additional costs from the acquisition of Eignarhaldsfelagid Verdbrefathing (EV) arose and impacted cash flow from investments negatively in the amount of ­ SEK 5 m.

Cash flow from divestments

During 2007, Lawshare, a unit under discontinuing operations, was divested. The cash flow from the divestment is described in the table below:

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2007    2006

Intangible assets

   15    —  

Tangible fixed assets

   3    —  

Receivables

   179    —  

Long-term liabilities

   —      —  

Current liabilities

   -169    —  

Total purchase price

   28    —  

Capital gains/losses

   3    —  

Total of purchase price received

   31    —  

Cash equivalents in divested Group companies

   -5    —  

Purchase price not yet paid

   31    —  

CASH FLOW FROM DIVESTMENTS

   -5    —  

ITEMS NOT AFFECTING CASH FLOW

Changes in the company’s asset structure related to acquisition are accounted for in the tables above “Cash flow from acquisitions” and “Cash flow from divestments.” Other transactions related to investment and financing operations that do not give rise to payments, despite the fact that they impact the company’s capital and asset structure, encompass depreciation/amortization and impairment, utilization of reserves, share in earnings of associated companies and capital gains/losses.

LIQUIDITY AND FINANCING

Interest-bearing net liabilities amounted to SEK 850 m (847) at the end of the reporting period. OMX’s interest-bearing financial assets totaled SEK 1,081 m (950), of which SEK 20 m (21) represented financial fixed assets.

Interest-bearing financial liabilities totaled SEK 1,931 m (1,797), of which SEK 858 m (1,360) was long-term.

Granted credit facilities amounted to SEK 3,684 m (3,741), of which SEK 82 m (30)was utilized. Of the granted credit facilities, SEK 1,468 m (1,335) refers to clearing operations. Cash equivalents equaled SEK 424 m (410) and consisted of short-term investments and cash and bank balances. Investments with lifetimes shorter than three months are included in the item “Cash equivalents”, since these securities are exposed to an insignificant level of risk and can be readily turned into cash.

 

71


NOTE 33. INFORMATION REGARDING THE PARENT COMPANY

OMX AB (publ) is a limited liability company registered in Sweden, with its registered office in Stockholm. The Parent Company’s shares are listed on the stock exchanges in Stockholm, Helsinki, Copenhagen and Iceland. The address of the headquarters is: OMX AB, SE-105 78 Stockholm, Sweden.

The consolidated accounts for 2007 comprise the Parent Company and its subsidiaries, referred to collectively as the Group. The Group also includes shareholdings in associated companies.

NOTE 34. SIGNIFICANT EVENTS AFTER THE END OF THE REPORTING PERIOD

CHANGE IN OWNERSHIP

On February 15, 2008, Borse Dubai announced that acceptance corresponding to approximately 68.6 percent of the total number of shares and votes in OMX had been provided for Borse Dubai’s public offer for OMX, which together with Borse Dubai’s earlier holdings in OMX and options agreements corresponds to approximately 97.6 percent of the total number of shares and votes in OMX. In light of this, Borse Dubai announced that the conditions of the offer had been satisfied, that Borse Dubai is to complete the offer, and that the acceptance period would be extended to make it possible for the shareholders who have not yet accepted the offer to tender their shares in OMX. According to Borse Dubai, the subsequent transactions with NASDAQ will take place as soon as possible following settlement of the shares tendered, provided the remaining terms and conditions for such transaction are satisfied or waived at such time.

 

72

Exhibit 99.4

Exhibit 99.4

OMX AB

INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

      Page

Report of Independent Auditor

   1

Consolidated Income Statements for the years ended December 31, 2006 and 2005

   2

Consolidated Balance Sheets at December 31, 2006 and 2005

   3

Changes in Consolidated Shareholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2006 and 2005

   5

Consolidated Cash Flow Statements for the years ended December 31, 2006 and 2005

   6

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

   22


Report of Independent Auditor

To the Shareholders in OMX AB

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of OMX AB and its subsidiaries as of December 31, 2006 and December 31, 2005 and the related consolidated statements of income, shareholders’ equity and cash flows for the years then ended. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with auditing standards generally accepted in the United States of America. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of OMX AB and its subsidiaries at December 31 2006 and December 31, 2005 and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the two years ended December 31, 2006 and December 31, 2005, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.

As discussed in the Accounting Principles to the consolidated financial statements, with effect from January 1, 2005, the Company prospectively adopted IAS 39, “Financial Instruments” and in 2006, the company adopted prospectively IAS 39 amendment “Cashflow hedge accounting of Forecast Intra group Transactions”.

August 6, 2007

PricewaterhouseCoopers AB

Stockholm Sweden


OMX AB

CONSOLIDATED INCOME STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2006 AND 2005

 

(in millions of SEK)

   Note    2006     2005  

Continuing operations(1)

       

Revenues

   2, 3     

Net sales

      3,313     2,969  

Own work capitalized

      68     125  

Other revenues

      105     —    
               

Total revenues, etc

      3,486     3,094  
               

Expenses

       

Premises expenses

   12    (204 )   (189 )

Marketing expenses

      (63 )   (40 )

Consultancy expenses

   6    (310 )   (253 )

Operations and maintenance, IT

   12    (239 )   (225 )

Other external expenses

   6    (167 )   (201 )

Personnel expenses

   7    (1,083 )   (1,049 )

Depreciation, amortization and impairment

   13,14    (216 )   (225 )
               

Total expenses

      (2,282 )   (2,182 )
               

Participation in earnings of associated companies

   10    46     15  

Operating income

   3    1,250     927  

Financial items

   9     

Financial revenues

      48     48  

Financial expenses

      (101 )   (112 )
               

Total financial items

      (53 )   (64 )
               

Income/loss after financial items

      1,197     863  

Tax for the year

   11    (240 )   (303 )
               

Net profit/loss for the period, continuing operations

      957     560  
               

Discontinuing operations ( 1)

       

Net profit/loss for the period, discontinuing operations

      (46 )   (17 )
               

Net profit/loss for the period

      911     543  
               

of which, attributable to shareholders of OMX AB

      907     538  

of which, attributable to minority interests

      4     5  

Average number of shares, millions

      118.671     118.108  

Number of shares, millions

      120.640     118.474  

Average number of shares after dilution, millions

      118.886     118.394  

Number of shares after dilution, millions

      120.640     118.760  

Continuing operations

       

Earnings per share, SEK(2)

   32    8.03     4.70  

Earnings per share after dilution, SEK( 2)

   32    8.03     4.70  

Discontinuing operations

       

Earnings per share, SEK(2)

   32    (0.39 )   (0.14 )

Earnings per share after dilution, SEK( 2)

   32    (0.39 )   (0.14 )

OMX Total

       

Earnings per share, SEK(2)

   32    7.64     4.56  

Earnings per share after dilution, SEK( 2)

   32    7.64     4.56  

Dividend per share, SEK

      6.50     6.50  

 

1)

The income statements for discontinuing operations has been adjusted compared with the 2006 and 2005 Annual reports as a result of organizational changes which led to certain parts of the business being retained.

 

2)

Earnings per share are calculated on the basis of the weighted average number of shares during the year. The amount is based on OMX AB shareholders’ portion of net profit/loss for the period.

 

2


CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

 

(SEK m)    Note    December 31, 2006    December 31, 2005

ASSETS

        

Fixed assets

        

Intangible assets

   13      

Goodwill

      3,140    2,925

Capitalized expenditure for R&D

      523    409

Other intangible assets

      687    498

Tangible fixed assets

   14      

Equipment

      321    355

Financial fixed assets

   28      

Participations in associated companies

   10    186    623

Other investments held as fixed assets

   15    363    56

Deferred tax assets

   11    125    237

Receivables from associated companies

   8    6    15

Other long-term receivables

   16, 27    40    163

Total fixed assets

      5,391    5,281

Current assets

        

Short-term receivables

   28      

Accounts receivable-trade

   18, 27    425    367

Market value, outstanding derivative positions

   17    4,401    2,312

Receivables from associated companies

   8    1    39

Tax receivables

   11, 27    6    37

Other receivables

   19, 27    888    684

Prepaid expenses and accrued income

   20, 27    418    587

Financial assets available for sale

   21, 28    519    328

Cash equivalents

   33, 28    409    915

Assets held for sale1)

   4, 27    70    62

Total current assets

        7,137    5,331

TOTAL ASSETS

      12,528    10,612

 

1)

Assets held for sale has been adjusted compared with the 2006 and 2005 Annual Reports as a result of organizational changes which led to certain parts of the discontinuing operations being retained.

 

3


(SEK m)    Note    December 31, 2006    December 31, 2005

SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY AND LIABILITIES

        

Shareholders’ equity

   22      

Share capital (120,640,467 shares, ratio value SEK 2)

      241    237

Other capital contributions

      3,536    3,271

Reserves

      -103    100

Profit brought forward

        923    1,127

Equity attributable to shareholders in Parent Company

      4,597    4,735

Minority interest

        17    14

Total shareholders’ equity

      4,614    4,749

Long-term liabilities

   28      

Interest-bearing long-term liabilities

   23    1,360    1,409

Deferred tax liability

   11    39    26

Other long-term liabilities

   23,27    123    19

Provisions

   24,27    121    154

Total long-term liabilities

      1,643    1,608

Short-term liabilities

   28      

Liabilities to credit institutions

   27    398    498

Accounts payable – trade

   27    109    137

Tax liabilities

   11,27    30    20

Market value, outstanding derivative positions

   17    4,401    2,312

Other liabilities

   25,27    836    701

Accrued expenses and deferred income

   26,27    473    546

Provisions

   24,27    24    41

Total short-term liabilities

        6,271    4,255

TOTAL SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY AND LIABILITIES

      12,528    10,612

For information on the Group’s pledged assets and contingent liabilities, see Notes 29, 30 and 31.

 

4


CHANGES IN CONSOLIDATED SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY, SEE NOTE 22

 

          Attributable to shareholders in the Parent Company          
(SEK m)    Note    Share
capital
  

Other

capital
contributions

   Reserves    Profit/loss
brought
forward
   Minority
interest
   Total
shareholders
equity

OPENING BALANCE, JANUARY 1, 2005

      231    3,045    -37    590    30    3,859

New share issue, net after transaction costs of SEK 0

      6    226             232

Minority interest

                  -23    -23

Translation differences

            125          125

Financial assets available for sale;

                    

Revaluations reported directly against shareholders’ equity

            20          20

Tax attributable to items reported directly against shareholders’ equity

   11          -8          -8

Change in associated companies’ shareholders’ equity

               -6       -6

Profit for 2005

                       543    7    550

OPENING BALANCE, JANUARY 1, 2006

      237    3,271    100    1,127    14    4,749

New share issue, net after transaction costs of SEK 0

      4    265             269

Minority interest

                  -1    -1

Dividend to shareholders

               -1,120       -1,120

Equity swap for Share Match Program

               -8       -8

Share Match Program

               2       2

Cash-flow hedging

                    

Gain/loss attributable to shareholders’ equity

            -9          -9

Carried forward/transferred to income

            -9          -9

Exchange-rate differences

                    

Hedging of shareholders’ equity

            25          25

Translation differences

            -198          -198

Financial assets available for sale

                    

Carried forward/transferred to income

            -12          -12

Change in associated companies’ shareholders’ equity

               15       15

Profit for 2006

                       907    4    911

CLOSING BALANCE, DECEMBER 31, 2006

      241    3,536    -103    923    17    4,614

 

5


OMX AB

CONSOLIDATED CASH FLOW STATEMENTS

FOR THE YEARS ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2006 AND 2005

 

(in millions of SEK)

   Note    Year Ended December 31,  
      2006     2005  

Operating activities

       

Continuing operations

       

Net profit/loss for the period

      957     560  

Adjustments for items not included in cash flow

       

Depreciation/amortization

   13,14    208     215  

Impairment

   13,14    8     10  

Utilization of provisions

   24    (41 )   (144 )

Participations in earnings of associated companies

   10    (46 )   (14 )

Capital gain

      (109 )   —    

Financial items

       (2 )   8  

Income tax paid

       158     190  

Other adjustments

      (93 )   (1 )
               

Total cash flow from operating activities before
changes in working capital

      1,040     824  
               

Changes in working capital

       

Operating receivables

      154     37  

Operating liabilities

      (158 )   (418 )
               

Total changes in working capital

      (4 )   (381 )
               

Cash flow from operating activities, continuing operations

      1,036     443  

Discontinuing operations

       

Net cash flow from operating activities,
discontinuing operations

      (4 )   37  
               

Cash flow from operating activities, total

      1,032     480  
               

Investing activities

       

Continuing operations

       

Investments in intangible assets

   13    (379 )   (287 )

Sale of intangible assets

   13    4     —    

Investments in tangible assets

   14    (67 )   (71 )

Sale of tangible assets

   14    9     —    

Cash flow from associated companies

   10    34     (13 )

Acquisitions of subsidiaries

   5    (19 )   (905 )

Sale of subsidiaries

      —       —    

Sale of associated companies

   10    575     —    

Sale of operations in OMX companies

      —       29  

Increase/decrease in other shares and participations

      (304 )   —    

Decrease/increase in long-term receivables

   16    60     (11 )

Increase/decrease in long-term liabilities

   23    14     (20 )

Decrease/increase in short-term investments of more than three months

      206     (25 )
               

Cash flow from investing activities, continuing operations

      133     (1,303 )
               

Discontinuing operations

       

Net cash flow from investing activities,
discontinuing operations

      -21     -71  

Cash flow from investing activities, total

      112     (1,374 )

Financing activities

       

Continuing operations

       

Dividend

      (1,120 )   —    

New share issue

      13     —    

Change in financial receivables

      70     76  

Loans raised

      —       553  

Amortization of loans

      (157 )   —    

Change in current trading account

      (1 )   (5 )
               

Cash flow from financing activities, continuing operations

      (1,195 )   624  
               

Discontinuing operations

       

Net cash flow from financing activities,
discontinuing operations

      (42 )   74  

Cash flow from investing activities, total

      (1,237 )   698  
               

Cash equivalents

      (93 )   (196 )

Cash equivalents – opening balance

      519     672  

Exchange-rate difference in cash equivalents

      (17 )   43  
               

Cash equivalents – closing balance

      409     519  

 

6


ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES

OMX AB (publ), Corporate Registration Number, 556243-8001 is a limited liability company registered in Sweden. The Parent Company has its registered office in Stockholm and is listed on the Stockholm Stock Exchange, the Copenhagen Stock Exchange, the Helsinki Stock Exchange and the Iceland Stock Exchange. OMX pertains to the OMX Group, comprising OMX AB and subsidiaries.

The consolidated accounts were approved for publication by the Board on February 15, 2007 and will be presented to the Annual General Meeting on April 12, 2007 for approval. Amounts are in SEK millions (SEK m) unless otherwise stated. Amounts in parentheses indicate values for 2005.

SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING PRINCIPLES

The most central accounting principles applied in the preparation of the consolidated accounts are described below. These principles have been applied consistently for all of the years presented unless otherwise stated.

The following standards and statements came into effect in 2006

 

 

IAS 19 Amendment – Actuarial Gains and Losses, Group Plans and Disclosures (January 1, 2006)

 

 

IAS 21 Amendment – Net investment in Foreign Operation (January 1, 2006)

 

 

IAS 39 Amendment – Cash Flow Hedge Accounting of Forecast Intragroup Transactions (January 1, 2006)

 

 

IAS 39 Amendment – The Fair Value Option (January 1, 2006)

 

 

IAS 39 and IFRS 4 Amendment Financial Guarantee Contracts (January 1, 2006)

 

 

IFRS 1 First-time Adoption of IFRS, IFRS4 and IFRS 6 Amendment (before January 1, 2006)

 

 

IFRS 6 Exploration for and Evaluation of Mineral Resources (January 1, 2006)

 

 

IFRIC 4 Determining whether an Arrangement contains a Lease (January 1, 2006)

 

 

IFRIC 5 Rights to Interests arising from Decommissioning, Restoration and Environmental Rehabilitation Funds (January 1, 2006)

 

 

IFRIC 6 Liabilities arising from Participating in a Specific Market: Waste Electrical and Electronic Equipment (December 1, 2005).

The new/amended IFRSs that came into effect from January 1, 2006 impact the OMX Group’s income statement, balance sheet, cash-flow statement and shareholders’ equity only as regards cash-flow hedging (IAS 39 Amendment—Cash flow Hedge Accounting of Forecast Intragroup Transactions). From January 1, 2006, OMX applies hedge accounting of hedging of internally forecast flows in foreign currency. Income from cash-flow hedges are reported against shareholders’ equity.

Regarding IFRIC 4, the Group has a number of large outsourcing contracts in which it assumes responsibility for operations for its customers. In management’s opinion, these contracts do not contain a leasing component since the OMX fixed assets involved are not utilized exclusively by one single customer.

COMPLIANCE WITH STANDARDS AND LEGISLATION

The consolidated accounts have been prepared in accordance with the International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) issued by the International Accounting principles Standards Board (IASB) and the interpretations issued by International Financial Reporting Interpretations Committee (IFRIC). In addition, the consolidated accounts also include certain additional information provided in accordance with the Swedish Financial Accounting Standards Council’s standard RR 30, Supplementary Accounting Regulations for Groups.

BASIS FOR THE PREPARATION OF THE REPORTS

The Group’s functional currency is SEK, which is also the reporting currency for the Group. This means that the financial statements are presented in SEK. Unless otherwise indicated, all amounts are rounded off to the nearest thousand. Assets and liabilities are stated at their historical cost, except for certain financial assets and liabilities that are stated at fair value. Financial assets and liabilities stated at fair value comprise derivative instruments, financial assets classed as financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement or as financial assets available for sale.

Fixed assets and disposal groups held for sale are stated at the lower of their previous carrying amount or their fair value after deductions for sales costs.

Preparing financial statements in accordance with IFRS requires that management make evaluations, estimations and assumptions that affect the application of the accounting principles and the stated amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and costs. Estimations and assumptions are based on historical experience and a number of other factors that may be considered reasonable under prevailing conditions. The results of these estimations and assumptions are then used to evaluate the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities not otherwise clear from other sources. The actual outcome may deviate from these estimations and assumptions.

Estimations and assumptions are regularly reviewed. Changes in estimations are reported in the period in which the change is made, if the change affects only that period, or in the period in which the change is made and subsequent periods if the change affects both the period concerned and subsequent periods.

Evaluations made by management in the implementation of IFRS that have a significant effect on financial statements and the estimations made that may entail material adjustments in subsequent years’ financial statements are described in greater detail in Note 1.

CONSOLIDATED ACCOUNTS

SUBSIDIARIES

Subsidiaries are all companies in which OMX has the right to devise financial and operative strategies in a manner normally associated with a shareholding amounting to more than half of voting rights. Subsidiaries are included in the consolidated accounts from the date on which the Group gains this controlling influence. Subsidiaries are excluded from the consolidated accounts from the date on which the controlling influence ceases. The purchase accounting method is used for the reporting of the Group’s acquisitions of subsidiaries. The acquisition cost of an acquisition comprises the fair value of assets transferred in payment, issued equity instruments and liabilities arising or assumed on the date of transfer, plus costs directly attributable to the acquisition. The identifiable acquired assets, assumed liabilities and contingent liabilities associated with an acquisition are initially valued at fair value on the date of acquisition, regardless of the extent of any minority interests. The surplus consisting of the difference between the acquisition cost and the fair value of the Group’s share of identifiable acquired net assets is reported as goodwill. If the acquisition cost is less than the fair value of the acquired subsidiary’s net assets, the difference is reported directly in the income statement. Inter-company transactions, balance sheet items and unrealized gains on transactions between Group companies are eliminated. Unrealized losses are also eliminated, unless the transaction is evidence of the need for impairment to be recognized in the transferred asset. The accounting principles for subsidiaries have been changed, where necessary, to guarantee the consistent application of Group principles.

 

7


ASSOCIATED COMPANIES

An associated company is an operation that is neither a subsidiary nor a joint venture, usually on the basis of holdings of between 20 and 50 percent of the voting rights, but in which OMX exercises a significant influence over its management. Associated companies are accounted for using the equity method and are initially valued at cost. The carrying amount of the Group’s holdings in associated companies includes goodwill (net after any impairment) identified on acquisition.

The Group’s share of the associated company’s earnings after tax generated following the acquisition is reported in the operating income and its share of changes in provisions following the acquisition is reported among provisions. The share of earnings is reported in operating income for cases in which the operations of the associated companies are similar to OMX’s own operations. Accumulated changes following the acquisition are reported as changes in the carrying amount of the holding. If the Group’s participations in an associated company’s losses amounts to or exceeds its holding in the associated company, including any unsecured receivables, the Group will not report further losses unless it has assumed obligations or made payments on behalf of the associated company. Any dilution gains or losses in associated companies are reported directly in shareholders’ equity.

Unrealized gains on transactions between the Group and its associated companies are eliminated in relation to the Group’s holding in the associated company. Unrealized losses are also eliminated, unless the transaction is evidence of the need for impairment to be recognized in the transferred asset. The accounting principles for associated companies have been changed, where necessary, to guarantee the consistent application of principles within the Group.

SEGMENT REPORTING

A business segment is a group of assets and operations providing products or services exposed to risks and opportunities that differ from those applicable to other business segments. Geographic segments provide products and services within an economic environment exposed to risks and opportunities that differ from those applicable to other economic environments.

From January 1, 2006, OMX has been divided into three divisions—Nordic Marketplaces, Information Services & New Markets and Market Technology. Geographically, OMX is divided into four regions: Nordic Countries, Rest of Europe, North America and Asia/Australia. The geographic grouping corresponds to regions where the company’s operations have relatively similar system solutions, rules and regulations and customer behavior. Comparative figures have been adjusted according to the new organization.

CURRENCY TRANSLATION

FUNCTIONAL CURRENCY AND REPORTING CURRENCY

Items included in the financial statements of the various units within the Group are valued in the currency used in the economic environment in which each company mainly operates (functional currency). In the consolidated accounts, SEK is used, which is the Parent Company’s functional and reporting currency.

TRANSACTIONS AND BALANCE SHEET ITEMS

Transactions in foreign currencies are translated into the functional currency according to the exchange rates applicable on the transaction date. Exchange-rate gains and losses arising through the payment of such transactions and on the translation of monetary assets and liabilities in foreign currencies at the exchange rate applicable on the closing date are reported in the income statement. The exception is where transactions represent hedges meeting the requirements for hedge accounting of cash flows or net investments where gains and losses are reported against shareholders’ equity. Translation differences for non-monetary items, such as shares classed as financial assets available for sale, are entered in the reserves in shareholders’ equity.

GROUP COMPANIES

The earnings and financial position of all Group companies (of which none uses a high-inflation currency), which use a functional currency other than the reporting currency, are translated into the Group’s reporting currency in accordance with the following:

 

a) assets and liabilities for each balance sheet are translated at the closing date exchange rate,

 

b) revenues and expenses for each income statement are translated at the average exchange rate, and

 

c) all exchange-rate differences that arise are reported as a separate item in shareholders’ equity.

In consolidation, exchange-rate differences arising as a consequence of the translation of net investments in foreign operations, borrowing and other currency instruments identified as hedges for such investments are allocated to shareholders’ equity. In the divestment of foreign operations, such exchange-rate differences are reported in the income statement as part of the capital gain/loss. Goodwill and adjustments of fair value arising in the acquisition of foreign operations are treated as assets and liabilities associated with those operations and are translated at the closing date exchange rate.

Tangible fixed assets

Tangible fixed assets are reported at their acquisition cost with deductions for depreciation and possible impairment. The acquisition cost includes expenses directly attributable to the acquisition of the asset. Depending on which alternative is suitable, additional expenses are added to the carrying amount of the asset or are reported as a separate asset only if it is probable that future financial advantages associated with the asset will benefit the Group and if the acquisition cost of the asset can be ascertained in a reliable manner. All other forms of repairs and maintenance shall be reported as costs in the income statement during the period in which they are incurred. Straight-line depreciation is conducted over three to ten years, which is estimated to be the asset’s useful life. Assets’ residual value and useful life are tested and adjusted as necessary. An asset’s carrying amount is immediately written down to its recoverable amount if the asset’s carrying amount exceeds its estimated recoverable amount. On divestment, gains and losses are determined by comparing the sales proceeds and the carrying amount and are reported in the income statement.

Intangible fixed assets

Intangible fixed assets are reported at their acquisition cost with deductions for amortization and possible impairment. The acquisition cost includes expenses directly attributable to the acquisition of the asset. Depending on which alternative is suitable, additional expenses are added to the carrying amount of the asset or are reported as a separate asset only if it is probable that future financial advantages associated with the asset will benefit the Group and if the acquisition cost of the asset can be ascertained in a reliable manner.

GOODWILL

Goodwill comprises the amount by which the acquisition cost exceeds the identifiable fair value of the Group’s share of the net assets of the acquired subsidiary/associated company at the time of acquisition. Goodwill on the acquisition of subsidiaries is reported as an intangible asset. On the acquisition of associated companies, goodwill is included in the holding in the associated company. Goodwill is deemed to have an indeterminate useful life and is divided among cash-generating units at as detailed a level as possible and is tested annually to identify possible impairment. The Group’s goodwill values are attributable mainly to the acquisitions of the Nordic exchanges within the Nordic Marketplaces division, where each legal company represents a cash-generating unit. The carrying amount is the acquisition cost less accumulated impairment. Gains or losses on the divestment of a unit include the remaining carrying amount of the goodwill attributable to the divested unit.

OTHER INTANGIBLE FIXED ASSETS

Other intangible fixed assets are amortized on a straight-line basis over an expected useful life of three to 20 years. All other intangible fixed assets are tested annually to identify possible impairment needs.

Capitalized expenditure for research and development

All expenditures for research are charged as an expense when they arise. Expenses relating to the development of new products are treated as intangible assets when they fulfill the following criteria: it is likely that the asset will provide future financial benefit to the Group (contribute a positive cash flow), the acquisition cost can be calculated in a reliable manner, the company intends to take the asset to completion, and that the company has the technical, financial and other resources to complete development, use or sell the asset. Important documentation for the verification of such capitalization includes business plans, budgets, outcomes and external evaluations. In certain cases, capitalization is based on the company’s estimation of future outcome, such as prevailing

 

8


market conditions. The acquisition cost of an internally developed intangible asset is the total of those expenses incurred from the time when the intangible asset first fulfils the criteria set out by generally accepted accounting principles (see criteria above). Internally developed intangible assets are reported at acquisition cost with deductions for accumulated impairment losses and any write-downs. Revenue from in-house work carried out during the fiscal year on company assets that have been carried forward as fixed assets is reported in the income statement under the heading “Own work capitalized.” The item relates only to capitalized personnel expenses. No reduction of personnel expenses has been made for work that relates to capitalized assets. Instead, these expenses have been met by the reported revenue. Own work capitalized has therefore no impact on income but does have a negative impact on the operating margin.

Customer contacts

Customer agreements that have been identified in conjunction with acquisitions have been valued on the basis of expected cash flow and reported as intangible assets. Reported customer agreements are entirely attributable to the acquisitions of the Copenhagen Stock Exchange (CSE) and Eignarhaldsfelagid Verdbrefathing hf (EV). Straight-line amortization is applied to these agreements over their estimated useful lives (20 years).

Brands and licenses

Brands and licenses are reported at their acquisition cost. Brands and licenses are reported at acquisition cost less accumulated amortization. Straight-line amortization is applied to distribute the cost of brands and licenses over their estimated useful lives (five to 20 years).

Software

Acquired software licenses are capitalized on the basis of the costs arising when the software concerned is acquired and brought into use. These costs are amortized over the estimated useful life (three to five years). Costs for the development or maintenance of software are expensed as they arise. Costs closely associated with the production of identifiable and unique software controlled by the Group, which generates probable financial benefit for more then a year and exceeds the costs, are reported as intangible assets. Costs closely associated with the production of software include personnel costs for software development and a reasonable portion of attributable indirect costs. Development costs for software reported as assets are amortized over their estimated useful lives.

Impairment

Assets with an indeterminable useful life are not depreciated/amortized but tested annually for impairment. Depreciated/amortized assets are assessed for a reduction in value whenever events or changes in conditions indicate that the carrying amount may not be recoverable. Impairment is recognized in the amount by which an asset’s carrying amount exceeds its recoverable amount. The recoverable amount is the higher of an asset’s fair value less sale costs and its value in use. In assessing the need for impairment, assets are grouped at the lowest level at which separately identifiable cash flows exist (cash-generating units). On the closing date, a test is performed on other assets than financial assets and goodwill that have previously been depreciated/amortized to ascertain whether the asset should be reversed.

Financial instruments

The Group classifies its financial instruments according to the following categories:

 

 

financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement

 

 

loan receivables and accounts receivable

 

 

financial instruments held to maturity

 

 

financial assets available for sale

 

 

financial liabilities stated at fair value in the income statement

 

 

financial liabilities carried at amortized cost.

The classification depends on the purpose for which the instruments were acquired. Management determines the classification of instruments on the first occasion on which they are reported and reassesses their classification on each report occasion.

A financial asset or liability is entered in the balance sheet when the company becomes a party to the contractual conditions of the instrument. Accounts receivable are recognized in the balance sheet once the invoice has been sent. Liabilities are recognized when the corresponding party has performed its undertaking and the company is liable for payment, even if the invoice has not yet been received. Accounts payable are recognized when invoices are received.

A financial asset is derecognized in the balance sheet when the rights conveyed by the agreement are realized, when they mature or when the company loses control over them. The same applies to part of a financial asset. A financial liability is derecognized in the balance sheet when the obligations of the contract have been met or otherwise concluded. The same applies to part of a financial liability.

Acquisitions and disposals of financial assets are recognized on the date of the transaction, the date on which the Group undertakes to acquire or divest the assets, except in cases where the company acquires or divests listed securities, in which case settlement date accounting is applied.

Financial instruments are initially stated at fair value plus transaction costs, which applies to all financial assets that are not valued at fair value in the income statement.

Financial assets stated at fair value in the income statement

This category has two subordinate categories: financial assets held for trading and those initially categorized as stated at fair value in the income statement. A financial asset is classified in this category if it is primarily acquired with the purpose of being sold within a short period of time or if this classification is determined by management. Derivative instruments are also categorized as held for trading if not identified as hedges. Assets in this category are classified as current assets if held for trading or expected to be sold within 12 months from the closing date. Assets in this category are continuously reported at fair value and changes in value are reported in the income statement.

Loan receivables and accounts receivable

Loan receivables and accounts receivable are non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable payments that are not listed in an active market. They are characterized by the fact that they arise when the Group makes funds, goods or services available directly to a customer without intending to trade the resulting receivable. They are included among current assets with the exception of items maturing more than 12 months after the closing date, which are classified as fixed assets. Loan receivables and accounts receivable are included under the heading accounts receivable and other receivables in the balance sheet. Accounts receivable are reported at the amount expected to be received less deductions for doubtful receivables judged on an individual basis. Because accounts receivable are expected to have a short maturity period, values are reported at a nominal amount without discounting. Impairment losses on accounts receivable are reported among operating expenses. Loan receivables are stated at amortized cost applying the effective interest method.

Financial instruments held to maturity

Financial instruments that are held to maturity are non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable payments and with specified terms, which the Group’s management intends and has the ability to hold until maturity. Assets in this category are stated at amortized cost applying the effective interest method.

Financial assets available for sale

Financial assets available for sale are non-derivative assets that are either attributable to this category or have not been classified in any of the other categories. They are included in fixed assets if management does not intend to divest the asset within 12 months after the balance sheet date. Assets in this category are continuously valued at fair value and the change in value is reported in shareholders’ equity. Exchange-rate fluctuations in monetary securities are reported in the income statement while exchange-rate fluctuations in non-monetary securities are reported against shareholders’ equity. When instruments classified as instruments available for sale are divested or when impairment losses are to be made on the instruments, accumulated adjustments in fair value are recognized in the income statement as gains and losses from financial instruments. Interest on securities available for sale that have been calculated by applying the effective interest method are reported in the income statement under other revenue. Dividends on equity instruments available for sale are reported in the income statement under other revenue when the Group’s right to receive payment has been established.

Financial liabilities stated at fair value in the income statement

Financial liabilities valued at fair value in the income statement are derivatives with negative fair values unless identified as hedges.

Financial liabilities carried at amortized cost

Financial liabilities carried at amortized cost denotes financial liabilities other than those included in the category financial liabilities stated at fair value in the income statement.

 

9


Borrowing is included among other financial liabilities, initially at fair value, net after transaction costs. Borrowing is subsequently reported at accrued acquisition cost and any difference between the amount received (net) and the repayment amount is distributed over the term of the loan as interest expense applying the effective interest method.

Cash equivalents

Cash equivalents include cash and bank balances and other short-term investments maturing within three months from the acquisition date and that can easily be converted into cash.

Share capital

Transaction costs directly attributable to the issuing of new shares or options are reported net after tax in shareholders’ equity as a deduction from the proceeds of the new share issue. In the event that a Group company acquires shares in the Parent Company (repurchase of treasury shares), the purchase price paid, including any directly attributable transaction costs (net after tax) reduces that part of shareholders’ equity that relates to shareholders in the Parent Company until the shares have been canceled, reissued or divested. If these shares are subsequently sold or reissued, the amount received, net after directly attributable transaction costs and income tax effects, is reported in that portion of shareholders’ equity that relates to shareholders in the Parent Company.

Deferred tax

Current and deferred income tax for Swedish and foreign Group companies is reported under the heading Taxes in the income statement. The companies are liable to pay taxes according to applicable legislation in each country. National income tax is calculated on nominally entered earnings with additions for non-deductible items, deductions for non-taxable revenues and other deductions, primarily untaxed dividends from subsidiaries. In the balance sheet, deferred tax liabilities and assets are calculated and reported on the basis of temporary differences between the carrying amounts and taxable values of assets and liabilities, as well as other tax-related deductions or deficits. Deferred tax assets are reported at a value considered true and fair and only when it is likely that it will be possible to realize the underlying loss carryforwards within the foreseeable future. The reported values are reviewed at each closing date. Deferred income tax is calculated by applying the tax rates and laws that have been decided or announced on the closing date and that are expected to apply when the deferred tax asset in question is realized or when the deferred tax liability is settled. The effects of changes in applicable tax rates are recognized in income in the period in which the change becomes law. See Note 11.

EMPLOYEE BENEFITS

PENSION COMMITMENTS

According to IAS 19, pension obligations are classified as defined-contribution plans or defined-benefit plans. The defined-contribution plans are mainly accounted for at the cost (premium/contribution) incurred during the fiscal year for securing employee pension benefits. In these cases, there is no need to perform an actuarial evaluation of the pension plan from an insurance perspective and the Group’s earnings are charged for expenses in pace with the benefits being earned. Defined-benefit plans must be established according to the present value of defined-benefit obligations and the fair value of any plan assets. In that case, the “Projected Unit Credit Method” is used to calculate obligations and costs, in which consideration is also given to future salary increases. OMX has only defined-contribution pension obligations and in the event that companies with defined-benefit plans are acquired, management will determine whether there is cause and opportunity to replace the defined-benefit plan with a defined-contribution plan.

EMPLOYEE STOCK OPTION PROGRAM

OMX issued employee stock options during the years 2000, 2001 and 2002.

If the share price exceeds the redemption price when the options are redeemed, the employee is entitled to receive shares or compensation in cash for the difference between the share price and the redemption price. This is known as a “cash-settled plan.” The options were allocated free of charge, and their fair value was reported as a liability as of January 1, 2004, when the transition to IFRS 2 took place. The valuation of the liability is affected by changes in the fair value of the options and by personnel turnover, and this is reported as changes in personnel costs in the income statement. When employees leave the company, the liability is reduced by the corresponding amount of the employee’s share. In order to limit the costs for the program (including social security contributions) in the event of a price increase, limit dilution and secure the provision of shares upon exercise of these options, an agreement was signed earlier with an external party to provide OMX shares at a fixed price (share swap). As described under “Financial instruments,” above, the share swap will be stated at fair value on an ongoing basis. Changes in fair value are transferred to the income statement and reported as changes in personnel costs, and thus limit the effect of changes in the fair value of the employee stock options as described above. The financing costs for the share swap are reported as a financial expense. For OMX employees in countries where social security contributions are payable for share-based benefits, the social security contributions are expensed on an ongoing basis for the benefit of the employee. The benefit consists of the fair value of the options as described above.

SHARE MATCH PROGRAM

A Share Match Program was introduced in 2006. The Share Match Program is a long-term program for approximately 30 senior executives and key individuals in OMX and runs over a period of three years.

The Share Match Program is a program regulated/settled on the basis of shareholders’ equity. Payroll costs for the Share Match Program are reported during the vesting period for matching shares based on the fair value of the shares on allotment date. The fair value is based on the share price when the investment is made, adjusted to ensure that no dividend is paid prior to the matching and adjusted to the market conditions included in the program. This date is the date of the offering. Amounts corresponding to the costs for the Share Match Program are reported in the balance sheet as shareholders’ equity. The vesting conditions affect the number of shares that OMX will match. We estimate the probability of achieving performance targets for shares under performance-based programs when personnel expenses are calculated for these shares. Costs are calculated based on the number of shares that is expected to be matched at the end of the vesting period. Non-market related conditions for vesting are considered in the assumptions regarding the number of options expected to be vested. When purchased and vested shares are matched, social security contributions shall be paid on the value of the employee benefit in certain countries. The employee benefit is generally based on the market value on matching date. Provisions for estimated social security contributions are established during the vesting period.

COMPENSATION UPON TERMINATION OF EMPLOYMENT

Compensation is payable upon termination of employment when an employee is given notice of termination of employment before the normal pension time, or when an employee voluntarily resigns in exchange for such compensation. The Group reports severance pay when it is demonstrably obliged either to layoff employees irrevocably in accordance with a detailed formal plan, or to pay compensation upon termination of employment resulting from an offer made to encourage voluntary resignation.

VARIABLE SALARY

The Group reports a liability and an expense for variable salary, based on a Group-wide program, “Short-term Incentive 2006,” see Note 7. The Group reports a provision when there is a legal obligation to do so, or an informal obligation based on prior practice.

Provisions

Provisions are reported in the balance sheet when the Group has an existing legal or informal obligation in this regard due to the occurrence of an event that can be expected to result in an outflow of financial benefits that can reasonably be estimated. Provisions for restructuring costs are reported when the Group has presented a detailed plan for implementing the measures, the plan has been communicated to the parties concerned, and a well-founded expectation has been created. See Note 24.

Derivative instruments and hedging measures

Derivative instruments comprise, among others, futures, options and swaps that are used to cover the risk of exchange-rate fluctuations or exposure to interest-rate risks. Derivative instruments are first reported at fair value on the date on which the contract was signed and the fair value is subsequently reassessed on each reporting occasion. The method for reporting gains or losses depends on whether the derivative instrument is classified as a hedging instrument and in such a case the nature of the hedged item. In the Group, derivative instruments are classified as either hedging of fair value of reported assets or liability or of a binding commitment (hedging of fair value), hedging of forecasted transactions (cash-flow hedging) or as hedging of net investments in foreign operations.

 

10


Whenever hedging is entered into, the relationship between the hedging instrument and the hedged items, and the company’s risk-management targets and strategy for hedging is documented in the Group. The Group also documents, whenever hedging is entered into, its assessment of whether the derivatives used in conjunction with hedging transactions are expected to be effective in achieving counteracting effects in fair value or the cash flow that are attributable to the hedged risk. The Group continuously documents the effectiveness of the hedging transactions.

Hedging of fair value

Changes in the fair value of derivative instruments classified as hedging of fair value are reported on the same line of the income statement as the change in value of the hedged item. Gains and losses pertaining to hedging are reported in the income statement on the same date as when gains and losses are reported for items that have been hedged. Since the entire change in value of the derivative instrument is reported directly in the income statement, any ineffective portion of the derivative instrument is recognized in the income statement. In the case that the conditions for hedge accounting are no longer fulfilled, the derivative instrument is reported at fair value including any change in value in the income statement in accordance with the principle described above.

Cash-flow hedging

Changes in value of cash-flow hedging are reported in shareholders’ equity and re-entered in the income statement in line with the hedged cash flow impacting the income statement. Any ineffective portion of the change in value is reported directly in the income statement. If the forecasted cash flow forming the basis of the hedging transaction is no longer deemed to be probable, the accumulated result reported in shareholders’ equity is transferred directly to the income statement.

Hedging of foreign net investments

Changes in value of exchange-rate differences attributable to derivative instruments intended to hedge net investments in foreign operations are reported in shareholders’ equity. Any ineffective portion of gains or losses is reported directly in the income statement as a financial item. The accumulated result in shareholders’ equity is re-entered in the income statement in the event that the foreign operations are divested.

Derivatives to which hedge accounting is not applied

If hedge accounting is not applied, increases or decreases in the value of the derivative are reported as income or expense in Operating profit/loss or in Net financial income/expense, depending on the purpose for which the derivative instrument is being used and whether its use relates to an operating item or a financial item. If hedge accounting is not applied when interest swaps are used, the interest coupon is reported as interest and any other value change of the interest swap is reported as other financial income or other financial expense.

Derivative positions at Nordic Marketplaces

By virtue of their clearing operations in the derivatives markets, Nordic Marketplaces is formally the counterparty in all derivative positions traded via the exchanges. However, the derivatives are not used by the exchanges for the purpose of trading on their own behalf but should be seen as a way of documenting the counterparty guarantees given in clearing operations. The counterparty risks are measured using models that are agreed with the financial inspection authority of the country in question. The risk situation in regard to the risks involved in liquidating positions is unchanged compared with before. Collateral for liquidating outstanding derivative instruments is pledged in the same manner as before. According to IAS 39/IAS 32, the market value of the above mentioned derivative positions must be reported gross in the balance sheet after netting by customer where an offset possibility exists.

Calculation of fair value

The fair value of financial instruments that are traded in an active market (such as market-listed derivative instruments, financial assets held for trading and financial assets available for sale) is based on quoted market prices on the closing date. The shares in Oslo Børs Holding ASA are listed on the Norwegian Securities Dealers Association’s OTC list. The market for the share is characterized by a low number of settlements and high volatility. The value of the shareholding is based on the volume-weighted average of transactions in the most recent quarter.

The fair value of financial instruments that are not traded in an active market (such as OTC derivatives) is determined by applying generally accepted valuation techniques. The Group uses a number of different methods and makes assumptions based on the market conditions that prevail on the closing date. Quoted market prices or quotes by brokers for similar instruments are used for long-term liabilities. Other techniques, such as calculation of discounted cash flows, are used to determine the fair value of the remaining financial instruments. The fair value of interest swaps is calculated as the present value of the estimated future cash flows. The fair value of currency futures is determined based on market prices for currency futures on the closing date. The par value of accounts receivable and accounts payable, less any perceived credits, is assumed to correspond to their fair value. The fair value of financial liabilities is calculated, for clarification in notes, by discounting the future contracted cash flow to the current market rate of interest available to the Group for similar financial instruments.

Collateral pledged to OMX’s exchange operations

Through their clearing operations, OMX’s exchanges enter as the counterparty into each options and futures contract, thereby guaranteeing the fulfillment of each contract. Customers, who either through an option or futures contract, incur a financial obligation towards OMX’s exchanges, must pledge collateral against this obligation in accordance with the specific rules regulating this area. Most of the collateral pledged comprises cash and securities issued by the Swedish State. For other collateral pledged, see Note 30.

Contingencies

A contingency relates to a possible commitment arising from events that have occurred but where the actual commitment can only be confirmed by the occurrence of one or more uncertain future events that are not fully within the company’s control, or a commitment that arises from events that have occurred but are not reported as liabilities or provisions due to the fact that it is unlikely that an outflow of resources will be required to regulate the commitment, or that the size of the commitment cannot be calculated with sufficient accuracy.

Revenue recognition

The Group’s reported net sales relate primarily to trading revenue and the sale of systems and services. Revenue is recognized in the income statement when the product or service has been delivered in accordance with the applicable terms and conditions for delivery and it is probable that future financial benefits will flow to the company and these benefits can be measured reliably. Interest income is recognized on a time proportion basis that is calculated on the basis of the yield on the underlying asset. Dividends are recognized in the income statement when the shareholders’ right to receive payment is established. Income received in the form of assets (for example shares) is valued at fair value on the transaction date.

NORDIC MARKETPLACES

Revenues within this business area comprise, in addition to trading revenues, premium revenues for options written and payments for futures sold. Premium revenue and expenses as well as futures payments made and received are shown as net figures in the income statement. Consequently, current account assets and liabilities are reported according to the net accounting principle in the balance sheet where right of offset applies. Issuers’ revenues are recognized on a continuous basis as services are rendered.

INFORMATION SERVICES & NEW MARKETS

Revenues within this business area comprise, in addition to trading revenues from Baltic Markets, information revenue, revenues from the central securities depositories in Tallinn and Riga and revenue from services in securities administration. These revenues are recognized on a continuous basis as services are rendered.

MARKET TECHNOLOGY

OMX applies the percentage-of-completion method to its technology sales, license and project revenues. In applying the percentage-of-completion method, income is recognized in line with the completion (development) of a project. An anticipated loss on a project is immediately treated as an expense. The fundamental premise of the percentage-of-completion method is that project revenue and expenditure can be accurately assessed and that the degree of development can be reliably established. At OMX, the degree of development is established through the relationship between the hours that have been worked by closing date and the estimated number of project hours in total. The occasional project arises for which an accurate assessment of project revenue and expenditure cannot be made when the year-end accounts are prepared. In these cases,

 

11


no profit is reported for the project. The percentage-of-completion method is applied as soon as possible. A present-value calculation has been performed for those project receivables that do not fall due within 12 months. Income from support and facility management services is recognized on a continuous basis as services are rendered and over the contract period.

Internal sales

The main principle for transactions between companies within the Group is that the price is determined according to market price. Market price is the price an external customer is willing to pay or the price an external supplier would charge for providing the service. In cases where comparable market prices cannot be established, the price of the transaction is determined according to the cost-coverage method plus a margin. The cost-coverage method entails remuneration for direct costs as well as a reasonable portion of the indirect costs that the company has accumulated while providing the service. Any internal profit that arises as a result is eliminated within the Group. Common functions, such as premises-leasing expenses and office services, are invoiced between companies within the Group according to the cost-coverage method.

Leasing

In the consolidated accounts, leasing is classified as financial or operational leasing. Financial leasing applies where the financial risks and benefits associated with ownership are, in all material aspects, transferred to the lessee. Where this is not the case, operational leasing applies. In the case of operational leasing, leasing fees are expensed over the period of the lease, which commences when usage starts. OMX only has operational leasing commitments.

Dividends

Dividends to the Parent Company’s shareholders are reported as a liability in the Group’s financial statements in the period when the dividend is approved by the Parent Company’s shareholders.

Fixed assets held for sale and discontinued operations

When a decision has been made to discontinue an asset or cash-generating unit by selling it, the asset or unit in question is classified as being held for sale.

Assets classified as held for sale are reported separately in the balance sheet at the lower of carrying amount and fair value, with a deduction made for selling costs. Earnings of discontinued operations and operations in the process of being discontinued are reported in a separate column in the income statement.

Losses resulting from decreases in value when assets are classified for sale are included in the income statement.

Cash-flow statement

The cash-flow statement was prepared in accordance with the indirect method. Financial investments with a duration in excess of three months are not included in cash equivalents. Accordingly, cash equivalents may fluctuate when there are changes in the duration of investments.

Current trading account

The current trading account’s assets and liabilities in OMX’s exchange operations have been reported according to the net accounting principle within the respective clearing operations in cases where a right of offset exists.

Clarification concerning future standards

When the consolidated financial statements were prepared as at December 31, 2006, the following standards and interpretations had been published but had not yet come into effect:

 

 

IAS 1 Amendment – Capital Disclosures (January 1, 2007)*

 

 

IFRS 7 Financial Instruments: Disclosures (January 1, 2007)*

 

 

IFRS 8 Operating Segments (January 1, 2009)*

 

 

IFRIC 7 Applying the Restatement Approach under IAS 29 Financial Reporting in Hyperinflationary Economies (March 1, 2006)*

 

 

IFRIC 8 Scope of IFRS 2 (May 1, 2006)*

 

 

IFRIC 9 Reassessment of Embedded Derivatives (June 1, 2006)*

 

 

IFRIC 10 Interim Financial Reporting & Impairment (November 1, 2006)*

 

 

IFRIC 11 Group and Treasury Share Transactions (March 1, 2007)*

 

 

IFRIC 12 Service Concession Arrangements (January 1, 2008)*.

 

* Earlier application encouraged.

Of the above-listed standards and interpretations, IFRS 8, IFRIC 10, IFRIC 11 and IFRIC 12 had not been adopted by the EU at January 1, 2007. In the management’s view, none of these new standards or changes to standards is expected to have any influence on the Group’s earnings or financial position at present.

 

12


RISK MANAGEMENT

(A) Risk Management at OMX

OMX’s business operations place high demands on effective risk management which comprise a fundamental part of the Group’s strategic and systematic efforts to achieve operational goals while minimizing potential disruptions. Units in OMX are directly or indirectly subject to special regulation and supervision. The conditions for an efficient process and controlled risk for the purpose of optimizing business value are created through a business adapted and integrated risk management model. There is particular focus at Group and business area levels to maintain high levels of capability in crisis management, business-related continuity and incident management, as well as business intelligence.

The aim of risk management is to increase value for our shareholders, customers, employees and other stakeholders by maintaining an adequate level of protection of the Group’s prioritized assets. This is achieved by eliminating or minimizing risks and disruptions to our business operations that would otherwise generate financial losses or other undesired costs.

(i) OMX’s risk management organization

The following roles and responsibilities are included in OMX’s risk management in order to ensure compliance with laws and regulations, governance, coordination and the development of methodology, as well as operational risk management activities:

 

   

The Board of Directors is ultimately responsible for adequate and efficient risk management.

 

   

The President is ultimately responsible for ensuring that risk management is applied in accordance with the Board’s directions.

 

   

The Group Risk Management & Control (GRMC) staff function has the task of governing and coordinating risk management with regard to organization, roles and responsibilities, framework including methodology, reporting and control. GRMC includes governance of Security, Risk Management, Insurance and Internal Control including coordination and support in the event of crises and major incidents.

 

   

Management (at executive, business area and business support level) is responsible for identifying, assessing, managing and reporting the risks found within their respective areas of responsibility.

 

   

Specialists in various security areas, such as operational and financial risk management and insurance, support management and others in the line organization with analyses and management of risks and incidents.

 

   

All employees and contracted personnel are, to a certain extent, included in risk management in their roles and respective areas of responsibility.

 

   

Internal Audit is responsible for the independent audit of risk management, regarding both observance of governance, control activities and reporting.

(ii) OMX’s risk management process

OMX’s risk management is a business-integrated process that covers both business and support units at various levels in the organization. The methodology applied is partially based on the international ERM-standard (Enterprise Risk Management standard) in accordance with COSO (the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission) with additional methodology for the areas of Security, Insurance and Internal

 

13


Control. The risk management process is integrated in the operations conducting business activities, such as strategic management and development work, and is directly linked to the company’s business planning and follow-up.

Risk management is a standardized and continuous process which aims to identify, evaluate, manage, control and report significant risks to which OMX may be exposed. Risk management employs different forms of preventative measures and strategies, such as risk prevention, damage limitation and risk financing, in order to safeguard the Group’s objectives and the majority of goals set at business area and operational levels.

OMX’s risk management not only includes risks in the day-to-day business operations but also risks arising in conjunction with forward-looking strategic investments in order to optimize the company’s business opportunities.

Risk management including control activities is decentralized to each business area and support function. As a result, all business areas, support functions and Group staff functions work with the management of financial, operational and strategic risks. Risks are divided into short-term and long-term risks.

The business areas and central support functions periodically report on risks to GRMC which presents consolidated risk reports to the Risk Steering Group. The CEO is the Chairman of the Risk Steering Group and periodically reports on risks in OMX to the OMX Board.

(iii) Risk management in OMX’s business areas

The Nordic Marketplaces business area and its units comprise operations that are subject to special regulation. Corresponding requirements apply to the Information Services & New Markets business area which comprises trading information, the Baltic exchange operations and central securities depositories. Finally, the Market Technology business area provides system solutions, systems operation and other services to exchanges, clearing organizations, central securities depositories and other types of authorized companies in the financial markets in a number of different countries. All business areas manage operational and strategic risks particularly those that fall under their respective areas of focus and responsibility.

(a) Nordic Marketplaces

Nordic Marketplaces primarily manages risks attributable to the clearing operations for derivatives instruments. These risks arise as a result of the clearing organization serving as the counterparty in those transactions that are subject to counterparty clearing in different markets, entailing issuing a guarantee for ensuring that a clearing contract will be fulfilled. The clearing operations’ risks include counterparty risks, settlement risks and liquidity risks, of which the significant risk is that one or more clearing counterparties will fail to fulfill its commitments. One of the primary obligations of clearing counterparties is to pledge the requisite collateral as required by the applicable rules as protection against the counterparty risk assumed. In addition, netting is applied which facilitates risk management in the clearing operations by decreasing the value of the payments to be made, thereby reducing the need for liquidity facilities. Furthermore, netting implies that the counterparty risk is reduced to the net exposure of outstanding positions vis-à-vis respective counterparties.

(b) Market Technology

The special risks associated with the Market Technology business area are attributable mainly to the various phases in the provision of a service: the sales phase, the delivery and implementation phase and the production phase. The sales phase involves the risk of the absence of profitability and foreign exchange risk. Operational risks are managed in the other phases. Significant emphasis is also placed on managing IT security and continuity operations.

 

14


(B) Financial Risk Management

OMX is exposed to various kinds of financial risks through its international operations.

(i) Organization and Operation

The Group’s financial operations and financial risk management are centered around OMX’s internal bank, OMX Treasury. The goal of OMX Treasury is, within given risk limitations, to manage the Group’s financial risk exposure, to optimize net financial income and generate value for business operations through financial services. Significant economies of scale, lower financial costs and better oversight and management of the Group’s financial risks are achieved through centralized financial operations. Operations are conducted according to a Financial Policy, which forms the framework and specifies guidelines and limitations. The Financial Policy is determined by OMX AB’s Board of Directors and revised continuously.

The Policy deals with the following risks:

 

   

Currency risks (transaction and translation exposure);

 

   

Interest-rate risks;

 

   

Financing risks; and

 

   

Credit and counterparty risks.

(a) Currency risks

A significant portion of the Group’s sales are attributable to operations outside Sweden, which means that changes in currency exchange rates have an impact on the Group’s income statement and balance sheet. Currency risk exposure occurs during the sale and purchase of foreign currencies (transaction exposure) and during the translation of foreign subsidiaries’ balance sheets and income statements to SEK (translation exposure).

In accordance with the Group’s Financial Policy, 100% of contracted flows and 0–100% of forecast flows up to 12 months shall be hedged. Deviations from the prescribed hedge levels can occur within specified guidelines. Hedging of transaction exposure is carried out through currency forwards and options or loans in foreign currencies. Currency forwards that hedge contracted flows fulfill the conditions for hedge accounting. These forwards have been defined as hedging of fair value and are reported in the income statement together with changes in fair value of the asset which gave rise to the hedged risk, see the Hedge relations table. The forward contracts that hedge forecasted flows fulfill the requirements for hedge accounting. These forward contracts have been defined as cash-flow hedging. Changes in fair value of these hedges are reported directly against shareholders’ equity, while the portion of the hedge that is not effective is reported directly in the income statement.

Transaction exposure originating from financial cash flows is eliminated by the subsidiaries raising borrowings and making investments in local currency or by hedging these flows by using currency forwards. Translation exposure occurs in conjunction the translation of OMX’s foreign subsidiaries’ balance sheets and income statements and in the recalculation of consolidated goodwill relating to foreign subsidiaries into SEK. In accordance with the Financial Policy, portions of the translation exposure are hedged in order to reduce the volatility of OMX’s financial key ratios (see table below in (C)(iii): Translation exposure).

(b) Interest-rate risks

The Group is exposed to interest-rate risks that can impact the Group’s earnings due to changing market rates. Both the Group’s interest-bearing assets, consisting primarily of regulatory capital for counterparty risks within the exchange and clearing operations, and interest-bearing liabilities are exposed to interest-rate risks. The speed with which a permanent change in interest rates can impact the Group’s net financial income depends on the fixed-interest terms of investments and loans.

 

15


Fixed-interest terms for the Group liabilities are short as stipulated in the Financial Policy. According to the Financial Policy, interest swaps and standardized interest futures are used to change the length of fixed-interest terms, thereby minimizing interest-rate risk.

According to OMX’s Financial Policy, the average fixed-interest term for regulatory capital for exchange and clearing operations is a maximum of three years. As a rule, other surplus liquidity is placed in investments with short fixed-interest terms. At year-end, net financial debt amounted to SEK 847 million (net debt: SEK 572 million, net asset: SEK 155 million). Financial assets as per December 31, 2006 amounted to SEK 950 million (1,334, 1,517) and the average effective rate of interest for these assets was 3.70%, while the fixed-interest term was approximately 1.2 years. Interest-bearing securities that are retained are booked at fair value. At year-end, interest-bearing financial liabilities amounted to SEK 1,797 million (1,906, 1,362), of which SEK 1,350 million (1,400, 700) are long-term (see table: Interest-bearing assets and liabilities). During the year, the average fixed-interest term for liabilities varied between two and four months. As per December 31, the fixed-interest term for borrowings was three months and the effective rate was 3.33%. The interest-bearing financial liabilities are not booked at fair value since the liabilities are to be held until maturity. The exceptions are bonds which have been hedged by using fixed-income derivatives. These fixed-income derivatives are defined as hedging of fair value and fulfill the requirements for hedge accounting. The fixed income derivative agreements are reported in the income statement together with changes in fair value of the asset or liability that gave rise to the hedged risk (see table below in (C)(iv): Hedge relations).

In the event of a parallel shift in the Swedish and foreign yield curves upward by one percentage point, the Group’s earnings would be negatively affected in an amount of SEK 23 million on an annualized basis, given the nominal amount and the fixed-interest terms prevailing on December 31, 2006.

(c) Financing risks

Financing risk refers to the risk that costs will be higher and financing possibilities limited when a loan is to be refinanced, and that it will not be possible to fulfill payment obligations due to insufficient liquidity or difficulties in obtaining financing. The Financial Policy specifies that unutilized credit facilities of sufficient size must exist to guarantee access to adequate funds. Financing risk is also dealt with by endeavoring to find a suitable balance between short and long-term financing and a diversification between various forms of financing and markets. OMX’s total granted credit facilities as per December 31, 2006 amounted to SEK 3,741 million (3,033, 3,067), of which SEK 30 million (0, 14) has been utilized (see table below in (E): Credit facilities).

Of OMX’s credit facilities, SEK 2,100 million is a syndicated credit facility with a three-year term. One portion, SEK 1,500 million, is linked to the company’s commercial paper program for the same amount and, if OMX is unable to issue the commercial papers, entitles the company to borrow capital in the amount of SEK 1,500 million. There is also a credit facility for approximately a year of SEK 1,200 million which is dedicated to liquidity requirements linked to the Stockholm Stock Exchange’s clearing operations. Financial conditions linked to these credit facilities will be applied if OMX receives a credit rating from Standard & Poor’s of BBB or below.

OMX’s rating with Standard & Poor’s remained unchanged during the year (with a long-term counterparty rating of “A with a stable outlook,” a short-term counterparty rating of A-1, and a rating of K1 on the Nordic scale).

During the year, a two-year bond of SEK 300 million was repaid and an eight-year bond of SEK 250 million was issued. This has resulted in the expansion and diversification of the Group’s total maturity structure of its liability portfolio. The average term of liabilities as per December 31, 2006 was 3.4 years (3.1). There are five bond loans totaling SEK 1,350 million (see table: Interest-bearing assets and liabilities).

 

16


(d) Credit and counterparty risks

The Group’s financial transactions give rise to credit risks towards financial counterparties. Credit risk or counterparty risk refers to the risk of loss if the counterparty does not fulfill its obligations. There are credit risks when investing in cash equivalents. In accordance with the Financial Policy, in the interest of limiting risk exposure, only investments in highly creditworthy securities with high liquidity are permitted.

A majority of the Group’s outstanding investments at year-end were in securities issued by the Swedish Government. The Group has no significant concentration of credit exposure to any other individual counterparty.

The derivative instruments that OMX uses involve a counterparty risk, that is, that the counterparty will not fulfill its portion of the agreement relating to futures or options. In order to limit counterparty risk, only counterparties with a high degree of creditworthiness according to the adopted Financial Policy are accepted. OMX also uses an ISDA agreement to minimize counterparty risk. The total counterparty risk related to financial transactions amounted to SEK 409 million as per December 31, 2006, including bank balances but excluding counterparty risk attributable to the Stockholm Stock Exchange’s clearing operations (see below) and collateral funds invested in Swedish Government securities. The largest exposure to an individual institution amounted to SEK 97 million.

No single OMX customer was responsible for more than 20% of invoicing as of December 31, 2006. Counterparty risk arises by the Stockholm Stock Exchange providing clearing services and thereby acts as the central counterparty in all contracts subject to counterparty clearing. For the purpose of minimizing this counterparty risk, the Stockholm Stock Exchange requires that the counterparties pledge collateral to guarantee fulfillment of their commitments to the Stockholm Stock Exchange. Pledged collateral amounts to SEK 15,458 million (11,533, 10,245) (see Note 29 Collateral received by OMX’s exchange operations). None of the members of the Stockholm Stock Exchange accounted for more than 15% of the total exposure on December 31, 2006.

(ii) Hedging of employee stock option program

In order to limit costs for the programs if the share price were to increase, limit dilution and ensure that shares can be provided when options are exercised, an agreement has previously been made with an external party regarding the provision of OMX shares, known as an equity swap. The agreement is valid until June 30, 2009 and corresponds to approximately 400,000 shares at an agreed price of SEK 126 per share. The equity swap agreement covers the portion of outstanding employee stock options that are currently deemed likely to be exercised. The amount of the equity swap will be continuously adjusted so that it corresponds to the number of employee stock options that are expected to be utilized.

OMX continuously pays interest compensation to the counterparty in exchange for the counterparty undertaking to provide the shares. Interest compensation in the agreement corresponds to the net amount of interest expenses on the underlying value of the shares when the agreement was signed and the dividend on the underlying shares (approximately 400,000). Interest expenses are based on a STIBOR of 90 days.

Changes in OMX’s share price affect the value of the equity swap. These changes in fair value are reported in the income statement.

(iii) Hedging of share match program

In order to limit expenses for the program in the event of an increase in the share price and to ensure that shares can be provided when shares are matched in the Share Match Program, OMX has signed an equity-swap agreement amounting to approximately 57,000 shares at a predetermined price of SEK 146 per share. The equity swap covers the portion of shares that are expected to be allotted at the end of the program and will be

 

17


continuously adjusted so that it corresponds to the number of shares that are expected to be allotted. The share swap is reported as an equity instrument in accordance with IAS 32.

OMX has also signed an equity-swap agreement amounting to 18,000 shares at a predetermined price of SEK 123.50 in order to limit the expenses for the social security contributions arising in conjunction with the Share Match Program. Changes in the price of OMX’s shares affect the value of the share swap. These changes in fair value are reported in the income statement.

OMX continuously pays interest compensation to the counterparty in exchange for the counterparty undertaking to provide the shares. Interest compensation in the agreement corresponds to the net amount of interest expenses on the underlying value of the shares when the agreement was signed and the dividend on the underlying shares. Interest expenses are based on a STIBOR of 90 days.

Following the Annual General Meeting’s approval of the Board’s proposal regarding authorization to repurchase shares, OMX replaced the equity swap utilized for hedging the Share Match program with the purchase of own shares.

(iv) Calculation of fair value

The fair value of financial instruments that are traded in an active market is based on quoted market prices on the closing date.

The fair value of financial instruments that are not traded in an active market is determined by applying generally accepted valuation techniques. The Group uses a number of different methods and makes assumptions based on the market conditions that prevail on the closing date. Quoted market prices or quotes by brokers for similar instruments are used for long-term liabilities. Other techniques, such as calculation of discounted cash flows, are used to determine the fair value of the remaining financial instruments. The fair value of interest swaps is calculated as the present value of the estimated future cash flows. The fair value of currency forwards is determined based on market prices for currency forwards on the closing date.

The par value of accounts receivable and accounts payable, less any estimated credits, is assumed to correspond to their fair value. The fair value of financial liabilities is calculated by discounting the future contracted cash flow to the current market rate of interest available to the Group for similar financial instruments.

(C) Currency Exposure

(i) Transaction Exposure

The table shows the Group’s commercial future net flows and net exposure as at December 31, 2006. A sensitivity analysis shows the effect on earnings of a plus or minus 5% change in the value of the SEK.

 

Currency

   Net flow in each
base currency
(millions)
   Future net flow
December 31, 2006
(in millions of
SEK)
   Net exposure
after hedging
(in millions
of SEK)
    Sensitivity
base
(in millions
of SEK)
 

AUD/SEK

   7.5    40.6    (48.6 )   (2.4 )

EUR/SEK

   21.7    195.8    0.0     0.0  

GBP/SEK

   1.1    15.2    (2.3 )   (0.1 )

NOK/SEK

   121.6    133.5    3.4     (0.2 )

SGD/SEK

   4.9    22.0    0.0     0.0  

USD/SEK

   27.2    187.0    (24.8 )   (1.2 )
                    

TOTAL

      594.1    (72.3 )   (3.9 )
                    

 

18


(ii) Hedging of Transaction Exposure

The table shows a summary of outstanding futures as per December 31, 2006 pertaining to all hedges for commercial flows and transaction exposure. The purpose of the hedges is to safeguard the value of contracted future flows and to increase forecastability. In accordance with the Group’s Financial Policy, 100% of the contracted flows and 0–100% of estimated flows of up to 12 months shall be hedged. Deviations from the prescribed degree of hedging are permitted within the established guidelines. Currency hedging is undertaken in the market through currency futures, option contracts or loans in foreign currencies.

 

Currency

   Hedged in each
base currency
(millions)
    Nominal value
at year-end rate
(in millions of
SEK)
    Nominal value
at forward rate
(in millions of
SEK)
    Unrealized
forward result
(in millions of
SEK)
   Average
forward rate(1)
   Date of
maturity

AUD/SEK

   (16.5 )   (89.2 )   (89.5 )   0.3    5.4350    <12 months

EUR/SEK

   (21.7 )   (195.9 )   (199.5 )   3.6    9.2080    <12 months

GBP/SEK

   (1.3 )   (17.5 )   (17.5 )   —      13.4252    <12 months

NOK/SEK

   (118.6 )   (130.1 )   (130.4 )   0.3    1.0997    <12 months

SGD/SEK

   (4.9 )   (22.0 )   (22.3 )   0.3    4.5415    <12 months

USD/SEK

   (30.8 )   (211.7 )   (218.5 )   6.8    7.0843    <12 months
                        

TOTAL

     (666.4 )   (677.7 )   11.3      
                        

 

(1) The average forward rate is based on the spot rate in the forward contracts entered into. Thus, the forward premium is excluded.

(iii) Translation Exposure – Net Investments in Foreign Subsidiaries

The table shows foreign subsidiaries’ net assets in foreign operations and goodwill denominated in foreign currencies. Translation exposure is hedged in order to reduce the volatility in OMX’s key ratios. A sensitivity analysis shows the effect on results in the event of a plus or minus 5% change in the value of SEK.

 

Currency

   Equity     Goodwill    Hedging of net
investment
    Total
    Sensitivity
     (in millions of SEK)

AUD

   14.5     —      —       14.5     0.7

CAD

   2.0     —      —       2.0     0.1

DKK

   788.1     1,126.5    —       1,914.6     95.7

EUR

   1,746.5     1,304.2    (1,446.5 )   1,604.3     80.2

EEK

   27.8     2.2    —       30.0     1.5

GBP

   (204.5 )   —      —       (204.5 )   10.2

HKD

   (2.2 )   —      —       (2.2 )   0.1

ISK

   35.6     280.3    —       315.9     15.8

LTL

   (0.8 )   11.1    —       10.3     0.5

LVL

   9.4     1.0    —       10.4     0.5

NOK

   43.4     20.7    —       64.1     3.2

SGD

   4.3     —      —       4.3     0.2

USD

   (129.3 )   8.9    —       (120.4 )   6.0
                           

Total

   2,334.8     2,754.9    (1,446.5 )   3,643.3     214.7
                           

 

19


(iv) Hedging Relations

The table summarizes the hedging relations reported by the Group for which hedge accounting are applied. The type of hedging entered into is specified in the table. All currency hedges expire within 12 months. The hedging relation for interest swaps expires in December 2008.

 

Hedging

instrument

  Type of hedging   Hedged item   Currency   Hedged
amount
in base
currency
(millions)
    Nominal
value
at year-end
rate,
(in millions
of SEK)
    Nominal
value
at forward
rate,
(in millions
of SEK)
    Unrealized
forward
rate,
(in millions
of SEK)
    Average
forward
rate(1)

Currency future

  Fair value hedge   Contracted currency flows   AUD/SEK   (43.4 )   (234.8 )   (235.7 )   0.9     5.44

Currency future

  Cash-flow hedge   Forecast currency flows   AUD/SEK   26.9     145.6     146.2     (0.6 )   5.44

Currency future

  Fair value hedge   Contracted currency flows   EUR/SEK   (21.7 )   (195.9 )   (199.5 )   3.6     9.21

Currency future

  Hedge of net
investment
  Shareholders’ equity in
subsidiary
  EUR/SEK   (160.0 )   (1,446.5 )   (1,446.4 )   (0.1 )   9.04

Currency future

  Fair value hedge   Contracted currency flows   GBP/SEK   (2.0 )   (27.2 )   (27.1 )   (0.1 )   13.42

Currency future

  Cash-flow hedge   Forecast currency flows   GBP/SEK   0.7     9.7     9.7     —       13.42

Currency future

  Fair value hedge   Contracted currency flows   NOK/SEK   (57.8 )   (63.4 )   (63.6 )   0.1     1.10

Currency future

  Cash-flow hedge   Forecast currency flows   NOK/SEK   (60.8 )   (66.7 )   (66.8 )   0.2     1.10

Currency future

  Fair value hedge   Contracted currency flows   SGD/SEK   (4.9 )   (22.0 )   (22.3 )   0.3     4.54

Currency future

  Fair value hedge   Contracted currency flows   USD/SEK   (45.2 )   (310.6 )   (320.4 )   9.8     7.08

Currency future

  Cash-flow hedge   Forecast currency flows   USD/SEK   14.4     98.8     101.9     (3.0 )   7.08

Interest swap

  Fair value hedge   Issued bonds   SEK   200.0     200.0     N/A     2.7     N/A

 

(1) The average forward rate is based on the spot rate in the forward contracts entered into. Thus, the forward premium is excluded.

(v) Hedging of Financial Loans and Assets

The table shows a summary of the Group’s currency futures for hedging of financial assets and loans as at December 31, 2006.

 

Currency

   Hedged in each
base currency
(millions)
    Nominal value at
year end rate
(in millions of
SEK)
    Nominal value at
forward rate
(in millions of
SEK)
    Unrealized
forward result
(in millions of
SEK)
    Average
forward rate(1)
   Date of
maturity

AUD/SEK

   21.2     114.8     115.2     (0.3 )   5.43    < 12 months

CAD/SEK

   (0.8 )   (4.6 )   (4.6 )   —       5.96    < 12 months

DKK/SEK

   385.7     467.6     467.7     (0.1 )   1.21    < 12 months

EUR/SEK

   54.0     487.7     487.6     0.1     9.04    < 12 months

GBP/SEK

   (12.6 )   (169.4 )   (168.4 )   (1.1 )   13.38    < 12 months

HKD/SEK

   (4.0 )   (3.5 )   (3.5 )   —       0.88    < 12 months

NOK/SEK

   4.9     5.4     5.6     (0.2 )   1.13    < 12 months

SGD/SEK

   0.9     3.8     3.8     —       4.47    < 12 months

THB/SEK

   (8.0 )   (1.5 )   (1.5 )   —       0.19    < 12 months

USD/SEK

   7.5     51.5     51.1     0.4     6.82    < 12 months
                         

Total

     951.8     953.0     (1.2 )     
                         

 

(1) The average forward rate is based on the spot rate in the forward contracts entered into. Thus, the forward premium is excluded.

 

20


(D) Interest-Bearing Assets and Liabilities

The table shows interest-bearing assets and liabilities as per December 31, 2006 and shows average remaining terms, fixed-interest terms and average interest.

 

     Outstanding
amount
   Remaining term,
months
   Remaining fixed-
interest term,
months
   Average
interest rate,     %

Assets

           

Current assets

   182    <12    <12    3.93

Long-term assets

   21    >12    <12    4.40

Regulatory capital

   747    >12    >12    3.63
             

Total assets

   950          3.70
             

Liabilities

           

Commercial paper

   398    1    1    3.00

Bond loans

           

OMX PP March 2008

   300    15    2    3.29

OMX PP December 2008(1)

   200    24    3    4.00

OMX PP December 2009

   200    36    3    3.45

OMX PP May 2013

   400    77    4    3.51

OMX PP Nov 2014

   250    96    5    3.65
             

Bond loans, total

   1,350    53    3.5    3.55
             

Bank loans

   39         

Other

   10         
             

Total liabilities

   1,797    40    3.0    3.33
             

 

(1) The issued bond has been swapped from a fixed to a variable interest rate. The swapped interest rate is applied when calculating the average interest rate.

(E) Credit Facilities

The table shows the Group’s total credit facilities and those that had been utilized as at December 31, 2006.

 

(in millions of SEK)

   Contracted facilities     Utilized facilities

Syndicated bank loan/commercial paper program

   1,500 (1)  

Syndicated bank loan

   600    

Overdraft facility

   171     4

Credit facility

   135    

Contracted facilities for exchange and clearing operations

    

Sweden (SEK)

   1,200    

Norway (NOK)

   44    

Denmark (DKK)

   24    

UK (GBP)

   67     26
          

Total

   3,741     30
          

 

(1) Since the credit facility is linked to the commercial paper program and is to function as a credit facility if OMX is unable to issue a commercial paper program, the unutilized credit facility shall be reduced by the outstanding commercial paper. The outstanding commercial paper as per December 31, 2006 amounted to SEK 400 million, implying that OMX can utilize only SEK 1,100 million of the current credit facility.

 

21


NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Amounts are in SEK millions (SEK m) unless otherwise stated. Amounts in parentheses indicate values for 2005. “OMX” refers to the OMX Group, that is OMX AB and its subsidiaries.

NOTE 1. USE OF ESTIMATES

In order to prepare the accounting in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, company management and the Board of Directors are required to make assessments and assumptions that affect asset and liability items, income and expense items, and other information reported in the accounts, for example contingent liabilities. These assessments are based on historical experience and the various assumptions that management and the Board deem to be reasonable under the prevailing circumstances. Consequently, such conclusions form the basis of decisions concerning reported values of assets and liabilities in the case that it is not possible to determine such values based on information from other sources. Actual outcomes may differ from these assessments if different assumptions are made or if different circumstances prevail. The areas of revenue recognition and doubtful receivables, the valuation of goodwill and capitalized development projects, taxes, provisions for expenses for premises and other restructuring measures, legal disputes and contingent liabilities in particular may entail a significant impact on OMX’s results and financial position (see the respective following Notes for further information).

NOTE 2. CLASSIFICATION OF REVENUE

The classification of revenue is based on a number of assessments and assumptions concerning revenue recognition in delivery projects in the Technology operations. These are reported as “License, support and project revenue” below. The uncertainty inherent in these assessments primarily refers to the forecast time of completion.

REVENUE PER SIGNIFICANT TYPE OF REVENUE, CONTINUING OPERATIONS

 

(SEK m)    2006    2005
Net sales:      

Trading revenue

   1,291    1,108

Issuers’ revenue

   343    309

Information revenue

   443    367

Revenue from Baltic Markets

   68    63

Revenue from Broker Services

   205    258

License, support and project revenue

   758    716

Facility Management Services

   200    222

Other revenue

   178    51

Total

   3,486    3,094
CAPITAL GAINS WITHIN OTHER REVENUES, CONTINUING OPERATIONS
Group    2006    2005

Capital gains, sale of NOS ASA

   22    —  

Capital gains, sale of VPC AB

   83    —  

Total

   105    —  

CURRENCY EFFECTS

The Group’s total revenue includes exchange-rate differences totaling negative SEK 7 m (positive: 17). Exchange-rate differences also had an effect on operating expenses of SEK 0 m(0, negative: 2).

NOTE 3. BUSINESS AREAS AND GEOGRAPHIC SEGMENTS

Internal reporting and follow-up within OMX is organized based on the business areas Nordic Marketplaces, Information Services & New Markets and Market Technology.

        These business areas make up OMX’s primary reporting segments while the geographic divisions make up the secondary reporting segment. OMX is divided into four geographic regions: Nordic countries, Rest of Europe, North America and Asia/Australia. This geographic division is based on the areas in which the Group’s operations have relatively similar systems solutions, frameworks of regulations and customer behavior.

REVENUE AND EARNINGS BY DIVISION, CONTINUING OPERATIONS

 

(SEK m)    2006     2005  
Revenue     

Nordic Marketplaces

   1,778     1,510  

Information Services & New Markets

   752     709  

Market Technology

   1,300     1,155  

Group eliminations

   (344 )   (280 )

TOTAL GROUP

   3,486     3,094  
Operating income     

Nordic Marketplaces1)

   940     689  

Information Services & New Markets1)

   217     176  

Market Technology1)

   93     61  

Result from participations in associated companies attributable to the Parent Company and other functions

   —       1  

TOTAL GROUP

   1,250     927  

 

1)

Including distribution of income for the Parent Company and other functions by SEK 15 m (loss: 117, loss: 256).

 

22


ASSETS AND LIABILITIES PER BUSINESS AREA

 

      2006    2005
(SEK m)    Assets    Liabilities    Assets    Liabilities

Nordic Marketplaces

   8,439    5,099    6,310    2,723

Information Services & New Markets

   417    72    302    135

Market Technology

   2,655    1,128    2,000    907

Operations being discontinued

   70    —      62    —  

Unallocated items

   947    1,615    1,938    2,098

TOTAL GROUP

   12,528    7,914    10,612    5,863

Items per business area are tangible assets, intangible assets, external operating receivables, external operating liabilities and goodwill. Other items are not allocated in the Group and are reported as unallocated items. Unallocated items also include all eliminations of internal business dealings between the various business areas and all interest-bearing liabilities. Assets and liabilities that could be affected by the business areas are allocated in accordance with OMX’s business control model, which does not support a full distribution of balance-sheet items.

INVESTMENTS, DEPRECIATION AND IMPAIRMENT PER BUSINESS AREA

 

      2006    2005
(SEK m)    Invest.    Deprec./
impairment
   Invest.    Deprec./
impairment

Nordic Marketplaces

   294    -70    1,389    -83

Information Services & New Markets

   19    -22    12    -21

Market Technology

   529    -132    318    -122

TOTAL GROUP

   842    -224    1,719    -226

Investments refer to acquisitions of tangible and intangible fixed assets. For further information on acquisitions, depreciation and impairment, see Notes 13 and 14.

INFORMATION REGARDING SECONDARY SEGMENTS

(GEOGRAPHIC AREAS), CONTINUING OPERATIONS

EXTERNAL REVENUE PER GEOGRAPHIC AREA1)

 

(SEK m)    2006    2005

Nordic countries

   2,134    2,005

Rest of Europe

   886    600

North America

   146    186

Asia/Australia

   340    303

TOTAL GROUP

   3,486    3,094

 

1)

Based on the location of customers.

ASSETS AND INVESTMENTS PER GEOGRAPHIC AREA

 

      2006    2005
\(SEK m)    Assets    Invest.    Assets    Invest.

Nordic countries

   5,581    788    3,620    1,673

Rest of Europe

   1,269    45    1,128    43

North America

   103    5    152    0

Asia/Australia

   26    4    22    3

Group eliminations and unallocated items1)

   5,549    —      5,690    —  

TOTAL GROUP

   12,528    842    10,612    1,719

 

1)

Group eliminations and unallocated items include goodwill in the amount of SEK 2,967 m (2,944).

Investments refer to acquisitions of tangible and intangible fixed assets.

NOTE 4. DISCONTINUING OPERATIONS

In August 2005, OMX announced the focusing of its technology operations through the divestment of operations targeting banks and brokerages within the former Banks & Brokers business area. During 2006, the continuing operations not yet divested were included among discontinuing operations. These primarily comprise the Nordic portion of the operations targeting banks and brokerages, which offer development and maintenance of systems for securities management, and the UK operations in securities administration services.

After the end of the reporting period, OMX signed an agreement with HCL Technologies, the global IT services provider, regarding an extended partnership, which means that OMX no longer has any discontinuing operations in the Nordic region. The partnership means that HCL Technologies will assume the responsibility for the development of systems for securities management targeting banks and brokers and that the remaining part of the Nordic operations, will be moved to the Information Services & New Markets business area, and will be included in the Broker Services unit. The statements for discontinuing operations has been adjusted compared with the 2006 Annual Report since only the UK sales operations in securities administration services remain as discontinuing operations.

OMX’s aim is to identify a long-term solution with clear advantages for the remaining parts of the discontinuing operations. Discussions are currently in progress with potential partners.

Income statement, discontinuing operations

 

(in millions of SEK)

   2006     2005  

Revenues

    

Net Sales

   124     42  

Own work capitalized

     —    

Other revenues

     —    
        

Total revenues

   124     42  

Expenses

    

Premises expenses

   (6 )   (2 )

Marketing expenses

   —       —    

Consultancy expenses

   —       —    

Operations and maintenance, IT

   (16 )   (7 )

Other external expenses

   (56 )   (29 )

Personnel expenses

   (77 )   (20 )

Depreciation and impairment

   (-8 )   (1 )
            

Total expenses

   (163 )   (59 )

Participation in earnings of ass. Companies

   —       —    
            

Operating income

   (39 )   (17 )

Financial items

    

Financial items

   (7 )   —    
            

Total financial items

   (7 )   —    
            

Income/loss after financial items

   (46 )   (17 )
            

Tax for the year

   —       —    

Net profit/loss for the period

   (46 )   (17 )
            

Assets classified as holdings held for sale

 

(SEK m)    2006    2005
Group      

Intangible assets

   61    53

Tangible fixed assets

   9    9

Total fixed assets held for sale

   70    62

NOTE 5. ACQUIRED OPERATIONS

COMPUTERSHARE

On January 31,2006, OMX signed a contract with Computershare Ltd regarding the acquisition of Computershare’s Market Technology operations in the amount of SEK 249 m. Payment will be paid in cash over a period of five years. The acquisition price has been discounted to present value. Acquisition costs amounted to SEK 5 m. The acquired operations are consolidated within OMX effective February 1, 2006.

 

(SEK m)    Fair value    Book value

Acquired net assets

   69    75

Goodwill

   180     

ACQUISITION PRICE

   249   

The acquired net assets comprise marketplace systems. Goodwill is attributable to the revenue and cost synergies that arose in conjunction with the integration with Market Technology. It is not possible in practical terms to provide disclosure regarding Computershare’s revenues and net income during the period since the operations have been fully consolidated with Market Technology’s operations since February 1.

EIGNARHALDSFELAGID VERDBREFATHING

On November 30, 2006, OMX acquired 100 percent of Eignarhaldsfelagid Verdbrefathing (EV) for a total amount of SEK 314 m, of which SEK 41 m was paid in cash and SEK 256 m was paid by 2,067,560 newly issued shares. The acquisition cost totaled SEK 17 m.

EV is consolidated into OMX’s income statement and balance sheet from December 1, 2006. The price of the new shares issued by OMX, which were utilized in the acquisition of EV, was SEK 123.75 on November 30.

 

23


ACQUIRED ASSETS AND LIABILITIES

 

(SEK m)    Fair
value
   Book
value

Fixed assets

   149    9

Current assets

   19    19

Cash and bank balances

   33    33

Current liabilities

   -22    -22

ACQUIRED NET ASSETS

   179    39

Goodwill

   135   

ACQUISITION PRICE

   314   

The difference between fair value and the carrying amount of fixed assets is primarily attributable to the valuation of acquired contracts.

Goodwill is attributable to the high level of profitability in the company and expected revenue synergies arising from the continued integration of the Nordic-Baltic securities market.

The cash-flow effect of the acquisition amounts to SEK 25 m, comprising a cash payment of SEK 41 m, acquisition costs of SEK 17 m, less received cash balances of SEK 33 m. Of the total amount of acquisition costs of SEK 17 m, only SEK 11 m had an effect on cash flow in 2006. The remaining SEK 6 m will impact cash flow in 2007. The new shares issued are valued at market value on the acquisition date.

During the year, EV contributed SEK 11 m to the Group’s revenue and SEK 5 m to net profit. EV’s revenue for the full-year 2006 amounts to SEK 102 m and net profit to SEK 26 m.

2005

At the beginning of 2005, OMX acquired 100% of Copenhagen Stock Exchange (CSE) at a value totaling SEK 1,457 million, of which SEK 1,174 million was paid in cash and SEK 232 million was paid in 2,927,292 newly-issued shares. Acquisition costs amounted to SEK 33 million.

Copenhagen Stock Exchange (CSE) has been included in the consolidated income statement and consolidated balance sheet since January 1, 2005 when it became known that the offer was to be accepted and the work to integrate the company was initiated. The newly-issued shares in OMX, which were utilized in the acquisition of CSE, were valued at a share price of SEK 79 on February 7, 2005.

Acquired assets and liabilities

 

(in millions of SEK)

   Fair value     Book value  

Fixed assets

   350     107  

Current assets

   80     80  

Cash and bank balances

   307     307  

Current liabilities

   (187 )   (187 )
            

Acquired Net Assets

   550     307  
            

Goodwill

   907    
        

Acquisition Price

   1,457    
        

The difference between fair value and the reported values of fixed assets is primarily attributable to the valuation of acquired contracts.

Goodwill is attributable to the company’s positive profitability and expected revenue synergy effects in conjunction with the continued integration of the Nordic-Baltic securities market.

Cash-flow effects of the acquisition amount to SEK 900 million, comprising a cash payment of SEK 1,174 million, acquisition costs of SEK 33 million, minus received cash and bank balances of SEK 307 million. Newly-issued shares are valued at market capitalization on acquisition date.

CSE contributed SEK 377 million to the Group’s revenues and SEK 131 million to net results during the year.

NOTE 6. AUDITORS’ FEES

 

The following remuneration was paid to auditors and accounting firms for auditing and audit-related services required by law as well as for advice and other assistance arising from observations made during the course of the auditing process.

Remuneration was also paid for additional independent advice, mostly pertaining to audit-related consultations on accounting and taxation issues.

REMUNERATION TO THE GROUP’S AUDITORS

 

      GROUP
(SEK 000s)    2006    2005
PricewaterhouseCoopers      

Auditing assignments

   10,729    9,022

Other assignments1)

   2,337    11,548
Ernst & Young      

Auditing assignments

   488    713

Other assignments2)

   918    3,452
KPMG      

Auditing assignments

   335    422

Other assignments

   378    730
BDO Feinstein      

Auditing assignments

   36    118

Other assignments

   —      21
Other auditors      

Auditing assignments

   780    315

Other assignments

   310    1,605

TOTAL

   16,311    27,946

 

1)

For 2006, other assignments refer primarily to tax consultations. For 2005, includes SEK 1,334,000 related to IFRS and costs in connection with the acquisition of CSE and Computershare of SEK 4,612,000. Otherwise, other assignments in 2005 pertain primarily to tax consultation.

 

2)

For 2006, other assignments refer primarily to tax consultations and IT reviews. For 2005, other assignments refer mainly to IFRS, tax consultation and IT studies.

NOTE 7. PERSONNEL

PERSONNEL EXPENSES AND BENEFITS PAID TO SENIOR EXECUTIVES

The reporting of senior executive benefits has been carried out in accordance with the recommendations of the Swedish Industry and Commerce Stock Exchange Committee (NBK).

SENIOR MANAGEMENT

NBK divides senior management into two categories: “top management” and “other senior management.” Top management comprises: the Chairman of the Board, any Board members receiving remuneration in addition to Board fees and the President and Chief Executive Officer (CEO). Other senior management normally relates to members of the executive management team.

Top management at OMX is defined as:

 

 

Olof Stenhammar (Chairman of the Board)

 

 

Magnus Böcker (CEO of OMX and President of OMX AB).

Other senior management at OMX is defined as the Group’s Executive Management Team and comprises the following five individuals:

 

 

Jukka Ruuska (President of Nordic Marketplaces)

 

 

Hans-Ole Jochumsen (President of Information Services and New Markets)

 

 

Markus Gerdien (President of Market Technology)

 

 

Kristina Schauman (Chief Financial Officer)

 

 

Bo Svefors (Senior Vice President Marketing & Communications).

The Secretary to the Executive Management Team was OMX’s General Counsel Magnus Billing.

OMX’S REMUNERATION COMMITTEE

The Remuneration Committee is appointed on an annual basis by the Board of Directors. The Remuneration Committee’s task is to prepare remuneration matters for Board decisions on issues relating to the salary and remuneration paid to the President and CEO, and to approve salaries and other remuneration to Executive Management Team which is subsequently reported to the Board. The Committee also approves the targets for the Executive Management Team established by the President. In addition, the Remuneration Committee’s task is to propose remuneration for the Board members in the subsidiaries within the OMX Group that have external Board members, and to make recommendations regarding remuneration principles, benefits and other types of remuneration for OMX employees. The Board appointed the following people as members of the Remuneration Committee: Olof Stenhammar (Chairman), Adine Grate Axén and Bengt Halse. The Committee’s secretary until April 2006 was Ulrika Wahllöf, acting Head of Human Resources. The Committee’s secretary during the remainder of the year was Pernilla Gladh, Senior Vice President of Corporate Functions & Human Resources. During 2006, the Remuneration Committee held a total of seven meetings at which minutes were taken. Among other matters during the year, the Committee had a particular focus on the following issues: programs for variable salaries 2006 and 2007 (Short Term Incentive), the Share Match Program 2006 and 2007 for senior executives (Long Term Incentive Scheme), remuneration to the President and proposals for principles for remuneration and other conditions of employment for the Executive Management Team.

OMX’S REMUNERATION POLICY

The aim of OMX’s remuneration policy is to offer market-based remuneration that is competitive and that promotes a situation whereby qualified expertise can be recruited to and retained within OMX.

The fundamental principles are:

 

 

To work towards a consensus between employees and shareholders regarding the long-term perspective of operations.

 

 

To ensure that employees within OMX’s different organizations receive remuneration that reflects market conditions and is competitive.

 

 

To offer a salary scale based on results achieved, work duties, skills, experience and position held, which also means adopting a neutral stance in relation to gender, ethnic background, disability, sexual orientation, etc.

 

24


REMUNERATION STRUCTURE 2006

OMX’s employee remuneration comprises the following parts:

 

 

Fixed salary

 

 

Variable salary

- Short Term Incentive Program

- Long Term Incentive Scheme (OMX Share Match Program 2006 and 2007)

 

 

Pension

 

 

Severance pay and other benefits.

At the discretion of the Board of Directors, decisions can be made to revise or terminate an existing program related to the remuneration structure.

FIXED SALARY

Every OMX employee has an annual salary review, with the exception of the members of the Executive Management Team, for whom a review takes place every second year and the President, for whom a review takes places every third year. The review considers employee performance, salary levels in the market and any changes to responsibilities as well as the company’s development and local rules and agreements.

VARIABLE SALARY

Short Term Incentive Program

OMX has had a Group-wide program for variable salary called OMX Short Term Incentive Program since 2004. The program consists of quantitative (financial) and qualitative (individual) goals. The prerequisite for achieving the quantitative goal is that OMX attained its established targets. The maximum dividend of the quantitative portion occurs at 130-percent fulfillment of the company’s goals. The qualitative goals are individual and are determined by an employee’s immediate superior during the first quarter of the year. The immediate superior also evaluates whether these goals have been achieved one year later.

Short Term Incentive 2006

The program for variable salary, Short Term Incentive 2006, comprised approximately 150 managers and key employees. The total maximum variable portion that can be paid out for 2006 is SEK 35 m, excluding social security contributions. The program comprised quantitative and qualitative targets, of which 60 percent were quantitative and 40 percent were qualitative. The quantitative goal for 2006 was connected to achievement of the budgeted operating income for OMX. Of the maximum SEK 21 m representing the quantitative portion, SEK 11.5 m will be paid out. The estimated payment for the qualitative portion is calculated at 75 percent of the maximum of SEK 14m, excluding social security contributions for 2006.

Short Term Incentive 2007

Variable salary 2007 follows the same structure for 2006. The program comprises quantitative and qualitative targets, of which 60 percent are quantitative and 40 percent are qualitative. The quantitative goal for 2007 is also connected to achievement of the budgeted operating income for OMX. OMX Short Term Incentive 2007 has been expanded to encompass 200 managers and key employees, compared with 150 employees in 2006. The total maximum variable portion that can be paid out for 2007 is SEK 43 m, excluding social security contributions. The prerequisites for the payment of bonuses follow the same guidelines as for 2005 and 2006.

The maximum bonus to senior executives for variable salary for 2004-2007 is 50 percent of fixed salary. The quantitative goals are linked to OMX’s return on capital employed and budgeted operating profit.

Long Term Incentive Scheme

OMX Share Match Program 2006

OMX’s Annual General Meeting in April 2006 approved the OMX Share Match Program 2006. The program for 2006 was directed to 30 senior executives and key individuals in OMX. Participants in the program are required to invest in OMX shares at a maximum of 7.5 percent of their fixed salary on an annual basis before tax or the maximum amount earned under the Short Term Incentive program in 2005 after tax. Under the prerequisite that employment is not terminated, the participants in the program will receive up to five OMX shares, known as matching shares, in 2009, for each invested OMX share, if the following conditions have been fulfilled:

 

(i) The average percentage increase in earnings per share between January 1, 2006 and December 31, 2008 is equal to or exceeds twenty five (25) percent, and

 

(ii) the total annual return to shareholders is equal to or exceeds an index determined by the Board, plus 10 percentage points.

No matching shares will be issued if the average annual percentage increase in earnings per share falls below two percent per year or if the total annual return to shareholders has not improved on the comparative index.

OMX Share Match Program 2007

At the Annual General Meeting of OMX on April 12, 2007, the shareholders approved the proposal of OMX’s Board of Directors to continue and expand the share match program for senior executives for a second year. The program for 2007 is targeted at 95 senior executives and key individuals in OMX. Participants in the program are required to invest in OMX shares at a maximum of 7.5 percent of their fixed salary on an annual basis before tax or the maximum amount earned under the Short Term Incentive program in 2006 after tax. Approximately 30 of the 95 participants may invest in OMX shares at a maximum of 15 percent of their fixed salary on an annual basis before tax or the maximum amount earned under the Short Term Incentive program in 2006 aftertax. Under the prerequisite that employment is not terminated, the participants in the program will receive in 2010 up to five OMX shares, known as matching shares, for each invested OMX share. President and CEO Magnus Böcker may invest a maximum of 10,000 OMX shares with a maximum matching level of eight OMX shares. For maximum matching, the following conditions must be fulfilled:

 

(i) The average percentage increase in earnings per share between January 1, 2007 and December 31, 2009 is equal to or exceeds twenty percent, and

 

(ii) the total annual return to shareholders is equal to or exceeds an index determined by the Board, plus 10 percent.

No matching shares will be issued if the average annual percentage increase in earnings per share falls below two percent per year or if the total annual return to shareholders has not improved on the comparative index.

PENSIONS

OMX offers its employees a defined-contribution occupational pension unless otherwise regulated in local agreements or other regulations. OMX’s pension plan for employees in Sweden has been created to provide employees with a market-competitive occupational pension. The age of retirement is 65 years. OMX’s President and CEO Magnus Böcker receives a defined-contribution pension benefit. The total premium provision amounts to 23 percent of fixed salary. For 2007, the pension premium is up to 30 percent of fixed salary.

Other members of the Executive Management Team are included in the OMX pension plan, with the exception of Jukka Ruuska and Hans-Ole Jochumsen. Jukka Ruuska is included in the pension plan stipulated by the Finnish labor market regulations. Current premiums for Jukka Ruuska are equivalent to a pension provision of 17 percent of total remuneration. Hans-Ole Jochumsen, is included in the pension plan stipulated by Danish labor market practice. Current premiums for Hans-Ole Jochumsen are equivalent to a pension provision of 20 percent of fixed remuneration.

The retirement age for employees, including the President and CEO and the Executive Management Team is 65 years.

SEVERANCE PAY AND OTHER BENEFITS

Severance Terms/Period of Notice

The period of notice that applies between OMX and the President and CEO is 12 months from the company’s side and six months from the employee’s side. In the event of a company initiative to terminate the employment contract of the President and CEO, remuneration will be paid to the President and CEO corresponding to the fixed salary and other benefits (occupational pension and insurance including health insurance) during the period of notice. In addition to this, the President and CEO will receive a severance payment of six months’ fixed salary. Other members of the Executive Management Team have a period of notice of 12 months from the company’s side and six months from the employee’s side. The President and CEO and other senior executives have a non-competition clause of 12 months. A penalty is included in the clause.

Other Benefits

In addition to the occupational pension premiums detailed above, OMX also pays for long-term disability insurance, occupational group life insurance (TGL) and workers’ compensation insurance (TFA). Employees may also complement their insurance coverage through OMX’s optional group insurance. Employees in Finland and Denmark have equivalent benefits that are stipulated in the collective agreement for the financial sector. Also, the Executive Managment Team is entitled to health insurance.

ABSENCE DUE TO ILLNESS

The number of employees on absence due to illness during the fiscal year is accounted for as a percentage of the employees’ total ordinary working hours in Sweden. Long-term absence due to illness is absence for 60 or more consecutive days.

 

25


ABSENCE DUE TO ILLNESS, SWEDEN, %    2006    2005

Total Absence due to illness

   2.3    2.4

Absence due to long-term illness (portion of total illness)

   41.7    46.8

Absence due to illness, men

   1.7    1.8

Absence due to illness, women

   3.6    3.2

Absence due to illness, employees under the age of 29

   1.5    1.4

Absence due to illness, employees aged between 30 and 49

   2.4    2.4

Absence due to illness, employees aged 50 and above

   2.3    2.3

DISTRIBUTION ACCORDING TO GENDER

 

      2006
Number of whom men
   2005
Number of whom men

Board of Directors (excl. CEO) 1)

           

Parent Company

   8    6    9    7

Subsidiaries

   85    76    71    66

TOTAL GROUP

   93    82    80    73

 

1)

Pertains to the number of Board members in the Group’s operating companies.

DISTRIBUTION ACCORDING TO GENDER (CONTIN.)

 

      2006
Number of whom men
   2005
Number of whom men

Group management (incl. CEO) 2)

           

Parent Company

   6    5    7    6

Subsidiaries

   62    46    53    40

TOTAL GROUP

   68    51    60    46

 

2)

Group management is defined as all presidents in the Group’s operating companies, persons who are members of the Executive Management Team and persons in the management groups within the OMX business areas.

 

     

2006

Number of whom men

  

2005

Number of whom men

Other employees

           

Parent Company

   28    12    20    5

Subsidiaries

   1,284    837    1,229    772

TOTAL GROUP

   1,312    849    1,249    777

REMUNERATION TO THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS AND THE EXECUTIVE MANAGEMENT TEAM

EXPENSED REMUNERATION

Board fees have not been paid to Board members who are employees of the Group. In addition to the Board fees below, Board fees totaling SEK 7 m (5) were paid during the year to subsidiary Board members. These fees have only been paid to persons who are not employees of the Group.

 

(SEK)          Board fees    Fixed salary    Variable salary    Pension    Benefits     TOTAL

Olof Stenhammar

   2006    800,000    —      —      —      543     800,543
   2005    750,000    —      —      —      9,197,314 1)   9,947,314

Magnus Böcker

   2006    —      4,646,117    1,665,000    1,007,400    1,969,353 3)   9,287,870
   2005    —      4,636,230    1,498,000    1,007,400    95,190     7,236,820

Executive Management, others 2)

   2006    —      12,260,008    4,955,000    2,459,845    128,787     19,803,640
   2005    —      13,908,558    3,888,040    2,453,046    636,117     20,885,761

Adine Grate Axén

   2006    400,000    —      —      —      —       400,000
   2005    300,000    —      —      —      —       300,000

Urban Bäckström

   2006    325,000    —      —      —      —       325,000
   2005    250,000    —      —      —      —       250,000

Bengt Halse

   2006    300,000    —      —      —      —       300,000
   2005    250,000    —      —      —      —       250,000

Birgitta Klasen

   2006    250,000    —      —      —      —       250,000
   2005    200,000    —      —      —      —       200,000

Tarmo Korpela

   2006    250,000    —      —      —      —       250,000
   2005    200,000    —      —      —      —       200,000

Henrik Normann

   2006    —      —      —      —      —       —  
   2005    33,333    —      —      —      —       33,333

Markku Pohjola

   2006    250,000    —      —      —      —       250,000
   2005    250,000    —      —      —      —       250,000

Timo Ihamuotila

   2006    —      —      —      —      —       —  
   2005    166,667    —      —      —      —       166,667

Mikael Lilius

   2006    —      —      —      —      —       —  
   2005    166,667    —      —      —      —       166,667

Hans Munk Nielsen

   2006    325,000    —      —      —      —       325,000
     2005    133,333    —      —      —      —       133,333

TOTAL

   2006    2,900,000    16,906,125    6,620,000    3,467,245    2,098,683     31,992,053

TOTAL

   2005    2,700,000    18,544,788    5,386,040    3,460,446    9,928,621     40,019,895

 

1)

Includes remuneration to one of Olof Stenhammar’s majority-owned companies comprising a fixed salary as well as a profit-related payment based on a license agreement. The profit-related portion represents 1 percent of OMX’s income after financial items. Remuneration for 2005 amounts to SEK 9,172,298. The amounts are paid out quarterly in arrears. The agreement, which was signed and stems from the founding of OM in 1985, has been terminated and expired on December 31, 2005.

 

2)

The other members of the Executive Management Team for 2006 includes: Jukka Ruuska, Kristina Schauman. Bo Svefors, Hans-Ole Jochumsen and Markus Gerdien.

 

3)

Refers primarily to the divestment of 37,000 employee stock options.

 

26


FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

 

      Employee stock options 1)    Share Match Program 2)
(Quantity)    2002    2001    2000     

Magnus Böcker

   0    76,000    150,000    4,615

Executive Management, others 3)

   0    0    0    10,023

TOTAL

   0    76,000    150,000    14,638

 

1)

For employee stock options, no consideration has been paid by employees who received options. For the theoretical value of the options at the time of issue, refer to the table below.

 

2)

Refers to the Share Match Program 2006.

 

3)

Refers to persons included in the Executive Management Team at December 31, 2006.

INFORMATION ON EACH YEAR’S EMPLOYEE STOCK OPTION PROGRAM

 

      2002    2001    2000

Strike price, SEK

   71    175    400

Redemption of shares with effect from

   July 2, 2003    June 15, 2002    May 25, 2001

Expiry date

   July 2, 2009    June 15, 2008    June 28, 2007

Number of allotted options

   733,000    1,100,000    1,400,000

Opening balance

   356,000    513,000    666,000

Exercised options

   155,000    —      —  

Expired and obsolete

   6,000    164,000    212,000

Closing balance

   195,000    349,000    454,000

Of which fully vested (guaranteed) (guaranteed) Dec 31, 2006

   195,000    349,000    454,000

Theoretical value, SEK m1)

   11    4    0

Theoretical value per option at issue1), SEK

   15    38    90

Theoretical value per option, SEK, as at Dec 31, 2006

   59    11    0

Theoretical dilution2), %

   0.2    0.3    0.4

Weighted average share price for redeemed employee stock options during the year

   131.66      

 

1)

The theoretical value of allotted options is fixed through an established options valuation model (Black & Scholes) at the time they are allotted. As at December 31, 2006, a volatility of 40 percent has been utilized.

 

2)

Theoretical dilution refers to the maximum number of shares that could be issued were it decided, on execution of redemption, to allot shares through a new share issue. However, to limit such dilution, hedging has been arranged through a “share swap,” meaning that no such dilution will occur.

OPENING AMOUNT OF NON-REDEEMED PORTION OF THE EMPLOYEE STOCK OPTIONS PROGRAM IN THE INCOME STATEMENT

 

(SEK m)    2006    2005

Income statement

     

Social security expenses attributable to personnel expenses

   1    -1

Interest attributable to agreements on synthetic share buy-back

   -2    -2

Change in value, employee stock options

   3    -6

Change in value, share swap

   15    35

Balance sheet

     

Liability pertaining to employee stock options program

   15    19

Liability, social security expenses, employee stock options program

   4    5

Receivable pertaining to share swap1)

   1    68

 

1)

The opening balance for 2005, recalculated in accordance with IAS 39, amounted to SEK 33 m.

In accordance with IFRS 2, the expenses for the stock options program are reported on an ongoing basis as personnel expenses in the income statement.

In order to limit costs for the programs (including social security contributions) if the share price were to increase, limit dilution and ensure that shares can be provided when redemption is requested, an agreement has previously been made with an external party regarding the provision of OMX shares if redemption were to be requested, known as a share swap. The agreement is valid until June 30, 2009 and corresponds to approximately 400,000 shares at an agreed price of SEK 126 per share. The buy-back agreement covers the portion of outstanding employee stock options that are currently deemed to be exercised. In the case that it is deemed probable that a number of employee stock options will be exercised over time, the number of shares in the agreement with the third-party will be amended. OMX continuously pays interest compensation to the counter-party in exchange for the counter-party undertaking to provide the shares. OMX receives the share dividend paid during the term of the agreement. Changes in the share price of OMX’s shares affect the value of the share swap and the result is reported against personnel expenses in the income statement. The share swap had a positive impact of SEK 15 m on personnel expenses for 2006.

SHARE MATCH PROGRAM 2006

 

Start date

   April 6, 2006

Matching date

   April 30, 2009

Number of invested shares

   26,855

Maximum number of matching shares

   134,275

Estimated number of matching shares

   57,000

Total estimated expense, SEK m

   12

Expenses for the year, SEK m

   3

Participants in the Share Match Program 2006 invest in OMX shares and, depending on whether OMX achieves performance targets related to earnings per share and how OMX’s shares perform in comparison to its competitors, participants may obtain a maximum of five matching shares per invested OMX share after three years. The number of shares that the participant may buy in the program is limited.

In order to limit expenses for the program in the event of an increase in the share price and to ensure that shares can be provided when shares are matched in the Share Match Program, OMX has signed a share-swap agreement amounting to approximately 57,000 shares at a predetermined price of SEK 146 per share. The share swap covers the portion of shares that are expected to be allotted at the end of the program. The share swap is reported as an equity instrument in accordance with IAS 32. OMX has also signed a share-swap agreement amounting to 18,000 shares at a predetermined price of SEK 123.50 to limit the expenses for the social security contributions arising in conjunction with the Share Match Program. Changes in the price of OMX’s shares affect the value of the share swap. These changes in fair value are reported in the income statement. OMX continuously pays interest compensation to the counterparty in exchange for the counterparty undertaking to provide the shares. Interest compensation in the agreement corresponds to the net amount of interest expenses on the underlying value of the shares when the agreement was signed and the dividend on the underlying shares. Interest expenses are based on a STIBOR of 90 days.

WARRANTS ISSUED TO EMPLOYEES

 

Subscription date

   Nov 20, 2003

Subscription price, SEK

   138.5

Number of shares upon full subscription

   1,150,000

Dilution upon full subscription, %

   1.0

Subscribed as at September 30, 2006

   286,000

Premium, SEK

   7.80

New subscription of shares with effect from

   July 1, 2006

Maturity date

   Sept 30, 2006

The warrants expired on September 30, 2006. Of the total number of 286,000 subscribed warrants, 98,600 warrants were utilized. Each warrant entitles the holder to one share and 98,600 new shares were issued.

 

27


AVERAGE NUMBER OF EMPLOYEES

 

      2006    2005
      Number of
employees
   of whom
men
   Number of
employees
   of whom
men

Parent Company

   33    17    31    13

Subsidiaries

           

Sweden

   821    555    896    590

Australia

   66    54    37    29

Denmark

   90    55    83    54

Estonia

   38    10    33    10

Finland

   107    58    164    92

Hong Kong

   5    2    4    3

Iceland

   29    23    —      —  

Italy

   2    2    3    3

Canada

   16    11    —      —  

Latvia

   25    9    24    10

Lithuania

   19    7    18    9

Norway

   9    9    11    10

Singapore

   5    5    3    3

UK

   17    13    17    11

USA

   42    35    46    37

Total subsidiaries

   1,291    848    1,339    861

TOTAL GROUP

   1,324    865    1,370    874

SALARIES AND REMUNERATION

SALARIES, OTHER REMUNERATION AND SOCIAL SECURITY EXPENSES

 

      2006     2005  
(SEK m)   

Salaries
and other

remuneration

   Social security
expenses (of which
pension expenses)
    Salaries and
other
remuneration
   Social security
expenses (of which
pension expenses)
 

Parent Company

   34    19  (6)   37    16  (6)

Subsidiaries

   797    268  (99)   755    265  (98)

TOTAL GROUP

   831    287  (105)   792    281  (104)

SALARIES AND OTHER REMUNERATION DISTRIBUTED PER COUNTRY AND BETWEEN BOARD MEMBERS AND EMPLOYEES

 

      2006    2005
(SEK m)    Board of
Directors and CEO
(of which variable
remuneration
and similar)
    Other
employees
  

Board of
Directors and CEO
(of which variable
remuneration

and similar)

    Other
employees

Parent Company

   (2)   25    (1)   27

Subsidiaries

         

Sweden

   (3)   455    (2)   476

Australia

   (0)   38    (0)   23

Canada

   (-)   9    (-)   —  

Denmark

   (1)   57    (1)   55

Iceland

   (-)   19    (-)   —  

Hong Kong

   (0)   3    (-)   3

Singapore

   (0)   4    (-)   2

Italy

   (1)   1    (0)   1

Norway

   (-)   6    (-)   8

UK

   (0)   72    (0)   30

USA

   (-)   43    (-)   45

Finland

   (0)   47    (1)   72

Estonia

   (0)   5    (0)   5

Latvia

   (-)   2    (0)   3

Lithuania

   (0)   3    (0)   3

Total subsidiaries

   33  (5)   764    30  (4)   726

TOTAL GROUP

   42  (7)   789    39  (5)   753

PENSIONS

OMX’s defined-contribution pension obligations are mainly accounted for at the cost (premium/contribution) incurred during the fiscal year for securing employee pension benefits. In these cases, there is no need to perform an actuarial valuation of the pension plan and the Group’s earnings are charged for expenses in pace with the benefits being earned.

INFORMATION ABOUT RELATED PARTIES

During 2005, one of Board Chairman Olof Stenhammar’s majority-owned subsidiaries received remuneration based on a license agreement related to the formation of OM in 1985. The payment comprises a fixed and a profit-related amount. The profit-related amount is 1 percent of OMX’s profit after financial items. The remuneration for 2005 amounts to SEK 9.2 m. The agreement has been terminated and expired on December 31, 2005.

NOTE 8. TRANSACTIONS WITH RELATED PARTIES

“Related parties” refers to companies and individuals on whom OMX is in a position to exercise significant, though not controlling, influence. When transactions with associated companies reported in accordance with the equity method are not eliminated in the consolidated financial statements, separate information is shown in the table below to disclose those transactions that took place between OMX and these companies. Information relating to transactions with individuals in close proximity (Board of Directors and senior executives) is set out in Note 7.

TRANSACTIONS WITH RELATED PARTIES, GROUP, 2006

 

(SEK m)    Sales    Purchases    Receivables     Liabilities

Associated companies

          

EDX London Ltd

   36    —      7 1)   —  

VPC AB

   19    1    —       —  

Näringslivskredit, NLK AB

   —      13    —       —  

Orc Software AB

   —      10    —       —  

 

1)

Of which SEK 6 m is a long-term receivable.

Sales and purchases from related parties occur at market prices.

NOTE 9. FINANCIAL ITEMS

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

FINANCIAL REVENUE

     

Interest revenue

   41    34

Interest revenue, Group companies

   —      —  

Dividends

   —      —  

Other investments including derivatives

   5    16

Exchange-rate differences

     

On derivatives intended for protection of shareholders’ equity in subsidiaries

   —      —  

On other loans and derivatives

   2    —  

Total financial revenue

   48    50

FINANCIAL EXPENSES

     

Interest expenses

   -85    -74

Other investments including derivatives

     

Net loss attributable to divestment of financial assets available for sale

   -11    -1

Exchange-rate differences

     

On other loans and derivatives

   —      -11

Refinancing of subsidiaries

      —  

Impairment loss on shares in subsidiaries

   —      —  

Other1)

   -5    -28

Total financial expenses

   -101    -114

TOTAL FINANCIAL ITEMS

   -53    -64

 

1)

For 2005, this item included impairment of external receivables of SEK 11 m and accrued interest for the repayment of VAT in the negative amount of SEK 3.5 m.

 

28


NOTE 10. ASSOCIATED COMPANIES

SHARES IN ASSOCIATED COMPANIES CONSOLIDATED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE EQUITY METHOD

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Reported value at beginning of year

   623    633

Acquisition of associated companies and capital contribution

   —      67

Sale of associated companies

   -459    0

Share in earnings of associated companies1)

   46    15

Dividends and Group contributions received from associated companies

   -34    -15

Translation differences

   -3    4

Other changes in associated companies’ equity

   13    -81

Reported value at year-end

   186    623

 

1)

Share in earnings of associated companies includes VPC AB in the amount of SEK 24 m in 2006.

The consolidated value of owned shares in income, earnings, assets and liabilities are specified below.

The market value of the holding in Orc Software (4.5 million shares) was SEK 524 m (398) as per December 31, 2006. The book value was SEK 76 m (62). Other holdings are not listed. For these amounts the fair value is deemed to be the same as book value.

At the beginning of October, OMX announced that it had sold its entire holding of 443,700 shares in VPC AB for a total of 575 m. The gain of SEK 83 m from this transaction was reported as other revenue.

 

(SEK m)    Country    Revenue    Income/loss    Assets    Liabilities    Shareh. equity    Ownership in %  

Associated companies, 2006

                    

Central Securities Depositories of Lithuania

   Lithuania    5    2    11    0    11    40  

EDX London Ltd

   UK    26    3    31    6    25    24  

Näringslivskredit NLK AB

   Sweden    1    1    99    27    72    48 2)

ORC Software AB

   Sweden    123    16    140    64    76    30  

Associated companies, 2005

                    

Central Securities Depositories of Lithuania

   Lithuania    5    2    13    1    12    40  

EDX London Ltd

   UK    55    -23    28    6    22    24  

VPC AB

   Sweden    137    32    293    53    240    20  

Näringslivskredit NLK AB

   Sweden    3    0    140    69    71    48 2)

ORC Software AB

   Sweden    86    4    100    40    60    31  

 

2)

Share of equity amounts to 90 percent

None of the above participations in associated companies are owned by the Parent Company. At December 31, 2006, participations in associated companies included goodwill amounting to SEK 2 m (217).

NOTE 11. TAXES

Both current and deferred income tax are reported for Swedish and foreign Group entities under “Taxes” in the income statement. Companies in the Group are liable to pay tax in accordance with relevant taxation legislation in the respective countries. The corporate tax rate was calculated on nominal reported income adding non-deductible items and deducting non-taxable revenue. Assessments and assumptions have been made when calculating the amounts and percentages presented in this Note. All assessments and assumptions involve a certain degree of uncertainty.

DISTRIBUTION OF INCOME BEFORE TAX

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Sweden

   334    381

Other countries

   771    450

Share in earnings of associated companies

   46    15

TOTAL

   1,151    846

The “Distribution of tax for the year” table reports how tax is specified between Sweden and other countries and the division of current and deferred taxes. The positive earnings in the Swedish portion of the operations led to a dissolution of tax loss carryforwards equivalent to tax assets. The Group’s operations in other countries resulted in mostly current tax and, to a lesser extent, utilized loss carryforwards.

DISTRIBUTION OF TAX FOR THE YEAR

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Current tax

     

Sweden

   -3    -79

Other countries

   -112    -40

Total

   -115    -119

Deferred tax

     

Sweden

   -97    -109

Other countries

   -28    -75

Total

   -125    -184

TOTAL

   -240    -303

Tax rate, %

   21    36

The Group’s positive deviation from the nominal Swedish tax rate of 28 percent is primarily due to tax-exempt capital gains arising from the sale of shares in VPC AB and NOS AS, and other tax-exempt revenue. The fact that the Group conducts operations in several countries with a lower tax rate than Sweden also has a positive impact on the tax rate. The fact that operations are conducted in countries with lower tax rates than the nominal Swedish tax rate and that the company receives tax-exempt revenues will continue to entail that the Group’s tax rate will amount to approximately 25 percent.

 

29


RECONCILIATION OF EFFECTIVE TAX

 

      GROUP
(%)    2006    2005

Swedish income tax rate

   28    28

Difference between different countries’ tax rates

   -1    -1

Deficit for which tax loss carryforwards have not been observed

   1    2

Utilization of previously non-capitalized deficits

   —      -1

Capital gains

   -4   

Tax-exempt revenues

   -5    -1

Non-deductible expenses

   1   

Earnings from associated companies

   -1    0

Adjustments for previous year

   —      9

Other

   2    0

EFFECTIVE TAX RATE

   21    36

Of the Group’s total tax loss carryforwards, which is approximately SEK 897 m, only SEK 433 m is considered in the calculation of deferred tax. The tax loss carryforwards that are considered in the calculation of deferred tax are reported to the extent that it is probable that it will be utilized against future taxable surplus. It is not deemed possible for those tax loss carryforwards not considered in the calculation to be utilized against in the foreseeable future since these loss carryforwards are attributable to countries in which the Group has limited revenues.

DISTRIBUTION OF ACCUMULATED TAX LOSS CARRYFORWARDS

 

     GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Sweden

   369    699

Other countries

   528    617

TOTAL

   897    1,316

TOTAL TAX LOSS CARRYFORWARDS THAT CORRESPOND TO TAX ASSETS

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Sweden

   369    699

Other countries

   64    108

TOTAL

   433    807

The Group’s deferred tax assets attributable to Sweden are deemed to be consumed within the forthcoming two years. The largest portion of foreign loss carryforwards that correspond to tax assets should be utilized within the same time period. Deferred tax assets referring to restructuring will be utilized at the same rate as the utilization of restructuring provisions and other provisions.

DEFERRED TAX ASSETS AND TAX LIABILITIES

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Deferred tax assets

     

Loss carryforwards

   115    217

Provisions for restructuring measures

   10    20

Total deferred tax assets

   125    237

Deferred tax liabilities

     

Untaxed reserves

   -39    -26

Total deferred tax liabilities

   -39    -26

DEFERRED TAX ASSETS, NET

   86    211

Losses in Swedish companies can be utilized for an unlimited amount of time. For foreign subsidiaries, the useful life of the loss is limited in certain cases. The minimum time period within which foreign losses can be utilized is 16 years. Of the losses that can be utilized for a limited amount of time (2019-2024), SEK 28 m are tax loss carryforwards that correspond to tax assets.

UTILIZATION OF TOTAL LOSSES AT YEAR-END

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Last utilization year

     

2019-2024

   128    147

Unlimited

   769    1,169

TOTAL

   897    1,316

UNTAXED RESERVES

Stockholmsbörsen AB signed a credit insurance related to clearing participants’ default. The insurance is intended to cover losses arising in clearing operations and which normally are covered solely by the company’s shareholders’ equity. The insurance has been signed by OMX’s wholly owned insurance company OMX Capital Insurance AG in Switzerland, which for part of the risk has secured reinsurance from Radian Asset Assurance Inc. in the US. OMX Capital Insurance AG has reserved funds in an insurance provision. At the Group level, the provision is distributed between unrestricted funds and deferred tax.

TAX ITEM REPORTED DIRECTLY AGAINST SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Deferred tax attributable to changed accounting principles

   —      10

Deferred tax attributable to revaluation of financial instruments

   7    8

Current tax in Group contribution received

   —      —  

TOTAL

   7    18

ONGOING TAX DISPUTES

OMX’s associated company, NLK, is party to a tax case concerning the possibility of loss carryforwards for which an appeal has been lodged with the Swedish Supreme Administrative Court. Since NLK has paid the tax expenses, the dispute will not have any further negative impact on the Group.

The Stockholmsbörsen AB subsidiary received a ruling from the Swedish Tax Board in 2004 pursuant to which the company will be subject to a value added tax surcharge for the support and facility management services it purchases from other companies in the Group. Stockholmsbörsen AB does not share the Swedish Tax Board’s assessment and will appeal against the ruling. Should the Swedish Tax Board’s opinion ultimately be upheld, this would give rise to a cost for the Group of SEK 90-110 m based on the situation on December 31, 2006 and increase ongoing expenses by SEK 2 m per month.

Other ongoing current disputes, either individually or collectively, are not considered to pose any material threat to the Group’s business operations, its financial position or its earnings.

 

30


NOTE 12. OPERATIONAL LEASING

GROUP

The Group has no financial leasing commitments. Set out below are the operational leasing commitments of the Group.

LEASING FEES FOR THE PERIOD

 

(SEK m)

   2006    2005

Equipment

   2    1

Computer operations

   57    76

Premises

   190    209

TOTAL

   249    286

CONTRACTED LEASING FEES

 

(SEK m)    2007    2008    2009    2010    2011    2012-17

Equipment1)

   18    2    2    —      —      —  

Computer operations

   18    15    7    —      —      —  

Premises

   175    165    168    170    167    890

of which, premises sublet

   25    25    25    22    22    71

of which, provisions made

   24    17    12    6    5    15

TOTAL

   211    182    177    170    167    890

 

1)

Of which SEK 16 m contracted for 2007 relates to leasing of computer equipment from the associated company, Näringslivskredit, NLK AB.

NOTE 13. INTANGIBLE ASSETS

 

GROUP, (SEK m)    Goodwill    Capitalized
expenditure
for
development
    Other
intangible
assets

Acquisition cost brought forward Jan 1, 2005

   1,950    879     199

Assets acquired through acquisitions

   917    —       350

Assets acquired during the year

   —      200     96

Reclassifications

   —      -20     —  

Exchange-rate differences

   93    —       -5

Acquisition cost carried forward, Dec 31, 2005

   2,960    1,059     640

Amortization brought forward, Jan 1, 2005

   —      383     67

Amortization for the year

   —      73     43

Amortization carried forward, Dec 31, 2005

   —      456     110

Impairment brought forward, Jan 1, 2005

   3    185     5

Impairment for the year

   2    9     2

Impairment carried forward, Dec 31, 2005

   5    194     7

BOOK VALUE, DEC 31, 2005

   2,955    409     523

Of which assets held for sale

   31    —       25

Acquisition cost brought forward, Jan 1, 2006

   2,960    1,059     640

Assets acquired through acquisitions

   335    —       244

Assets acquired during the year

   —      185     26

Reclassifications

   —      —       18

Exchange-rate differences

   -120    —       -10

Acquisition cost carried forward, Dec 31, 2006

   3,175    1,244     918

Amortization brought forward, Jan 1, 2006

   —      456     110

Amortization for the year

   —      51     78

Amortization carried forward, Dec 31, 2006

   —      507     188

Impairment brought forward, Jan 1,2006

   5    194     7

Impairment for the year

   —      21 1)   4

Impairment carried forward, Dec 31, 2006

   5    215     11

BOOK VALUE, DEC 31, 2006

   3,170    522     719

Of which assets held for sale

   30    —       32

 

1)

Of which SEK 20 m relates to the impairment of intangible assets that took place in conjunction with the sale of shares in VPC AB.

 

31


TOTAL INTANGIBLE ASSETS, USEFUL LIFE

 

(SEK m)    Acquisition cost    Book value  

Development in progress

   294    269  

3 years

   22    4  

5 years

   1,019    313  

10 years

   390    250  

20 years

   435    405  

TOTAL

   2,160    1,241  

(out of which assets held for sale

   30    30 )

The useful life for intangible assets found in the Parent Company is five years.

Development in progress relates to various components in the marketplace system. Their values are reviewed continuously and amortization is initiated when the respective part has been completed. Of the book value per December 31, 2006, SEK 32 m refers to the Banks & Brokers operation which is being discontinued.

Assets with a useful life of 10 years mainly consist of the product EXIGO CSD, which is a central system in OMX’s systems platform.

Assets with a useful life of 20 years comprise surplus values in customer contracts attributable to the acquisition of CSE and EV.

The review of the value of all intangible assets takes place on an ongoing basis throughout the year by using a risk-adjusted discounted cash flow. This review is based on assumptions and assessments, which entail a certain degree of uncertainty. OMX’s WACC has been utilized as the discount factor, which is 10 percent for the Technology operations and 9 percent for the Exchange operations. The lifetime is assumed to be the same as the amortization period.

During 2006, impairment of SEK 21 m was recognized since it was not possible to justify the book value of these assets with the value of the future cash flow and that the book value exceeded fair value. The cost has been booked as an impairment in the income statement.

CAPITALIZED EXPENDITURE FOR RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT

This item relates to OMX’s systems solutions. The major components are the new development of OMX’s platform for future systems solutions – GENIUM, a new system for settlement, registration and custody of securities – EXIGO CSD, the next generation of CLICK™ – CLICK XT, a systems solution for banks and brokerage firms – STP, and a systems platform for energy trading – CONDICO™.

OTHER INTANGIBLE ASSETS

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Software

   120    119

Licenses

   1    2

Surpluses in acquired customer contracts

   405    285

Other

   161    92

TOTAL

   687    498

GOODWILL

Goodwill is divided between the Group’s cash-generating units, primarily within the Nordic Marketplaces business area:

 

(SEK m)    2006    2005

Nordic Marketplaces

     

Stockholm Stock Exchange

   590    590

Helsinki Stock Exchange

   1,304    1,362

Copenhagen Stock Exchange

   876    924

Iceland Stock Exchange

   130    —  

Total Nordic Marketplaces

   2,900    2,876

Information Services & New Markets

     

Other exchanges

   14    15

Market Technology

     

Computer share

   180    —  

Other

   76    64

Total Market Technology

   256    64

TOTAL

   3,170    2,955

out of which assets held for sale

   30    30

An impairment test of goodwill was performed at the end of 2006. It is necessary to make a number of assessments and assumptions that entail a certain degree of uncertainty for this test.

The value in use of goodwill attributable to exchange operations was calculated based on the discounted eternal cash flow with a growth rate of 0 percent and a discount rate of 9 percent which corresponds to the company’s WACC for the Exchange operations.

The eternal useful life was applied against the background of the company’s long history of a stable and strong cash flow. The acquisitions are of great strategic importance to OMX. A larger market and increased liquidity were achieved through these acquisitions. Cost-efficiency, and thereby competitiveness are increased by integrating the technical infrastructure. OMX’s technology operations also benefit from the large home market that was created. A growth rate of 0 percent based on expected outcome for 2006 was applied by way of precaution due to the difficulty in assessing the market of the exchange operations. The value in use was calculated at a discount rate (WACC) of 10 percent corresponding to the company’s average cost of capital for the Technology operations. No impairment requirements were identified.

A sensitivity analysis in which the discount rate was increased by 10 percent and the cash flow was decreased by 10 percent did not give rise to any further impairment requirements.

NOTE 14. TANGIBLE FIXED ASSETS

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Equipment

     

Acquisition cost brought forward

   1,091    1,111

Assets acquired through acquisitions

   1    10

Acquisitions for the year

   77    85

Disposals

   -36    -144

Sales

   -23    -6

Exchange-rate differences

   -22    35

Acquisition cost carried forward

   1,088    1,091

Depreciation brought forward

   711    727

Depreciation for the year

   87    97

Disposals

   -28    -137

Sales

   -15    -2

Exchange-rate differences

   -18    26

Depreciation carried forward

   737    711

Impairment brought forward

   18    18

Impairment for the year

   4    —  

Impairment carried forward

   22    18

BOOK VALUE

   329    362

Of which assets held for sale

   8    7

The useful life for computers amounts to three years, for reconstructions to ten years and for other equipment to five years.

 

32


NOTE 15. OTHER INVESTMENTS HELD AS FIXED ASSETS

GROUP

 

(SEK m)    2006    2005

Financial assets valued at fair value via the income statement

     

Shares and participations

   —      4

Financial assets available for sale

     

Shares and participations

   363    52

TOTAL

   363    56
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Acquisition cost brought forward

   56    50

Acquisitions during the year

   363    4

Divestments during the year

   -56    -15

Revaluation of shareholders’ equity

   —      20

Reclassification

   —      -3

ACQUISITION COST CARRIED FORWARD

   363    56

NOTE 16. OTHER LONG-TERM RECEIVABLES

GROUP

 

      2006    2005
(SEK m)   

Reported

value

  

Fair

value

  

Reported

value

  

Fair

value

Other deposits

   17    17    53    53

Long-term project receivables

   —      —      —      —  

Hedge employee stock options

   —      —      68    68

Other long-term receivables

   23    23    42    42

TOTAL

   40    40    163    163

NOTE 17. MARKET VALUE, OUTSTANDING DERIVATIVE POSITIONS

Through its clearing operations in the derivative markets, Nordic Marketplaces is the formal counterparty in all derivative positions traded via the exchanges. However, the exchanges do not utilize the derivatives for purpose of conducting their own trading, instead these derivatives are to be seen as a method of documenting the counterparty guarantees established in the clearing operations. Counterparty risks are measured by models that have been agreed upon with the financial supervisory authority in the respective countries. The risk situation associated with the divestment of positions remains unchanged compared with prior years. Collateral for the divestment of outstanding derivative instruments is provided as previously. According to IAS 39/32, the market value of the above-mentioned derivative positions is reported in the balance sheet.

Receivables and liabilities attributable to outstanding derivative positions have been netted to the extent that such a legal offset right exists and, at the same time, that it is OMX’s intention to settle these items. The market value as per December 31, 2006 was SEK 4,401 m, which almost exclusively refers to the Stockholm Stock Exchange’s derivative positions.

 

33


NOTE 18. ACCOUNTS RECEIVABLE — TRADE

 

     GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Accounts receivable

   426    372

Less doubtful receivables

   -1    -5

TOTAL

   425    367

NOTE 19. OTHER RECEIVABLES

 

     GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Current account assets

   748    556

Other non interest-bearing receivables

   139    126

Other interest bearing receivables

   1    2

TOTAL

   888    684

NOTE 20. PREPAID EXPENSES AND ACCRUED INCOME

 

     GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Premises, rent

   34    43

Systems sales, facility management1)

   216    304

Information sales

   97    59

Transaction revenue

   25    109

Insurance

   14    12

Unrealized exchange-rate gains

   23    39

Other

   9    21

TOTAL

   418    587

 

1)

The item includes project revenue reported in accordance with the percentage-of-completion principle.

NOTE 21. FINANCIAL ASSETS AVAILABLE FOR SALE

 

     GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Government securities

   519    724

Bank and financial institutions

   —      —  

TOTAL

   519    724

The fair values of the above items correspond to the reported values.

NOTE 22. SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

A new share issue took place in October in conjunction with the expiry of the employee warrants program, entailing that the number of shares increased by 98,600 to 118,572,907. In November, a new share issue took place in conjunction with the acquisition of Eignarhaldsfelagid Verdbrefathing, entailing that the number of shares increased by 2,067,560 to 120,640,467, with a ratio value of SEK 2 with one vote per share. Consolidated shareholders’ equity amounted to SEK 38 (40) per share.

ASSOCIATED COMPANIES

Income that is not paid out as a dividend in associated companies is recorded in the Group’s shareholders’ equity among profit/loss brought forward. The application of the equity method of accounting for associated companies means that the value of shareholders’ equity in the Group is reported at SEK 76 m (64) higher than if the acquisition cost method had been used.

SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY, GROUP

 

(SEK m)    2006    2005

Share capital

   241    237

Other contributed funds

   3,536    3,271

Other reserves

     

Fair value reserve

   —      12

Hedging reserve

   -18    —  

Translation reserve

   -85    88

Profit/loss bought forward

   16    584

Net income for the year

   907    543

Minority interests

   17    14

TOTAL SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

   4,614    4,749

OTHER RESERVES, GROUP

 

(SEK m)   

Fair value

reserve

  

Hedging

reserve

  

Translation

reserve

   Total

Opening balance, 2005

   —      —      -37    -37

Revaluation of shares available for sale

   12    —      —      12

Translation differences

   —      —      125    125

Closing balance 2005

   12    —      88    100

Cash-flow hedging

           

Gain/loss to shareholders’ equity

   —      -9    —      -9

Transferred to income statement

   —      -9    —      -9

Exchange-rate differences

           

Hedging of equity

   —      —      25    25

Translation differences

   —      —      -198    -198

Financial assets available for sale

           

Transferred to income statement

   -12    —      —      -12

Closing balance 2006

   —      -18    -85    -103

Items are reported net after tax.

FAIR VALUE RESERVE

The fair value reserve includes the accumulated net change in fair value of financial assets available for sale until the asset is eliminated from the balance sheet.

HEDGING RESERVE

The hedging reserve includes the change in value of cash-flow hedges. The change in value is re-entered in the income statement in line with the hedged cash flow impacting the income statement.

TRANSLATION RESERVE

The translation reserve includes all exchange-rate differences arising in conjunction with the translation of financial statements from foreign operations that have prepared their financial statements in a currency other than the currency in which the consolidated financial statements are presented. The Parent Company and Group present their financial statements in Swedish kronor (SEK). The translation reserve also comprises exchange-rate differences arising in conjunction with the translation of liabilities reported as hedging instruments of a net investment in a foreign operation.

 

34


NOTE 23. LONG-TERM LIABILITIES

This Note contains information on the Group’s long-term liabilities. For information regarding dates of maturity for the long-term liabilities, refer to Note 27 and for information regarding the Group’s exposure to interest rate risks of exchange-rate fluctuations, refer to section entitled Risk Management on page 13.

For information regarding the reporting of employee stock options, refer to the section entitled Accounting principles.

Division of long-term liabilities.

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Interest-bearing long-term liabilities

     

Bond loans (interest-bearing)

   1,360    1,409

Other long-term liabilities

     

Liabilities, employee stock options

   15    18

Liabilities Computershare

   97    —  

Rent deposit

   9    —  

Other long-term liabilities

   2    1

TOTAL

   1,483    1,428

NOTE 24. PROVISIONS

RESTRUCTURING RESERVE

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Opening balance

   —      26

Provisions made during the period

   —      —  

Utilized reserves

   —      -26

TOTAL

   —      —  

Refers to savings program in 2003. All remaining reserves were utilized in 2005.

OTHER PROVISIONS

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Opening balance

   128    208

Reclassifications

   —      27

Provisions made during the period

   —      —  

Utilized reserves

   -44    -113

Exchange-rate effects

   -5    6

TOTAL

   79    128

The opening balance comprises the reserve of SEK 10 m for the integration of OM and HEX, and provisions for expenses for unutilized premises of SEK 118 m. The integration reserve was utilized during the year in the amount of SEK 10 m and has thereby been utilized in its entirety. The provision for premises was utilized in the amount of SEK 39 m including exchange-rate effects.

The provision for expenses for unutilized premises is based on management’s assumptions and assessments and is associated with a certain degree of uncertainty. These expenses refer primarily to OMX’s offices in London and New York. The provision was established in 2004 as a result of the reduction in personnel associated with the focus on cost-savings and efficiency-enhancement measures in the operations which OMX has worked with in recent years, and a decline in market conditions for the lease of premises, leading to certain areas being leased at a lower rent than OMX’s lease conditions. See Note 12 regarding the cash-flow dates. For leasing contracts invoicing sub-lets, a reserve has been established for known losses for five years in the future. The leasing contract will expire during the period 2009-2015.

RESTRICTED RESERVE, CSE

The total amount of provisions presented below also includes a reserve attributable to the operations in the Copenhagen Stock Exchange, CSE. This reserve may not be distributed and may only be used to cover losses in CSE in accordance with the Danish Security Trading Act. The reserve amounts to SEK 66 m as per December 31, 2006 and is classified in its entirety as long term.

TOTAL PROVISIONS

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Long-term portion

   121    154

Short-term portion

   24    41

TOTAL

   145    195

NOTE 25. OTHER LIABILITIES

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Current account liabilities

   650    613

Other non interest-bearing liabilities

   148    88

Other interest-bearing liabilities

   38    —  

TOTAL

   836    701

NOTE 26. ACCRUED EXPENSES AND DEFERRED INCOME

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Personnel expenses

   187    182

Systems sales1)

   8    11

Support revenue

   26    —  

Facility Management1)

   15    12

Trading revenue

   10    —  

Issuers’ revenue2)

   60    53

Commission revenue

   22    —  

Other deferred income

   27    53

Unrealized exchange-rate losses

   13    106

Accrued interest

   30    —  

Other

   75    129

TOTAL

   473    546

 

1)

Customer invoicing terms for projects are usually set within a contract and it is not uncommon that payments do not correspond to work carried out at a given time. Work that has been invoiced, but not yet carried out, is treated as a liability to the customer. During the period when the work to which the invoice relates is carried out, this liability is re-booked as revenue.

2)

Relates to listing fees paid by companies listed on the exchanges within OMX’s exchanges. These fees are paid quarterly in advance and are based on the average market capitalization of a company over the preceding 12-month period.

 

35


NOTE 27. DUE DATES FOR RECEIVABLES AND LIABILITIES

GROUP

 

(SEK m)   

Within

12 months

  

Within

2-5 years

  

After

5 years

   TOTAL

Other long-term receivables

   —      29    11    40

Accounts receivable

   425    —      —      425

Tax assets

   6    —      —      6

Other receivables

   888    —      —      888

Prepaid expenses and accrued income

   397    20    1    418

Assets available for sale

   70    —      —      70

Interest-bearing long-term liabilities

   —      1,360    —      1,360

Other long-term liabilities

   —      122    1    123

Provisions

   24    40    81    145

Liabilities to credit institutions1)

   398    —      —      398

Accounts payable

   109    —      —      109

Tax liabilities

   30    —      —      30

Other liabilities

   836    —      —      836

Accrued expenses and deferred income

   458    15    —      473

NET RECEIVABLE (+)/NET LIABILITY (-)

   -69    -1,488    -70    -1,627

 

1)

Refers to the commercial paper program.

NOTE 28. OTHER INTEREST-BEARING AND NON INTEREST-BEARING RECEIVABLES AND LIABILITIES

This Note contains information on the classification between interest-bearing and non interest-bearing items in the balance sheet. For information regarding dates of maturity, fixed-interest periods and the average weighted interest of interest-bearing items, refer to section entitled Risk Management on page 13.

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    Interest-bearing   

Non

interest-bearing

   Total

Financial fixed assets

   21    699    720

Current receivables

   1    6,138    6,139

Financial assets available for sale

   519    —      519

Cash equivalents

   409    —      409

Long-term liabilities

   1,361    258    1,619

Short-term liabilities

   436    5,859    6,295

RECEIVABLES AND LIABILITIES, NET

   -847    720    -127

NOTE 29. COLLATERAL RECEIVED BY OMX’S EXCHANGE OPERATIONS

Through its clearing operations, the Stockholm Stock Exchange is a counterparty in every options and futures contract and thereby guarantees the fulfillment of each contract. Customers, who through an options or futures contract, assume an obligation to the Stockholm Stock Exchange, must pledge collateral for the obligation according to special rules for this.

GROUP

 

(SEK m)    2006    2005

Stockholm Stock Exchange

   15,458    11,533

TOTAL

   15,458    11,533

NOTE 30. PLEDGED COLLATERAL

GROUP

 

(SEK m)    2006    2005      

OMX Treasury AB

   —      45    Lease deposit

OMX Technology Pty Ltd

   3    2    Lease deposit

OMX Technology Ltd (Hong-Kong)

   —      1    Lease deposit

HEX Securities Services Ltd OY1)

   32    44    Liquidity guarantee

TOTAL

   35    92   

 

1)

Relates to pledged collateral for the right to act as the Swedish equivalent of the account-handling institution.

NOTE 31. CONTINGENT LIABILITIES

GROUP

 

(SEK m)    2006    2005

Guarantees issued for clearing operations (OMX AB)1)

   3,020    1,414

Other guarantees (OMX AB)2)

   174    69

Total

   3,194    1,483

 

1)

Through its clearing operations, OMX AB’s exchange operations act as a counterparty in each transaction and thereby guarantees the fulfillment of each contract. OMX’s exchange operations are to pledge collateral for commitments with other clearing houses. The amount of these commitments is calculated on the gross exposure between the clearing houses. As collateral for these obligations, the operations have obtained bank guarantees, which are guaranteed by OMX AB through counterparty agreements.

2)

Primarily obligations for leasing contracts and in conjunction with the systems sales in Market Technology. In addition to the items above, there are general Parent Company guarantees for wholly owned subsidiaries of OMX AB.

OMX is party to a number of cases and disputes for which no provisions have been established since it is the opinion of management that all cases will be found in favor of OMX. There is naturally a certain degree of uncertainty associated with this opinion.

 

36


NOTE 32. EARNINGS PER SHARE

CHANGE IN NUMBER OF SHARES

After authorization was received at OMX’s Extraordinary General Meeting of shareholders on October 23, 2006, the company’s share capital was increased by SEK 4,135,120 by a new share issue of 2,067,560. The newly-issued shares were utilized as part payment for the acquisition of Eignarhaldsfelagid Verdbrefathing (the holding company for the Iceland Stock Exchange and central securities depository). A new share issue took place in October in conjunction with the expiry of the employee warrants program, entailing that the company’s share capital increased by SEK 197,200 and the number of shares increased by 98,600.

 

      2006    2005

Outstanding shares at beginning of the period

   118,474,307    115,547,015

New share issue

   2,166,160    2,927,292

Outstanding shares at the end of the period

   120,640,467    118,474,307

EARNINGS PER SHARE BEFORE DILUTION

Earnings per share are based on net income/loss for the year attributable to the Parent Company’s owners:

 

      2006    2005

Net income/loss for the year, SEK m, attributable to the shareholders in OMX AB

   907    538

Average number of shares outstanding

   118,671,254    118,108,396

EARNINGS PER SHARE, SEK

   7.64    4.56

Of which attributable to continuing operations

   8.03    4.70

Of which attributable to discontinued operations

   -0.39    -0.14

EARNINGS PER SHARE AFTER DILUTION

Earnings per share are based on net income/loss for the year attributable to the Parent Company’s owners:

 

      2006    2005

Net income/loss for the year, SEK m, attributable to the shareholders in OMX AB

   907    538

Average number of shares after dilution and with full utilization of options1)

   118,885,754    118,394,396

EARNINGS PER SHARE, SEK2)

   7.64    4.56

1)

For information relating to OMX’s employee stock options (no dilution), see Note 7.

2)

Earnings per share after dilution corresponds to earnings per share before dilution since it has not been deemed probable that the warrants will be utilized due to the fact that the issue price was higher than the share price in 2005 and 2006.

NOTE 33. CASH FLOW

CASH EQUIVALENTS

The following sub-components are included in cash equivalents:

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Cash and bank balances

   409    519

Financial assets available for sale

   519    724

Total cash equivalents

   928    1243

Financial assets available for sale with tenures of > 3 months

   -519    -724

Total according to balance sheet

   409    519

Financial assets available for sale are short-term investments that comprise discounting instruments, bonds and securities issued by the government, local authority, a Swedish limited liability company and a Swedish housing finance institution. All short-term investments entail an insignificant risk of fluctuations in value and can readily be converted to cash funds. However, only those investments with a maximum tenure of three months are included in the item “Cash equivalents” in the balance sheet and in the cash-flow statement. Other short-term investments are reported as “Cash flow from investing activities”.

Cash equivalents that were not available to the Group amounted to SEK 21 m at the end of the period. Blocked funds primarily refer to cash equivalents utilized as hedging in clearing activities. The Group’s total hedges in interest-bearing assets relating to clearing activities amount to approximately SEK 750 m, the majority of which are investments with tenures exceeding three months.

FINANCIAL ITEMS

The following financial items reported in the income statement affect the cash flow:

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Other interest income and similar profit/loss items

     

Dividends

   —      —  

Interest

   48    34

Exchange-rate differences

   0    —  

Other

   5    4

Total

   53    38

Interest expense and similar profit/loss items

     

Interest

   -99    -74

Interest, Group

   —      —  

Exchange-rate differences

   —      -11

Other

   -16    -9

Total

   -115    -94

TOTAL

   -62    -56

CASH FLOW FROM ACQUISITIONS AND DIVESTMENTS OF GROUP COMPANIES

Cash flow from acquisitions

During 2006, Eignarhaldsfelagid Verdbrefathing (EV) was acquired and in 2005 the Copenhagen Stock Exchange (CSE) was acquired. The cash flow from these acquisitions is described in the table below:

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Intangible assets

   275    1,224

Tangible fixed assets

   1    12

Financial fixed assets

   8    21

Receivables

   19    80

Cash equivalents

   33    307

Long-term liabilities

   —      —  

Current liabilities

   -22    -187

Minority interests

   —      —  

Total purchase price

   314    1,457

Total purchase price paid

   -314    -1,457

Less earlier holding in acquired company

   —      18

Less payment with treasury shares

   256    232

Purchase price paid

   -58    -1,207

Cash equivalents in acquired Group company

   33    307

CASH FLOW FROM ACQUISITIONS

   -25    -900

Acquisition costs affecting cash flow in the forthcoming year

   6    —  

TOTAL CASH FLOW FROM ACQUISITIONS DURING THE FISCAL YEAR

   -19    -900

 

37


Cash flow from divestments

During 2005, the operations within Banks & Brokers in Australia were divested. The cash flow from these divestments is described in the table below;

 

      GROUP
(SEK m)    2006    2005

Intangible assets

   —      29

Tangible fixed assets

   —      —  

Receivables

   —      —  

Cash equivalents

   —      —  

Long-term liabilities

   —      —  

Current liabilities

   —      —  

Total purchase price

   —      29

Capital gains/losses

   —      —  

Total of purchase price received

   —      29

Less cash equivalents in divested companies

   —      —  

Restructuring reserve

   —      —  

Cash and cash equivalents in divested Group companies

   —      —  

CASH FLOW FROM DIVESTMENTS

   —      29

ITEMS NOT AFFECTING CASH FLOW

Changes in the company’s asset structure related to acquisition are accounted for in the tables above “Cash flow from acquisitions” and “Cash flow from divestments.” Other transactions related to investment and financing operations that do not give rise to payments, despite the fact that they impact the company’s capital and asset structure, encompass depreciation/amortization and impairment, utilization of reserves, share in earnings of associated companies and capital gains/losses.

LIQUIDITY AND FINANCING

Interest-bearing net liabilities amounted to SEK 847 m (572) at the end of the reporting period. OMX’s interest-bearing financial assets totaled SEK 950 m (1,334), of which SEK 21 m (90) represented financial fixed assets.

Interest-bearing financial liabilities totaled SEK 1,797 m (1,906), of which SEK 1,360 m (1,400) was long-term.

Agreed credit facilities amounted to SEK 3,741 m (3,033), of which SEK 30 m (0) was utilized. Of the granted credit facilities, SEK 1,335 m (823) refers to clearing operations. Cash equivalents equaled SEK 409 m (915) and consisted of short-term investments and cash and bank balances. Investments with lifetimes shorter than three months are included in the item “Cash equivalents”, since these securities are exposed to an insignificant level of risk and can be readily turned into cash.

NOTE 34. INFORMATION REGARDING THE PARENT COMPANY

OMX AB (publ) is a limited liability company registered in Sweden, with its registered office in Stockholm. The Parent Company’s shares are listed on the stock exchanges in Stockholm, Helsinki, Copenhagen and Iceland. The address of the headquarters is: OMX AB, 105 78 Stockholm, Sweden.

The consolidated accounts for 2006 comprise the Parent Company and its subsidiaries, referred to collectively as the Group. The Group also includes shareholdings in associated companies.

NOTE 35. SIGNIFICANT EVENTS AFTER THE END OF THE REPORTING PERIOD

DISCONTINUING OPERATIONS

After the end of the reporting period, OMX signed an agreement with HCL Technologies, the global IT services provider, regarding an extended partnership which means that OMX no longer has any discontinuing operations in the Nordic region. The partnership means that HCL Technologies will assume responsibility for the development and maintenance of systems for securities management targeted to banks and brokers and that the remaining part of the Nordic operations will be moved to Information Services & New Markets business area, and will be included in the Broker Services unit. A number of employees’ work tasks will be within the Market Technology business area to replace consultants and minimize new recruitments. The transferred unit had sales of SEK 160 m and costs of SEK 195 m in 2006. The unit expects to report a profit in 2007. The changes will be implemented in OMX’s financial statements as per January 1, 2007.

SHARE MATCH PROGRAM 2007

On April 12, 2007, the Annual General Meeting of OMXAB approved the proposal of the OMX Board to continue and expand the share match program for senior executives for a second year. The program is targeted at approximately 95 senior executives and key individuals in OMX. The duration of the program is three years and requires employees to invest their own funds in OMX shares. Participants in the program invest in OMX shares and, provided that OMX achieves performance targets related to earnings per share and how the OMX’s shares perform in comparison to its competitors, after three years, participants may obtain a maximum of five matching shares per invested share. President and CEO Magnus Böcker may receive a maximum of eight matching shares per invested OMX share. The number of shares that the participant may buy in the program is limited.

Costs for OMX’s Share Match Program for 2007 involve administrative expenses, compensation costs and social security contributions which the Board expects to amount to approximately SEK 25 m over the period 2007-2009.

PROPOSAL FOR AUTHORIZATION ON REPURCHASE OF SHARES

After the reporting period, the OMX Board decided to propose to the 2007 Annual General Meeting that it authorize the Board to repurchase shares corresponding to a maximum of 10 percent of the number of shares outstanding. The repurchase could take place through trading on the stock exchange or a directed offering to shareholders. OMX does not currently own any treasury shares. This mandate shall apply until the 2008 Annual General Meeting. The purpose of the proposal is to be able to continuously adapt the capital structure to the company’s needs, and thereby increase value for shareholders and repurchase shares that could be used for the execution of OMX’s Share Match Program. The details of the proposal will be communicated when notice of the 2007 Annual General Meeting is made.

 

38

Exhibit 99.5

Exhibit 99.5

The NASDAQ OMX Group, Inc.

Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Combined Statement of Income

Year Ended December 31, 2007

(in thousands, except per share amounts)

 

     Nasdaq     OMX US
GAAP
    Equity
Investment
in DIFX
(Note 4)
    Pro Forma
Adjustments
    Note     NASDAQ OMX
Pro Forma
Combined
    PHLX    PHLX
Pro Forma
Adjustments
    Note     Pro Forma
Combined
 

Revenues

                     

Market Services

   $ 2,152,390     $ 397,864     $ —       $ —         $ 2,550,254     $ 125,526    $ —         $ 2,675,780  

Issuer Services

     283,885       60,363       —         —           344,248       —        —           344,248  

Market Technology

     —         111,575       7,429       —           119,004       —        —           119,004  

Other

     317       1,043       —         —           1,360       7,335      —           8,695  
                                                                   

Total revenues

     2,436,592       570,845       7,429       —           3,014,866       132,861      —           3,147,727  

Cost of revenue

                     

Liquidity rebates

     (1,049,812 )     —         —         —           (1,049,812 )     —        —           (1,049,812 )

Brokerage, clearance and exchange fees

     (574,541 )     —         —         —           (574,541 )     —        —           (574,541 )
                                                                   

Total cost of revenues

     (1,624,353 )     —         —         —           (1,624,353 )     —        —           (1,624,353 )
                                                                   

Revenues less liquidity rebates, brokerage, clearance and exchange fees

     812,239       570,845       7,429       —           1,390,513       132,861      —           1,523,374  
                                                                   

Expenses

                     

Compensation and benefits

     200,369       176,214       —         —           376,583       70,067      —           446,650  

Marketing and advertising

     20,822       10,321       —         —           31,143       —        —           31,143  

Depreciation and amortization

     38,890       40,553       —         (12,820 )   5 (b)     96,523       12,597      11,000     3 (a)     120,120  
           29,900     5 (a)           

Professional and contract services

     32,113       64,546       —         (11,840 )   5 (g)     84,819       9,187      —           94,006  

Computer operations and data communications

     28,694       47,753       —         (12,932 )   5 (h)     63,515       12,585      —           76,100  

Provision for bad debts

     1,858       —         —         —           1,858       —        —           1,858  

Occupancy

     34,556       29,931       —         —           64,487       4,899      —           69,386  

Regulatory

     28,865       —         —         —           28,865       —        —           28,865  

General, administrative and other

     60,410       47,532       —         (5,836 )   6 (a)     102,106       17,023      (5,600 )   3 (b)     113,529  
                                                                   

Total operating expenses

     446,577       416,850       —         (13,528 )       849,899       126,358      5,400         981,657  
                                                                   

Operating income

     365,662       153,995       7,429       13,528         540,614       6,503      (5,400 )       541,717  

Interest income

     37,646       13,906       —         (16,318 )   5 (i)     35,234       2,364      —           37,598  

Interest expense

     (72,863 )     (21,341 )     —         (88,800 )   5 (c)     (113,624 )     —        (47,600 )   3 (c)     (161,224 )
           (9,362 )   5 (c)           
           21,341     5 (c)           
           57,401     6 (a)           

Loss from unconsolidated investees, net

     —         6,495       (7,408 )     —           (913 )     —        —           (913 )

Gain on foreign currency contracts

     43,950       —         —         7,841     6 (a)     51,791       —        —           51,791  

Dividend income

     14,540       —         —         (14,540 )   6 (a)     —         532      —           532  

Capital gains from shares in equity investments

     —         15,178       —         —           15,178       —        —           15,178  

Gain on sale of strategic initiative

     431,383       —         —         (431,383 )   6 (a)     —         —        —           —    

Strategic initiative costs

     (26,511 )     —         —         26,511     6 (a)     —         —        —           —    

Minority interests

     96       (1,035 )     —         —           (939 )     —        —           (939 )
                                                                   

Income before income taxes

     793,903       167,198       21       (433,781 )       527,341       9,399      (53,000 )       483,740  

Income tax provision

     275,502       32,571       8       (140,822 )   5 (e)     167,259       6,132      (26,026 )   3 (d)     147,364  
                                                                   

Net income

   $ 518,401     $ 134,627     $ 13     $ (292,959 )     $ 360,082     $ 3,267    $ (26,974 )     $ 336,376  
                                                                   

Basic and diluted earnings per share:

                     

Basic

   $ 4.47     $ 1.12                    $ 1.90  
                                       

Diluted

   $ 3.46     $ 1.12                    $ 1.62  
                                       

Weighted-average common shares outstanding for earnings per share:

                     

Basic

     116,064       120,640         60,562     5 (f)              176,626  

Diluted

     152,529       120,640         60,562     5 (f)              213,091  

See Notes to the Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Combined Financial Statements.

 

1


The NASDAQ OMX Group, Inc.

Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Combined Balance Sheet

As of March 31, 2008

(in thousands, except share and par value amounts)

 

     NASDAQ
OMX
Consolidated
    PHLX     Pro Forma
Adjustments
    Note     Pro Forma
Combined
 

Assets

          

Current assets:

          

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 736,020     $ 51,239     $ (43,700 )   3     $ 714,334  
         (9,743 )   3    
         (2,000 )   3, 3 (c)  
         (17,482 )   2    

Financial investments, at fair value

     121,208       16,547       —           137,755  

Receivables, net

     403,614       22,293       —           425,907  

Deferred tax assets

     15,987       —         —           15,987  

Market value, outstanding derivative positions

     476,954       —         —           476,954  

Other current assets

     181,231       8,838       (3,257 )   3       186,812  
                                  

Total current assets

     1,935,014       98,917       (76,182 )       1,957,749  
                                  

Clearing and depository items

     —         6,921       —           6,921  

Advance to clearing accounts

     —         3,124       —           3,124  

Available for sale, held to maturity

     —         3,068       —           3,068  

Property and equipment, net

     189,786       60,852       (26,536 )   2       224,102  

Non-current deferred tax assets

     156,948       19,720       —           176,668  

Goodwill

     3,918,636       —         428,322     3       4,502,910  
         98,897     5 (a)  
         57,055     2    

Intangible assets, net

     2,214,228       —         335,000     3       2,385,628  
        
(163,600
)
  5 (a)  

Other assets

     376,695       622       (7,148 )   2       370,169  
                                  

Total assets

   $ 8,791,307     $ 193,224     $ 645,808       $ 9,630,339  
                                  

Liabilities and stockholders’ equity

          

Current liabilities:

          

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

   $ 208,837     $ 22,594       —         $ 231,431  

Section 31 fees payable to SEC

     77,686       —         —           77,686  

Accrued personnel costs

     82,762       2,435       5,641     2       90,838  

Deferred revenue

     203,195       5,648       —           208,843  

Income tax payable

     110,293       9,010       —           119,303  

Other accrued liabilities

     155,855       921       —           156,776  

Deferred tax liabilities

     29,579       171       5,023     3 (a)     28,156  
         (6,617 )   5 (a)  

Market value, outstanding derivative positions

     476,954       —         —           476,954  

Current portion of debt obligations

     68,906       —         24,375     3 (c)     93,281  
                                  

Total current liabilities

     1,414,067       40,779       28,422         1,483,268  

Clearing and depository items

     —         6,921       —           6,921  

Debt obligations

     1,574,590       —         625,625     3 (c)     2,200,215  

Non-current deferred tax liabilities

     925,832       —         147,938     3 (a)     1,015,684  
         (58,086 )   5 (a)  

Non-current deferred revenue

     136,835       —         —           136,835  

Other liabilities

     115,007       47,185       248     2       162,440  
                                  

Total liabilities

     4,166,331       94,885       744,147         5,005,363  

Minority interests

     12,391       —         —           12,391  

Stockholders’ equity

          

Common stock, $0.01 par value, 300,000,000 shares authorized, 199,921,225 shares issued and 199,665,445 shares outstanding

     2,001       4       (4 )   3       2,001  

Preferred stock, 30,000,000 shares authorized, none issued or outstanding

     —         —         —           —    

Additional paid-in capital

     3,465,194       113,614       (113,614 )   3       3,465,194  

Common stock in treasury, at cost: 255,780 shares

     (9,259 )     (3,240 )     3,240     3       (9,259 )

Accumulated other comprehensive income

     2,888       (3,678 )     3,678     3       2,888  

Retained earnings

     1,151,761       (8,361 )     8,361     3       1,151,761  
                                  

Total stockholders’ equity

     4,612,585       98,339       (98,339 )       4,612,585  
                                  

Total liabilities, minority interests and stockholders’ equity

   $ 8,791,307     $ 193,224     $ 645,808       $ 9,630,339  
                                  

See Notes to the Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Combined Financial Statements.

 

2


The NASDAQ OMX Group, Inc.

Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Combined Statement of Income

Three Months Ended March 31, 2008

(in thousands, except per share amounts)

 

     NASDAQ
OMX
Consolidated
    OMX US
GAAP:
1/1/08-
2/26/08
    Equity
Investment
in DIFX:
1/1/08-
2/26/08
(Note 4)
    OMX
Pro Forma
Adjustments
    Note     NASDAQ
OMX

Pro Forma
Combined
    PHLX    PHLX
Pro Forma
Adjustments
    Note     Pro Forma
Combined
 

Revenues

                     

Market Services

   $ 726,963     $ 72,525     $ —       $ —         $ 799,488     $ 38,110    $ —         $ 837,598  

Issuer Services

     75,688       10,508       —         —           86,196       —        —           86,196  

Market Technology

     11,023       12,642       1,238       —           24,903       —        —           24,903  

Other

     152       69       —         —           221       1,102      —           1,323  
                                                                   

Total revenues

     813,826       95,744       1,238       —           910,808       39,212      —           950,020  

Cost of revenue

                     

Liquidity rebates

     (384,771 )     —         —         —           (384,771 )     —        —           (384,771 )

Brokerage, clearance and exchange fees

     (150,723 )     —         —         —           (150,723 )     —        —           (150,723 )
                                                                   

Total cost of revenues

     (535,494 )     —         —         —           (535,494 )     —        —           (535,494 )
                                                                   

Revenues less liquidity rebates, brokerage, clearance and exchange fees

     278,332       95,744       1,238       —           375,314       39,212      —           414,526  
                                                                   

Expenses

                     

Compensation and benefits

     73,402       31,111       —         —           104,513       17,735      —           122,248  

Marketing and advertising

     1,898       1,899       —         —           3,797       —        —           3,797  

Depreciation and amortization

     15,912       7,296       —         (2,195 )   5 (b)     24,599       3,400      2,750     3 (a)     30,749  
           3,586     5 (a)           

Professional and contract services

     13,801       10,163       —         —           23,964       2,296      —           26,260  

Computer operations and data communications

     8,177       7,874       —         —           16,051       2,928      —           18,979  

Provision for bad debts

     966       —         —         —           966       —        —           966  

Occupancy

     12,333       4,253       —         —           16,586       1,316      —           17,902  

Regulatory

     7,472       —         —         —           7,472       —        —           7,472  

Merger expenses

     1,461       —         —         —           1,461       —        —           1,461  

General, administrative and other

     9,891       6,830       —         —           16,721       4,822      —           21,543  
                                                                   

Total operating expenses

     145,313       69,426       —         1,391         216,130       32,497      2,750         251,377  
                                                                   

Operating income

     133,019       26,318       1,238       (1,391 )       159,184       6,715      (2,750 )       163,149  

Interest income

     10,146       1,098       —         (6,348 )   5 (i)     4,896       374      —           5,270  

Interest expense

     (8,687 )     (3,426 )     —         (12,510 )   5 (c)     (22,656 )     —        (9,907 )   3 (c)     (32,563 )
           (1,459 )   5 (c)           
           3,426     5 (c)           

Investment income

     397       1,349       —         —           1,746       —        —           1,746  

Gain from unconsolidated investees, net

     26,336       738       (1,418 )     (26,000 )   4       (344 )     —        —           (344 )

Gain on foreign currency contracts

     35,254       —         —         —           35,254       —        —           35,254  

Dividend income

     —         —         —         —           —         123      —           123  

Minority interests

     (253 )     (154 )     —         195     5 (d)     (212 )     —        —           (212 )
                                                                   

Income before income taxes

     196,212       25,923       (180 )     (44,087 )       177,868       7,212      (12,657 )       172,423  

Income tax provision

     74,849       7,513       (71 )     (18,086 )   5 (e)     64,205       3,217      (5,779 )   3 (d)     61,643  
                                                                   

Net income

   $ 121,363     $ 18,410     $ (109 )   $ (26,001 )     $ 113,663     $ 3,995    $ (6,878 )     $ 110,780  
                                                                   

Basic and diluted earnings per share:

                     

Basic

   $ 0.75     $ 0.15                    $ 0.56  
                                       

Diluted

   $ 0.69     $ 0.15                    $ 0.52  
                                       

Weighted-average common shares outstanding for earnings per share:

                     

Basic

     160,979       120,640         37,934     5 (f)              198,913  

Diluted

     176,184       120,640         37,934     5 (f)              214,118  

See Notes to the Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Combined Financial Statements.

 

3


Notes to the Unaudited Pro Forma Condensed Combined Financial Statements of The NASDAQ OMX Group, Inc.

Note 1. Description of the PHLX Acquisition and OMX Business Combination

Acquisition of PHLX

On July 24, 2008, NASDAQ OMX completed the acquisition of PHLX, or the PHLX acquisition. NASDAQ OMX’s cost to acquire PHLX of approximately $708.7 million ($652.0 million cash paid plus approximately $56.7 million of direct acquisition costs and working capital adjustments) is subject to certain post-closing adjustments.

Business Combination with OMX

On February 27, 2008, Nasdaq and OMX combined their businesses and Nasdaq was renamed The NASDAQ OMX Group, Inc., or NASDAQ OMX. The business combination was completed pursuant to the terms of an agreement with Borse Dubai Limited, a Dubai company, or Borse Dubai, dated November 15, 2007. Pursuant to that agreement, Borse Dubai conducted an offer to acquire all of the outstanding shares of OMX and subsequently, on February 27, 2008, sold the OMX shares acquired in the offer or otherwise owned by Borse Dubai or its subsidiaries to Nasdaq. Nasdaq acquired 117,227,931 OMX shares, representing 97.0% of the share capital of OMX for SEK 11,678,630,352 ($1,879.4 million) in cash and 60,561,515 shares of Nasdaq common stock ($2,266.8 million) issued to Borse Dubai. Subsequently, Borse Dubai acquired an additional 2,013,350 shares of OMX and, on March 17, 2008, sold those OMX shares to us in exchange for SEK 533,537,750 ($88.4 million) in cash, as a result of which we now own 98.8% of OMX’s outstanding shares. Nasdaq’s cost to acquire OMX of $4,309.4 million, which includes $74.8 million of direct acquisition costs, is recorded in the NASDAQ OMX historical condensed combined balance sheet as of March 31, 2008 and is subject to certain post-closing adjustments. The cash component of the purchase price, including acquisition and acquisition-related costs, was financed through cash on hand, our new credit facilities and the issuance of 2.5% convertible senior notes.

As part of the business combination with OMX, on February 27, 2008, we also acquired 33 1/3% of the equity of DIFX in exchange for a contribution of $50 million in cash to DIFX and the entry into certain technology and trademark licensing agreements.

The business combination of Nasdaq and OMX and the acquisition of the equity interest in DIFX are collectively referred to herein as the Transactions.

Note 2. Basis of Presentation

The unaudited pro forma condensed combined financial statements are presented to illustrate the effects of the PHLX acquisition and the Transactions on the historical financial position and operating results of Nasdaq, OMX and PHLX. In accordance with Regulation S-X, we have excluded the material non-recurring charges or credits and related tax effects which resulted directly from our initial equity investment in DIFX that were included in our historical condensed consolidated statement of income for the three months ended March 31, 2008. The remaining effects of the DIFX transaction have been included in our pro forma condensed combined statements of income. In addition, we have also excluded the material non-recurring charges or credits and related tax effects related to our investment in the London Stock Exchange plc, or the LSE, that were included in Nasdaq’s historical statement of income for the year ended December 31, 2007. On September 25, 2007, Nasdaq, through its wholly-owned subsidiary Nightingale Acquisition Limited, sold shares, representing at that time 28.0% of the share capital of the LSE, to Borse Dubai for $1,590.7 million in cash. Nasdaq sold the substantial balance of its remaining holdings in the LSE in open market transactions for approximately $193.5 million in cash on September 26, 2007. Total proceeds from the sale of our holdings in the LSE were $1,784.2 million. As a result of the sale, Nasdaq recognized a $431.4 million pre-tax gain, which is net of $18.0 million of costs directly related to the sale, primarily broker fees. On September 28, 2007, Nasdaq used approximately $1,055.5 million of the proceeds from the above transactions to repay in full and terminate our then-outstanding credit facilities. The remaining effects of the LSE transaction have also been included in our pro forma statement of income. See Note 4, “Equity Investment in DIFX,” and Note 6, “LSE Related Transactions,” for further discussion.

The unaudited pro forma condensed combined statements of income combine the historical consolidated statements of income of Nasdaq, OMX and PHLX, giving effect to the PHLX acquisition and the Transactions as if they had been completed on January 1, 2007. The unaudited pro forma condensed combined statement of income for the three months ended March 31, 2008, or the interim pro forma income statement, includes OMX’s operations from the date of the business combination of February 27, 2008 through March 31, 2008, and the historical OMX consolidated

 

4


statement of income from January 1, 2008 through February 26, 2008. The equity investment in DIFX and the OMX pro forma adjustments in the interim pro forma income statement represent adjustments for the period January 1, 2008 through February 26, 2008, as results after February 26, 2008 have been consolidated in the historical NASDAQ OMX income statement. The unaudited pro forma condensed combined balance sheet combines the historical consolidated balances sheets of NASDAQ OMX and PHLX, giving effect to the PHLX acquisition as if it had occurred on March 31, 2008.

The unaudited pro forma condensed combined financial statements have been prepared using the purchase method of accounting with NASDAQ OMX treated as the acquirer, have been prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP and should be read together with the separate financial statements of Nasdaq, OMX and PHLX.

The unaudited pro forma condensed combined financial data is presented for informational purposes only and is not necessarily indicative of the operating results or financial position that would have occurred if the PHLX acquisition and the Transactions had been completed during the period or as of the dates for which the pro forma data is presented. In addition, the unaudited pro forma condensed combined financial data does not purport to project the future consolidated financial position or operating results of the combined company.

The purchase price for PHLX has been allocated to the assets acquired and liabilities assumed based on management’s preliminary estimate of their respective fair values. Independent valuation specialists assisted NASDAQ OMX’s management in the acquisition in determining the fair values of the net assets acquired and the intangible assets. The work performed by the independent valuation specialists has been considered by management in determining the fair values reflected in these unaudited pro forma condensed combined financial statements. The valuations are based on the actual assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the acquisition date and management’s consideration of the independent specialists’ valuation work. Among the provisions of Statement of Financial Accounting Standards, or SFAS, No. 141, “Business Combinations,” or SFAS 141, criteria have been established for determining whether intangible assets should be recognized separately from goodwill. SFAS No. 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets,” or SFAS 142, provides, among other guidelines, that goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite lives will not be amortized, but rather are tested for impairment on at least an annual basis. The purchase price allocation pro forma adjustments are preliminary, have been made solely for the purpose of providing unaudited pro forma condensed combined financial data and are subject to revision based on a final determination of fair value as soon as possible, but no later than one year from the date of the PHLX acquisition.

The accompanying unaudited pro forma condensed combined statements of income do not include (1) any revenue or cost saving synergies that may be achievable through the PHLX acquisition and the business combination with OMX, or (2) the impact of non-recurring items directly related to the PHLX acquisition and the business combination with OMX.

NASDAQ OMX expects to incur a number of non-recurring costs associated with combining the operations of the companies such as, but not limited to, severance, contract terminations and technology integration and the related elimination of duplicative costs, as well as the realization of other efficiencies related to the integration of their respective businesses. We have begun to finalize our plan to integrate certain activities related to our business combination with OMX. In accordance with EITF 95-3, we have identified $57.1 million of adjustments associated with combining the operations of Nasdaq and OMX. As these adjustments constitute additional purchase price under the provisions of EITF 95-3, we have included them as pro forma adjustments to goodwill in the unaudited pro forma condensed combined balance sheet. The additional costs are as follows (in millions):

 

•   Additional direct acquisition costs incurred

   $ 17.5

•   Technology write-downs

     26.5

•   Reduction in the fair value of certain assets acquired

     7.2

•   Additional severance costs

     5.6

•   Other

     0.3
      
   $ 57.1
      

For PHLX, such costs have not been reflected in the pro forma condensed combined financial data because they represent non-recurring charges directly attributable to the PHLX acquisition. At this time, the specific amount cannot be estimated as sufficient information is not available. Following the completion of the integration with OMX and PHLX, NASDAQ OMX will continue to revise its disclosure on a go-forward basis.

For the purpose of the pro forma condensed combined financial information, OMX financial information has been translated into U.S. Dollars and is presented in accordance with U.S. GAAP. The statement of income of OMX for the year ended December 31, 2007 has been translated using an average exchange rate of 6.7568. The presentation in U.S. Dollars of OMX’s statement of income for the period January 1, 2008 through February 26, 2008 is based on average monthly SEK/U.S. Dollar exchange rates in effect for the applicable periods.

Certain reclassifications have been made to the historical financial statements of PHLX and OMX to conform to the presentation expected to be used by NASDAQ OMX. We expect there could be additional reclassifications in the year following the completion of the PHLX acquisition and the business combination with OMX.

 

5


Note 3. PHLX Acquisition

Purchase price

The total preliminary purchase price is estimated at approximately $708.7 million and is comprised of (in millions):

 

Cash component

   $ 652.0 (a)

Acquisition costs

     13.0 (b)

Working capital adjustments

     43.7 (c)
        

Total purchase consideration

   $ 708.7  
        

 

 

(a)

Source of the cash component is the drawdown of debt of $650.0 million under a five-year $2,000.0 million senior secured term loan facility and the use of $2.0 million cash on hand.

 

 

(b)

Management’s estimate of direct costs of the acquisition, which include legal and advisory fees incurred by NASDAQ OMX. This estimate was based on NASDAQ OMX’s historical experience as well as fee estimates provided by advisors. Of the $13.0 million of acquisition costs, $3.3 million were capitalized as other assets on the historical balance sheet of NASDAQ OMX as of March 31, 2008 and included as a pro forma adjustment to that line on the unaudited pro forma condensed combined balance sheet. The remaining costs were funded with cash on hand.

 

 

(c)

Estimated working capital surplus paid at closing per the acquisition agreement. We deposited $15.0 million of the approximately $43.7 million into an escrow account until the final working capital adjustment is calculated. This payment will be funded with cash on hand.

The above estimated purchase price has been preliminarily allocated based on an estimate of the fair value of PHLX’s assets acquired and liabilities assumed. In addition, we have begun to finalize our plan to integrate certain activities related to our acquisition of PHLX. We are still gathering information from which to make final decisions regarding the optimal organization of the combined company, from which additional adjustments and refinements to our plan will arise. As such, additional adjustments to the PHLX purchase price allocation will be recorded as we estimate restructuring costs associated with integration activities of the combined company in accordance with the requirements of Emerging Issues Task Force No. 95-3, “Recognition of Liabilities in Connection with a Purchase Business Combination,” or EITF 95-3. Upon completion of the organizational analysis and the approval of appropriate management, our plan will be finalized. The future adjustments, whether increasing or decreasing our plan’s total value, will impact goodwill and accounts payable and accrued liabilities. We expect our plan to be finalized during the one year allocation period. We are completing our plan under the provisions of EITF 95-3. All other restructuring liabilities outside the scope of EITF 95-3 will be recognized in the income statement when those costs have been incurred in accordance with SFAS No. 146, “Accounting for Costs Associated with Exit or Disposal Activities.” The final valuation of net assets will be completed as soon as possible but no later than one year from the acquisition date. To the extent that the estimates need to be adjusted, we will do so, but no later than one year after closing in accordance with SFAS 141.

The following is a summary of the preliminary allocation of the total purchase price in the PHLX acquisition as reflected in the unaudited pro forma condensed combined balance sheet as of March 31, 2008:

 

     (in millions)  

Historical equity of PHLX

   $ 98.3  

Fair value of identifiable intangible assets:

  

Exchange and futures registrations

     198.5  

Customer relationships

     119.5  

Technology

     10.6  

Trade name

     6.4  
        

Total fair value of identifiable intangible assets

     335.0  

Deferred tax impact of purchase accounting adjustments

     (152.9 )

Residual goodwill created from the PHLX acquisition

     428.3  
        

Total preliminary purchase price

   $ 708.7  
        

In performing the preliminary purchase price allocation, NASDAQ OMX considered, among other factors, the intention for the future use of the acquired assets, analyses of historical financial performance, and an estimate of the future performance of PHLX’s business. The estimate of the fair values of intangible assets is based, in part, on a valuation using an income approach, market approach, or cost approach, as appropriate. The risk-adjusted discount rates used to compute the present value of the expected net cash flows of individual intangible assets, based on PHLX’s weighted average cost of capital, ranged from 12.0% to 12.5%. These discount rates were determined after consideration of PHLX’s rate of return on debt and equity and the weighted-average return on invested capital. In estimating the remaining useful lives of the intangible assets, NASDAQ OMX considered the six factors presented in paragraph 11 of SFAS 142 and an analysis of the intangible assets’ relevant historical attrition data.

Pro forma adjustments

a) To adjust the book value of PHLX assets to their estimated fair value and record amortization expense on PHLX intangible assets. The preliminary allocations are as follows (in millions):

 

     Value    Estimated
Average
Remaining
Useful Life
(in Years)
   Estimated Annual
Depreciation and
Amortization
Expense for 2007
   Estimated
Three Month
Depreciation and
Amortization
Expense for 2008

Intangible assets:

           

Exchange and futures registrations

   $ 198.5    Indefinite      #      #

Customer relationships

     119.5    19-23 years    $ 5.7    $ 1.4

Technology

     10.6    1-3 years      5.3      1.4

Trade name

     6.4    Indefinite      #      #
                       

Total depreciation and amortization expense

         $ 11.0    $ 2.8
                   

Total intangible assets

   $ 335.0         
               

 

# Not Applicable

Exchange and Futures Registrations

The exchange and futures registrations represent licenses that provide PHLX with the ability to operate its equity and options exchanges. NASDAQ OMX views these intangible assets as perpetual licenses to operate the exchange and futures functions so long as PHLX meets certain regulatory requirements. NASDAQ OMX selected a variation of the income approach called the Greenfield Approach to value the self-regulatory organization, or SRO, exchange registration and the cost approach to value the Philadelphia Board of Trade, or PBOT, futures registration. PBOT is a subsidiary of The Philadelphia Stock Exchange, Inc.

An indefinite life was assumed for these registrations as PHLX is the oldest securities exchange in the United States. Furthermore, since no legal, contractual, competitive, economic, or other factors limit the useful life of these intangible assets, NASDAQ OMX considered the useful life of the exchange and futures registrations to be indefinite. We assessed the factors listed in paragraph 11 of SFAS 142 in making this indefinite life determination.

 

6


SRO Exchange Registration

The Greenfield Approach refers to a discounted cash flow analysis that assumes the buyer is building the exchange operation from a start-up business to a normalized level of operation as of the acquisition date. This discounted cash flow model considers the required resources and eventual returns from the build-out of an operational exchange and the acquisition of customers, once the exchange registration is obtained. The advantage of the approach is that it reflects the actual expectations that will arise from an investment in the registration and it directly values the registration. The Greenfield Approach relies on assumptions regarding projected revenues, margins, market share, capital expenditures, depreciation, and working capital during the two year pre-trade phase, the 10 year ramp-up period, and the terminal period.

A steady state projection for PHLX was established first. The projection excluded revenue from options and clearing. A steady state projection was used starting in year 12 based on the assumption that a stock exchange can expect to reach normalized operations at this time. In the terminal year, NASDAQ OMX assumed a market share equal to 80.0% of current projections. This is because PHLX would be a late entrant into this business and would not achieve the same market penetration they currently enjoy given their long history. It also reflects what a market participant would be able to achieve by the end of the 10 year ramp-up period. A terminal growth rate of 3.0% was chosen as a reasonable estimate of the growth rate of the stock exchange industry on a long-term basis.

NASDAQ OMX divided the costs into fixed costs and variable costs. Annual fixed costs were estimated to grow steadily from $20 million in 2008 to $50 million in 2019. Variable costs were estimated as a proportion of the revenue.

Based on historical working capital levels and a review of working capital for comparable companies operating in the industry, working capital for a typical market participant, as a percentage of incremental revenue, is projected to be approximately 34.0%.

The cash flows were then tax-effected at a rate of 40.0%, and a discounted tax amortization benefit was added to the fair value of the asset under the assumption that the SRO exchange registration would be amortized for tax purposes over a period of 15 years.

The following is a summary of the indicated fair value for the SRO exchange registration:

 

(in millions)

   SRO Exchange
Registration

Sum of costs

   $ 160.0

Discounted tax amortization benefit

     38.0
      

Indicated fair value

   $ 198.0
      

PBOT Futures Registration

The fair value of PBOT futures registration was valued using the cost approach, specifically the replacement cost new approach, to determine the current cost to purchase or replace the futures registration. This valuation methodology is based on the concept that a prudent investor would pay no more for an asset than the amount necessary to replace the asset.

The following is a summary of the indicated fair value for PBOT futures registration:

 

(in millions)

   PBOT Futures
Registration

Sum of costs

   $ 0.4

Discounted tax amortization benefit

     0.1
      

Indicated fair value

   $ 0.5
      

 

7


Customer Relationships

Customer relationships represent the non-contractual and contractual relationships that PHLX has with its members. PHLX’s customer relationships were valued using the income approach, specifically an excess earnings method. This valuation approach relied on assumptions regarding projected revenues, attrition rates, and operating cash flows for its customers, which were projected up to 35 years.

NASDAQ OMX assumed annual revenue attrition of 5.0% for the customers and that 95.0% of the projected revenue growth came from existing customer relationships. Charges for contributory assets were taken, and the tax-effected cash flows were discounted at a rate of 12.5%.

The cash flows were then tax-effected at a rate of 40.0%, and a discounted tax amortization benefit was added to the fair value of the asset under the assumption that the customer relationships would be amortized for tax purposes over a period of 15 years.

The following is a summary of the indicated fair value for the customer relationships asset:

 

(in millions)

   Total

Sum of discounted cash flows

   $ 97.1

Discounted tax amortization benefit

     22.4
      

Indicated fair value

   $ 119.5
      

The estimated remaining useful life captures 90.0% to 95.0% of the present value of the cash flows generated by the customer relationships. The remaining useful life was determined based on an analysis of the historical attrition rates of PHLX customers and paragraph 11 of SFAS 142, which included an analysis of the legal, regulatory, contractual, competitive, economic, or other factors that limit the useful life of this intangible asset. The useful life of customer relationships is addressed in the section below, “Customer Relationships and Technology Lives.”

Technology – XL, PBOT, XLE, and SCCP

NASDAQ OMX acquired five technologies from PHLX: XL, PBOT, XLE, SCCP, and certain supporting technologies. These technologies represent the existing portfolio of software technologies that PHLX had developed or acquired and currently uses to operate its exchange.

NASDAQ OMX will develop new integrated trading functions based on existing NASDAQ OMX technologies, and accordingly will either re-platform or discontinue using PHLX’s XL, PBOT, XLE, and SCCP technologies while incorporating several supporting, peripheral technologies into the revised platform. The fair values of the technologies being re-platformed or discontinued were valued using the income approach, specifically the relief from royalty approach, relying on publicly available information to determine the royalty rate that PHLX would have to pay a third-party for the use of the technologies. This valuation methodology is based on the concept that because PHLX owns the technologies, it does not have to pay a third-party for the right to license the technology.

NASDAQ OMX researched public documents and accessed the Royalty Source database for license agreements involving similar trade names in the financial services industries. The guideline sample of license agreements yielded a range of royalty rates extending from 0.25% to 40.0% for financial services technologies. Based on the functionality of the technologies, NASDAQ OMX estimated the royalty rates to be 8.0% for XL, XLE, and SCCP technologies and 5.0% for PBOT technology.

The cash flows were then tax-effected at a rate of 40.0%, and a discounted tax amortization benefit was added to the fair value of the asset under the assumption that the technologies would be amortized for tax purposes over a period of 15 years.

 

8


The following is a summary of the indicated fair value for XL, PBOT, XLE, and SCCP technologies:

 

     XL    PBOT    XLE    SCCP    Total
          (in millions)     

Sum of discounted cash flows

   $ 6.2    $ 0.0    $ 0.0    $ 0.0    $ 6.2

Discounted tax amortization benefit

     1.4      0.0      0.0      0.0      1.4
                                  

Indicated fair value

   $ 7.6    $ 0.0    $ 0.0    $ 0.0    $ 7.6
                                  

The estimated useful life of the technologies was based on discussions with PHLX management as to the likely duration of benefit to be derived from the technology. Since NASDAQ OMX will be re-platforming most of the existing technologies, NASDAQ OMX considered the migration cycle for re-platforming the existing technologies. NASDAQ OMX also gave consideration to paragraph 11 of SFAS 142 and to the pace of the technological changes in the industries in which PHLX sells its products.

Technology – Supporting

The fair values of certain supporting technologies were valued using the cost approach, specifically the replacement cost new approach, to determine the current cost to purchase or replace the supporting technologies. This valuation methodology is based on the concept that a prudent investor would pay no more for an asset than the amount necessary to replace the asset.

The following is a summary of the indicated fair value for the supporting technologies:

 

(in millions)

   Supporting

Sum of estimated replacement costs

   $ 2.5

Discounted tax amortization benefit

     0.5
      

Indicated fair value

   $ 3.0
      

Trade Name

In valuing PHLX’s trade names and trademarks, we used the income approach, specifically the relief from royalty approach, relying on publicly available information to determine the royalty rate that PHLX would have to pay a third-party for the use of the trade name. This valuation methodology is based on the concept that because PHLX owns the trade name, it does not have to pay a third-party for the right to use the trade name.

NASDAQ OMX researched public documents and accessed the Royalty Source database for license agreements involving similar trade names in the financial services and technology industries. The guideline sample of license agreements yielded a typical royalty rate of 0.5% for financial services companies.

The cash flows were then tax-effected at a rate of 40.0%, and a discounted tax amortization benefit was added to the fair value of the asset under the assumption that the trade name would be amortized for tax purposes over a period of 15 years.

The following is a summary of the indicated fair value for the trade name asset:

 

(in millions)

   Total

Sum of discounted cash flows

   $ 5.2

Discounted tax amortization benefit

     1.2
      

Indicated fair value

   $ 6.4
      

Customer Relationships and Technology Lives

The following summarizes the methodologies and assumptions NASDAQ OMX used to estimate the remaining economic lives of the customer relationships and technology.

a. The expected use of the asset by the entity—As previously discussed, most of the existing technology will be re-platformed or discontinued in the next two years. The determination of the useful life of supporting technologies was based on the historical development and life cycles of existing technology products within NASDAQ OMX.

 

9


b. The expected useful life of another asset or group of assets to which the useful life of the intangible asset may relate—The useful lives of the technology and customer relationships assets are not significantly impacted by any other asset or group of assets. The life of the customer relationships is about 19 to 23 years. For technology, the existing technologies will be re-platformed in the next 0.25 to two years whereas supporting technologies have a 5 year life.

c. Any legal, regulatory or contractual provisions that may limit the useful life—We are not aware of any.

d. Any legal, regulatory or contractual provisions that enable renewal or extension of the asset’s legal or contractual life without substantial cost—We are not aware of any other legal, regulatory, or contractual provisions that may impact the lives of the customer relationships and technology.

e. The effects of obsolescence, demand, competition, and other economic factors—Since NASDAQ OMX will re-platform most of the existing technologies, they would become obsolete in approximately 0.25 to two years. The life cycles were based on the business plans to re-platform the existing technologies within NASDAQ OMX and PHLX. With regards to the customer relationships, an analysis of attrition rates was performed based on historical information.

f. The level of maintenance expenditures required to obtain the expected future cash flows from the asset. PHLX expects to incur research and development expenses to maintain its technology. With respect to the customer relationships, PHLX incurs little, if any, sales and marketing expenses to maintain the current customers. NASDAQ OMX believes that historically the research and development have maintained the quality of its products and services, thus contributing to the shorter life.

Deferred Tax Liability

A $5.0 million current deferred tax liability and a $147.9 million non-current deferred tax liability (total deferred tax liability of $152.9 million) has been set up against the $335.0 million value of PHLX’s assets outlined in the above table. The deferred tax liabilities represent the tax effect of the difference between the estimated assigned fair value of the acquired intangible assets ($335.0 million) and the tax basis ($0) of such assets. The estimated amount of $152.9 million is determined by multiplying the difference of $335.0 million by the U.S. effective tax rate of 45.66%.

b) To adjust general, administrative and other expense for non-recurring charges recorded by PHLX in 2007 of $3.1 million related to the payment for a class action lawsuit that was settled in 2007 and $2.5 million expense related to additional PHLX Board of Governors meeting fees. The additional meeting expense was related to the acquisition by NASDAQ OMX. The total adjustment to general, administrative and other expense totaled $5.6 million.

c) To adjust debt obligations for the borrowing of $650.0 million ($24.4 million short-term and $625.6 million long-term) under our senior secured term loan facility to finance the $652.0 million cash payment for the acquisition of PHLX. NASDAQ OMX utilized cash on hand for the difference between the cash purchase price of $652.0 million and the debt financing of $650.0 million and also utilized $43.0 million of cash on hand for both the acquisition and acquisition-related costs. The term loan has a variable interest rate.

 

10


Pro forma interest expense resulting from our additional debt obligation is as follows (dollars in millions):

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
2007
    Three Months
Ended
March 31,
2008
 

Average term loan borrowing (i)

   $ 647.0  (1)   $ 625.6 (1)  

Interest rate (average 3 month LIBOR plus spread of 2.0%) (ii)

     7.36 %     6.33 %

Months outstanding (iii)

     12/12       3/12  
                

Pro forma adjustment (i)* (ii)*(iii)

   $ 47.6     $ 9.9  
                

 

 

(1)

The terms of our senior secured term loan facility contain a mandatory principal payment of $12.2 million each quarter beginning September 30, 2008. We have incorporated these payments in our average outstanding debt obligation as of December 31, 2007 and March 31, 2008 as if they began on September 30, 2007, in order to calculate interest expense for the periods then ended.

A 1.0% increase in the variable interest rate on the senior secured term loan facility would result in additional pro forma interest expense of $6.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2007 and $1.6 million for the three months ended March 31, 2008.

d) To record an income tax benefit of $26.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2007 and $5.8 million for the three months ended March 31, 2008 based on the PHLX pro forma income statement adjustments related to the following items (in millions):

 

December 31, 2007

   Jurisdiction    Amount     Tax Rate     Tax Benefit  

Depreciation and amortization

   U.S.    $ 11.0     45.66 %   $ 5.0  

General, administrative and other

   U.S.      (1.6 (1)   45.66 %     (0.7 )

Interest expense

   U.S.      47.6     45.66 %     21.7  
                     

Total

      $ 57.0       $ 26.0  
                     

 

 

(1)

Of the $5.6 million pro forma adjustment to general, administrative and other expense, $1.6 million is tax deductible and included in the pro forma tax adjustment.

 

March 31, 2008

   Jurisdiction    Amount    Tax Rate     Tax Benefit

Depreciation and amortization

   U.S.    $ 2.8    45.66 %   $ 1.3

Interest expense

   U.S.      9.9    45.66 %     4.5
                  

Total

      $ 12.7      $ 5.8
                  

Note 4. Equity Investment in DIFX

As part of the Transactions, we also acquired 33 1/3% of the equity of DIFX in exchange for $50 million of cash consideration to DIFX and the entry into certain technology and trademark licensing agreements. These agreements are intended to be nontransferable and perpetual, subject to various exceptions. The agreements grant to DIFX and/or its affiliates rights to use or sublicense certain intellectual property (including, in some instances, on an exclusive basis). We will also be responsible for 50% of any additional capital contribution calls made by DIFX, subject to a maximum aggregate additional commitment by us of up to $25 million.

Included in the NASDAQ OMX historical balance sheet as of March 31, 2008 is our equity method investment in DIFX, for approximately $128 million. Our investment includes $50 million of cash consideration and the contribution of certain licenses related to our technology, or technology licenses, and the Nasdaq trade name with a gross value of $117 million (net value of $78 million after reduction by the portion of economic interest retained through our 33 1/3% equity investment in DIFX). Upon the concurrent closing of the Transactions, we recognized a non-recurring pre-tax gain of $26 million ($15.7 million after-tax) in the first quarter of 2008 on the transfer of the Nasdaq trade name asset. In accordance with Regulation S-X, we have excluded this $26 million gain and related tax effect from the December 31, 2007 and March 31, 2008 unaudited pro forma condensed combined statements of income as it represents a material non-recurring charge. In addition, as discussed below, we recorded deferred revenue of $52 million related to the transfer of the technology licenses and will ratably recognize this revenue over a seven year period, which is an estimate of the relevant period for which service will be provided to DIFX.

The basis of the estimated fair values of the technology licenses and the Nasdaq trade name and the calculation of deferred revenue on the technology licenses and the calculation of the Nasdaq trade name pre-tax and after-tax gains are presented below.

 

11


Estimated Fair Value of Licenses related to Technology and Calculation of Deferred Revenue

Estimated Fair Value of Technology Licenses

The technology licenses contributed to DIFX was valued using the cost savings method. As part of the Transactions, DIFX was granted the rights to use or sublicense certain intellectual property (including in some instances, on an exclusive basis) for use in DIFX’s operations in certain territories. Furthermore, DIFX can sublicense current or future commercially available technologies owned by NASDAQ OMX to any of its affiliated entities. Nasdaq estimated the hypothetical after-tax license fees saved by DIFX based on similar license agreements. The applicable license fees saved by the affiliated entities were based on the analysis of likely licensors of commercially available technologies. A hypothetical license agreement with DIFX and their affiliated entities was assumed to span a period of five years, and the license fees were assumed to be paid at the beginning of each period. The tax rate in Dubai is zero. The tax-effected license fee savings cash flows were discounted at a rate of 19.1%. The discount rate was developed using the comparable public company data and economic data reflecting the risk environment in DIFX’s market area. The discount rate was based on the capital asset pricing model and represents the weighted-average cost of capital.

The fair value of the technology licenses was determined to be approximately $78 million.

Calculation of Deferred Revenue

As part of the perpetual technology license agreement, we are obligated to provide DIFX with additional unspecified software developed or marketed by NASDAQ OMX in the future. As such, we have deemed our contribution of technology to be an “in-substance subscription” in accordance with SOP 97-2, “Software Revenue Recognition.” As such, revenue that is earned as a result of the license agreement will be recognized ratably over its estimated economic useful life. We have recorded deferred revenue equal to the fair value of the technology licenses. The deferred revenue will be reduced by the portion of the economic interest retained since we will have a 33 1/3% equity investment in DIFX and the deferred revenue will be recognized ratably over the estimated economic useful life of the technology licenses, which is seven years.

Calculation is as follows:

 

 

 

$78 million value to technology licenses *66  2/3% interest sold = $52 million.

As noted above, the $52 million will be recognized ratably over the estimated economic useful life of the technology licenses which is estimated to be seven years. As the recognition of this revenue is considered a recurring item, we have included a pro forma adjustment to revenue of $7.4 million ($4.5 million after-tax) for the year ended December 31, 2007 and $1.2 million ($0.7 million after-tax) for the period ended February 26, 2008 in the unaudited pro forma condensed combined statements of income.

Estimated Fair Value of License related to the Nasdaq Trade Name and Calculation of Gain on Transfer of the Nasdaq Trade Name

Estimated Fair Value of Nasdaq Trade Name

Nasdaq used the relief from royalty method in valuing DIFX’s right to the Nasdaq trade name. As a part of the Transactions, DIFX received rights to use the Nasdaq trade name. The valuation methodology used is based on the after-tax royalties saved by DIFX because of the licensing agreement. The royalty rate used was selected after researching publicly available information on license agreements involving similar trade names. Based on these license agreements, a royalty rate of 3.0% was selected, which was multiplied by DIFX’s projected revenue stream to derive the after-tax royalty savings. The tax rate in Dubai is zero. The resulting after-tax royalty savings were discounted using a rate of 19.1%, which represents the weighted average cost of capital.

The fair value of the license related to the Nasdaq trade name was determined to be approximately $39 million.

Calculation of Gain on Transfer of Asset

As noted above, the fair value of the license related to the Nasdaq trade name was approximately $39 million and had a zero carrying value on Nasdaq’s books and records prior to the transfer. The contribution of the Nasdaq trade name is considered an exchange of monetary assets in accordance with EITF 01-02 “Interpretations of APB Opinion No. 29”, therefore we determined that a gain should be recognized for the difference between Nasdaq’s carrying value and the fair value of this contributed asset. This gain is reduced by the portion of economic interest retained since we will have a 33 1/3% equity investment in DIFX, resulting in a gain of $26.0 million (15.7 million after-tax)

The pre-tax gain was calculated as follows:

 

 

 

$39 million value to trade name *66  2/3% interest sold = $26 million.

 

12


The after-tax gain was calculated as follows:

 

   

$26 million gain less taxes at 39.55% ($10.3 million) = $15.7 million.

DIFX Loss Calculation

Under the equity method of accounting, we recognized a loss of $7.4 million (4.5 million after-tax) for the year ended December 31, 2007 and $1.4 million ($0.8 million after-tax) for the period ended February 26, 2008 on our investment in DIFX. The loss was calculated as 33 1/3% of DIFX’s net loss for the respective periods. DIFX recorded a loss of $22.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2007 and $4.3 million for the three months ended March 31, 2008, under IFRS. The difference between IFRS and U.S. GAAP was immaterial. The amortization expense related to identified finite lived intangible assets was immaterial.

Note 5. OMX Pro Forma Adjustments

(a) To record amortization expense on OMX intangible assets (in millions):

 

     Value     Estimated Average
Remaining
Useful Life
(in Years)
   Estimated Annual
Depreciation and

Amortization Expense
for 2007
    Estimated
Depreciation and
Amortization Expense
for the period
January 1, 2008
through February 26,
2008, adjusted(3)
 

Intangible assets:

         

Exchange registrations

   $ 1,143.7     Indefinite      #       #  

Trade name

     195.7     Indefinite      #       #  

Customer relationships:

         

Issuer/Market Services

     439.9     22-28 years    $ 17.6     $ 3.0  

Market Technology

     65.3     22-26 years      2.7       0.1  
                           

Total customer relationships

     505.2          20.3       3.1  

Market technology:

         

Developed

     28.7     3 years      9.6       0.5  

New

     4.5     9 years      —   (2)     —   (2)
                           

Total market technology

     33.2          9.6       0.5  
               

Total intangible assets

   $ 1,877.8  (1)       
               

Total depreciation and amortization expense

        $ 29.9     $ 3.6  (3)
                     

# —Not Applicable

 

(1)

As we finalize the factors and assumptions that we obtained to determine the purchase price allocation, the fair values of certain purchased intangible assets were adjusted resulting in a decrease of $163.6 million. The adjusted fair value of purchased intangible assets is $1,877.8 million. Based on the adjusted fair values, current and non-current deferred tax liabilities decreased $6.6 million and $58.1 million, respectively, and goodwill increased $98.9 million. We have not finalized the allocation of the purchase price related to the OMX business combination and expect there to be further adjustments to goodwill within one year from the purchase date.

 

(2)

The new technology asset is not in production, therefore we have not recorded amortization expense related to this intangible asset.

 

(3)

Based on our preliminary estimate of the fair values of intangible assets, NASDAQ OMX recorded $3.9 million of amortization expense related to OMX’s intangible assets in our historical condensed consolidated statement of income for the three months ended March 31, 2008. As noted in footnote (1) above, as we finalize the factors and assumptions that we obtained to determine the purchase price allocation, the fair values of certain purchased intangible assets were adjusted and are stated above. Based on the adjusted fair values, the estimated amortization expense for the three months ended March 31, 2008 is $7.5 million. Therefore, $3.6 million ($7.5 million less $3.9 million) of amortization expense was recorded in the pro forma condensed combined statement of income for the period January 1, 2008 through February 26, 2008.

In performing the preliminary purchase price allocation, Nasdaq considered, among other factors, the intention for the future use of the acquired assets, analyses of historical financial performance, and an estimate of the future performance of OMX’s business. The preliminary estimate of the fair values of intangible assets is based, in part, on a valuation using an income or cost approach, as appropriate. The risk-adjusted discount rates used to compute the present value of the expected net cash flows of individual intangible assets were based on OMX’s weighted average cost of capital, which ranged from 7.8% to 9.6%. These discount rates were determined after consideration of OMX’s rate of return on debt and equity and the weighted-average return on invested capital. In estimating the remaining useful lives of the intangible assets, we considered the six factors presented in paragraph 11 of SFAS 142 and an analysis of the intangible assets’ relevant historical attrition data.

 

13


Exchange and Clearing Registrations

The exchange and clearing registrations represent licenses that provide OMX with the ability to operate its equity and derivative exchanges as well as the clearing function. Nasdaq views these intangible assets as a perpetual license to operate the exchanges so long as OMX meets its regulatory requirements. Nasdaq selected a variation of the income approach called the Greenfield Approach to value the exchange and clearing registrations. The Greenfield Approach refers to a discounted cash flow analysis that assumes the buyer is building the exchange and clearing operations from a start-up business to a normalized level of operations as of the acquisition date. This discounted cash flow model considers the required resources and eventual returns from the build-out of operational exchanges and the acquisition of customers, once the exchange and clearing registrations are obtained. The advantage of the approach is that it reflects the actual expectations that will arise from an investment in the registrations and it directly values the registrations. The Greenfield Approach relies on assumptions regarding projected revenues, margins, capital expenditures, depreciation, and working capital during the two year pre-trade phase, the 10 year ramp-up period as well as the terminal period.

A steady state projection for OMX was established first. The projection included synergies that a market participant buyer could realize. Since OMX has a strong market position, Nasdaq assumed that the projected revenues represent nearly 100.0% of the potential market until 2019, and that a market participant would be able to achieve 90.0% of the market within the 12 year ramp-up period. A terminal growth rate of 4.0% was chosen as a reasonable estimate of the growth rate of the stock exchange industry on a long-term basis. A steady state projection was used starting in year 12 based on the assumption that a stock exchange can expect to reach normalized operations at this time.

Nasdaq characterized the costs into fixed costs, variable costs, and technology costs. Annual fixed costs remained constant throughout the projection at approximately $135.8 million, which represents 50.0% of normalized costs. The remaining 50.0% of the costs were variable costs, which were estimated as a proportion to the revenue. It was estimated that OMX would have to incur approximately $200.0 million in upfront technology to start the exchanges, and ongoing maintenance technology costs would be equal to 15.0% of revenues thereafter.

The initial capital expenditures in years one and two reflect the costs associated with obtaining the fixed assets and the minimal regulatory fees required to start exchanges. Subsequent annual capital expenditures and depreciation were estimated at 6.1% of the revenue, assuming that maintenance capital expenditures are required to replace the depreciated fixed assets. Nasdaq also assumed that the exchanges would require $100.0 million of initial clearing capital which would increase to $300.0 million by the time the exchange reached normalized operations.

Based on historical working capital levels and a review of working capital for comparable companies operating in the industry, working capital for a typical market participant, as a percentage of incremental revenue, is projected to be approximately 12.5%.

The cash flows were then tax-effected at a rate of 25.0%, and a discounted tax amortization benefit was added to the fair value of the asset under the assumption that the exchange registrations would be amortized for tax purposes over a period of seven years.

An indefinite life was assumed for these registrations as the exchanges have operated, in some cases, for more than 140 years and the authorization to operate these exchanges is perpetual so long as OMX meets its regulatory requirements. Furthermore, since no legal, contractual, competitive, economic, or other factors limit the useful life of these intangible assets, Nasdaq considered the useful life of the exchange and clearing registrations to be indefinite. As noted above, we assessed the factors listed in paragraph 11 of SFAS 142 in making this indefinite life determination.

The fair value of the exchange registrations was determined to be approximately $1,143.7 million.

Trade Name

Nasdaq has incorporated OMX into three reporting segments - Issuer Services, Market Services, and Market Technology. The OMX trade name was valued as used in each of these reporting segments. The trade name represents the value of the market recognition of quality service that OMX and its predecessor entities have developed in their 140 years of operation. In valuing the acquired trade names, we used the income approach, specifically the relief from royalty approach, relying on publicly available information to determine the royalty rate that OMX would have to pay a third-party for the use of the trade name. This valuation methodology is based on the concept that because OMX owns the trade name, it does not have to pay a third-party for the right to use the trade name.

Nasdaq researched public documents and accessed the Royalty Source database for license agreements involving similar trade names in the financial services and technology industries. The guideline sample of license agreements yielded a range of royalty rates extending from 0.5% to 2.0% for financial services and technology companies. Based on the margins of the reporting segments, Nasdaq estimated the royalty rates to be 2.0% for Issuer Services, 2.0% for Market Services, and 0.5% for Market Technology.

The cash flows were then tax-effected at a rate of 25.0%, and a discounted tax amortization benefit was added to the fair value of the asset under the assumption that the trade name would be amortized for tax purposes over a period of seven years for Issuer Services and Market Services and five years for Market Technology.

 

14


The following is a summary of the indicated fair value for the trade name asset:

 

     Issuer
Services
   Market
Services
   Market
Technology
   Total
     (in millions)

Sum of discounted cash flows

   $ 17.8    $ 126.3    $ 15.0    $ 159.1

Discounted tax amortization benefit

     4.1      28.6      3.9      36.6
                           

Indicated fair value

   $ 21.9    $ 154.9    $ 18.9    $ 195.7
                           

Customer Relationships

Customer relationships represent the non-contractual and contractual relationships that OMX has with issuers, traders, information vendors, and technology customers. OMX’s customer relationships were valued using the income approach, specifically an excess earnings method. This valuation approach relied on assumptions regarding projected revenues, attrition rates, and operating cash flows for each customer type, which were projected up to 45 years.

The following chart depicts OMX’s primary revenue streams and how the 2008 revenues were divided amongst the three customer relationship intangible assets:

 

     Issuer
Services
    Market
Services
    Market
Technology
    Unallocated  
     (in millions)  

The Nordic Exchange

        

Trading revenues

     100 %    

Issuers’ revenues

   100 %      

Other revenues

         100 %

Information Services

        

Information sales

     100 %    

Revenues from Baltic Markets

     100 %    

Revenues from Broker Services

     100 %    

Other revenues

         100 %

Market Technology

        

License, support, and project revenues

       75 %   25 %

Facility management services revenues

       75 %   25 %

Other revenues

         100 %

For operating income, Nasdaq assumed that the weighted-average growth for existing customers was 20.0% for each reporting segment. Nasdaq also adjusted for synergies that would be available to the typical market participant, as well as the cost savings, assumed to be 2.0% of revenue, related to servicing an existing customer base versus a future revenue base.

Nasdaq assumed annual revenue attrition of 5.0% for the customers for all reporting segments, as well as charges for contributory assets. The tax-effected cash flows were discounted at a rate of 9.6%, 10.1%, and 8.0% for Issuer Services, Market Services, and Market Technology, respectively.

The cash flows were then tax-effected at a rate of 25.0%, and a discounted tax amortization benefit was added to the fair value of the asset under the assumption that the customer relationships would be amortized for tax purposes over a period of seven years for Issuer and Market Services and five years for Market Technology.

The following is a summary of the indicated fair value for the customer relationship assets:

 

     Issuer
Services
   Market
Services
   Market
Technology
   Total
     (in millions)

Sum of discounted cash flows

   $ 103.3    $ 256.4    $ 51.7    $ 411.4

Discounted tax amortization benefit

     23.3      56.9      13.6      93.8
                           

Indicated fair value

   $ 126.6    $ 313.3    $ 65.3    $ 505.2
                           

 

15


The estimated remaining useful life captures 90.0% to 95.0% of the present value of the cash flows generated by each customer relationship. The remaining useful life was determined based on an analysis of the historical attrition rates of OMX customers and paragraph 11 of SFAS 142, which included an analysis of the legal, regulatory, contractual, competitive, economic, or other factors that limit the useful life of this intangible asset. The useful life is addressed in the section below, which discusses the assessment of the lives of the customer relationships and market technology.

Technology – Licensed to Third Parties

Nasdaq acquired two types of technology from OMX, developed and new. The developed technology represents the existing portfolio of software technologies that OMX had developed or acquired. These software technologies are licensed to more than 60 external unrelated customers and are also currently used internally by OMX. The new technology includes Genium. Our future technology platform is an ongoing effort as we further evaluate both Nasdaq and OMX technologies. NASDAQ OMX has refocused the development of Genium to combine our INET (Nasdaq’s current trading platform) and CLICK technologies with the original Genium concepts and components. Ongoing Genium development will predominantly incorporate our core INET functionality, including order routing that will be deployed in the new NASDAQ OMX Pan-European Market. We will develop new integrated trading and clearing functions based on CLICK and SECUR, and the Genium platform will include Genium Market Info, our information dissemination solution. The Nordic Exchange will begin the migration to the Genium platform in 2010. The fair values of the technologies licensed to third parties were computed using the income approach, specifically the excess earnings approach. This valuation approach relied on assumptions regarding projected revenues, operating cash flows and core technology charges for each technology, which were projected over three years for developed technology and over 10 years for new technology.

The technology revenue streams include 75.0% of license, support, and project revenues and facility management services revenues. Nasdaq assumed that certain customers will gradually start migrating from the existing technology to Genium starting in 2010 and will be almost fully migrated to Genium by 2014.

The projected margins for the technology business are consistent with the overall Market Technology business but are adjusted for research and development, or R&D, costs spent on each technology. Nasdaq assumed that for developed technology, 2.0% of the overall expenses were related to R&D associated with developed technology, and that for new technology, 10.0% of the overall expenses were related to R&D associated with developed technology.

A contributory asset charge for the use of other assets was deducted from the after-tax operating income yielding the excess earnings generated by the technologies, which were discounted at a rate of 8.0% for developed and new technologies.

The cash flows were then tax-effected at a rate of 25.0%, and a discounted tax amortization benefit was added to the fair value of the asset under the assumption that the technology would be amortized for tax purposes over a period of five years.

The fair value of the new technology was adjusted for the INET components that Nasdaq and OMX are incorporating into Genium, which represented approximately 96.0% of value.

The following is a summary of the indicated fair value for the technology asset:

 

     Developed
Technology
   New
Technology
 
     (in millions)  

Sum of discounted cash flows

   $ 0.5    $ 36.7  

Discounted tax amortization benefit

     0.1      9.6  
               

Indicated fair value

     0.6      46.3  

Value Adjustment for Nasdaq and OMX

     —        (44.7 )
               

Indicated fair value

   $ 0.6    $ 1.6  
               

The estimated useful life of the developed and new technology was based on discussions with OMX management as to the likely duration of benefit to be derived from the technology. Nasdaq considered such factors as the migration cycle from the existing technology to Genium, the estimated research and development costs, and the development of future generations of technology. Nasdaq also gave consideration to paragraph 11 of SFAS 142 and to the pace of the technological changes in the industries in which OMX sells its products.

 

16


Technology – Internal Use

The fair values of the internally used technology were valued using the income approach, specifically the relief from royalty approach, relying on publicly available information to determine the royalty rate that OMX would have to pay a third-party for the use of the technologies. This valuation methodology is based on the concept that because OMX owns the technologies it does not have to pay a third-party for the right to license the technology.

Nasdaq researched public documents and accessed the Royalty Source database for license agreements involving similar trade names in the financial services and technology industries. The guideline sample of license agreements yielded a range of royalty rates extending from 0.25% to 40.0% for financial services technologies. Based on the functionality of the technologies, Nasdaq estimated the royalty rates to be 5.0% for the developed and new technology.

The cash flows were then tax-effected at a rate of 25.0%, and a discounted tax amortization benefit was added to the fair value of the asset under the assumption that the technologies would be amortized for tax purposes over a period of seven years.

The fair value of the new technology was adjusted for the INET components that Nasdaq and OMX are incorporating into Genium, which represented approximately 96.0% of value.

The following is a summary of the indicated fair value for the internally licensed existing and new technologies:

 

     Developed
Technology
   New
Technology
 
     (in millions)  

Sum of discounted cash flows

   $ 22.9    $ 66.4  

Discounted tax amortization benefit

     5.2      15.0  
               

Indicated fair value

     28.1      81.4  

Value Adjustment for Nasdaq and OMX

     —        (78.5 )
               

Indicated fair value

   $ 28.1    $ 2.9  
               

Customer Relationships and Market Technology Lives

The following summarizes the methodologies and assumptions Nasdaq used to estimate the remaining economic lives of the customer relationships and market technology.

a. The expected use of the asset by the entity—As previously discussed, the existing technology will be partially replaced by the Genium technology over the next 6 years. In addition, the existing technology and Genium technology will be obsolete after three and 10 years, respectively. The determination of the useful life of Genium was based on the historical development and life cycles of existing technology products within Nasdaq and OMX.

b. The expected useful life of another asset or group of assets to which the useful life of the intangible asset may relate—The useful lives of the technology and customer relationship assets are not significantly impacted by any other asset or group of assets. The life of the customer relationships varies depending on the customers. The issuers generally have a 22 to 28 year life, the traders/information vendors have a 22 to 28 year life, and the market technology customers have a 22 to 26 year life. For technology, the existing technology has a three year life whereas Genium has a 9 to 10 year life.

c. Any legal, regulatory or contractual provisions that may limit the useful life—We are not aware of any.

d. Any legal, regulatory or contractual provisions that enable renewal or extension of the asset’s legal or contractual life without substantial cost—The market technology customers enter into license and facilities management contracts with a duration of three to 10 years. Such contracts are generally renewed at least once with minimal cost. The useful life of 22 to 26 years was selected based on the fact that many contracts are renewed more than one time, and a majority of the contracts have terms in the eight to 10 year range. We are not aware of any other legal, regulatory, or contractual provisions that may impact the lives of the customer relationships and market technology.

e. The effects of obsolescence, demand, competition, and other economic factors—Genium will be introduced both internally and externally beginning in 2010 and will be fully operational by 2009. The existing technology would become obsolete in approximately three years. In addition, Genium would become obsolete in approximately ten years should OMX not invest in upgrades and improvements. The life cycles were based on the historical development and life cycles of existing software products within Nasdaq and OMX.

 

17


With respect to the customer relationships, the issuers are generally loyal to their home country and, as such, list on the local exchanges. Most delistings relate to mergers or acquisitions rather than competition. However, within Europe, there has been increased competition with respect to the trading business, resulting in higher attrition rates for the listing/information vendor business. Finally, for the market technology customers, OMX faced competition from exchanges that choose to develop their own exchange technologies. The present competition does not have a large impact on the life cycle as customers typically return due to better pricing options and the high cost of changing providers.

f. The level of maintenance expenditures required to obtain the expected future cash flows from the asset. OMX expects to incur research and development expenses to maintain its technology. With respect to the customer relationships, OMX incurs sales and marketing expenses to maintain the current customers. Nasdaq believes that historically the research and development and sales and marketing expenses have maintained the quality of its products and services, thus contributing to a longer life.

(b) To eliminate amortization expense of $12.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2007 and $2.2 million for the period ended February 26, 2008 related to the historical intangible assets recorded by OMX.

(c) To adjust debt obligations for the borrowing of $1,050.0 million under our senior secured term loan facility and $475.0 million in 2.50% convertible senior notes by Nasdaq to finance the $1,967.8 million cash payment for OMX and refinance existing debt at OMX of $294.1 million. Nasdaq also utilized cash on hand for the cash payment for OMX and the OMX debt refinancing, which totaled $736.9 million. The senior secured term loan facility has a variable interest rate and the notes have a fixed interest rate.

Pro forma interest expense is as follows (dollars in millions):

 

     Year Ended
December 31,
2007
    For the Period
January 1, 2008

through
February 26,
2008
 

Average term loan borrowing (i)

   $ 1,045.1  (1)   $ 1,010.6 (1)

Interest rate (average 3 month LIBOR plus spread of 2.0%) (ii)

     7.36 %     6.25 %

Months outstanding (iii)

     12/12       2/12  
                

Pro forma adjustment (i)*(ii)*(iii)

   $ 76.9     $ 10.5  
                

Convertible note borrowing (iv)

   $ 475.0     $ 475.0  

Interest rate (fixed 2.5%) (v)

     2.5 %     2.5 %

Months outstanding (vi)

     12/12       2/12  
                

Pro forma adjustment (iv)*(v)*(vi)

   $ 11.9     $ 2.0  
                

Total pro forma interest expense

   $ 88.8     $ 12.5  
                

 

(1)

The terms of our senior secured term loan facility contain a mandatory principal payment of $19.7 million each quarter beginning September 30, 2008. We have incorporated these payments in our average outstanding debt obligation as of December 31, 2007 and February 26, 2008 as if they began on Septemer 30, 2007, in order to calculate interest expense for the periods then ended.

A 1.0% increase in the variable interest rate on the term loan would result in additional pro forma interest expense of $10.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2007 and $1.7 million for the period January 1, 2008 through February 26, 2008.

As the interest expense calculated above includes the refinancing of the existing OMX debt, we have included pro forma adjustments to remove OMX’s historical interest expense of $21.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2007 and $3.4 million for the period January 1, 2008 through February 26, 2008.

In addition, Nasdaq incurred and paid with cash on hand $46.8 million in debt issuance costs related to the above, which were capitalized as other assets at the time of the combination and will be amortized over five years. We recorded pro forma amortization expense of $9.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2007 and $1.5 million for the period January 1, 2008 through February 26, 2008 in the unaudited pro forma condensed combined statements of income.

(d) NASDAQ OMX owned 98.8% of the outstanding shares of OMX at March 31, 2008 and recorded minority interest for the 1.2% of OMX’s net income from February 27, 2008 through March 31, 2008. For pro forma purposes, we assume that we have a 100.0% ownership in OMX as of January 1, 2007 and therefore excluded $0.2 million of minority interest recorded in the NASDAQ OMX historical condensed combined statement of income for the three months ended March 31, 2008.

 

18


(e) To record an income tax benefit of $140.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2007 and $18.1 million for the three months ended March 31, 2008 based on the condensed combined statements of income OMX pro forma adjustments related to the following items (in millions):

December 31, 2007

 

Item

   Jurisdiction    Amount     Tax Rate     Tax Benefit  

Depreciation and amortization

   Sweden    $ (12.8 )   28.0 %   $ (3.6 )

Depreciation and amortization

   U.S      29.9     39.6 %     11.9  

Professional and contract services

   Sweden      (11.8 )   28.0 %     (3.3 )

Computer operations and data communications

   Sweden      (12.9 )   28.0 %     (3.6 )

General, administrative and other

   U.S      (5.8 )   39.6 %     (2.3 )

Interest income

   U.S      16.3     39.6 %     6.4  

Interest expense

   U.S      40.7     39.6 %     16.1  

Interest expense

   Sweden      (21.4 )   28.0 %     (6.0 )

Loss on foreign currency option contracts

   U.S      (7.8 )   39.6 %     (3.1 )

Dividend income

   U.S      14.5     35.0 %     5.1  

Gain on sale of strategic initiative

   U.S      431.4     31.0 %     133.7  

Strategic initiative costs

   U.S      (26.5 )   39.6 %     (10.5 )
                     

Total

      $ 433.8       $ 140.8  
                     
March 31, 2008          

Item

   Jurisdiction    Amount     Tax Rate     Tax Benefit  

Depreciation and amortization

   Sweden    $ (2.2 )   28.0 %   $ (0.6 )

Depreciation and amortization

   U.S      3.6     39.6 %     1.4  

Interest income

   U.S      6.4     39.6 %     2.6  

Interest expense

   U.S      13.9     39.6 %     5.5  

Interest expense

   Sweden      (3.4 )   28.0 %     (1.0 )

Gain from unconsolidated investees, net

   U.S      26.0     39.6 %     10.3  

Minority interest

   U.S      (0.2 )   39.6 %     (0.1 )
                     

Total

      $ 44.1       $ 18.1  
                     

(f) To adjust the weighted average number of shares outstanding used to determine basic and diluted pro forma earnings per share based upon approximately 60.6 million Nasdaq shares issued upon completion of the Transactions. The historical NASDAQ OMX condensed combined statement of income for three months ended March 31, 2008 included the 60.6 million Nasdaq shares issued on February 27, 2008 in the weighted average number of shares outstanding since that date. The additional 37.9 million shares included in the March 31, 2008 unaudited pro forma condensed combined statement of income represents the pro forma weighted average affect of issuing the 60.6 million shares as of January 1, 2007.

For the year ended December 31, 2007, 2.8 million options and 37,753 shares of restricted stock were considered antidilutive and were properly excluded.

For the three month ended March 31, 2008, 2.8 million options and 736 shares of restricted stock were considered antidilutive and were properly excluded.

(g) OMX has incurred direct acquisition-related costs related to the proposed offer, which includes legal and advisory fees. Nasdaq and OMX signed an agreement where Nasdaq will reimburse OMX for such costs. Therefore, under IFRS, OMX has deferred such costs until reimbursed by Nasdaq.

Under U.S. GAAP, since the agreement to reimburse such costs is not unconditional, OMX has recognized these acquisition-related costs incurred as expense in their historical statement of income for the year ended December 31, 2007. As these costs are material non-recurring transactions under Regulation S-X, we recorded a pro forma adjustment to exclude these costs from the pro forma condensed combined statement of income. At December 31, 2007, these direct acquisition costs totaled $11.8 million.

(h) To adjust computer operations and data communications expense for a non-recurring charge of $12.9 million incurred by OMX in 2007 related to a valued added tax surcharge for the support and operations services OMX purchased from other companies within the OMX group.

 

19


(i) To adjust interest income earned on the cash received from the sale of our investment in the LSE. Pro forma cash and cash equivalents is net of the cash received from the sale of the LSE investment, as well as cash used for the business combination with OMX and PHLX acquisition (in millions):

 

     Year ended
December 31,
2007
    Period ended
March 31,
2008
 

Pro forma cash and cash equivalents (i)

   $ 421.3     $ 728.6  

Average interest income rate (ii)

     5.05 %     2.06 %

Months outstanding (iii)

     12/12       3/12  
                

Interest income on pro forma cash balance (i)*(ii)*(iii)

   $ 21.3     $ 3.7  

Historical interest income (iv)

     37.6       10.1  
                

Pro forma interest income adjustment (iii)-(iv)

   $ (16.3 )   $ (6.4 )
                

Note 6. LSE Related Transactions

(a) In accordance with Regulation S-X, we have excluded the material non-recurring charges or credits and related tax effects related to our investment in the LSE that were included in our historical statement of income for the year ended December 31, 2007. The remaining effects of the LSE Transaction have been included in our pro forma condensed combined statement of income.

The LSE related transactions for the year ended December 31, 2007 included the following (in millions, except dividend per share and exchange rate):

 

Income (expense)

            

•   Loss on the early extinguishment of debt related to the repayment of our credit facilities

     $ (5.8 )

•   Interest expense related to the financing of the purchase of our share capital of the LSE (see 5(b) below for calculation)

       (57.4 )

•   Loss on foreign currency option contracts purchased to hedge the foreign currency exposure on our acquisition bid:

    

Sale amount

   $ 65.3    

Book value

     (73.1 )     (7.8 )
                

•   Dividend income received from the LSE:

    

5/16/07 dividend per share

   £ 0.12    

Shares held

     x 61.3    

GBP exchange rate

     x 1.98       14.5  
                

•   Gain on sale of our share capital of the LSE:

    

Gross proceeds

   $ 1,784.2    

Cost basis

     (1,334.8 )  

Costs to sell

     (18.0 )     431.4  
                

•   Strategic initiative costs – these costs include direct acquisition costs, such as legal and advisory, in connection with our strategic initiative related to the LSE including our acquisition bid

       (26.5 )

See Note 5(e) for the tax impact of the above adjustments.

(b) The determination of the interest expense adjustment is as follows (in millions, except weighted-average interest rate):

 

     December 31,
2007
 

Weighted-Average Daily Balances

  

$825.0 million senior credit agreement

   $ 724.6  

$434.8 million secured term loan credit agreement

     333.5  

Weighted-Average Interest Rate

  

$825.0 million senior credit agreement

     7.13 %

$434.8 million secured term loan credit agreement

     7.13 %

Number of Days

     270  

Interest Expense (calculated on a 360 day convention)

  

$825.0 million senior credit agreement

     38.8  

$434.8 million secured term loan credit agreement

     17.8  

Amortized Financing Fees

  

$825.0 million senior credit agreement

     0.3  

$434.8 million secured term loan credit agreement

     0.5  

Total Interest Expense

  

$825.0 million senior credit agreement

     39.1  

$434.8 million secured term loan credit agreement

     18.3  
        
   $ 57.4  
        

 

20


Note 7. Integration Plan

NASDAQ OMX expects that in the period beginning twelve months following consummation of the PHLX acquisition, this acquisition will be accretive to stockholders, primarily as a result of technology cost savings and other synergies as follows:

 

 

Both parties believe the acquisition will create substantial value for shareholders, with net pre-tax annual synergies estimated at $51 million. Of this amount, $57 million constitutes estimated cost synergies and $(6) million estimated revenue synergies;

 

 

Cost synergies will be realized through the rationalization of IT systems and data centers, rationalization of non-IT functions, and reduced capital and procurement expenditure; and

 

 

Negative Revenue synergies will be realized due to the discontinuation of certain business units.

 

21